diff options
| -rw-r--r-- | .gitattributes | 3 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-8.txt | 8474 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-8.zip | bin | 0 -> 149518 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-h.zip | bin | 0 -> 455732 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-h/33939-h.htm | 10750 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-h/images/cover.jpg | bin | 0 -> 118225 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939-h/images/frontis.jpg | bin | 0 -> 178316 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939.txt | 8474 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | 33939.zip | bin | 0 -> 149499 bytes | |||
| -rw-r--r-- | LICENSE.txt | 11 | ||||
| -rw-r--r-- | README.md | 2 |
11 files changed, 27714 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6833f05 --- /dev/null +++ b/.gitattributes @@ -0,0 +1,3 @@ +* text=auto +*.txt text +*.md text diff --git a/33939-8.txt b/33939-8.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..f219726 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-8.txt @@ -0,0 +1,8474 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + +Title: Sturdy and Strong + How George Andrews Made His Way + +Author: G. A. Henty + +Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1 + +*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + + + + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + + + + + + + + + STURDY AND STRONG + + G. A. HENTY + + + [Illustration: "SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE, + TELLING THEM SEA STORIES."--_Frontispiece._ + _Sturdy and Strong._] + + + + STURDY AND STRONG + OR + _How George Andrews Made His Way_ + + BY + G. A. HENTY + + AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE IN INDIA," + "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH," + ETC., ETC., ETC. + + + NEW YORK + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY + PUBLISHERS + + + + +PREFACE. + + +Whatever may be said as to distinction of classes in England, it is +certain that in no country in the world is the upward path more open +to those who brace themselves to climb it than in our own. The +proportion of those who remain absolutely stationary is comparatively +small. We are all living on a hillside, and we must either go up or +down. It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who fixes his +eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb, and determines with all +his might and power to win his way towards the top, is sure to find +himself at the end of his day at a far higher level than when he +started upon his journey. It may be said, and sometimes foolishly is +said, that luck is everything; but in nineteen cases out of twenty +what is called luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of the +readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity to advantage. The +voyager must take every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he +would make a favorable journey; and for success in life it is +necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast, and true, but to have the +faculty of turning every opportunity to the best advantage; just as a +climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little shrub, every +projecting rock, as a hold for his hands or feet. George Andrews had +what may be called luck--that is, he had opportunities and took +advantage of them, and his rise in life was consequently far more +rapid than if he had let them pass without grasping them; but in any +case his steadiness, perseverance, and determination to get on would +assuredly have made their way in the long run. If similar qualities +and similar determinations are yours, you need not despair of similar +success in life. + + G. A. HENTY. + + + + +CONTENTS. + + + STURDY AND STRONG: PAGE + I. ALONE, 1 + II. TWO FRIENDS, 25 + III. WORK, 48 + IV. HOME, 74 + V. AN ADVENTURE, 97 + VI. FIRE! 117 + VII. SAVED! 142 + DO YOUR DUTY, 165 + SURLY JOE, 231 + A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM, 257 + + + + +STURDY AND STRONG. + + + + +CHAPTER I. + +ALONE. + + +"You heard what he said, George?" + +"Oh, mother, mother!" + +"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen it coming a long time, +and, hard as it seems, it will be better. There is no disgrace in it. +I have tried my best, and if my health had not broken down we might +have managed, but you see it was not to be. I shall not mind it, dear; +it is really only for your sake that I care about it at all." + +The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a white set face. + +"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I cannot keep you from +this. If we could only have managed for a year or two I could have +earned more then; but to think of you--you in the workhouse!" + +"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother said gently. "You see it +is not as if it were from any fault of ours. We have done our best. You +and I have managed for two years; but what with my health and my eyes +breaking down we can do so no longer. I hope it will not be for long, +dear. You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I shall soon be +able to be out again." + +"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought not to use your eyes for +months." + +"Even months pass quickly, George, when one has hope. I have felt this +coming so long that I shall be easier and happier now it has come. After +all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital, and it would not seem +so very dreadful to you my going into a hospital; the difference is only +in name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is kept up out of +subscriptions, the other from the rates." + +His mother's words conveyed but little comfort to George Andrews. He had +just come in from his work, and had heard what the parish doctor had +told his mother. + +"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews. You must have rest and +quiet for your eyes, and not only that, but you must have strengthening +food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is painful for you, I know. +I can well understand that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go +I won't answer for your life." + +"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly. "I know that it will be +best. It will be a blow to my boy, but I see no other way." + +"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the world, ma'am, you will do +as I advise you. I will go round in the morning and get you the order of +admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I will, if you like, +take you myself." + +"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes, I will be ready in the +morning, and I thank you for your offer." + +"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said briskly. "At ten +o'clock I will be here." + +Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries was a kind-hearted and +humane man. + +"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went downstairs, "it is hard for +her. It is easy to see that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but +what can I do for her! I might get her a little temporary help, but that +would be of no use--she is completely broken down with anxiety and +insufficient food, and unless her eyes have a long holiday she will lose +her sight. No, there's nothing else for it, but it is hard." + +It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor said, a lady. She had lost +both her parents while she was at school. She had no near relations, and +as she was sixteen when her mother died she had remained at school +finishing her education and teaching the younger children. Then she had +obtained a situation as governess in a gentleman's family, and two years +afterwards had married a young barrister who was a frequent visitor at +the house. + +Mr. Andrews was looked upon as a rising man, and for the first seven or +eight years of her marriage his wife's life had been a very happy one. +Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which he caught in one of the +midland towns while on circuit, and although he partially recovered he +was never himself again. His power of work seemed to be lost; a languor +which he could not overcome took possession of him. A troublesome cough +ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs. Andrews was a widow, and +her boy, then nine years old, an orphan. + +During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews had earned but +little in his profession. The comfortable house which he occupied had +been given up, and they had removed to one much smaller. But in spite +of this, debts mounted up, and when, after his death, the remaining +furniture was sold and everything settled, there remained only about +two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get some pupils among her +late husband's friends, but during the last two years she had lost +sight of many of these, and now met with but poor success among the +others. She was a quiet and retiring woman, and shrank from continuous +solicitations, and at the end of three years she found her little +store exhausted. + +Hitherto she had kept George at school, but could no longer do so, +and, giving up her lodging in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where +someone had told her that they thought she would have a better chance +of obtaining pupils, but the cards which some of the tradesmen allowed +her to put in the window led to no result, and finding this to be the +case she applied at one of the milliner's for work. This she obtained, +and for a year supported herself and her boy by needlework. + +From the time when George left school she had gone on teaching him his +lessons; but on the day when he was thirteen years old he declared +that he would no longer submit to his mother working for both of them, +and, setting out, called at shop after shop inquiring if they wanted +an errand-boy. He succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's +where he was to receive three shillings a week and his meals, going +home to sleep at night in the closet-like little attic adjoining the +one room which his mother could now afford. + +For a while they were more comfortable than they had been for some +time; now that his mother had no longer George to feed, her earnings +and the three shillings he brought home every Saturday night enabled +them to live in comparative ease, and on Sunday something like a feast +was always prepared. But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt her +eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and a dull aching pain +settled in the eyeballs. Soon she could only work for a short time +together, her earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers +presently told her that she kept the work so long in hand that they +could no longer employ her. There was now only George's three +shillings a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by the rent. +In despair she had applied to the parish doctor about her eyes. For a +fortnight he attended her, and at the end of that time had +peremptorily given the order of which she had told her son. + +To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must come. Piece by piece +every article of clothing she possessed, save those she wore, had been +pawned for food, and every resource was now exhausted. She was worn +out with the struggle, and the certainty of rest and food overcame her +repugnance to the house. For George's sake too, much as she knew he +would feel her having to accept such a refuge, she was glad that the +struggle was at an end. The lad had for the last six months suffered +greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat down at his +employer's seemed to choke him as he contrasted it with the fare to +which she was reduced, although, as far as possible, she had concealed +from him how sore was her strait. + +George cried himself to sleep that night, and he could scarce speak +when he said good-by to his mother in the morning, for he could not +tell when he should see her again. + +"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?" + +"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet what I shall do; but +please don't ask me to promise anything. You must let me do what I +think best. I have got to make a home for you when you are cured. I am +fourteen now, and am as strong as most boys of my age. I ought to be +able to earn a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings a +week, mother, and you just working a little, you know, so as not to +hurt your eyes, we ought to be able to do. Don't you bother about me, +mother. I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come out. When you +do, then I will do whatever you tell me; that's fair, isn't it?" + +Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he said: + +"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a year's character from +Dutton, so that if I can't get anything else to do I can get the same +sort of place again, and as I am a year older than I was when he took +me, and can tie up parcels neatly now, I ought to get a little more +anyhow. You see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never +grumbled, you know, mother--have I?--I think I would rather do +anything than be a grocer's boy. I would rather, when I grow up, be a +bricklayer's laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's work, +than be pottering about behind a counter, with a white apron on, +weighing out sugar and currants." + +"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews said with a sigh. "It's +natural, my boy. If I get my eyesight and my health again, when you +grow up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and you and I will +go out together to one of the colonies. It will be easier to rise +again there than here, and with hard work both of us might surely hope +to get on. There must be plenty of villages in Australia and Canada +where I could do well with teaching, and you could get work in +whatever way you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set that +before us. It will be something to hope for and work for, and will +cheer us to go through whatever may betide us up to that time." + +"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort indeed to have +something to look forward to. Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but +if anything could it would be some such plan as that." + +The last words he said to his mother as, blinded with tears, he kissed +her before starting to work, were: + +"I shall think of our plan every day, and look forward to that more +than anything else in the world--next to your coming to me again." + +At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews' humble lodging +in a brougham instead of his ordinary gig, having borrowed the +carriage from one of the few of his patients who kept such a vehicle, +on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for she was so weak and worn that he +was sure she would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the three +miles that had to be traversed. He managed in the course of his rounds +to pass the workhouse again in the afternoon, and brought George, +before he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf torn from his +pocketbook: + + "My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything is clean and + nice, and the doctor and people kind. Do not fret about + me.--Your loving mother." + +Although George's expressed resolution of leaving his present +situation, and seeking to earn his living in some other way, caused +Mrs. Andrews much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade him +from it. No doubt it would be wiser for him to stay in his present +situation, where he was well treated and well fed, and it certainly +seemed improbable to her that he would be able to get a better living +elsewhere. Still she could not blame him for wishing at least to try. +She herself shared to some extent his prejudice against the work in +which he was employed. There is no disgrace in honest work; but she +felt that she would rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than +as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed he could come +back again to Croydon, and, with a year's character from his present +employer, would probably be able to obtain a situation similar to that +which he now held. She was somewhat comforted, too, by a few words +the doctor had said to her during their drive. + +"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs. Andrews. He seems to me a +fine steady boy. If I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you +are away from him, I will." + +George remained for another month in his situation, for he knew that +it would never do to start on his undertaking penniless. At the end of +that time, having saved up ten shillings, and having given notice to +his employer, he left the shop for the last time, and started to walk +to London. It was not until he began to enter the crowded streets that +he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking. To be alone in London, +a solitary atom in the busy mass of humanity, is a trying situation +even for a man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying a penny +roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the niches of a bridge over +the river, and then kneeling up watched the barges and steamers +passing below him. + +Had it not been for his mother, his first thought, like that of most +English boys thrown on the world, would have been to go to sea; but +this idea he had from the first steadily set aside as out of the +question. His plan was to obtain employment as a boy in some +manufacturing work, for he thought that there, by steadiness and +perseverance, he might make his way. + +On one thing he was resolved. He would make his money last as long as +possible. Three penny-worth of bread a day would, he calculated, be +sufficient for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought he might manage +to sleep anywhere; it was summer time and the nights were warm. He had +no idea what the price of a bed would be, or how to set about getting +a lodging. He did not care how roughly he lived so that he could but +make his money last. The first few days he determined to look about +him. Something might turn up. If it did not he would set about getting +a place in earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and, keeping +straight on, found himself in Covent Garden, where he was astonished +and delighted at the quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers. + +Although he twice set out in different directions to explore the +streets, he each time returned to Covent Garden. There were many lads +of his own age playing about there, and he thought that from them he +might get some hints as to how to set about earning a living. They +looked ragged and poor enough, but they might be able to tell him +something--about sleeping, for instance. For although before starting +the idea of sleeping anywhere had seemed natural enough, it looked +more formidable now that he was face to face with it. + +Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market he bought two slices +of plum-pudding. He rather grudged the twopence which he paid; but he +felt that it might be well laid out. Provided with the pudding he +returned to the market, sat himself down on an empty basket, and began +to eat slowly and leisurely. + +In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own age watching him +greedily. + +He was far from being a respectable-looking boy. His clothes were +ragged, and his toes could be seen through a hole in his boot. He wore +neither hat nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been combed +since the day of his birth. There was a sharp, pinched look on his +face. But had he been washed and combed and decently clad he would not +have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate George liked his face better +than most he had seen in the market, and he longed for a talk with +someone. So he held out his other slice of pudding, and said: + +"Have a bit?" + +"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?" + +"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?" + +"No larks?" asked the boy. + +"No; no larks. Here you are." + +Feeling assured now that no trick was intended the boy approached, +took without a word the pudding which George held out, and, seating +himself on a basket close to him, took a great bite. + +"Where do you live?" George asked, when the slice of pudding had half +disappeared. + +"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand round. + +"I mean, where do you sleep?" + +The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place was included in +the general description of his domicile. + +"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired. + +"The beaks, they moves you on when they ketches you; but ef yer get +under a cart or in among the baskets you generally dodges 'em." + +"And suppose you want to pay for a place to sleep, where do you go and +how much do you pay?" + +"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a first-rate, fourpence. +Does yer want to find a crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his +companion. + +"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find some quiet place where I can +sleep, cheap, you know." + +"Out of work?" the boy inquired. + +"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present. I am looking for a +place, you know." + +"Don't know no one about?" + +"No; I have just come in from Croydon." + +The boy shook his head. + +"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said. "Why, yer'd get them +clothes and any money yet had walked off with the wery fust night." + +"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose, even for fourpence?" +George asked, making a rapid calculation that this would come to two +and fourpence per week, as much as his mother had paid for a +comparatively comfortable room in Croydon. + +The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his companion requiring a +room for himself. + +"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with yer!" + +"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just some place to sleep in. +Just some straw in any quiet corner." + +This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he thought the matter +over. + +"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place where they puts up the +hosses of the market carts. I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when +it's wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it warm and +comfortable just! I helps him with the hosses sometimes, and that's +why. I will ax him if yer likes." + +George assented at once. His ideas as to the possibility of sleeping +in the open air had vanished when he saw the surroundings, and a bed +in a quiet loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in a room +with twenty others. + +"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and what's your name?" + +"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather proudly; "but my real +name's Bill." + +"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George asked. + +"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands on me," Bill +replied. + +"But what do they want to lay hands on you for?" George asked. + +"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied calmly. + +"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?" George said, greatly shocked. + +"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied; "not wipes, yer +know, nor tickers, nor them kind of things. I aint never prigged +nothing of that kind." + +"Well, what is it then you do--prig?" George asked, mystified. + +"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes, onions sometimes, or +'taters. That aint regular prigging, you know." + +"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing," George said, after a +pause. + +"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all," the Shadow said +angrily. "Everyone as aint a fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no +one can't say as a apple and a ticker are the same." + +"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you see one is just as much +stealing as the other." + +"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the same as money and +t'other aint. I am hungry and I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint +the worse for it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here? Why, +there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is rotten. Well, it aint +no more if I takes one than if it was rotten. Is it now?" + +George thought there was a difference, but he did not feel equal to +explaining it. + +"The policemen must think differently," he said at last, "else they +wouldn't be always trying to catch you." + +"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously. "I don't; and I +don't want no more jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer +leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I? So now then." + +George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and moreover he saw that +in the event of a quarrel his chance of finding a refuge for the night +was small. In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he was +loath to break with the only acquaintance he had made. + +"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said; "only I was sorry to +hear you say you took things. It seems to me you might get into +trouble; and it would be better after all to work for a living." + +"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively. "Who's agoing to give me +work? Does yer think I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for +'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing about my character, I +suppose? nor where I had worked before? nor where my feyther lived? +nor nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming easy to get work +about here; only got to ax for it, that's all. Good wages and all +found, that's your kind." + +"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but it seems to me people +could get something to do if they tried." + +"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think we don't try! Why, we +are always trying to earn a copper or two. Why, we begins at three +o'clock in the morning when the market-carts come in, and we goes on +till they comes out of that there theater at night, just trying to +pick up a copper. Sometimes one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's a +good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner by the end of it. +Don't tell me! And now as to this ere stable; yer means it?" + +"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it." + +"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at nine o'clock. I will go +before that and square it with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking +of." + +"I had better give you something to give him," George said. "Will a +shilling do?" + +"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights. Are you going to trust +me with it?" + +"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure you wouldn't be so mean +as to do me out of it; besides, you told me that you never stole money +and those sort of things." + +"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob for all that," Bill +replied; "and yer are running a risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer +goes on with that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore yer've +done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going to bilk yer." + +The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of confidence on the part +of his companion really touched him, and as he went off he said to +himself, "He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so precious +green. I must look arter him a bit and see he don't get into no +mischief." + +George, on his part, as he walked away down into the Strand again, +felt that he had certainly run a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of +his capital to his new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner had +attracted him, and he felt that, although the Shadow's notions of +right and wrong might be of a confused nature, he meant to act +straight toward him. + +George passed the intervening hours before the time named for his +meeting in Covent Garden in staring into the shop windows in the +Strand, and in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles and foot +passengers flowing steadily out westward. He was nearly knocked under +the wheels of the vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to +the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused by the jostling +and pushing that he was glad to turn down a side street and to sit +down for a time on a doorstep. + +When nine o'clock approached he went into a baker's shop and bought a +loaf, which would, he thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself +and his companion. Having further invested threepence in cheese, he +made his way up to the market. + +The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling loudly. + +"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along. I have squared Ned, +and it's all right." + +He led the way down two or three streets and then stopped at a +gateway. + +"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as there aint no one but Ned +about." + +He returned in a minute. + +"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a hoss; he won't take no +notice of yer as yer pass. He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause +in case anyone comed and found yer up there he could swear he never +saw yer go in, and didn't know nothing about yer. I will go with yer +to the door, and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer whip +up that yer'll find it all right up there." + +"But you are coming too, aint you?" George asked. + +"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a chap like me up there. I +might pick yer pocket, yer know; besides I aint your sort." + +"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like to have you with me, Bill; +I should really. Besides, what's the difference between us? We have +both got to work for ourselves and make our way in the world." + +"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the way as I do; yer have +been brought up different. Don't tell me." + +"I may have been brought up differently, Bill. I have been fortunate +there; but now, you see, I have got to get my living in the best way I +can, and if I have had a better education than you have, you know ever +so much more about London and how to get your living than I do, so +that makes us quits." + +"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same to this child. So if +yer aint too proud, here goes." + +He led the way down a stable yard, past several doors, showing the +empty stalls which would be all filled when the market carts arrived. +At the last door on the right he stopped. George looked in. At the +further end a man was rubbing down a horse by the faint light of a +lantern, the rest of the stable was in darkness. + +"This way," Bill whispered. + +Keeping close behind him, George entered the stable. The boy stopped +in the corner. + +"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give yer a hand when yer +gets to the top." + +George stood quiet until his companion had mounted, and then ascended +the ladder, which was fixed against the wall. Presently a voice +whispered in his ear: + +"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your foot." + +In a minute he was standing in the loft. His companion drew him along +in the darkness, and in a few steps arrived at a pile of hay. + +"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer 'ave only to make +yourself comfortable there. Now mind you don't fall down one of the +holes into the mangers." + +"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he ensconced himself +in the hay. + +"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill said, as he left his +side, and directly afterwards a door opened and the light of a +gaslight in the yard streamed in. + +"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said as he rejoined him. +"I shuts it up afore I goes to sleep, 'cause the master he comes out +sometimes when the carts comes in, and there would be a blooming row +if he saw it open; but we are all right now." + +"That's much nicer," George said. "Now here's a loaf I brought with +me. We will cut it in half and put by a half for the morning, and eat +the other half between us now, and I have got some cheese here too." + +"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good sort, I could see that, +and I am pretty empty, I am, for I aint had nothing except that bit +of duff yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust then. 'Cept +for running against you I aint been lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job +nohows, and it aint for want of trying neither." + +For some minutes the boys ate in silence. George had given much the +largest portion to his companion, for he himself was too dead tired to +be very hungry. When he had finished, he said: + +"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning. I am so dead beat I can +scarcely keep my eyes open, so I will just say my prayers and go off +to sleep." + +"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment. "Do yer mean to say as +yer says prayers!" + +"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?" + +"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly; "don't know how, +don't see as it would do no good ef I did." + +"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I hope some day you will think +differently, and I will teach you some you will like." + +"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively. "A missionary chap, +he came and prayed with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not +make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same, so you see what +good did it do her?" + +But George was too tired to enter upon a theological argument. He was +already half asleep, and Bill's voice sounded a long way off. + +"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you in the morning," and in +another minute he was fast asleep. + +Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly over his companion; +then he closed the door of the loft and threw himself on the hay, and +was soon also sound asleep. When George woke in the morning the +daylight was streaming in through the cracks of the door. His +companion was gone. He heard the voices of several men in the yard, +while a steady champing noise and an occasional shout or the sound of +a scraping on the stones told him the stalls below were all full now. + +George felt that he had better remain where he was. Bill had told him +the evening before that the horses and carts generally set out again +at about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better wait till they had +gone before he slipped down below. Closing his eyes he was very soon +off to sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by his side looking +at him. + +"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said. "Why, it's nigh ten +o'clock, and it's time for us to be moving. Ned will be going off in a +few minutes, and the stables will be locked up till the evening." + +"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?" George asked. + +"No, we had better eat it when we get down to the market; come +along." + +George at once rose, shook the hay off his clothes, and descended the +ladder, Bill leading the way. There was no one in the stable, and the +yard was also empty. On reaching the market they sat down on two empty +baskets, and at once began to eat their bread and cheese. + + + + +CHAPTER II. + +TWO FRIENDS. + + +"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he had eaten a few +mouthfuls; "but you were out." + +"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to come in," Bill said, +"and a wery good morning I have had. One old chap gave me twopence for +looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into the market with his +flowers. But the best move was just now. A chap as was driving off +with flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect, by the look +of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't see it till I ran after him +with it, then he gave me a tanner; that was something like. Have yer +finished yer bread and cheese?" + +"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink of water if I could +get one." + +"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you come along with me, I +am agoing to stand two cups of coffee if yer aint too proud to take +it;" and he looked doubtfully at his companion. + +"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he saw that the +slightest hesitation would hurt his companion's feelings. + +"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a brightened look on +his face he turned and led the way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's +hot and sweet, and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny." + +George found the coffee really better than he had expected, and Bill +was evidently very much gratified at his expression of approval. + +"Now," he said, when they had both finished, "for a draw of 'baccy," +and he produced a short clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?" + +"No, I haven't begun yet." + +"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is," Bill said. "Why, when +yer are cold and hungry and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful +thing, and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer thirty pipes +if yer don't squeeze it in too hard. Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs +threepence halfpenny, so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a +penny; and now," he went on when he had filled and lit his pipe, +"let's know what's yer game." + +"You mean what am I going to do?" George asked. + +Bill nodded. + +"I want to get employment in some sort of works. I have been an +errand-boy in a grocer's for more than a year, and I have got a +written character from my master in my pocket; but I don't like the +sort of thing; I would rather work with my own hands. There are plenty +of works where they employ boys, and you know one might get on as one +gets older. The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of that +sort are." + +"There are lots of works at the East End, I have heard tell," Bill +said; "and then there's Clerkenwell and King's Cross, they aint so far +off, and there are works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but +I don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The only work as I have +done is holding hosses and carrying plants into the market, and +sometimes when I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out what I +got in _Echoes_, or _Globes_, or _Evening Standards_; that pays yer, +that does, for if yer can sell them all yer will get a bob for eight +penn'orth of papers, that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and +I calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out for a bob! +Oh, no, I should think not! Well, what shall it be? I knows the way +out to Whitechapel and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I can +show yer." + +"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try that first," George +said, "and I shall be much obliged to you for showing the way." + +The two boys spent the whole day in going from workshop to workshop +for employment; but the answers to his application were unvarying: +either he was too young or there was no place vacant. George took the +disappointment quietly, for he had made up his mind that he would have +difficulty in getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf +of his companion. + +"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A chap can pick up a few +coppers there, and here we have been a-tramping about all day and aint +done nothing." + +Day after day George set out on his quest, but all was without +success. He and Bill still slept in the loft, and after the first day +he took to getting up at the same time as his companion, and going out +with him to try and pick up a few pence from the men with the +market-carts. Every other morning they were able to lie later, as +there were only regular marketdays three mornings a week. + +On market mornings he found that he earned more than Bill, his better +clothes giving him an advantage, as the men were more willing to trust +their carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking boy +than to that of the arabs who frequented the Garden. But all that was +earned was laid out in common between the two boys, and George found +himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence on his private stock. +He had by this time told the Shadow exactly how much money he had, and +the boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting work, was +most averse to the store being trenched upon, and always gave his vote +against the smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread and +cheese being purchased, except from their earnings of the day. This +George felt was the more creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the +latter had, in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the petty +thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned his dry crusts. + +George had learned now what Bill knew of his history, which was little +enough. He supposed he had had a father, but he knew nothing of him; +whether he had died, or whether he had cut away and left mother, Bill +had no idea. His mother he remembered well, though she had died when +he was, as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in a hushed +voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior being. + +"We was poor, you know," he said to George, "and I know mother was +often short of grub, but she was just kind. I don't never remember her +whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she was good, she was. +She used to pray, you know, and what I remember most is as the night +afore she was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live honest, +Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't you take to stealing, +however poor you may be;' and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and +over again. "When I has seed any chap going along with a ticker handy, +which I could have boned and got away among the carts as safe as +ninepence, or when I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of +them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to bless myself with, and +perhaps nothing to eat all day, I have felt it hard not to make a +grab; but I just thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I +told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or out of the +baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as that was stealing, but as +you says it is, I aint going to do so no more. Now look yer here, +George; they tells me as the parsons says as when people die and they +are good they goes up there, yer know." + +George nodded, for there was a question in his companion's tone. + +"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there. Now it aint likely +as ever I should see her again, 'cause, you know, there aint nothing +good about me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I might be, and +was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been a-stealing?' do yer think she +would feel very bad about them 'ere apples and things?" + +"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see you didn't quite know that +was stealing, and you kept from stealing the things that you thought +she spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking even little +things you are not going to take them any more." + +"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said; "not if I never gets +another apple between my teeth." + +"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it, not only to please +your mother, but to please God. That's what my mother has told me over +and over again." + +"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest, "and did you use to prig +apples and sichlike sometimes?" + +"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but she was talking of +things in general. Of doing things that were wrong, such as telling +lies and deceiving, and that sort of thing." + +"And your mother thinks as God knows all about it?" + +George nodded. + +"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done bad?" + +George nodded again. + +"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill said in solemn wonder. +"Why, I heard a woman say last week as six children was enough to +worrit anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of us!" and +Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive way and repeated, "What a time +he must have of it!" + +For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill wondering over the +problem that had presented itself to him, and George trying to find +some appropriate explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had +started. At last he said: + +"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to you, for I am not +accustomed to talk about such things. My mother talks to me sometimes, +and of course I went to church regularly; but that's different from my +talking about it; but you know what we have got to do is to try and +please God, and love him because he loves us." + +"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've heard fellows say +beats 'em. If he loves a chap like me how is it he don't do something +for him? why don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint been +a-prigging apples or a-putting him out. That's what I wants to know." + +"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it would be very hard +to understand if this world were the only one; but you see we are only +here a little time, and after that there's on and on and on, right up +without any end, and what does it matter if we are poor or unhappy in +this little time if we are going to be ever so happy afterwards? This +is only a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were, and +if we do the best we can, even though that best is very little, then +you see we get a tremendous reward. For instance, you would not think +a man was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his horse on a cold +day, if he were going to give you enough to get you clothes and good +lodging for the rest of your life." + +"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so it's like that, is +it?" + +George nodded. "Like that, only more." + +"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in astonishment at this new +view of things. + +After that there were few evenings when, before they nestled +themselves down in the hay, the boys did not talk on this subject. At +first George felt awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the +generality of English boys, however earnest their convictions may be, +he was shy of speaking what he felt; but his companion's eagerness to +know more of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak, and +having in his bundle a small Bible which his mother had given him, he +took to reading to Bill a chapter or two in the mornings when they had +not to go out to the early market. + +It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled him. The boy saw +things in a light so wholly different from that in which he himself +had been accustomed to regard them that he found a great difficulty in +replying to them. + +George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her exactly what he was +doing, for he knew that if he only said that he had not yet succeeded +in getting work she would be very anxious about him, and although he +had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at least he could tell her that +he had sufficient to eat and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he +received replies from her, directed to him at a little coffee-house, +which, when they had had luck, the boys occasionally patronized. As +time went on without his succeeding in obtaining employment George's +hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate; "I will try for another +fortnight, Bill, and if at the end of that time I don't get anything +to do I shall go back to Croydon again." + +"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated. + +"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving, but that is all, +Bill. I came up to London in hopes of getting something to do by which +I might some day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this I +should be going down, and a nice sight I should be to mother if, when +she gets well enough to come out of the infirmary, I were to go back +all in rags." + +"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked. "Is there any chance of +picking up a living there? 'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I +goes with yer. I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we +might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer wouldn't mind that?" + +"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a good friend to me, and +I should be sorry to think of you all alone here." + +"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied. "I aint done +nothing except put yer in the way of getting a sleeping-place, and as +it's given me one too I have had the best of that job. It's been good +of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't know how to read or +write or nothing, and as aint no good anyway. But you will let me go +with yer to Croydon, won't yer?" + +"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to see much of me. I +shall have to get a place like the last. The man I was with said he +would take me back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am all +day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of course you would +have to be busy too at something." + +"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I can hold a hoss, but that +aint much for a living. One may go for days without getting a chance." + +"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would be to try and get +work either in a brickfield or with a market-gardener. At any rate we +should be able to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was +always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in work we could take +a room together." + +Bill shook his head. + +"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it, George. I knows as I +aint fit company for yer, and if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he +would think yer was going to run off with the money if he knew yer +kept company with a chap like me. No, the 'greement must be as yer +goes yer ways and I goes mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to +do up here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this place of +yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on getting work here." + +A week later the two boys were out late in Covent Garden trying to +earn a few pence by fetching up cabs and carriages for people coming +out from a concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded in +earning threepence, and had returned to the entrance to the hall, and +was watching the people come out, and trying to get another job. +Presently a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years old, came +out and took their place on the footpath. + +"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked. + +"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it." + +George fell back and stood watching the girl, who was in a white +dress, with a little hood trimmed with swansdown over her head. + +Presently his eye fell on something on which the light glittered as it +hung from her neck. Just as he was looking a hand reached over her +shoulder, there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child, then a +boy dived into the crowd, and at the same moment George dashed after +him. There was a cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab +at George as he dived through the crowd; but he slipped through them +and was soon in the roadway. + +Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy running. He turned up +Bow Street and then dashed down an alley. He did not know that he was +followed until suddenly George sprang upon his back, and the two fell +with a crash, the young thief undermost. George seized his right hand, +and kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and forced him to +open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise, and not knowing who was +his assailant, making but slight resistance. + +George seized the gold locket and dashed back at full speed into the +market, and was soon in the thick of the crowd round the entrance. The +gentleman was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking a note +of the description of the lost trinket. The girl was standing by +crying. + +"Here is your locket," George said, putting it into her hand. "I saw +the boy take it, and have got it from him." + +"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my locket again." + +"Why, where did you get it from?" her father asked in astonishment. + +"This boy has just given it to me," she replied. "He says he took it +from the boy who stole it." + +"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who brought it back?" + +The girl looked round, but George was gone. + +"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her father said. "Of course I +should wish to thank and reward him, for the locket was a very +valuable one, and the more so to us from its having belonged to your +mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?" + +"No, sir, I did not see him at all." + +"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?" + +"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied. "At least I +don't think so; but I only looked at his face. He didn't speak like a +poor boy at all." + +"Would you know him again?" + +"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking boy with a nice +face." + +"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my dear. Evidently he does +not want a reward, but at any rate I should have liked to thank him. +Are you always on this beat, policeman?" + +"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are on." + +"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables who are about here in +the daytime. I wish you would mention the fact to them, and ask them +if they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me this service, to +let me know. Here is a card with my name and address." + +After restoring the locket George made his way to the entrance to the +stables, where he generally met Bill after the theater had closed and +there was no farther chance of earning money. It was not till half an +hour later that the boy came running up. + +"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is something like luck. I got +three jobs. One stood me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence +each. What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee afore we turns +in?" + +"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence. We will put +that by, with the sixpence we saved the other day, for the hostler. We +haven't given him anything for some time. Your eightpence will get us +a good breakfast in the morning." + +When they had comfortably nestled themselves in the hay George told +his companion how he had rescued and restored the locket. + +"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd tell of such a scaly +trick as that. I should ha' said it ought to have been good for a bob +anyway." + +"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given the little girl her +locket I bolted." + +"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have waited to have seen what +the bloke meant to give yer?" + +"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as that," George replied. +"I don't mind being paid when I have done a job for anyone; but this +was different altogether." + +Bill meditated for a minute or two. + +"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last. "Yer did him a +good turn, and got the thing back. I dare say it were worth five bob." + +"A good deal more than that, Bill." + +"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have come down handsome. +Didn't yer run like winking, and didn't yer jump on the chap's back +and knock him down, and didn't yer run back again? And warn't there a +chance, ef one of the bobbies had got hold of yer collar and found it +in yer hand, of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer walks +off and don't give him a chance of giving yer nuffin. My eye, but yer +are a flat!" + +"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill. But when people do a +thing to oblige somebody, and not as a piece of regular work, they +don't expect to be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered +me money for such a thing." + +"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill rejoined; "but it +seems a rum sort of notion to me. When people loses things they +expects to pay to get 'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice +station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so much for giving +back things as is lost. I can't read 'em myself, yer know; but chaps +have read 'em to me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being +offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies coming out of +theayters, and I have often thought what a turn of luck it would be to +light on one of 'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the money +ef I found it." + +"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing and saw a reward +offered, and you wanted the money, you would have good right to take +it. But, you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at losing +her locket, and I went after it to please her, and I was quite content +that I got it back for her." + +Bill tried again to think the matter over in his mind, but he was +getting warm and sleepy, and in a few minutes was sound off. + +Two or three days later the lads had, to their great satisfaction, +obtained a job. Walnuts were just coming in, and the boys were engaged +to take off the green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he +had never before been taken on for such a job, and he considered it a +sort of promotion. Five or six women were also employed, and as the +group were standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly nudged his +friend: + +"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?" + +George looked up from his work and at once recognized the girl to whom +he had restored the locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment. + +"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if you brought me down to +the market I felt sure I should know the boy again if I saw him. +That's him, the one looking down into the basket. But he knew me +again, for I saw him look surprised when he noticed me." + +The gentleman made his way through the women to George. + +"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket to my daughter three +evenings ago?" + +"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked up. "I was standing +close by when the boy took it, so I gave chase and brought it back, +and that's all." + +"You were off again in such a hurry that we hadn't time to thank you. +Just come across to my daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for +a minute?" + +"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George said, and looking rather +shamefaced he followed the gentleman to the sidewalk. + +"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie." + +"I was sure I should know him again," the child said, "though I only +saw him for a moment. We are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and +me, because it had been mamma's locket, and we should have been very +sorry to have lost it." + +"I am glad I was able to get it back for you," George said; "but I +don't want to be thanked for doing it; and I don't want to be paid +either, thank you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his +hand into his pocket. + +"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise. "You have done me a +great service, and there is no reason why I should not pay you for it. +If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to get it back." + +"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all the same I would +rather not be paid for a little thing like that." + +"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said again. "One does not +expect to find a boy in the market here refusing money when he has +earned it." + +"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George said; "but I don't +call getting back a locket for a young lady who has lost it earning +money." + +"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a boy who has been brought +up in the market here." + +"I have only been here three months," George said. "I came up to +London to look for work, but could not get any. Most days I go about +looking for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's a chance." + +"What sort of work do you want? Have you been accustomed to any work? +Perhaps I could help you." + +"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George answered; "but I didn't +like it, and I thought I would rather get some sort of work that I +could work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking in a shop." + +"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman asked. + +"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an infirmary, and so as I +was alone I thought I would come to London and try to get the sort of +work I liked; but I have tried almost all over London." + +"And are you all alone here?" + +"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in that boy there, and we +have worked together since I came up." + +"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it you." + +"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently. + +"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some works down at Limehouse +and employ a good many boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card +from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of it, and handed it to +George. + +"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he will arrange for you +to begin work on Monday. Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the +fruit for to-morrow, you know." + +So saying he took his daughter's hand, and George, wild with delight, +ran off to tell Bill that he had obtained work for them both. + +"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?" + +"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa; didn't he look pleased? +Wasn't it funny his saying he wouldn't have any money?" + +"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal in Covent Garden; +but you were right, child, and you are a better judge of character +than I gave you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad, and +spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is really a very good style of +boy. Of course he is shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an +errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better brought up than +the generality of such lads. The one he called his friend looked a +wild sort of specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I should +say he was one of the regular arabs hanging about this place. If so, I +expect a very few days' work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be +surprised if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it." + +The next morning the two boys presented themselves at Mr. Penrose's +works at Limehouse. These were sawing and planing works, and the sound +of many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws innumerable, came +out through the open windows of the building as they entered the yard. + +"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said as he appeared at one of +the doors. + +"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I have a card for him from +Mr. Penrose." + +"I will let him know," the man replied. + +Two minutes later the foreman came out, and George handed him the +card. He read what Mr. Penrose had written upon it and said: + +"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay, eight shillings a week; +seven o'clock; there, that will do. Oh, what are your names?" taking +out a pocket-book. "George Andrews and William Smith;" and then, with +a nod, he went back into his room, while the boys, almost bewildered +at the rapidity with which the business had been arranged, went out +into the street again. + +"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in delight. + +"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more doubtful tone; "it's a +rum start, aint it? I don't expect I shall make much hand of it, but I +am wery glad for you, George." + +"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it? You are as strong as I am." + +"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed to work regular, and I +expect I shan't like it--not at first; but I am going to try. George, +don't yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort; still I +expects I shall get the sack afore long." + +"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once get accustomed to it, +and it's a thousand times better having to draw your pay regularly at +the end of the week than to get up in the morning not knowing whether +you are going to have breakfast or not. Won't mother be pleased when I +write and tell her I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said +that she was a great deal better, and the doctor thought she would be +out in the spring, and then I hope she will be coming up here, and +that will be jolly." + +"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it is; you and I will +get on fust-rate, but it aint likely as your mother would put up with +a chap like me." + +"My mother knows that you have been a good friend to me, Bill, and +that will be quite enough for her. You wait till you see her." + +"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about here!" Bill said, +"just all the same pattern; and how wide the streets is to what they +is up Drury Lane!" + +"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a room here, Bill, now +that we shall have money to pay for it; only think, we shall have +sixteen shillings a week between us!" + +"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen bob! My eye, there +aint no saying what it will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more +respectable," he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies of +his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden; but to go to work with a +lot of other chaps, these togs aint what you may call spicy." + +"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with a laugh. "We must see +what we can manage." + +George's own clothes were worn and old, but they looked respectable +indeed by the side of those of his companion. Bill's elbows were both +out, the jacket was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his +trousers were far too large for him, and were kept up by a single +brace, and were patched in a dozen places. + +When George first met him he was shoeless, but soon after they had set +up housekeeping together George had bought from a cobbler's stall a +pair of boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost +falling to pieces, were still the best part of Bill's outfit. + + + + +CHAPTER III. + +WORK. + + +The next morning George went out with the bundle containing his Sunday +clothes, which had been untouched since his arrival in town, and going +to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit of working clothes +in fair condition, and then returning hid his bundle in the hay and +rejoined Bill, who had from early morning been at work shelling +walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised at his companion not +beginning work at the usual time he asked no questions, for his faith +in George was so unbounded that everything he did was right in his +eyes. + +"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill," George said as +they reached their loft that evening. + +"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no doubt; but I expects it +aint mine by a long way. I have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and +I don't think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint fit to +go to such a place, and they are sure to make it hot for me." + +"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish sort of boys in +works of that sort, and you will soon be at home with the rest." + +"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the interruption, "I +shall be getting into some blooming row or other afore I have been +there a week, and they will like enough turn you out as well as me. +That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If they chucks me the +chances are as they chucks you too; and if they did that arter all the +pains you have had to get a place I should go straight off and make a +hole in the water. That's how I looks at it." + +"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance of your getting into +a row. Of course at first we must both expect to be blown up +sometimes, but if we do our best and don't answer back again we shall +do as well as the others." + +"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I am pretty well used to +getting blown up. Every one's always at it, and I know well enough as +it don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a market-cart +between you and a clear road for a bolt. I wasn't born yesterday. +Yer've been wery good to me, you have, George, and before any harm +should come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself under a +market-wagon." + +"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say, you have been a far +greater help to me than I have to you. Anyhow we are not going to part +now. You are coming to work with me to start with, and I know you will +do your best to keep your place. If you fail, well, so much the worse, +it can't be helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Penrose I +feel quite sure that the foreman would not turn me off even if he had +to get rid of you." + +"D'yer think so?" + +"I do, indeed, Bill." + +"Will yer take yer davey?" + +"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will take my davey that +I do not think that they would turn me off even if they sent you +away." + +"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help yer?" + +"Really and truly, Bill." + +"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer, it's 'cause yer wishes +me." + +So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and George soon heard by +his regular breathing that he was sound asleep. + +The next morning, before anyone was stirring, they went down into the +yard, as was their custom on Sunday mornings, for a good wash, +stripping to the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each other. +Bill had at first protested against the fashion, saying as he did very +well and did not see no use in it; but seeing that George really +enjoyed it he followed his example. After a morning or two, indeed, +and with the aid of a piece of soap which George had bought, Bill got +himself so bright and shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and +remark from his former companions, which led to more than one +pugilistic encounter. + +That morning George remained behind in the loft for a minute or two +after Bill had run down, attired only in his trousers. When Bill went +up the ladder after his ablutions he began hunting about in the hay. + +"What are you up to, Bill?" + +"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of yourn knocking about, but +I can't see where's mine, nor my jacket neither." + +"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find them, and even if +you found them you couldn't put 'em on. I have torn them up." + +"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation. "What lark are +yer up to now, George?" + +"No lark at all. We are going together to work to-morrow, and you +could not go as you were; so you put on that shirt and those things," +and he threw over the clothes he had procured the day before. + +Bill looked in astonishment. + +"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows yer only had four bob +with what we got yesterday. Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't--no, +in course yer didn't--nip 'em." + +"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said, laughing. "I swapped +my Sunday clothes for them yesterday. I can do without them very well +till we earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say anything +about it, Bill, else I will punch your head." + +Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute, and then threw +himself down in the hay and burst into tears. + +"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed. "What have you to cry +about?" + +"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed, "to find a chap +doing things for him like that? I wish I may die if I don't feel as if +I should bust. It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one +side; that's the wust of it." + +"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill; so don't let's say +anything more about it, but put on your clothes. We will have a cup of +coffee each and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will go +for a walk into the park, the same as we did last Sunday, and hear the +preaching." + +The next morning they were up at their accustomed hour and arrived at +the works at Limehouse before the doors were opened. Presently some +men and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the two boys followed +the others in. + +"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate asked. + +George gave their names, and the man looked at his time-book. + +"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You are to go into that +planing-shop," and he pointed to one of the doors opening into the +yard. + +The boys were not long before they were at work. Bill was ordered to +take planks from a large pile and to hand them to a man, who passed +them under one of the planing-machines. George was told to take them +away as fast as they were finished and pile them against a wall. When +the machines stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were to +sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags, in which they were +carried to the engine-house. + +For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the whirl of the machinery, +the rapid motion of the numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of +the broad bands which carried the power from them to the machinery on +the floor, by the storm of shavings which flew from the cutters, and +the unceasing activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving +an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone--for conversation in an +ordinary voice would have been inaudible--nothing occurred till the +bell rang at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery +suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded the din which had +prevailed. + +"How long have we got now?" George asked the man from whose bench he +had been taking the planks. + +"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried away. + +"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George asked when they had got +outside. + +"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill replied. "Why, talk +about the Garden! Lor', why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what +I was a-doing at first." + +"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you do and not touch any of +those straps and wheels and things. I know when I was at Croydon there +was a man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the strap; they +said it drew him up and smashed him against the ceiling. And now we +had better look out for a baker's." + +"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere handy?" + +"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we have no time to spare +to look for one. There's a pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of +water as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem very hard, Bill," +George said as they ate their bread. + +"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't for all them +rattling wheels. But I expect it aint going to be like that regular. +They've just gived us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be +worse presently." + +"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill, and I don't think we +shall find the work any harder. They don't put boys at hard work, but +just jobs like we are doing, to help the men." + +"What shall we do about night, George?" + +"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the man we work for. He +looks a good-natured sort of chap. He may know of someone he could +recommend us to." + +They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as they came out George +said to the man with whom they were working: + +"We want to get a room. We have been lodging together in London, and +don't know anyone down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of +some quiet, respectable people who have a room to let?" + +The man looked at George more closely than he had hitherto done. + +"Well, there aint many people as would care about taking in two boys, +but you seem a well-spoken young chap and different to most of 'em. Do +you think you could keep regular hours, and not come clattering in and +out fifty times in the evening, and playing tom-fools' tricks of all +sorts?" + +"I don't think we should be troublesome," George said; "and I am quite +sure we shouldn't be noisy." + +"You would want to be cooked for, in course?" + +"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond hot water for a cup of +tea in the evening, we should not want much cooking done, especially +if there is a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in the +morning." + +"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?" + +George looked puzzled. + +"I mean bed and chairs, and so on." + +George shook his head. + +"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't any now." + +"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows. I have got a bedroom in +my place empty. A brother of mine who lodged and worked with me has +just got a job as foreman down in the country. At any rate I will try +you for a week, and if at the end of that time you and my missis don't +get on together you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that will +about suit you?" + +George said that would suit very well, and expressed his thanks to the +man for taking them in. + +They had been walking briskly since they left the works, and now +stopped suddenly before the door of a house in a row. It was just like +its neighbor, except that George noticed that the blinds and windows +were cleaner than the others, and that the door had been newly painted +and varnished. + +"Here we are," the man said. "You had best come in and see the missis +and the room. Missis!" he shouted, and a woman appeared from the +backroom. "I have let Harry's room, mother," he said, "and these are +the new lodgers." + +"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't mean to say that you let +the room to them two boys. I should have thought you had better sense. +Why, they will be trampling up and down the stairs like young hosses, +wear out the oil cloth, and frighten the baby into fits. I never did +hear such a thing!" + +"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't give much trouble. At +any rate I have agreed to try them for a week, and if you don't get +on with them at the end of that time, of course they must go. They +have only come to work at the shop to-day; they work with me, and as +far as I can see they are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads, +I will show you your room." + +It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the house, over the +kitchen, which was built out there. It was a comfortable little room, +not large, but sufficiently so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest +of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a strip of carpet +ran alongside the bed, and there was, moreover, a small fireplace. + +"Will that do for you?" the man asked. + +"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;" while Bill was so +taken aback by its comfort and luxury that he was speechless. + +"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If you have got any +things you can bring 'em in when you like." + +"We have not got any to speak of," George said, flushing a little. "I +came up from the country three months ago to look for work, and beyond +odd jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything I had is +pretty well gone; but I can pay a week's rent in advance," he said, +putting his hand in his pocket. + +"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as you work in the shop +it's safe enough. Now I must get my dinner, else I shall be late for +work." + +"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George asked as they left the +house. + +"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it nice just! Why, yer +couldn't get a room like that, not furnished, anywhere near the +market, not at four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if the +house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down every day! What a +woman that must be for washing!" + +"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and make as little +mess as we can in going in and out." + +"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to me as if it could be +true as we're to have such a room as that to ourselves, and to walk +into a house bold without being afraid as somebody would have his eye +on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week for grub regular." + +"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill; pretty near half our +time must be gone, and mind we must be very saving at first. There +will be several things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot, +and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a gridiron for frying +rashers of bacon upon." + +"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in. + +"And we shall want some towels," George went on with his enumeration. + +"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they like?" + +"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face after you have +washed." + +"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of course we must get 'em; +but I've always found my hands dried quick enough by themselves, +especially if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers." + +"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I want to save every +penny we can, so as to get some things to furnish two rooms by the +time mother comes out." + +"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly, though a slight shade +passed over his face at the thought that they were not to be always +alone together. "Well, yer know, George, I am game for anythink. I can +hold on with a penn'orth of bread a day. I have done it over and over, +and if yer says the word I am ready to do it again." + +"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed. "Still, we must live +as cheap as we can. We will stick to bread for breakfast, and bread +and cheese for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a rasher +as a great treat. At any rate we will try to live on six shillings a +week." + +"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently; "and then two +shillings for rent, and that will leave us eight shillings a week to +put by." + +"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she would be able to come +out 'til the spring. We are just at the beginning of November, so if +she comes out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two +weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings, let me see. That's eight +pounds in twenty weeks, eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would +furnish two rooms very well, I should think." + +"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for to his mind eight +pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of sum, and the fact that his +companion had been able to calculate it increased if possible his +admiration for him. + +It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs. Grimstone to her new +lodgers. + +"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of the week to a +neighbor, "as two boys could have been that quiet. They comes in after +work as regular as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat, and +you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't hear no more of 'em +till they goes out agin in the morning. They don't come back here to +breakfast or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing like." + +"But what do they do with themselves all the evening, Mrs. Grimstone?" + +"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can hear a voice going +regular over the kitchen." + +"And how's their room?" + +"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't lock the door when they +goes out, and I looked in yesterday, expecting to find it like a +pigsty; but they had made the bed afore starting for work, and set +everything in its place, and laid the fire like for when they come +back." + +Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended six pence in as many +old books at a bookstall. One of them was a spelling-book, and he had +at once set to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first +protested. "He had done very well without reading, and didn't see much +good in it." However, as George insisted he gave way, as he would have +done to any proposition whatever upon which his friend had set his +mind. So for an hour every evening after they had finished tea Bill +worked at his letters and spelling, and then George read aloud to him +from one of the other books. + +"You must get on as fast as you can this winter, Bill," he said; +"because when the summer evenings come we shall want to go for long +walks." + +They found that they did very well upon the sum they agreed on. Tea +and sugar cost less than George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in +for them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for tea they were +generally able to afford a bloater between them, or a very thin rasher +of bacon. Their enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed +frequently protested that they were spending too much money; but +George said as long as they kept within the sum agreed upon, and paid +their rent, coal, candles, and what little washing they required out +of the eight shillings a week, they were doing very well. + +They had by this time got accustomed to the din of the machinery, and +were able to work in comfort. Mr. Penrose had several times come +through the room, and had given them a nod. After they had been there +a month he spoke to Grimstone. + +"How do those boys do their work?" + +"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys we have ever had. No +skylarking about, and I never have to wait a minute for a plank. They +generally comes in a few minutes before time and gets the bench +cleared up. They are first-rate boys. They lodge with me, and two +quieter and better-behaved chaps in a house there never was." + +"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am interested in them, +and am pleased to hear so good an account." + +That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went to get their money +they received ten shillings apiece. + +"That's two shillings too much," George said as the money was handed +to them. + +"That's all right," the foreman said. "The governor ordered you both +to have a rise." + +"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What do you think of that, +George? Four bob a week more to put by regularly. How much more will +that make by the time your mother comes?" + +"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other will be enough. This +four shillings a week we will put aside at present for clothes. We +want two more shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall +want some shoes before long, and another suit of clothes each. We must +keep ourselves decent, you know." + +From the time when they began work the boys had gone regularly every +Sunday morning to a small iron church near their lodging, and they +also went to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too, at home +was often on religion, for Bill was extremely anxious to learn, and +although his questions and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he +was always ready to explain things as far as he could. + +February came, and to George's delight he heard, from his mother that +she was so much better that the doctor thought that when she came out +at the end of April she would be as strong as she had ever been. Her +eyes had benefited greatly by her long rest, and she said that she was +sure she should be able to do work as before. She had written several +times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing her great pleasure +at hearing that George was so well and comfortable. At Christmas, the +works being closed for four days, George had gone down to see her, and +they had a delightful talk together. Christmas had indeed been a +memorable occasion to the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had +left a basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews." The boys had +prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting of some fine rashers of +bacon and sixpenny-worth of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and +had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs. Grimstone had that +afternoon invited them to dine downstairs. George was reading from a +book which he bought for a penny that morning when there was a knock +at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone said: + +"Here is a hamper for you, George." + +"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment, opening the door. +"Why, whoever could have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake." + +"That's your name on the direction, anyhows," Mrs. Grimstone said. + +"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George agreed, and at once began +to unknot the string which fastened down the lid. + +"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he shouted. He turned it over. +On the back were the words: + +"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose." + +"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a husky voice; and indeed +it was the kindness that prompted the gift rather than the gift itself +that touched him. + +"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never mind that there card, +let's see what's inside." + +The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain a cold goose, a +Christmas pudding, and some oranges and apples. These were all placed +on the table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill executed a +war-dance in triumph and delight. + +"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as he sat down +exhausted. "There's a Christmas dinner for yer! Why, it's like them +stories of the genii you was a-telling me about--chaps as come +whenever yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought a tuck-out or +whatever yer asked for. Of course that wasn't true; yer told me it +wasn't, and I shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere +is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was right and what I +said was wrong. I thought yer were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take +nothing for getting back that there locket, and now yer see what's +come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas dinner fit for a +king. Now what are we going to do with it, 'cause yer know we dines +with them downstairs to-morrow?" + +"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered, "will be to +invite all of them downstairs, Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three +young uns, to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after, because +I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but say the evening after." + +"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking round the room. + +"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I dare say they will let +us have the feed in their parlor. There will be nothing to get, you +know, but some bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs. Grimstone +don't take it, so we must have plenty of tea." + +"I should like some beer too, just for once, George, with such a +blow-out as that." + +"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You know we agreed that we +wouldn't take beer. If we begin it once we shall want it again, so we +are not going to alter from what we agreed to. We see plenty of the +misery which drink causes all round and the way in which money is +wasted over it. I like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I +get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with my dinner +regularly, though I won't do even that if I find it makes me want to +take more; but anyhow at present we can do without it." + +Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and the supper two nights +afterwards came off in due course, and were both most successful. + +The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter of some trouble to +George, but he had finally bought a pretty New Year's card and had +written on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George Andrews," and +had sent it to the daughter of his employer. + +At the beginning of April George had consulted Grimstone and his wife +as to the question of preparing a home for his mother. + +"How much would two rooms cost?" he had asked; "one a good-sized one +and the other the same size as ours." + +"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs. Grimstone replied. + +"And supposing we had a parlor and two little bedrooms?" + +"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say," Mrs. Grimstone +replied. + +"And how much for a whole house?" + +"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings a week, but you +might get one without the kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six +shillings." + +"That would be much the nicest," George said, "only it would cost such +a lot to furnish it." + +"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs. Grimstone suggested. +"Just a kitchen and two bedrooms for a start, and you can put things +into the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when we first +married. But you must have some furniture." + +"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and two bedrooms?" + +"Of course going cheaply to work and buying the things secondhand, I +should say I could pick up the things for you, so that you could do +very well," Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds." + +"That will do capitally," George said, "for by the end of this month +Bill and I will have more than ten pounds laid by." + +"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed in astonishment. "Do +you mean to say you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?" + +"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife put in. + +"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!" + +"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I am sure Bill is a stone +heavier than when he came here." + +"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit," Bob Grimstone said. +"It isn't every boy, by a long way, would stint himself as you must +have done for the last five months to make a comfortable home for his +mother, for I know lots of men who are earning their two quid a week +and has their old people in the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that +if I or the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a house we +shall be right down glad." + +"Thank you," George said. "We will look about for a house, and when we +have fixed on one if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for us I +shall be much obliged, for I don't think landlords would be inclined +to let a house to two boys." + +"All right, George! we will do that for you with pleasure. Besides, +you know, there are things, when you are going to take a house, that +you stand out for; such as papering and painting, or putting in a new +range, and things of that sort." + +After their dinner on the following Sunday the two boys set out +house-hunting. + +"If it's within a mile that will do," George said. "It doesn't matter +about our going home in the breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a +basket and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do; but if +it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get there and back for +dinner. Still there are plenty of houses in a mile." + +There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular rows, bare and +hard-looking, but George wanted to find something more pleasant and +homelike than these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he +wanted. It was just about a mile from the works and beyond the lines +of regular streets. Here he found a turning off the main road with but +eight houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the man who +built them had intended to run a street down for some distance, but +had either been unable to obtain enough ground or had changed his +mind. + +They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front, with a bow-window +and little portico. They appeared to be inhabited by a different class +to those who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the +gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and spotless, muslin +curtains hung in the windows, and fancy tables with pretty ornaments +stood between them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the left-hand +side, was to let. + +"What do you think of this, Bill?" + +"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the rent, George? I +should think they were awful dear." + +"I don't suppose they are any more than the houses in the rows, Bill. +They are very small, you see, and I don't suppose they would suit +workmen as well as the others; at any rate we will see." + +Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of paper the name of the agent +of whom inquiry was to be made. + +"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the street? Oh, there it is. +Laburnum Villas. No. 8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate, +doesn't it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the agent +to-morrow." + +This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she was asked. After +speaking to her husband she said, "I will get the key from the agent's +and will be there just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there +straight when you get out you will be able to see the rooms and what +state it's in." + +"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked. + +"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will set it out for him +before I start." + +"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you very much. It would be +just the thing." + +Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the following day the two +boys arrived breathless at No. 8 Laburnum Villas. + +"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs. Grimstone at the window." + +The door was opened and they rushed in. + +"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said; "and it's in good +order and won't want any money laying out upon it." + +The house was certainly small, but the boys were delighted with it. On +the ground-floor were two little rooms opening with folding doors, +and a little kitchen built out behind. There was a room over this, and +two rooms above the sitting rooms. + +"That's just the right number," George said, "a bedroom each for us; +it couldn't be nicer; and what pretty paper!" + +"And there is a good long slip of garden behind," Mrs. Grimstone said, +"where you could grow lots of vegetables. Of course in the front you +would have flowers." + +"And how much do they want for it?" + +"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and taxes. I call it dear +for its size, but then of course it's got the garden and it looks +pretty and nice. The agent says it's been painted and papered from top +to bottom since the last people left, but he says the owner won't let +it unless somebody comes who is likely to stop, and he will want +references of respectability." + +"All right!" George said; "I can manage that," for he had already been +thinking of the question in his mind; "and we can manage seven and +sixpence a week; can't we, Bill?" + +"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he was as much pleased +with the cottage as George was. + +They explored the garden behind the house. This was about a hundred +feet long by twenty-five wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a +plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and had evidently +been dug up by the last tenants ready for planting. + +"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow all our own potatoes +here!" George exclaimed in delight. + +Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head. + +"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if you gave it all up to +potatoes; but if you planted the further end with potatoes you might +get a good many, and then, you know, at this end you might have three +or four rows of peas and French beans, and lettuces and such like, but +you will have to get some manure to put in. Things won't grow without +manure even in the country, and I am sure they won't here; and then +you know you can have flowers in the front of the house. But it's time +for you to be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure it's +more than half an hour since you came in. I will take the key back and +tell them they shall have an answer by Wednesday or Thursday." + +George did not think they could have been a quarter of an hour; +however, he and Bill started at a trot, which they increased into a +run at the top of their speed when the first clock they saw pointed to +seven minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached the +works; it stopped when they were within fifty yards, and the gate was +just closing as they rushed up. + +"Too late," the man said. + +"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's the first time we +have ever been late, and we have run a mile to be here in time!" + +"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the gate a few inches to +look through. "Ah, well I will let you in this time, 'cause you are +well-behaved young chaps; but don't you run it so close another time, +else you will have to lose your hour." + + + + +CHAPTER IV. + +HOME. + + +That evening George wrote a letter to Dr. Jeffries at Croydon, saying +that he had taken a little house for his mother to come to when she +came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said that he would +render her help if he could, would he be good enough to write to the +agent whose address he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was about +taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person of respectability. + +The following evening he received a letter from the doctor saying that +he had written to the agent, and that he was glad indeed to hear that +George was getting on so well that he was able to provide a home for +his mother. + +On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone handed George a key. + +"There you are, George. You are master of the house now. The agent +said the reference was most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and +sixpence you gave me for a week's rent in advance, and you can go in +when you like. We shall be sorry to lose you both, for I don't want +two better lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has been quiet +and pleasant in the house; and to think what a taking I was in that +day as Bob brought you here for the first time, to think as he had let +the room to two boys. But there, one never knows, and I wouldn't have +believed it as boys could be so quiet in a house." + +"Now we must begin to see about furniture," Bob Grimstone said. "The +best plan, I think, will be for you two to go round of an evening to +all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just what you think +will suit you. You put down the prices stuck on them, and just what +they are, and then the missis can go in the morning and bargain for +them. She will get them five shillings in the pound cheaper than you +would. It's wonderful how women do beat men down, to be sure. When a +man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves it or takes it just as +he likes, but a woman begins by offering half the sum. Then the chap +says no, and she makes as if she was going away; he lets her go a +little way and then he hollers after her, and comes down a goodish bit +in the price. Then she says she don't particularly want it and +shouldn't think of giving any such price as that. Then he tries again, +and so they gets on till they hit on a figure as suits them both. You +see that little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just three weeks +buying that caddy. The chap wanted seven and six for it, and she +offered him half a crown. He came down half a crown at the end of the +first week, and at last she got it for three and nine. Now, the first +thing you have got to do is to make out a list. First of all you have +got to put down the things as you must have, and then the things you +can do without, though you will get them if you can afford it. Mother +will help you at that." + +So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with paper and a pencil, and +George was absolutely horrified at the list of things which Mrs. +Grimstone declared were absolutely indispensable. However, after much +discussion, some few items were marked as doubtful. When the list was +finished the two boys started on an exploring expedition, and the next +week all their evenings were fully occupied. In ten days after they +began the three bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly +furnished, Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand at bargaining, and +making the ten pounds go farther than George had believed possible. On +the Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to inspect the house. + +"It's a very comfortable little place," he said, "and that front +bedroom with the chintz curtains the missis made up is as nice a +little room as you want to see. As to the others they will do well +enough for you boys." + +The only articles of furniture in the sitting room were two long +muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone had bought a bargain at a shop +selling off; for it was agreed that this was necessary to give the +house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone was so much pleased at +what had been done that he shared George's feeling of regret that one +of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished, and on the walk home +said: + +"Look here, George. I know you would like to have the house nice for +your mother. You couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable +not under a five-pound note, not even with the missis to market for +you, but you might for that. I have got a little money laid by in the +savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and welcome, if you +like to take it. I know it will be just as safe with you as it will be +there." + +"Thank you very much, Bob--thank you very much, but I won't take it. +In the first place, I should like mother to know that the furniture is +all ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and in the next +place, I should find it hard at first to pay back anything. I think we +can just manage on our money, but that will be all. I told you mother +does work, but she mayn't be able to get any at first, so we can't +reckon on that. When she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to +buy the furniture." + +"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man said after a pause. +"You would have been welcome to the money: but perhaps you are right +not to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first went into +housekeeping, and it took a wonderful trouble to pay off, and if +there's illness or anything of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I +should be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me, but it would +worry you." + +A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary, and on Saturday +George asked for a day off to go down to fetch her. Every evening +through the week he and Bill had worked away at digging up the garden. +Fortunately there was a moon, for it was dark by the time they came +out from the works. Bill was charged with the commission to lay in the +store of provisions for the Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a +capital fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which George +calculated he would be back. + +Very delighted was George as in his best suit--for he and Bill had two +suits each now--he stepped out of the train at Croydon and walked to +the workhouse. His mother had told him that she would meet him at the +gate at half-past two, and punctually at the time he was there. A few +minutes later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as he had seen her at +Christmas, in the infirmary garb, but in her own clothes. George gave +a cry of delight as he ran forward to meet her. + +"My darling mother! and you are looking quite yourself again." + +"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a long nine months, but the +rest and quiet have done wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind; +and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you had got work that you +liked helped me to get strong again. And you are looking well too; and +your friend, I hope he is well?" + +"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about you. He is glad you +are coming because I am glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up +his mind that you won't like him and you won't think him a fit +companion for me. I told him over and over again that you are not that +sort; but nothing can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't talk +good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions; but he is very much +changed in that way since I first knew him, and he tries very hard, +and don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he is beginning to +read easy words quite well; and he is one of the best-hearted fellows +in the world." + +"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you, that's enough for me," +Mrs. Andrews said; "but I have no doubt I shall soon like him for +himself. You could not like him as much as you do if there were not +something nice about him. And you have succeeded in getting a room for +me in the house in which you lodge?" for George had never mentioned a +word in his letter about taking a house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if +he should see his mother to say nothing to her about his application +to him. + +"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied briskly. + +"And you have got some new clothes since I saw you last, George. You +wanted them; yours were getting rather shabby when I saw you at +Christmas." + +"Yes, mother, they were." + +"I suppose you had to part with your best suit while you were so long +out of work?" + +"That was it, mother; but you see I have been able to get some more +things. They are only cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well +until I can afford better ones. I am not walking too fast for you, am +I? But we shall just catch the train. Or look here, would you mind +going straight by yourself to the railway station? Then you can walk +slowly. I will go round and get your box. I went into our old place as +I came along, and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs for +me as I came back." + +"No, I would rather go round with you, George. I want to thank her for +having kept it for me so long. Even if we do miss the train it will +not matter much, as it will make no difference whether we get in town +an hour earlier or later." + +As George could not explain his special reason for desiring to catch +that train he was obliged to agree, and they stopped a quarter of an +hour at their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon their having +a cup of tea which she had prepared for them. However, when they +reached the station they found that a train was going shortly, and +when they reached town they were not so very much later than George +had calculated upon. + +They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews' box was not heavy, it was +too much for George to carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews +herself was tired from her walk to the station from the infirmary, +having had no exercise for so long. When they got into the +neighborhood of Limehouse George got outside to direct the cabman. It +was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up at No. 8 Laburnum +Villas. + +"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked in surprise as George +jumped down and opened the door. "Why, you told me in one of your +letters it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place! It is +really here, George?" + +"It is here, mother; we moved the other day. There is Bill at the +door;" but Bill, having opened the door, ran away out into the garden, +and George, having paid the cabman, carried his mother's box in and +entered the house with her. + +"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the end." + +"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews said as she entered it; +"and tea all laid and ready! What, have they lent you the room for +this evening?" + +"My dear mother," George said, throwing his arms round her neck, +"this is your kitchen and your house, all there is of it, only the +sitting room isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you know." + +"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy! that is very nice; but +can we afford it, George? It seems too good to be true." + +"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear little house, and +will be splendid when we have got it all furnished. Now come up and +see the bedrooms. This is Bill's, you know," and he opened the door on +the staircase, "and this is mine, and this is yours." + +"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews said: "but, my dear +George, the rent of this house and the hire of the furniture will +surely be more than we can afford to pay. I know what a good manager +you are, my boy, but I have such a horror of getting into debt that it +almost frightens me." + +"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a week, mother, with +rates and taxes, and we can afford that out of Bill's earnings and +mine, even if you did not do any work at all; and as to the furniture, +it is every bit paid for out of our savings since we went to work." + +On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms round George's neck and +burst into tears of happiness. She was not very strong, and the +thought of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to get a +house together for her completely overpowered her. + +"It seems impossible, George," she said when she had recovered +herself. "Why, you have only been earning ten shillings a week each, +and you have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and all sorts of +things; it seems impossible." + +"It has not cost so much as you think, mother, and Bill and I had both +learned to live cheap in Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs; +you have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be ready." + +But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to go out into the garden +to fetch him. + +"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything. She won't eat +you, you know." + +"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will think me an out-and-out +sort of 'ottentot," which word had turned up in a book the boys had +been reading on an evening previously. + +"Well, wait till she says so; come along." + +So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him along, and brought him +shamefaced and bashful into the kitchen. + +"This is Bill, mother." + +"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said, holding out her hand. +"I have heard so much of you from George that I seem to know you quite +well." + +Bill put his hand out shyly. + +"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs. Andrews went on. "I +shall never forget that you were a friend to my boy when he was +friendless in London." + +"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said eagerly; "don't you go +for to think it. Why, just look what George has done for me! There was +I, a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving, and sure to get +quadded sooner or later; and now here I am living decent, and earning +a good wage; and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know about +things, and aint been ashamed of me, though I am so different to what +he is. I tell you, ma'am, there aint no saying what a friend he's been +to me, and I aint done nothing for him as I can see." + +"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other something," Mrs. Andrews +said: "and I owe you something as well as my son, for George tells me +that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own that I owe this +delightful surprise of finding a home ready for me; and now," she went +on, seeing how confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you two +ought to make tea this evening, for you are the hosts, and I am the +guest. In future it will be my turn." + +"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair; Bill, you do the +rashers, and I will pour the water into the pot and then toast the +muffins." + +Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as they had hitherto +attempted had generally fallen to his share, as he had a greater +aptitude for the work than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a +turn was soon upon the table. + +Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely, and was pleased with the +result of her observation. Bill was indeed greatly improved in +appearance since he had first made George's acquaintance. His cheeks +had filled out, and his face had lost its hardness of outline; the +quick, restless, hunted expression of his eyes had nearly died out, +and he no longer looked as if constantly on the watch to dodge an +expected cuff; his face had always had a large share of that merriment +and love of fun which seem the common portion of the London arabs, and +seldom desert them under all their hardships; but it was a happier and +brighter spirit now, and had altogether lost its reckless character. A +similar change is always observable among the waifs picked up off the +streets by the London refuges after they have been a few months on +board a training ship. + +When all was ready the party sat down to their meal. Mrs. Andrews +undertook the pouring out of the tea, saying that although she was a +guest, as the only lady present she should naturally preside. George +cut the bread, and Bill served the bacon. The muffins were piled on a +plate in the front of the fire as a second course. + +It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the three had ever sat +down to. Mrs. Andrews was not only happy at finding so comfortable a +home prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of pride and +thankfulness at the evidence of the love, steadiness, and +self-sacrifice of her son. George was delighted at having his mother +with him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment at the +home he had prepared for her. Bill was delighted because George was +so, and he was moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews less +terrible than he had depicted her. + +After tea was cleared away they talked together for a while, and then +Bill--feeling with instinctive delicacy that George and his mother +would like to talk together for a time--said he should take a turn for +an hour, and on getting outside the house executed so wild a war-dance +of satisfaction that it was fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas +would have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle. + +"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews said when she was +alone with George. "I was sure from what you told me that he must be a +good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been, poor boy, I feared a +little that he would scarcely be a desirable companion in point of +manners. Of course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar; but +his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice, considering all." + +"Look what an example he's had, mother," George laughed; "but really +he has taken great pains ever since he knew that you were coming +home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything he does which is +not right, especially about eating and that sort of thing. You see he +had never used a fork till we came down here, and he made me show him +directly how it should be held and what to do with it. It has been +quite funny to me to see him watching me at meals, and doing exactly +the same." + +"And you have taught him to read, George?" + +"Yes, mother." + +"And something of better things, George?" she asked. + +"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't know anything when I met +him; but he goes to church with me now regularly, and says his prayers +every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it. More, I think, +than I ever did," he added honestly. + +"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you have done him, George." + +"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When you see a chap so very +earnest for a thing you can't help being earnest yourself; besides, +you know, mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had not been +accustomed to talk much of these matters with his mother--"you see +when one's down in the world and hard up, and not quite sure about the +next meal, and without any friend, one seems to think more of these +things than one does when one is jolly at school with other fellows." + +"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know why it should be so, for the +more blessings one has the more reason for love and gratitude to the +giver. However, dear, I think we have both reason to be grateful now, +have we not?" + +"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference since we said +good-by to each other last summer! Now here you are strong and well +again, and we are together and don't mean to be separated, and I have +got a place I like and have a good chance of getting on in, and we +have got a pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be able +to live a little like a lady again,--I mean as you were accustomed +to,--and everything is so nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every +reason to be grateful!" + +"We have indeed, George, and I even more than you, in the proofs you +have given me that my son is likely to turn out all that even I could +wish him." + +Bill's hour was a very long one. + +"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to get out of our way," Mrs. +Andrews said when he returned, "else I shall think that I am in your +way. It was kind of you to think of it the first evening, and George +and I are glad to have had a long talk together, but in future I hope +you won't do it. You see there will be lots to do of an evening. There +will be your lessons and George's, for I hope now that he's settled he +will give up an hour or two every evening to study. Not Latin and +Greek, George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something like +dismay in George's face, "that will be only a waste of time to you +now, but a study of such things as may be useful to you in your +present work and in your future life, and a steady course of reading +really good books by good authors. Then perhaps when you have both +done your work, you will take it by turns to read out loud while I do +my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who knows, if we get on very +flourishingly, after we have furnished our sitting room, we may be +able to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have a little music +of an evening." + +"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be really like old times, +when you used to sing to me!" + +Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the thought of the old times, +but she kept them back bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment, +the happiness of this first evening. So they chatted till nine +o'clock, when they had supper. After it was over Mrs. Andrews left the +room for a minute and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned +with a Bible in her hand. + +"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this first happy evening +in our new home by thanking God together for his blessings." + +"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and Bill's face expressed +his approval. + +So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they knelt and thanked God +for his blessings, and the custom thus begun was continued henceforth +in No. 8 Laburnum Villas. + +Hitherto George and his companion had found things much more pleasant +at the works than they had expected. They had, of course, had +principally to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were many other men +in the shop, and at times, when his bench was standing idle while some +slight alterations or adjustment of machinery were made, they were set +to work with others. Men are quick to see when boys are doing their +best, and, finding the lads intent upon their work and given neither +to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp word addressed to +them. But after Mrs. Andrews had come home they found themselves +addressed in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men. Bob Grimstone +had told two or three of his mates of the sacrifices the boys had made +to save up money to make a home for the mother of one of them when she +came out of hospital. They were not less impressed than he had been, +and the story went the round of the workshops and even came to the +ears of the foreman, and there was not a man there but expressed +himself in warm terms of surprise and admiration that two lads should +for six months have stinted themselves of food in order to lay by half +their pay for such a purpose. + +"There's precious few would have done such a thing," one of the older +workmen said, "not one in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred, +even when he's going to be married, will stint himself like that to +make a home for the gal he is going to make his wife, so as to start +housekeeping out of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will +you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as much for his mother as +for the gal who is agoing to be his wife, seeing how much he owes her; +but how many does it, that's what I says, how many does it?" + +So after that the boys were surprised to find how many of the men, +when they met them at the gate, would give them a kindly nod or a +hearty, "Good-morning, young chaps!" + +A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in Laburnum Villas she +went up to town and called upon a number of shops, asking for work. As +she was able to give an excellent reference to the firm for whom she +had worked at Croydon she succeeded before the end of the week in +obtaining millinery work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard, and as +she had excellent taste and was very quick at her needle she was soon +able to earn considerably more than she had done at Croydon. + +The three were equally determined that they would live as closely as +possible until the sitting-rooms were furnished, and by strict +management they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews' earnings +being devoted to the grand purpose. The small articles were bought +first, and each week there was great congratulation and pleasure as +some new article was placed in the rooms. Then there was a pause for +some time, then came the chairs, then after an interval a table, and +lastly the carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until the end +of July. After this they moved solemnly into the sitting-room, +agreeing that the looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added +at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs. Andrews' earnings +need no longer be devoted. + +"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable evening, "I want you +in future, when you come in, to change your working clothes before you +come in here to your teas. So long as we lived in the kitchen I have +let things go on, but I think there's something in the old saying, +'Company clothes, company manners,' and I think it is good when boys +come in that they should lay aside their heavy-nailed shoes and their +working clothes. Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render +people clumsy in their movements, and the difference of walk which you +observe between men of different classes arises very greatly from the +clumsy, heavy boots which workingmen must wear." + +"But what does it matter, mother?" George urged, for it seemed to him +that it would be rather a trouble to change his clothes every day. +"These little things don't make any real difference to a man." + +"Not any vital difference, George, but a real difference for all +that. Manners make the man, you know! that is, they influence +strangers and people who only know him in connection with business. If +two men apply together for a place the chances are strongly in favor +of the man with the best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think +the observance of little courtesies of this kind make home pleasanter +and brighter. You see I always change my dress before tea, and I am +sure you prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat with a +fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place in my working dress with +odds and ends of threads and litter clinging to it." + +"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you mean now. Certainly I will +change my things in future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?" + +Bill would not have minded in the least any amount of trouble by which +he could give the slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had now +a place in his affections closely approximating to that which George +occupied. + +During the summer months the programme for the evening was not carried +out as arranged, for at the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared +that there must be a change. + +"The evenings are getting light enough now for a walk after tea, boys, +and you must therefore cut short our reading and studies till the days +close in again in the autumn. It would do you good to get out in the +air a bit." + +"But will you come with us, mother?" + +"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get longer we may make little +excursions together: go across the river to Greenwich and spend two or +three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go up the river to Kew; +but as a general thing you had better take your rambles together. I +have my front garden to look after, the vegetables are your work, you +know, and if I like I can go out and do whatever shopping I have to do +while you two are away." + +So the boys took to going out walks, which got longer and longer as +the evenings drew out, and when they were not disposed for a long +ramble they would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and watch +the barges drifting down the river or tacking backwards and forwards, +if there was a wind, with their great brown and yellow sails hauled +tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly down the river, and +the little busy tugs dragging great ships after them. There was an +endless source of amusement in wondering from what ports the various +craft had come or what was their destination. + +"What seems most wonderful to me, George," Bill said one day, "when +one looks at them big steamers----" + +"Those," George corrected. + +"Thank ye--at those big steamers, is to think that they can be tossed +about, and the sea go over them, as one reads about, just the same +way as the wave they make when they goes down----" + +"Go down, Bill." + +"Thank ye--go down the river, tosses the little boats about; it don't +seem possible that water can toss itself about so high as that, does +it?" + +"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that it is so because there +are constantly wrecks; but looking at the water it does not seem +possible that it should rise up into waves large enough to knock one +of those great steamers in pieces. Some day, Bill, not this year, of +course, because the house isn't finished, but next year, I hope we +shall be able all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have seen +it stuck up you can go to Margate and back for three or four +shillings; and though Bob Grimstone says that isn't regular sea, it +would be enough to show us something of what it's like." + +The garden occupied a good deal of the boys' time. Bill's long +experience in the market had given him an interest in vegetables, and +he was always ready for an hour's work in the garden after tea. The +results of much labor and plenty of manure were not unsatisfactory, +and Mrs. Andrews was delighted with her regular supply of fresh +vegetables. Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount that could be +grown in a limited space were by no means fulfilled, and seeing the +small amount which could be daily gathered, and recalling the +countless piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to see in +Covent Garden, he was continually expressing his astonishment at the +enormous quantity of ground which must be employed in keeping up the +supply of the market. + +They did not that year get the trip to Margate; but in the autumn, +after the great work of furnishing was finished, they did get several +long jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus, once in a +steamer up to Kew, and several times across to Greenwich Park. Mrs. +Andrews found it a very happy summer, free from the wear of anxiety, +which, more even than the work, had brought on her long illness. She +grew stronger and better than she had ever expected to be again, and +those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking needlewoman of +Croydon would not have recognized her now; indeed, as George said +sometimes, his mother looked younger and younger every day. She had +married very young, and was still scarcely five-and-thirty, and +although she laughed and said that George was a foolish boy when he +said that people always took her for his sister, she really looked +some years younger than she was. Her step had regained its elasticity, +and there was a ring of gladness and happiness in her voice which was +very attractive, and even strangers sometimes looked round as they +passed the bright, pleasant-looking woman chatting gayly with the two +healthy, good-looking young fellows. + + + + +CHAPTER V. + +AN ADVENTURE. + + +In August the annual outing, or, as it was called, the bean-feast, at +the works took place. Usually the men went in vans down into Epping +Forest; but this year it was determined that a steamer should be +engaged to take the whole party with their wives and families down to +Gravesend. They were to make an early start, and on arriving there all +were to do as they pleased until they assembled to dine in a pavilion +at one of the hotels. After this they were to go to the gardens and +amuse themselves there until the steamer started in the evening. The +party embarked at Blackwell at ten o'clock in the morning. George and +Bill got together up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted +with their voyage down, their only regret being that Mrs. Andrews had +declined to accompany them, saying that she would far rather go with +them alone than with so large a party. + +"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when they landed. "We are not +to dine till two, so we have two good hours before us. I vote we hire +a boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here as up in that +crowded river by London." + +This was said in reference to various short rows which they had had +in boats belonging to barges which had been sometimes lent them for +half an hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as they hung +about the wharves. + +"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the waterman, whom they hired +the boat of, said. + +"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the confidence of youth. + +"Mind the tide is running out strong," the waterman said. + +"All right, we will mind," George answered, scarce heeding his words; +and getting out the oars they pushed off. + +For some little time they rowed among the anchored vessels, both being +especially filled with delight at the yachts moored opposite the +clubhouses. These were new craft to them, and the beauty and neatness +of everything struck them with surprise and admiration. Tide had only +turned a short time before they got into their boat, and while keeping +near the shore they had no difficulty in rowing against it. + +Presently they determined to have a look at a fine East-Indiaman +moored well out in the stream a short distance below Gravesend. They +ceased rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on their oars +talking over the distant voyage on which she was probably about to +start, and the country she might visit, George was telling his +companion the ports she would touch if her destination was China, and +absorbed in their conversation they paid no attention to anything +else, until George gave a sudden exclamation. + +"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so far behind. It is two +miles, I should think, from the town. We must set to work or we shan't +be back in time for dinner." + +The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the Thames was not sufficient +to tell them that to row against tide it is necessary to keep close +inshore, and turning the boat's head they set to work to row back in +the middle of the river. Their knowledge of rowing was but slight, and +the mere operation of their oars took up all their attention. They +rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration ran down their +faces. + +After half an hour of this George looked round, thinking that he ought +to be near to the vessel by this time. He uttered an exclamation of +surprise and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were visible. +Their puny efforts had availed nothing against the sweeping tide. They +had already, without knowing it, swept round the turn in the river, +and were now entering Sea Reach. + +"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just look at that buoy; we are +going past it as fast as a horse could trot. Look what a width the +river is. What on earth are we to do?" + +"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall we go to if we go on like +this?" + +"Right out to sea, I should think," George said. "I do not know how +far it is; but the river seems to get wider and wider in front." + +"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn again and take us +back." + +"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you know, all the way down, +and could only have turned a little while before we got in the boat. +Look at that line of barges sailing down on the right-hand side. I +vote we pull to them and ask the men what we had better do. Anyhow we +could row to the land and get out there and wait till tide turns. It +turned at about eleven, so that it will turn again somewhere about +five. The steamer is not to start till eight, so we shall be back in +plenty of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and the fun in +the gardens, but that can't be helped." + +"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully; "this is a regular +venture, this is; but I say, shan't we have to pay a lot for the +boat?" + +"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps the man will let us +off cheap when he sees we couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered +sort of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute it is taking us +further away." + +They set steadily to work. The boat was a large and heavy one, and +their progress was by no means rapid. + +"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed suddenly. + +"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye, George, I can't see the +barges!" + +Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily creeping up the river. They +were just at its edge when they made the discovery. Another two +minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they could not see ten +yards away. They looked at each other in silent bewilderment. + +"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at length in awe-struck tones. + +"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no use rowing, that I +see, for we don't know which way the boat's head is pointing." + +"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically. "I am going to +have a pipe. Oh, I say, aint my hands blistered!" + +"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but keep your oar in your +hand to be ready to row." + +"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you said it warn't no use +rowing!" + +"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for those big buoys. If the +tide were to sweep us against one of them we should capsize to a +certainty. That must have been a big steamer," he went on, as the boat +rolled suddenly. "It's lucky we were pretty well over towards the side +of the river, before the fog came on. Listen--there's another. I can +hear the beat of her engines. I have an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed +suddenly. "We know the steamers were passing to the left of us when +the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles and the sound of their +paddles, and then row to the right, we shall get to the bank at last." + +"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying down the pipe he had +just lighted. "There's a whistle over there." + +"Yes, and another the other way," George said, puzzled. "Why, how can +that be! Oh, I suppose one is coming up the river and one down, but +it's awfully confusing." + +It was so, but by dint of listening intently the boys gained some idea +of the proper direction; but they could only row a few strokes at a +time, being obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance. + +Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water, and the upper spars +of the steamers were above it, and men placed there were able to +direct those on deck as to their course. Had it not been for this the +steamers must all have anchored. As it was they proceeded slowly and +cautiously on their way, whistling freely to warn any small craft, +that might be hidden in the fog, of their coming. + +Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous exclamation. +The boat had quietly grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could +not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it was. Bill at once +offered to get overboard and reconnoiter, but George would not hear of +it. + +"You might not be able to find your way back, Bill, or you might sink +in the mud and not be able to get out again. No, we won't separate; +and, look here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge of the +mud. If we were to get left here we should not float again till tide +comes up to us, and that wouldn't be till about two hours before high +tide, and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock at night." + +"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking round at the +wall of white vapor which surrounded them. "It regular confuses a +chap. I say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at present. +I feel awfully hungry." + +"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall be a good deal more +hungry before we are done; but I am so glad we have found the land and +stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being hungry." + +"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are we to find our way +back to Gravesend?" + +"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to the edge of the +mud--just as close as the boat will swim. That way, you know, we must +come to Gravesend at last." + +"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have got a good head, George, +you have. I should never have thought about the way to find the bank +if it hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating and +floating till we was starved." + +"This fog can't last forever, Bill." + +"No, but I have known them last a week in London." + +"Yes, but not in August, Bill." + +"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you see these here fogs may +last just as long down here in August as they do in London in +November." + +"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter to us; we have got +the land for a guide, and I hope we shall be back in Gravesend before +it's quite dark." + +"But if we don't, George?" + +"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before it gets too dark, and +wait till it is morning. We shall be all right if we keep quite cool +and use our senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind a bit, +except that mother will be getting anxious about us. It's a regular +adventure, and we shall have something to talk about for a long time. +Look out, Bill, we must push her further off--she's getting aground!" + +For an hour they sat and chatted. + +"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last. "That's the rattle of a +chain. I expect it's a barge anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can +hear voices. I vote we hollo." + +George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The shout was repeated +not very far off, and was followed by the shout of "Who are you?" + +"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost our way," George +shouted back. "We will come on board if you will let us." + +"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on shouting and you row to +my voice." + +It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close at hand said +sharply: + +"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain." + +Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw that they were close +to the bows of a barge. Half a dozen more strokes and they were +alongside. Bill seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and the +boat was soon towing astern. + +"Well, young men, however did you manage to get here?" one of the +bargemen asked. "It's lucky for you you weren't taken out to sea with +the tide." + +George related the history of their voyage and how they had managed to +reach the shore. + +"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the man said; "aint they, +Jack? Most chaps your age would just have sat in the boat and howled, +and a good many longshoremen too. You have done the best thing you +could under the circumstances." + +"Where are we?" George asked. + +"You are on board the _Sarah and Jane_ topsail barge, that's where you +are, about three parts down Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well +even in a fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the Swashway +with it as thick as this, so we brought up." + +"Where is the Swashway?" George asked. + +"The Swashway is a channel where the barges go when they are making +for Sheerness. It's well buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the +help of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs are worse +than anything. It aint no use groping about for the buoy when you +can't see ten yards ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on +the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap this fog will clear +off before evening, and we shall be able to work in; and now I expect +you two young uns would like some grub. Come below." + +The two boys joyfully followed into the little cabin, and were soon +satisfying their hunger on bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug +of water from the breaker and placed it before them. + +"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would give yer a cup of +tea--that's our tipple; we don't keep spirits on board the _Sarah and +Jane_. I like a drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge, +where you wants your senses handy at all times. And now what are you +thinking of doing?" he asked when the boys had finished. + +"What we had made up our minds to do was to lie where we were at the +edge of the mud till tide turned, and then to keep as close to the +shore as we could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer we came +by does not go back till late, and we thought we should be back by +that time." + +"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the middle of the stream you +would be back in two hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide +don't help you much there, and half your time you are in eddies and +back-currents. No, you wouldn't be back in Gravesend by eight noway." + +"Then what would you advise us to do?" + +"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at all. We will see how +things are going after a bit. Now let's take a look round." + +So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed by the boys. The +white fog still shut the boat in like a curtain. + +"What do you think of it, Jack?" + +"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just now there was a puff of +air coming down the river. I wish it would, or we shan't make +Sheerness to-night, much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure +enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like enough in half an hour there +will be a brisk wind blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before +it." + +Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples swept across the +oil-like face of the water. + +"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said. "I'd bet a pot of +beer as the fog will have lifted in a quarter of an hour." + +Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind. + +The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand. It was no longer a +dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark shadows seemed to flit across it, and +sometimes the view of the water extended here and there. + +"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly, but ere George could +turn round to look it was gone again. + +"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now I tell you what will +be the best thing for you if the wind holds, as I expect it will. We +shall be at Sheerness in little over an hour--that will make it four +o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and the young flood will be +coming up soon afterwards, and I shall go up with the first of it to +Rochester. We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven o'clock. Now +the best thing I can do for you is to tow that ere boat up to +Rochester with me, and you can get a train there that will take you up +to town in goodish time." + +"You are very kind," George said; "but what are we to do about the +boat?" + +"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more likely next morning, +and I will take her along and hand her over to her rightful owner at +Gravesend." + +"James Kitson." + +"Yes, I know him." + +"But how about paying for it?" George said. "I am afraid he will +expect a great deal of money, for it has been away all the time, and +we have only got six shillings between us." + +"You will want that to get up to town. Never mind about the boat. I +will put that square for you. I will tell Kitson as how you have been +shipwrecked, and he will think himself precious lucky in getting the +boat without being damaged. If I take the trouble to tow it up to +Rochester and back, he needn't grumble about getting no fare." + +"I would rather pay something," George said; "though, you see, we +can't afford to pay much." + +"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for five bob. I will +tell him you are going to send him that, and he will thank his stars +he has got so well out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he +expects you have by this time, and the boat didn't get smashed by a +steamer, you would likely enough have been taken off by one of them; +but the captain wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub. I +looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so don't you worry about +him. There, the mist's driving off fast. We will up with the kedge." + +The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the anchor was soon hanging +from the bow. Then the brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great +sail shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few minutes the +_Sarah and Jane_ was running before a brisk wind down Sea Reach. + +The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear astern, though a thick +bank still hung over the river ahead, but this was rapidly melting +away; and the bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins, +pointed out a large building low down on the water ahead. + +"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can lend Jack a hand to get up +the topsail. The wind is rising every minute, and we shall soon be +bowling along hand over hand." + +Both ahead and astern of them were a line of barges, which had, like +the _Sarah and Jane_, anchored when the fog was thickest, and were, +like her, making their way to Sheerness. The wind was blowing briskly +now, and the barge made her way through the water at a rate which +surprised the boys. + +"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George said. + +"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins replied. "With a +breeze so strong that they can only just carry their topsails, they +will hold their own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are mighty +few yachts can keep alongside us when we are doing our best." + +As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour they brought up just +inside the mouth of the Medway, and dropped the anchor to wait till +the tide turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock they were +again under way. The wind had fortunately veered round somewhat to the +north of west, and they were able for the most part to lay their +course, so that soon after seven they were abreast of the dockyard, +and a few minutes later dropped anchor off Rochester. + +"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured bargeman said; "I will +put you ashore at once. There is the station close to the end of the +bridge." + +With many very hearty thanks for his kindness the lads jumped ashore +and hurried up to the station. They found that there would be a train +in half an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in town. + +Before they had landed the bargeman had scrawled on a piece of paper, +"Your boat was picked up by the _Sarah and Jane_. Will bring her back +on return trip. No damage done. William Atkins." This he had handed to +the boys, and they now got an envelope and directed it to "James +Kitson, Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set out to walk +home. + +"It's not been the sort of day we expected," George said; "but it's +been good fun, hasn't it?" + +"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so when we were in the +middle of that fog listening to them whistles and trying to find out +the way. I didn't say much, George, but I felt downright funky." + +"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a horribly lonely +feeling, lost in the fog there; but it was all right as soon as we +touched the mouth, and got an idea where we were. I was worrying most +about mother getting anxious if we did not get back to-night, and a +little about what we should have to pay for the boat. It was lucky +that bargeman took the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should +have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully good fellow, wasn't +he?" + +"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He was a good un, and no +mistake. It aint cost us so very much either, considering." + +"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece railway fare, that's +four and sixpence, and five bob we are to send down for the boat, nine +shillings and sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings for +the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have spent another shilling +apiece in things at the gardens, perhaps more; that would make four +shillings anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings more than +we calculated. And haven't we got a lot to talk about! It's been a +regular adventure." + +"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think I want many more of +them kind of adventures. It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't +jolly at the time. I always thought as adventures was jolly; but that +didn't seem to me to have no jolliness about it, not when we was out +there. It's all very well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with +savages, but I expect there aint no larks about it at the time. I +suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow, and get it off your +mind?" + +"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for another three or four +days. The man will have got his boat back all right then, and the five +bob would come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell Kitson that +he had arranged with us that was what we were to pay, as we couldn't +afford more; but he will never expect to get it, so when it comes he +will be only too glad to receive it." + +They were met at the door of the house by Bob Grimstone, who was just +coming out. + +"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said angrily. "I have been +wondering all day what has become of you, and the missis has done +nothing but worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day. What have +you been up to? I haven't seen you since we got ashore at Gravesend, +and I have just come round to ask your mother if she has heard of +you." + +"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at least it was not +altogether our fault. We went for a row, and the tide took us down, +and then the fog came on and we got lost." + +"I expected better of you," Grimstone said angrily. "Foggy, indeed! +I've been anxious and worried all day. I did think as you warn't like +other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go and play such a +prank as this. Well, go in; your mother is in a nice taking about +you." + +"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I am so sorry you have +been uneasy about us, awfully sorry; but really it hasn't been our +fault altogether." + +"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews said, throwing her arms +round his neck. "Fortunately I did not know anything about it till Mr. +Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been expecting you in for +some little time, but I supposed the steamer was late, and I was not +at all uneasy till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not +seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend, and that you +had not come back with the rest. Is Bill with you?" + +"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to Bob." + +"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs. Andrews said. "He has been +most kind, and he had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first +train in the morning if you did not come home to-night, and to make +inquiries about you there. He tried to cheer me up by saying that as +you were together nothing could very well happen to you and that +probably you had only got into some boyish scrape--perhaps, he +suggested, only gone out into the country and had helped yourselves to +some apples, and had so got locked up." + +Bob, however, would not come in again, but went off saying he would +hear all about it in the morning, but would go off to tell his wife at +once that they had returned safely, for "that she was in such a worry +as never was." + +Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat since two o'clock, Mrs. +Andrews at once laid the table for supper; and when they had finished +it listened to George's account of their adventure. + +"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said when they had finished. +"You might have been swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the +fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you forget to thank God +for his protection through the danger you have run; and I do hope, my +dear boys, that you will be more careful in future." + +The next evening, after work was over, George went in to Bob +Grimstone's and told them all that had happened. When the story was +told, Bob agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault, and +that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified his opinion of +them. Mrs. Grimstone, however, was not so easily pacified. They had +come back, she said; but it was more than likely that they wouldn't +have come back at all, but might have been drifting out far at sea, +perhaps cutting each other's throats and eating each other alive, +which was, as the good woman said, what she had heard happened when +boats were lost at sea. + +Two days later they sent off the money to the waterman, and received +in reply a letter from him saying that the boat had been brought +safely back by the _Sarah and Jane_ and that he was glad to get the +five shillings. + +"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send it; but knowing what +boys is, I say fair as I didn't expect to see the color of your money. +It aint everyone as would have paid up when they got safe away, and I +consider as you have behaved handsome." + +They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off which the _Sarah and Jane_ +might generally be found moored, between her cruises, and after one or +two ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge there when they +rowed up to the spot. She had but just returned from a trip to +Rochester and Bill Atkins was still on board. He was very glad to see +the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading him to accept a +pound of tobacco which their mother had sent off to him with her +compliments as a token of gratitude for his kindness to them. + +"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of the sort, but seeing +as your mother has got it for me it wouldn't be manners to say no. +Well, look here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down to +Rochester and back you're free of the _Sarah and Jane_, and heartily +glad shall I be to have you with me." + +The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as they were still at +work there was but small chance of their being able to accept it, but +that they should be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes +when he was in the Pool. + + + + +CHAPTER VI. + +FIRE! + + +One Saturday evening early in October the boys had been for a long +walk down among the marshes. They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be +late, and it was past eight o'clock when they came along past the +works. + +"We shan't get home at this hour again for some time, I expect," +George said, "for they say that we are going to begin to work overtime +on Monday, and that the orders are so heavy that it will very likely +have to be kept up all through the winter." + +"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied; "it would have been +horrid if we had lost all our walks while the weather was fine. How +dark the place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still it is +after the rattle we are accustomed to!" + +"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand on his arm. + +"What is it, George?" + +"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment, as if I saw the big +stack clearly and then it was dark again." + +"How could that be, George?" + +"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a reflection of light +from one of the windows at the back there. There it is again." + +"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it be?" + +"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back. There might +be--it's awful to think of--but there might be a fire." + +The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of the works onto a piece +of waste ground behind. + +"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room. There must be +fire. Here, help to put this bit of old timber against the wall." + +The piece of wood was placed into position, the two lads climbed up it +onto the wall, and dropped into the yard within. Just as they did so +there was a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light as +a body of flame burst out from one of the windows. + +"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call people's attention, +and then we must do the best we can." + +They ran along until they reached the front gate, and then, seizing +the bell-rope, rang it violently. + +In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside, and shouts of +"What's the matter?" + +"There is a fire in the molding-room," George shouted; "run for the +engines, someone, and break the gate open. Now come on, Bill." + +The two boys ran towards that part of the building where the flames +had been seen, broke a window, and climbed in. There was an almost +stifling smell of burning wood and at a door at the end of the +planing-room they could see a light flame flickering through the +cracks of the door leading into the molding-room, which was next to +it. + +"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the hydrant. We must stop +it from getting through here till the engines come." + +The hydrant communicated with the great tank at the top of the +building, and as soon as the hose was screwed on and Bill stood with +the nozzle directed towards the burning door, George turned the cock +and volumes of water flew out. + +The first result seemed disastrous. The door was already nearly burned +through, and, as the powerful jet flew against it, it seemed to +crumble away and a mass of flame darted out from the molding-room. The +joists and timbers supporting the floor above the planing-room would +have caught at once, but the boys deluged them with water, as also the +framework of the door, and then, throwing the stream of water into the +blazing workshop, they kept down the flames near the door. The smoke +was stifling. + +"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped. + +"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always better near the +ground." + +This they found to be the case, and they were still able to direct the +jet of water. But three or four minutes had elapsed when the outer +door of the planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and several +other men rushed in, but were at once driven back by the smoke. George +had recognized Grimstone's voice, and shouted: + +"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet. Come and lend a hand, +for it's gaining on us in spite of the water. You can breathe if you +kneel down." + +Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled in and joined the +boys. + +"What! is it you, George? How on earth did you get here?" Bob +exclaimed. + +"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in from behind. When we +saw what it was we rang the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do +what we could till help came." + +"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone said admiringly; "but I am +afraid it's not much good." + +"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters drenched there. Bill and +I will crawl forward and clear the shavings out of the way if we can. +They have caught half a dozen times already." + +The two boys crawled forward, and although the heat was tremendous +they managed to clear away the shavings for a considerable distance. +The smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged to crawl back +into the outer air, where for a while they lay almost insensible. +There were crowds of men in the yard now, but most of them were round +at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only watching the +flames as they roared through the whole of the windows of the +molding-room. + +Men were hurrying past with buckets of water, and one of them, seeing +the condition of the boys, dashed some over their heads and faces, and +they presently staggered to their feet. It was now a quarter of an +hour since they had first given the alarm, and they were just about to +re-enter the planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and his +comrades coming out. + +"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines aint here in a minute +or two it will be too late." + +But just at that moment there was a cheer outside, and immediately +afterwards a fire-engine dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to +the firemen as they leaped off. + +"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it spreading from that shop +into this. We have been keeping it back till now, but the tank has +just run dry." + +While the other firemen were fitting the hose to the fire-plug just +outside the gates one of them made his way into the planing-room to +ascertain the exact position of affairs. + +"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be lost; the fire is +making its way through. Another five minutes and we should have been +too late to save any of this block. Is there any communication through +the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone. + +"Yes, there is a door on each floor," + +"Have you got any empty sacks about the place?" + +"Yes, there is a pile of them in there." + +The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades, while he himself +made his way into the planing-room with the hose; the other got out +the sacks, and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands drenched +them with water, and then proceeding to the door on the first floor +piled them against it. + +"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand upon it. "Now, do you +men bring me buckets of water. Keep the sacks drenched till another +engine comes up." + +George and Bill, finding they could be of no more use, made their way +out to the back and joined the crowd watching the flames, which had +already spread to the first floor. They were, however, with the rest +of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the yard by the police, who, +having now arrived in sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear +the premises of all save a score or two of men who were engaged in +assisting the firemen. + +As the boys went out through the front gate another engine dashed up +at full speed, dropping lighted cinders on its way. + +"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect they will do now." + +Then the boys made their way round again to the back, and by means of +the pieces of timber established themselves on the wall, where they +were soon joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle with +the flames. + +In half an hour six engines were on the spot; but even this force had +no visible effect upon the flames in that portion of the building in +which they had taken possession, and the firemen turned the whole of +their efforts to prevent it from spreading. + +The party wall dividing it from the main building was a very strong +one; but so hot had it become that the floor boards touching it were +over and over again in flames. + +A score of men with saws and axes cut away the flooring adjoining the +doors on the first and second stories. The planing-room was +fortunately not boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade worked +unceasingly in preventing the spread of the flames in this direction, +the rest turned their attention to the great wood piles, which were +repeatedly ignited by the fragments of burning wood. + +Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up high into the air, +but grand as the sight was, the boys did not wait any longer looking +on. Their faces smarted severely from the heat to which they had been +exposed; their hands had been a good deal burned by the shavings; +their hair, eyebrows, and eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs +ached with the glare. + +"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely enough hear of the +fire, and as we said we should be back soon after eight she will be +getting anxious." + +"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and see the end of it +here." + +But this George would not hear of. + +"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must get some grease or +something to put on my face and hands; they are smarting awfully." + +Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise and alarm as the boys +entered. The irritation of the wood smoke had so much inflamed their +eyes that they could scarcely see out of them, and their faces looked +like pieces of raw beef. + +"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed. + +"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it broke out just as we +were passing, so we stopped to help for a bit, and then came home to +tell you, thinking that you might be anxious." + +"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed; "that is dreadful. +Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and for all of you who work there; more, +perhaps, for you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and you may +be out of work for months. Thank God I have plenty of work, so I dare +say we shall be able to tide it over." + +"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop and the floors +above it are on fire at present, and as there are six fire-engines at +work, and they keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will save +the rest; and now, mother, what can we do to our faces and hands, they +are smarting awfully?" + +"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought you were only dreadfully +hot." + +"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were being roasted." + +"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing," Mrs. Andrews said, +hurrying away to the kitchen, and coming back with a piece of +cotton-wool, and some olive-oil in a cup. + +"You are burned, George. Why, child, your hair is all singed, and your +eyebrows and eyelashes. Why, what have you been doing to yourselves? +There could have been no occasion to put your heads into the flames +like that. Why, your hands are worse still; they are quite blistered. +I had better wrap them up in cotton-wool." + +"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps if you put a bit of +cotton-wool there and tie it round the back it will do; we can't go +out with our hands all swaddled round like that. And now, please, +directly you have done we want to go down again to see the fire. Just +you go up to the road corner, mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell +you." + +"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly; "everything has +been ready except pouring the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a +quarter past nine now. After we have done I will put on my bonnet and +walk down with you as near as I can get. I am not going to lose you +out of my sight again." + +So after their meal they went down together, but could not get +anywhere near the works, all the approaches now being guarded by the +police. It was a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was a +general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it would spread no +further. A dozen engines were at work now. Some of the firemen were on +the roof, some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot from the +deep glow from the fire. The flames were intermittent now, sometimes +leaping up high above the shell of the burned-out buildings, then +dying down again. + +"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said fervently. "It would have +been a bad winter for a great many down here if the fire had spread; +as it is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned." + +"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a tenth, I should say. It's +lucky that there was a strong wall between that and the next shops, or +it must all have gone. I have heard them say that part was added on +five or six years ago, so that the wall at the end of the planing-shop +was an outside wall before; that accounts for its being so thick." + +After looking on for about half an hour they went back home. But +neither of the boys got much sleep that night, the excitement they had +gone through and the pain of their burns keeping them wide awake till +nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard no movement in their +rooms--whereas they were usually up and about almost as early on +Sundays as on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual +hour for rising--she did not disturb them. George was the first to +awake, and looking out of the window felt sure by the light that it +was later than usual. He put his head out of the door and shouted: + +"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer. "Mother, are you up; what +o'clock is it?" + +"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past eleven!" + +George gave an exclamation of astonishment and rushed into Bill's +room. The latter had woke at his shout. + +"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up for hours;" and he +dashed off again to his room to dress. It was but a few minutes before +they came downstairs just at the same moment. + +"Why didn't you wake us, mother?" + +"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on, George. I guessed +that your burns had kept you awake for some time." + +"That they did. I thought I was never going to get to sleep," George +said; and Bill gave a similar account of himself. "Still, mother, a +short night does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to get to +church." + +"It does not matter for once, George. What figures you both are!" + +"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I hardly knew myself when I +looked in the glass. My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is +peeling off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby; and Bill +looks as bad as I do. You are a figure, Bill!" and George burst into a +fit of laughter. + +"He's no worse than you, George; but come along, breakfast is +waiting." + +"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope, mother?" + +"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys, and had a slice of +bread and butter, for I thought you might not be down for some time; +but I am quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put them down +directly you called." + +"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother; and I am glad too you +didn't have your regular breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit +down on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only regular +breakfast we get in the week." + +Just as they had finished their meal there was a knock at the door. It +was Bob Grimstone. Bill opened the door. + +"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I would just come round and +see. You look pretty badly burned; and so do you, George," he added, +as he followed Bill into the sitting room. + +"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews." + +"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews said. Since her coming the +Grimstones had several times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum +Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished them to come in more +frequently, for she felt much indebted to them for their kindness to +George, and, moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were good +specimens of their class. + +"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone; your face looks +scorched; but you did not manage to get yourself burned as these silly +boys did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did not +spread!" + +"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two lads can have told you +what they did, for if they had you would hardly call them silly boys." + +Mrs. Andrews looked surprised. + +"They told me they lent a hand to put out the fire--I think those were +George's words--but they did not tell me anything else." + +"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't been for them there +would not have been a stick or stone of Penrose's standing now; the +shops and the wood piles would all have gone, and we should all have +been idle for six months to come; there is no doubt about that at +all." + +"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How was it they did more than +anyone else?" + +"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and rung the +alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found out for another five minutes, +and five minutes would have been enough for the fire. In the next +place, when they had given the alarm they did the only thing that +could have saved the place: they got into the planing-shop and turned +on the hose there, and fought the fire from spreading through the +door till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was all we could +do to stop it then; but if they hadn't done what they did the +planing-shop would have been alight from end to end, and the floors +above it too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing could +have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs. Andrews, that there +isn't a man on the works, nor the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that +they owe these two lads their living through the winter. I don't know +what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I know what we all feel." + +"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her eyes were filled with +happy tears at the praises of her son, "why did you not tell me about +it?" + +"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell," George said, "and Bob +has made a great fuss about nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as +we came along and when we went round behind and got on the wall we saw +the place was on fire, so we rang the alarm-bell, and then turned on +the hose and flooded the place with water till Bob and some more came +to help us." + +"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can tell you it wasn't so. +When we opened the door of the planing-shop it was so full of smoke +that it didn't seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute, and +as we could see the glare of the flames at the other end we thought +the place was gone. We should have gone out and waited for the engines +if we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were there; and even +though we knelt down and crawled in, as they shouted to us to do, we +were pretty nearly stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward +and got the shavings cleared away; that was how they burned their +hands, I expect; and I hear they tumbled down insensible when they got +out. Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever two young +chaps behaved like heroes they did, and you have every right to be +proud of them--I say of them, because although Bill's no son of yours +I know he is what you and your boy have made him. He was telling me +about it one day." + +"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?" George asked, in order to +change the subject. + +"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob said; "but in our shop +and the floors above it it will take a day or two to clear up. I saw +the foreman just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters +will be put on, for both the floors are burned away at the end of the +wall and pretty near twenty feet of the roof are charred. Two +surveyors are coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and say +whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that are burned out must +come down, of course. The surveyor says that if the wall at the end of +the planing-room looks pretty strong they will build up another wall +against it as soon as it gets cold enough and the rubbish is cleared +away for men to work; that will make a strong job of it, and there +won't be any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to come down +there can't be much work done in the shops till it's finished. The +governor got down about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up to +him almost directly after the fire broke out, but he was out at +dinner, and by the time he got down here all danger of it spreading +was over. He had a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall +with him. He is as anxious as we are that there should be no delay, +for there are some heavy orders in, and, of course, he doesn't want +them taken anywhere else." + +"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I don't know much about +it, but they seem to be badly burned." + +"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said when he had examined them; +"pretty nigh raw. If I might give an opinion, I should say as the +doctor had better see them; they are precious painful, aint they, +George?" + +"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I don't see any use in +a doctor. I don't suppose he can do more than mother has." + +"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them for all that; he may +give you some cooling lotion for them, and I can tell you burns on the +hand are apt to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers may +get stiffened. I have known two or three cases like that. You had +better go at once to Dr. Maxwell; he always attends if there are any +accidents at the works. You know the house, George; it is about +halfway between this and the works." + +"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews said; "there, put +on your hats and be off." + +"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway, for the missis will be +waiting dinner for me." + +"Are we to pay, mother?" + +"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say you will have to have +your hands dressed several times." + +"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs. Andrews. The firm always +pays the doctor in case of accidents, and you may be very sure that in +this case they will be only too glad." + +"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said, "you can tell the +doctor that you will pay when he says that you need not come to him +again. If Mr. Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should not +think of refusing, as you have been burned in his service; but +certainly I should not assume that he will do so." + +"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when they reached the door. +"I know the doctor; he attended me two years ago when I pretty nigh +had my finger taken off by one of the cutters." + +"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would." + +They were shown into the surgery, where the doctor soon joined them. + +"I've brought these two young chaps for you to look at their hands, +Dr. Maxwell. They got them burnt last night at the fire. Mrs. +Andrews, the mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would pay +the charges when you have done with them; but as if it hadn't been for +them the works would have been burnt down as sure as you are standing +there, I expect the firm will take the matter in their own hands." + +"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining the boys' +hands. "Can you open and shut them, boy?" + +"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but I shouldn't like to +try, for if I move my fingers at all it hurts them awfully." + +"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your hands." + +"Yes." + +"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on some soothing +poultices. Tell your mother to get some linseed and mix it with +olive-oil. I will give you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about +twenty drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with the +linseed. Every four or five hours change the poultices. I think you +will find that will relieve the pain a good deal. I see your faces are +scorched too. You can do nothing better than keep them moistened with +sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet as possible for three +or four days." + +"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George said. + +"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can use your hands in +another fortnight. I will send in the usual certificate to the works." + +"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said when they left the +doctor's, "how it is we can't come to work? You tell him we wanted to, +and that we hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right; +because, you see, the men and boys at the shops which have been burnt +down will be all out of work, and it would be awful if we found our +places filled up when we went to work again." + +"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of your being out of +work after what you have done." + +"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews' first question when +they returned home. + +"He didn't say much, mother, except that we must not think of going to +work for a fortnight anyhow, and we are to have poultices made with +linseed mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from this bottle, +and it must be put on fresh every three or four hours. I am afraid it +will be an awful trouble." + +"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said brightly. "Did he say +you were to go to bed?" + +"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we could." + +"Then in that case, George, I think you had better go to bed." + +"No; I am sure we had better not," George said. "I should toss and +fidget about there horridly. The best thing will be for us to sit +here, and then we shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and +perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much. What are you going +to do, mother?" he asked five minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came +down with her bonnet on. + +"I am going to get some linseed, George, of course. I haven't got any +in the house." + +"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be shut." + +"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They will always supply +things that are needed even on Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as +well as any other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than a quarter +of an hour. You must keep very quiet till I come back." + +The boys found a good deal of relief from the effect of the poultices, +and were very much better after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock +the next morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work, with the +boys both on the hearthrug in front of the fire, there was a knock at +the door. It was a loud double knock, quite unlike the ordinary +summons of the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller. The boys +jumped up in surprise. + +"Who can that be, mother?" + +"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly. + +She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see a gentleman +standing there, whom, by the description the boys had given of him, +she guessed to be their employer. A little girl was standing by his +side. + +"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked. + +"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly. + +"My name is Penrose. I have called with my daughter to inquire after +the two lads--one of them your son, I believe--who so gallantly saved +my place from being burned down on Saturday evening. I only heard +about it late yesterday evening, when I came down to arrange about +some matters with the foreman. He did not know the facts of the case +on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday, and there can be no +doubt whatever, from what he says, that had it not been for the +presence of mind and bravery of these two lads nothing could have +saved the entire works and all the wood piles from destruction. I told +my daughter this morning, and she insisted on coming down with me. You +know she is already indebted to your son for saving a locket which we +both greatly valued." + +"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews showed them into the sitting +room. + +Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by Mrs. Andrews' manner, +although the foreman, in telling him of the boys' conduct, had also +stated what he knew about them. + +"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he said. "There was quite +a talk about them in the shops in the spring. They lodged with +Grimstone, and it seems that after they had been here at work five +months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was coming to them, and they +got Grimstone to take a house for them, and it turned out that ever +since they had been at work here they had been putting by half their +wages to furnish a place for her, so they must have lived on about +five shillings a week each and got clothes for themselves out of it. +Now, sir, boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there was +quite a talk among the men about it. I hear from Grimstone that Mrs. +Andrews is a superior sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does +work, I believe, for some London shop." + +Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the boys in a more +comfortable abode than usual, and their mother what the foreman called +a superior sort of woman; but he perceived at once by her address that +Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one, and that she was indeed a +lady. The prettiness of the little sitting room, with its comfortable +furniture, its snowy curtains and pretty belongings, heightened this +feeling. + +"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to tell you how indebted +I feel to you for your exertions on Saturday. There is no doubt that +had it not been for you the place would have been entirely burned. It +was fully insured, but it would have been a serious matter for me, as +I should have lost four or five months' work, and it would have been +still more serious for the men to have been thrown out of employment +at this time of the year, so we all feel very much indebted to you. I +hope you are not much burned." + +"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they will be all right +in a few days. Bill and I are very glad, sir, that we happened to be +passing, and were able to give the alarm and do something to stop the +flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that it was anything +out of the way. It was just a piece of fun and excitement to us." + +"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose, when they came home, +and it was only when one of the men came in next day to ask after them +that I heard that they had really been of use." + +"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose replied; "but there +is no doubt you showed a great deal of courage, as well as presence of +mind, and you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And now, Mrs. +Andrews," he said, turning round to her, "I feel rather in a false +position. I came round to see the lads, who, when I last saw them, +were not in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going to make +them a present for the service they had done me, and my daughter has +brought them a basket with some wine, jelly, and other things such as +are good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them, in your care and +in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty about it altogether." + +"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the kindness of your +intention; but my boys--for although one is in no way related to me I +feel towards him as if he were my own--would not like to take money +for doing their duty towards their employer." + +"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously. + +"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were good enough to give the +boys and to my needle,"--and she glanced towards the articles on the +table,--"we are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys will be very +glad to accept the things which your daughter has been so kind as to +bring down for them, and will feel very much obliged for her +thoughtfulness." + +"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved. "Nelly, you may as well +leave the basket as it is. I am sure you don't want to carry it back +again?" + +"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the empty basket would have +been more than the child could well have carried. It had come on the +top of the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had +accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum Villas. + +"You would have hardly known your young friend. Would you, Nelly?" + +"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her head. "He looks +dreadfully burned, and his hair is all funny and frizzled." + +"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling. "The doctor says our +faces will be all right when the skin is peeled off. Thank you very +much, Miss Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate day +indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing your locket." + +"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr. Penrose responded. "Now, +Mrs. Andrews, we will say good-by. You will not mind my calling again +to see how the boys are getting on?" + +"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be glad to see you," +Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope in a few days they will both be out +of the doctor's hands." + +"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said, patting the boys on +the shoulder, "but I hope next time I see you to be able to do so. +Good-morning, Mrs. Andrews." + + + + +CHAPTER VII. + +SAVED! + + +"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother," George said as Mrs. +Andrews returned into the room after seeing her two visitors off. +"It's very kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us +money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?" + +"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose is evidently a +gentleman of delicacy and refinement of feeling, and he saw that he +would give pain if he did so." + +"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked. "You know you thought +I was a fool not to take money when he offered it for getting back the +locket; but you see it in the same way now, don't you?" + +"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money," Bill said. "I sees----" + +"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected. + +"Thank you. I see things different--differently," he corrected +himself, seeing that George was about to speak, "to what I did then." + +"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the basket; it's almost as +big as a clothes-basket, isn't it?" + +The cover was lifted and the contents, which had after much thought +been settled by Nelly herself, were disclosed. There were two bottles +of port-wine, a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen oranges, +some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some almonds and raisins, two +packets of Everton toffee, a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of +black-currant jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a +sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in a tumbler of water for +a drink at night." + +"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a jolly collection, isn't +it? I think Miss Penrose must have chosen it herself, don't you?" + +"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews replied, smiling. +"I do not think any grownup person would have chosen mince-pies and +toffee as appropriate for sick boys." + +"Yes; but she must have known we were not badly burned, mother; and +besides, you see, she put in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there +are the oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and some toffee at +once, Bill." + +"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them in the market, but I +never tasted toffee." + +"It's first-rate, I can tell you." + +"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the packet was opened. + +George burst into a laugh. + +"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you peel that off, Bill, +and you will find the toffee inside. Now, mother, you have a glass of +wine and a piece of cake." + +"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am not going to open the +wine. We will put that by in case of illness or of any very +extraordinary occasion." + +"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother, or I expect you would +be wanting to put them all away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?" + +"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made of?" + +"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire." + +"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews laughed, "instead of boys +getting on for sixteen years old. Now I must clear this table again +and get to work; I promised these four bonnets should be sent in +to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be done to them yet." + +It was three weeks before the boys were able to go to work again. The +foreman came round on Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called +again; this time they were out, but he chatted for some time with Mrs. +Andrews. + +"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews," he said, after +asking about the boys; "but I have a motive for asking if your son +has, as I suppose he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair +education." + +"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs. Andrews said quietly; +"circumstances at that time obliged me to remove him; but I have +since done what I could myself towards continuing his education, and +he still works regularly of an evening." + +"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should like in time to place him +in the counting-house. I say in time, because I think it will be +better for him for the next two or three years to continue to work in +the shops. I will have him moved from shop to shop so as to learn +thoroughly the various branches of the business. That is what I should +do had I a son of my own to bring into the business. It will make him +more valuable afterwards, and fit him to take a good position either +in my shops or in any similar business should an opening occur." + +"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said gratefully; +"though I say it myself, a better boy never lived." + +"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him, and I shall be only too +glad, after the service he has rendered me, to do everything in my +power to push him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the same +advantages. At the time I first saw him he looked a regular young +arab." + +"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow. He was very kind to my +boy when he was alone in London, and gave up his former life to be +with him. George taught him to read before I came here, and he has +worked hard ever since. No one could be nicer in the house than he is, +and had I been his own mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious +to please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for my home here as +much to him as to my own boy." + +"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for of course I should +wish to do something for him too. At any rate, I will give him, like +your son, every opportunity of learning the business, and he will in +time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop--by no means a bad one +for a lad who has had such a beginning as he has had. After that, of +course, it must depend upon himself. I think, if you will allow me to +suggest, it would be as well that you should not tell them the nature +of our conversation. Of course it is for you to decide; but, however +steady boys they are, it might make them a little less able to get on +well with their associates in a shop if they know that they are going +to be advanced." + +"I don't think it would make any difference to them, sir; but at the +same time I do think it would be as well not to tell them." + +One day Bill was out by himself as the men were coming out of the +shop, and he stopped to speak to Bob Grimstone. + +"Oh! I am glad to find you without George," Bob said; "'cause I want +to talk to you. Look here! the men in all the shops have made a +subscription to give you and George a present. Everyone feels that +it's your doing that we have not got to idle all this winter, and when +someone started the idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that +didn't agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's come to +just thirty pounds. Now I don't know what you two boys would like, +whether you would like it in money, or whether you would like it in +something else, so I thought I would ask you first. I thought you +would know what George would like, seeing what friends you are, and +then you know it would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do you +say?" + +"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure George would like +anything better than money, and so should I." + +"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know in a day or two. We +were thinking of a watch for each of you, with an inscription, saying +it was presented to you by your shopmates for having saved the +factory, and so kept them at work for months just at the beginning of +winter. That's what seemed to me that you would like; but if there is +anything you would like better, just you say so. You come down here +to-morrow or next day, when you have thought it over, and give me an +answer. Of course you can consult George if you think best." + +Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day. + +"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know what George and me +would like better than any possible thing you could get." + +"Well, what is it, Bill?" + +"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what we were going to save +up our money to get, was a piano for George's mother. I heard her say +that we could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds, and it +would be splendid if you were all to give it her." + +"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know a chap as works at +Kirkman's, and I expect he will be able to give us a good one for the +money." + +Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the boys were going to +work again, Mrs. Andrews and George were astonished at seeing a cart +stop before the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and four other +men coming up to the door. + +Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered. He had been +apprised of the time that they might be expected, and at once showed +them in. + +"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my mates here are a +deputation from the hands employed in the shop, and we have come to +offer you a little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your son +and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving the shops. If it +hadn't been for them it would have been a bad winter for us all. So +after thinking it over and finding out what form of testimonial the +lads would like best, we have got you a piano, which we hope you may +live long to play on and enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch +each; but we found that they would rather that it took the form of a +piano." + +"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. Andrews said, much affected. +"I shall indeed be proud of your gift, both for itself and for the +kind feeling towards my boys which it expresses." + +"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just bring it in;" and the +deputation retired to assist with the piano. + +"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling me!" Mrs. Andrews +exclaimed. + +George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise. + +"But I didn't know anything about it, mother. I don't know what they +mean by saying that we would rather have it than watches. Of course we +would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they knew it." + +"Then it must have been your kind thought, Bill." + +"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but they spoke to me about +it, and I knew that a piano was what we should like better than +anything else, and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob +Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise to George as +well as to you." + +"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking Bill by the hand; "why, +there never was such a good idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?" + +The men now appeared at the door with the piano. This was at once +placed in the position which had long ago been decided upon as the +best place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. Andrews opened it, +and there on the front was a silver plate with the inscription: + +"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at Messrs. Penrose & Co., in token +of their gratitude to George Andrews and William Smith for their +courage and presence of mind, by which the factory was saved from +being destroyed by fire on Saturday the 23d of October, 1857." + +The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered it difficult for +her to read the inscription. + +"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps you would like to hear +its tones." So saying she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home." "It +has a charming touch," she said as she rose, "and, you see, the air +was an appropriate one, for your gift will serve to make home even +sweeter than before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those of my +boys, to all who have subscribed." + +The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had long been a subject of +considerable discussion and interest to their neighbors, for the +appearance of the boys as they came home of an evening in their +working clothes seemed altogether incongruous with that of their +mother and with the neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was, +indeed, considered derogatory to the respectability of Laburnum Villas +in general. Upon this evening they were still further mystified at +hearing the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness, +accompanied by a piano, played evidently by an accomplished musician, +issuing from the house. As to the boys, they thought that, next only +to that of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was such a happy +evening spent in the world. + +I do not think that in all London there was a household that enjoyed +that winter more than did the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their +total earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week, much less than +that of many a mechanic, but ample for them not only to live, but to +live in comfort and even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into +the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have dreamed that the +lady at the piano worked as a milliner for her living, or that the +lads were boys in a manufactory. + +When spring came they began to plan various trips and excursions which +could be taken on bank holidays or during the long summer evenings, +when an event happened which, for a time, cut short all their plans. +The word had been passed round the shops the first thing in the +morning that Mr. Penrose was coming down with a party of ladies and +gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were to be made as +tidy as possible. + +Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and vast quantities of +shavings and sawdust were swept up from the floors, although when the +machines had run again for a few hours no one would have thought that +a broom had been seen in the place for weeks. + +George was now in a shop where a number of machines were at work +grooving, mortising, and performing other work to prepare the wood for +builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work had recommenced +after dinner. + +There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many ladies. Nelly Penrose, +with two girls about her own age, accompanied the party. They stopped +for a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the nature of the +work and the various points of the machinery. + +They had passed through most of the other rooms before they entered +that in which George was engaged, and the young girls, taking but +little interest in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat +away from the rest of the party, chatting among themselves. George had +his eye upon them, and was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round +and speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly and not +paying sufficient heed to the machinery. + +Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward with a shout; but +he was too late, a revolving-band had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In +an instant she was dragged forward and in another moment would have +been whirled into the middle of the machinery. + +There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden crash and a harsh +grating sound, and then the whole of the machinery on that side of the +room came to a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had +happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends rushed forward to raise +Nelly. Her hand was held fast between the band and the pulley, and the +band had to be cut to relieve it. + +"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose murmured, as he lifted +her. "Another second and nothing could have saved her. But what +stopped the machinery?" and for the first time he looked round the +shop. There was a little group of men a few yards away, and, having +handed Nelly, who was crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised, +to one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The foreman came +forward to meet him. + +"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of the shop. I am +afraid young Andrews is badly hurt." + +"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked. + +"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter was in, and shoved his +foot in between two of the cog-wheels." + +"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as he pushed forward among +the men. + +Two of them were supporting George Andrews, who, as pale as death, lay +in their arms. One of his feet was jammed in between two of the +cog-wheels. He was scarcely conscious. + +"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a low tone, "his foot must be +completely crushed! Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?" + +"Yes, sir, I did that first thing." + +"That's right; now work away for your lives, lads." This was said to +two men who had already seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts +of the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to be lifted and +the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr. Penrose returned to his friends. + +"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down into the office. There's +been a bad accident; a noble young fellow has sacrificed himself to +save Nelly's life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off a +man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump into one of the cabs he +will find waiting at the gate, and tell the man to drive as hard as he +can go. If Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone else." + +George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly Penrose. When he +saw the band catch her dress he had looked round for an instant for +something with which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing at +hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had thrust his foot +between the cog-wheels. He had on very heavy, thickly nailed working +boots, and the iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent the +shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George felt a dull, sickening +pain, which seemed to numb and paralyze him all over, and he +remembered little more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot +was extricated and he was laid gently down on a heap of shavings. The +first thing he realized when he was conscious was that someone was +pouring some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat. + +When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling beside him, was +supporting his head, while on the other side knelt Bill Smith, the +tears streaming down his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs. + +"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then the remembrance of what +had passed flashed upon him. + +"Is she safe; was I in time?" + +"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your noble sacrifice was not in +vain," Mr. Penrose answered with quivering lips, for he too had the +greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion. + +"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a pause, "because, if so, +will you please send home for mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I +feel strange and weak." + +"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly crushed, but +otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot threw the machinery out of gear." + +In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already been informed of the +nature of the accident. + +"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr. Penrose asked in a low +voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped over George's leg. + +"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the same tone. "The foot +is crushed to a pulp. It must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save +it. He had better be taken home at once. You had best send to Guy's +and get an operating surgeon for him. I would rather it were done by +someone whose hand is more used than mine to this sort of work." + +"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said, "and will send off at +once for one of their best men. You are not afraid of the case, I +hope, Dr. Maxwell?" + +"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied; "but the shock to the +system of such a smash is very severe. However, he has youth, +strength, and a good constitution, so we must hope for the best. The +chances are all in his favor. We are thinking of taking you home, my +boy," he went on, speaking aloud to George. "Are you in any great +pain?" + +"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully cold, and, please, +will someone go on before and tell mother. Bill had better not go; he +would frighten her to death and make her think it was much worse than +it is." + +"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will prepare her for your +coming." + +"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor said; "that will warm you +and give you strength for your journey." + +There was a stretcher always kept at the works in case of emergency, +and George was placed on this and covered with some rugs. Four of the +men raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose at once +driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews. + +Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When it neared home he +fell behind and wandered away, not being able to bring himself to +witness the grief of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about, +sitting down in waste places and crying as if his heart would break. +"If it had been me it wouldn't have mattered," he kept on +exclaiming--"wouldn't have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no +odds one way or the other. There, we have always been together in the +shops till this week, and now when we get separated this is what comes +of it. Here am I, walking about all right, and George all crushed up, +and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I would rather a hundred times +that they had smashed me up all over than have gone and hurt George +like that!" + +It was dark before he made his way back, and, entering at the back +door, took off his boots, and was about to creep upstairs when Mrs. +Andrews came out of the kitchen. + +"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the tears again burst from him. + +"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and the doctors have +every hope that he will recover. They are upstairs with him now, with +a nurse whom Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital. He will +have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added with a sob that she could +not repress, "but we should feel very thankful that it is no worse +after such an accident as that. The doctor says that his thick boots +saved him. If it hadn't been for that his whole leg would have been +drawn into the machinery, and then nothing could have saved him. Now I +must go upstairs, as I only came down for some hot water." + +"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?" + +"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here for the present for +both your sakes. I will let you know when you can go up to him." + +So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He heard movements +upstairs and wondered what they were doing and why they didn't keep +quiet, and when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice the nurse +came down for hot water, but Bill did not speak to her; but in half an +hour Mrs. Andrews herself returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler +than before. + +"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy, that it's all over. +They gave him chloroform, and have taken his foot off." + +"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an awed voice. + +"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it, and the first thing he +asked when he came to was when they were going to begin. They will be +going away directly, and then you can come up and sit quietly in his +room if you like. The doctors say he will probably drop asleep." + +Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle with himself before +he felt that he was fit to go up into George's room. It was a long +struggle, and had George caught his muttered remonstrances to himself +he would have felt that Bill had suffered a bad relapse into his +former method of talking. It came out in jerks between his sobs. + +"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of yerself, a-howling and +a-blubbering like a gal! Call yerself a man!--you are a babby, that's +what you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more of it." + +But it was a long time before he again mastered himself; then he went +to the scullery and held his head under the tap till the water took +away his breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then went +and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came in and told him that he +could go upstairs to George. He went up to the bedside and took +George's hand, but he could not trust himself to speak. + +"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in a somewhat lower +voice than usual, "this is a sudden go, isn't it?" + +Bill nodded. He was still speechless. + +"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said, feeling that the lad +was shaking from head to foot. "It won't make much odds, you know. I +shall soon be about again all right. I expect they will be able to put +on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping about as well as ever, +though I shouldn't be much good at a race." + +"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I would have jammed my head +in between them wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you should +have gone and done it." + +"Fortunately there was no time," George said with a smile. "Don't you +fret yourself, Bill; one can get on well enough without a foot, and it +didn't hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze either, not +regular hurting; it was just a sort of scrunch, and then I didn't feel +anything more. Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at play +and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked much worse to you than +it felt to me." + +"We will talk of it another time," Bill said huskily. "Your mother +said I wasn't to talk, and I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit +down here quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So saying he +sat down by the bedside. George asked one or two more questions, but +Bill only shook his head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a +short time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed that he was +asleep. + +The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to George. Every day +hampers containing flowers and various niceties in the way of food +were sent down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself very +frequently called in for a chat with him. As soon as the wound had +healed an instrument-maker came down from town to measure him for an +artificial foot, but before he was able to wear this he could get +about on crutches. + +The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Penrose brought Nelly down +to see him. The child looked pale and awed as he came in. + +"My little girl has asked me to thank you for her, George," Mr. +Penrose said as she advanced timidly and placed her hand in his. "I +have not said much to you about my own feelings and I won't say much +about hers; but you can understand what we both feel. Why, my boy, it +was a good Providence, indeed, which threw you in my way! I thought so +when you saved the mill from destruction. I feel it tenfold more now +that you have saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed, strange. +Who would have thought that all this could have sprung from that boy +snatching the locket from Helen as we came out of the theater! And now +about the future, George. I owe you a great debt, infinitely greater +than I can ever repay; but what I can do I will. In the future I shall +regard you as my son, and I hope that you will look to me as to a +father. I have been talking to your mother, and she says that she +thinks your tastes lie altogether in the direction of engineering. Is +that so?" + +"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather be an engineer than +anything else, but I don't like----" + +"Never mind what you like and what you don't like," Mr. Penrose said +quietly. "You belong to me now, you know and must do as you are told. +What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good school for +another three years, and I will then apprentice you to a first-class +engineer, either mechanical or civil as you may then prefer, and when +you have learned your business I will take good care that you are +pushed on. What do you say to that?" + +"I think it is too much altogether," George said. + +"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said, "that is my business. If +that is the only objection we can imagine it settled. There is another +thing. I know how attached you are to your friend Bill, and I am +indebted to him, too, for the part he played at the fire, so I +propose, if he is willing, to put him to a good middle-class school +for a bit. In the course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient +education to get on fairly with, and then I propose, according as you +may choose to be a civil or mechanical engineer, to place him with a +mason or smith; then by the time that you are ready to start in +business he will be ready to take a place under you, so that you may +again work together." + +"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even more pleased at the news +relating to Bill than at his own good fortune, great as was the +delight which the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused him. + +As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose sent him with his mother +and Bill down to the seaside. Here George rapidly regained strength, +and when, after a stay there of two months, he returned to town, he +was able to walk so well with his artificial foot that his loss would +not have been noticed by a stranger. + +The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were all in due time carried +out. George went for three years to a good school, and was then +apprenticed to one of the leading civil engineers. With him he +remained five years and then went out for him to survey a railroad +about to be constructed in Brazil, and remained there as one of the +staff who superintended its construction. Bill, who was now a clever +young mason, accompanied him, and through George's interest with the +contractor obtained the sub-contract for the masonry of some of the +bridges and culverts. + +This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is now one of the most +rising engineers of the day, and whatever business he undertakes his +friend Bill is still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in all +respects as good as his word, and has been ready to assist George with +his personal influence in all his undertakings, and in all respects +has treated him as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the +affection of a sister. + +Both George and Bill have been married some years, and Mrs. Andrews +the elder is one of the proudest and happiest of mothers. She still +lives with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who is often +left alone during George's frequent absence abroad on professional +duties. As for Bill, he has not even yet got over his wonder at his +own good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first met George in +Covent Garden. + + + + +DO YOUR DUTY. + + +Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor was sitting on a +bench gazing over the stretch of sea which lies between Hayling Island +and the Isle of Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those +days ships of war were constantly running in and out, and great +convoys of merchantmen sailed under the protection of our cruisers; +and the traffic between Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a +much frequented road. + +Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's service, and had +settled down in his old age on a pension, and lived in a small cottage +near the western extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see what +was going on at Spithead, and when he needed a talk with his old +"chums" could get into his boat, which was lying hauled up on the +sand, and with a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was +sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up by a very high +tide on the sandy slope, when his meditations were disturbed by a +light step behind him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen +years of age, with a bright honest face, came running down behind him. + +"Hallo, dad!" + +"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought o' seeing you!" and the +old man clasped the boy in his arms in a way that showed the close +relationship between the two. "I didn't expect you for another week." + +"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy said; "fine wind all +the way up, with a gale or two in the right quarter. We only arrived +in the river on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I got +leave to run down to see you." + +"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old sailor said. "It's the +duty of every hand to stop by the ship till she's cleared out." + +"I have always stayed before till the crew were paid off; but no +sooner had we cast anchor than one of the owners came on board, and +told the captain that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to be +unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and sail again in a +fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was on the point of sailing for +the West Indies under a strong convoy." + +"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old sailor said. "And the goods +will have to be bundled out and in again with double speed. I know +what it will be. You will be going out with the paint all wet, and +those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off as fast as it's put on. +Well, a few days at sea will shake all down into its place. But how +did you get leave?" + +"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the lad said. "The +men who desired to leave were to be discharged at once and a fresh +gang taken on board, so I asked him directly the news came round if I +might have four days away. He agreed at once, and I came down by the +night coach; and here I am for eight-and-forty hours." + +"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after more than a year +away, but we mustn't waste the time in regretting it. You've grown, +Harry, and are getting on fast. In another couple of years you'll be +fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've got over your silly idea +about sticking to the merchant service. It's all very well to learn +your business there as a boy, and I grant that in some things a +merchantman is a better school than a king's ship. They have fewer +hands, and each man has to do more and to learn to think for himself. +Still, after all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement +and happiness." + +"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been learning a little +navigation. The first officer has been very kind to me, and I hope in +the course of two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third +mate. Still, I should like three or four years on board a man-of-war." + +"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a man ought to do his +duty to his country." + +"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to their country," the +boy said. + +"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's a great difficulty +in finding hands for the navy. Everyone wants to throw their duty upon +everyone else. They all hanker after the higher wages and loafing life +on board a merchantman, and hate to keep themselves smart and clean as +they must do in a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should serve +at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war. It is above all +things essential, Harry, that you should do your duty." + +"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said, "when the time comes. I +do it now to the best of my power, and I have in my pocket a letter +from the first officer to you. He told you when you went down with me +to see me off on my last voyage that he would keep an eye upon me, and +he has done so." + +"That's right," the old man said. "As you say, Harry, a man may do his +duty anywhere; still, for all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a +sailor, to help his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies. +Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh fifty years, and was in +action one way and another over a hundred times, and here I am now +with a snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious majesty +himself. What can you want more than that?" + +"I don't know that I can want more," the boy said, "in its way, at +least; but there are other ways in the merchant service. I might +command a ship by the time I am thirty, and be my own master instead +of being a mere part of a machine. I have heard the balls flying too," +he said, laughing. + +"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?" the old tar said, greatly +interested. + +"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer off the coast of +Spain. Fortunately the old bark carries a long eighteen, as well as +her twelves, and when the Frenchman found that we could play at long +bowls as well as himself he soon drew off, but not before we had +drilled a few holes in his sails and knocked away a bit of his +bulwarks." + +"Were you hit, Harry?" + +"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did little damage beyond +knocking away a few of the fittings and frightening the lady +passengers. We had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that the +skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman come close before +he opened fire. We should like to have towed him up the river with our +flag over the tricolor." + +"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said, "you were just as ready +to fight as if you had been on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing +ship you only get a chance if one of these privateers happens to see +you, in a king's ship you go looking about for an enemy, and when you +see one the chances are he is bigger, instead of smaller, than +yourself." + +"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it, I expect," the boy +said; "but for all that, I do mean to serve for a few years in a +man-of-war. I expect that we may have a chance of seeing some +fighting in the West Indies. There are, they say, several French +cruisers in that direction, and although we shall have a considerable +convoy the Frenchmen generally have the legs of our ships. I believe +that some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out troops, and that +we are going to have a slap at some of the French islands. Has there +been any news here since I went?" + +"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers. The revenue officers +have a busy time here. There's no such place for smuggling on the +coast as between Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just the +places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic in the Channel that +a solitary lugger does not attract the attention of the coastguard as +it does where the sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself +one way or the other about it. I may know a good deal of the +smuggling, or I may not, but it's no business of mine. If it were my +duty to lend a hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it +isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am content enough to +get my spirits cheap." + +"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the king being cheated?" +Harry said with a smile. + +"If the king himself were going to touch the money," the old sailor +said sturdily, "I would lend a hand to see that he got it, but there's +no saying where this money would have gone. Besides, if the spirits +hadn't been run, they would not have been brought over here at all, +so after all the revenue is none the worse for the smuggling." + +The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad, when you like, but you +know as well as I do that smuggling's dishonest, and that those who +smuggle cheat the revenue." + +"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I don't clearly see +that it's my duty to give information in the matter. If I did feel as +it were going to be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it, +and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything within earshot +of me, that I might feel called on to repeat. And now, let's go up to +the cottage and see the old woman." + +"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said, "as I passed. Mother +looks as hale and hearty as she did when I left, and so do you, dad." + +"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old man said. "I have been +so thoroughly seasoned with salt water that it would take a long time +for me to decay." + +When they got up to the cottage they found that Jane Langley had got +breakfast prepared. Rashers of bacon were smoking on the table, and a +large tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of tea had +not become general in this country. + +"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said, "that the boy is to +leave us again in forty-eight hours?" + +"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is hard news. I had hoped +that you would be with us for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast +in life, and may not be here when you return." + +"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing as that," Harry said. +"Father was just saying that he's so seasoned that even time cannot +make much of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as he is." + +"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when old oak does come +down, he generally falls sudden. However, we won't make our first meal +sad by talking of what might be." + +Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents of Harry's +voyage to India and back. It was his second trip. The lad had had a +much better education than most boys in his rank of life at that time, +the boatswain having placed him at the age of ten in charge of a +schoolmaster at Portsmouth. When Harry had reached that age Peter had +retired from the service, and had settled down at Hayling, but for two +years longer he had kept Harry at school. Then he had apprenticed him +to a firm of shipowners in London, and one of the officers under whom +Peter had served had spoken to the heads of the firm, so that the boy +was put in a ship commanded by a kind and considerate officer, and to +whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus he had not forgotten +what he had learned at school, as is too often the case with lads in +his position. His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what he +knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each day such subjects as +would be useful to him in his career. + +After breakfast the pair again went out onto the sandhills, Peter, as +usual, carrying a huge telescope with him, with which he was in the +habit of surveying every ship as she rounded the west of the island +and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth. Most of the +men-of-war he knew in an instant, and the others he could make a +shrewd guess at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full of talk +of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's future bearing, and of +suggestions and hints as to the best course to be adopted in various +emergencies. But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and smoked +his pipe, and looked out in silence over the sea, scarcely even +lifting his telescope to his eye. + +"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last, "that as you are going +away again, and, as the old woman says, you may not find us both here +when you come back, it is right that I should tell you a little more +about yourself. I once told you, years ago, that you were not my son, +and that I would give you more particulars some day." + +The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It was a matter which +he had often thought over in his mind, for although he loved the +honest tar and his good wife as much as he could have done his natural +parents, still, since he had known that he was their adopted son only, +he had naturally wondered much as to who his parents were, and what +was their condition in life. + +"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not to tell you this +here yarn until you were getting on. Boys' heads get upset with a +little breeze, especially if they have no ballast, and though it isn't +likely now that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and it +will make no difference whether it was a duke or a ship's caulker who +was your father, still it's right that you should know the facts, as +no one can say when they start on a voyage in life what craft they may +fall aboard before they've done. It may be, Harry, that as you intends +to stick to the merchant service--saving, of course, that little time +you mean to serve on board a king's ship--you may rise to be a +skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy, that as a skipper you +may fall in love with some taut craft sailing in your convoy. I've +seen such things before now, and then the fact that you might be, for +aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of being that of a +boatswain, might score in your favor. Women have curious notions, and +though, for my part, I can't see that it makes much difference where +the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and well-built, +there are those who thinks different. + +"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen years ago that I +was boatswain aboard the _Alert_ frigate, as taut a craft as ever +sailed. We had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd want to +see. We were cruising in the West Indies, and had for months been, +off and on, in chase of a craft that had done much damage there. She +carried a black flag, and her skipper was said to be the biggest +villain that ever even commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed but +some ship was missing. It mattered little to him whether she sailed +under the English, the French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to +him. Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never reached Europe. +Sometimes a few charred timbers would be thrown up on the shore of the +islands, showing that the ship to which they belonged had been taken +and burned before she had gone many days on her way. Often and often +had the pirate been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in itself a +very unusual thing with pirates--indeed, I never knew of one before. +But she had been, I believe, a merchantman captured by the pirate, and +was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her, and handed his own +schooner over to his mate. Somehow or other he had altered her +ballast, and maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have a +rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are so strong that they +can, if need be, build a ship of their own. Anyhow, she was the +fastest ship of her class that ever was seen on those seas, and though +our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she laughed at them, +and would for a whole day keep just out of reach of their bow-chasers +with half her sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under +every rag they could put on their masts. Then when she was tired of +that game she would hoist her full canvas and leave the king's vessel +behind as if she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got +caught by cruisers coming up in different directions, but each time +she managed to slip away without ever having a rope or stay started by +a shot. We in the _Alert_ had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but +had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the mere name of the +_Seamew_ was sufficient to put any one of us into a passion. There +wasn't one of the ship's company, from the captain down to the +powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully given a year's pay to get +alongside the _Seamew_. The _Alert_ carried thirty-two guns, and our +crew was stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there was a +good deal of boat service, and it was considered that at any moment +'Yellow Jack' might lay a good many hands up--or down, as the case may +be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto Rico, and the first +lieutenant had strolled up with two of the middies to the top of a +hill just before the sun went down. He had taken a glass with him. +Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck, who was +looking at the shore with a glass, said to the second lieutenant, who +was on watch: + +"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen and Hobart down that hill +as if he were running a race. He isn't likely to be racing the +middies. What can he be after?' + +"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile; 'Mr. Jones is hardly +likely to be racing the middies'; which, indeed, was true enough, for +the first lieutenant was as stiff as a ramrod--a good officer, but as +strict a martinet as ever I sailed under. + +"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw that, whatever the +reason might be, it was as the midshipman had said. The news that Mr. +Jones was coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was after him, +soon spread, and there was quite an excitement on the quarter-deck as +to what could be the matter. + +"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming off to the ship, and +it was evident, by the way the spray was flying and the oars bending, +that the men were pulling as if for life or death. By this time the +news had spread through the ship, and the captain himself was on the +quarter-deck. + +"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as the boat came within +call he shouted, 'What's the matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?' + +"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up and making a trumpet +with his two hands, 'two craft together round the point of the island +some fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line, but by +their look I think that one is the _Seamew_ and the other a +merchantman she has captured.' + +"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the orders sharp and quick. +The men, who were all standing about, were in a minute clustering on +the yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster than it was on +the _Alert_ that evening. Before the boat was fairly run up to the +davits the anchor was at the cat-head, and the _Alert's_ bows were +pointing seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every stitch of +canvas set, we were running out of the harbor. The first lieutenant +had taken the bearings pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk +evening breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By this time it +was dark, and we had every hope that we might come upon the pirate +before she had finished transferring the cargo of her prize under her +own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as the moon was not up we +hoped to get within gunshot before being seen, as the pirate, seeing +no craft within sight before the sun went down, would not suspect that +the _Alert_ could be on his traces. We had to sail close to the wind +till we were round the point of the island, and then to run nearly +before it towards the spot where the vessels had been seen. In two +hours from the time of starting we reckoned that we must be getting +close to them if they still remained hove-to. + +"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point or two off the +starboard bow, a great flame shot up. Every moment it grew and grew +until we could see a large ship in flames, while another lay about a +quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were pulling from the +ship in flames towards the other, and as this was a bark we had no +doubt that we had caught the _Seamew_ at her villainous work. The +pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman, so that while +her spars stood out clear and distinct against the glare of light we +must have been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly forward +for the men to go to quarters. Every gun was double-shotted and run +out, and then, all being ready for the fight, the men stripped to +their waists, cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we waited +with breathless anxiety. We were already within range of our +bow-chasers, and as yet there was no sign that the pirate was +conscious of our presence. The boats were now near him, and no doubt +those on board were looking rather in their direction than to +windward. Rapidly the _Alert_ tore through the water, the sail +trimmers were all ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's +notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck, and the men stood +by their guns with every eye strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer +we came, and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were within a mile +now, when suddenly a great movement was seen on board the pirate. The +breeze was steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command could +be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran up the rattlins. It was clear +we were seen. There was no further need of concealment, and the +captain gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as the pirate +got her canvas spread--and I do think that sharp as we had been on +board the _Alert_, the _Seamew_ was even quicker in getting under +canvas--we were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she got +fairly under way. Up to this moment not a gun had spoken save the two +bow-chasers, as the captain would not yaw her until the last moment +Then round she came and poured a broadside into the _Seamew_. Orders +had been given to fire high, and every man was on his mettle. The +maintop-mast of the _Seamew_ fell, snapped at the cap; the peak +halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a number of holes were +drilled through her sails. A loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as +the _Seamew_ was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent her +getting away, and at last she was to show whether she could fight as +well as run, and I must say for her she did. + +"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two, but they were of +far heavier metal, and after ten minutes the _Alert_ was as much +bruised and battered as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of equal +size for an hour. However, we had not been idle, and as our shot had +been principally directed against the enemy's rigging, as our great +object was to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away, she +was by this time a mere wreck above, although her sides were scarcely +touched; whereas two of our ports had been knocked into one, and some +thirty of our men had been struck down either by shot or by splinters. +Pouring a last broadside into her, the captain ordered the _Alert_ to +be brought alongside the _Seamew_. There was no need to call upon the +boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared, and as the vessels came +alongside our men rushed to the assault. But the crew of the _Seamew_ +were as eager to board us as we were them, and upon the very bulwarks +a desperate combat ensued. Strong as we were, the _Seamew_ carried +fully as many hands, and as they were fighting with halters round +their necks it's little wonder that they fought so well. + +"I've been in a good many fights, but never did I see one like that. +Each man hacked, and hewed, and wielded his boarding-pike as if the +whole fight depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the men +whose places were at the guns on the starboard side left their places +and joined in the fight, while those on the port side continued to +pour a fire of grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour before +we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and then steadily and +gradually we fought our way forward. But it was another half-hour +after the pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and +fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered. + +"On board the _Alert_ we had fully one-third of our complement killed +or wounded. Mr. Jones had been shot through the head; the second and +third lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain himself had +had his jaw broken by a pistol fired in his face. I got this scar on +my cheek, which spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I +had been over thirty years married to the old woman that made but +little difference. Never were a crew more glorious than we were that +night. Even the wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply +purchased. We had captured the scourge of these seas, which had for +ten years laughed at all the fastest cruisers of our navy, and we felt +as proud as if we had captured a French first-rate. + +"All hands were at work next day in repairing damages. I was up aloft +seeing to the fitting of fresh gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw +something floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed to me +like a box, and an empty one, for it floated high on the water. Its +lid seemed to be open, and I thought once or twice that I saw +something inside. I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I +had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty with his arm in a +sling, was not disposed to take the men off their work to lower a +boat; but as I pointed out that the box might have belonged to the +merchantman which had been burned overnight, and that it might afford +some clew as to the name of the ship, he consented, and with four +hands I was soon rowing towards the box. + +"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I was never more +surprised than when, getting there, I found that it was a trunk, and +that in it, sitting up, was a child about eighteen months old. That +was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were a locket with a +woman's likeness in it, a curious Indian bangle, and a few other +articles of jewelry. How you got there we never knew, but the +supposition was that when the pirate was overhauling the merchantman, +and her true nature was ascertained, some mother, knowing the fate +that awaited all on board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in +what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped the trunk overboard, +in hopes that it might drift away and be picked up by some passing +ship. It was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against its +success, but the Lord had watched over it, and there you were as snug +and comfortable as if you had been laying in your own cot, though, by +the way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens, and I +expect had missed your breakfast considerably. You were sitting up, +and it was lucky that you were backward of your age, for, although by +your size we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still unable +to walk. If you had been as active as some chaps of that age you would +have scrambled onto your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat. + +"Well, we brought you on board, and there was a great talk as to what +was to be done with you; but as I was your discoverer I claimed you as +a lawful prize, and I thought you would amuse the old woman while I +was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort to me when I got laid up in +ordinary, as indeed you have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every +inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship which exactly +answered to the description. You see, beyond the fact that she was a +square-rigged ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments +found in the box seemed to show that she had come from the East +Indies, but of course that could not be, for what would she be doing +there? But at any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and who +was no doubt your mother, had been to the East Indies, or at least had +been given those ornaments by someone who had, for there was no doubt +where they were turned out. + +"Well, on board the _Alert_ everyone got promoted. There was enough +valuable property found on board the _Seamew_ to give us a handsome +sum all round, and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled me +to buy this little cottage, and went no small way towards paying for +your schooling and board. As no one else claimed you, and your friends +could not be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship; +and so, my boy, here you have been cruising about the world as Harry +Langley ever since." + +The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some time before he spoke. + +"Well, dad, you may not have been my real father, but no one could +have been a better father to me than you have, and as it isn't likely +now that I shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to discover +who I am, I shall continue to regard you as my real father. Still, as +you say, it may perhaps in life be some advantage to me to be able to +claim that I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily. They +talked the matter over for some time, and then Harry changed the +subject. + +"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked. + +"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his cable six months since, and +his wife, poor old soul, is gone to some friends near Winchester." + +"Who's living in the cottage?" + +"Black Jack has taken it." + +"What! has he moved from his old place, then?" + +"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy, who comes down off +and on. They say he's in the smuggling business with Black Jack, and +that he disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over in the +_Lucy_, and that Jack trades over in France with his friends. The +lieutenant at the coast-guard station has his eye upon him, and I +believe that some day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo; +but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day for Hayling if +they could do so, for he and his crew do a lot of harm to the place. +They look more like men who have belonged to the _Seamew_ I was +talking to you about than honest English fishermen." + +"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman should be coming +backwards and forwards here, and I wonder that the revenue people +don't inquire into it." + +"I don't suppose that they know very much about it, Harry. He comes +off and on, generally arriving at night, and leaving a few hours +afterwards. I hear about these things because everyone knows that old +Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into other people's +business. I don't like these goings on, I must say, and consider they +will end badly. However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our +brandy cheap in Hayling--nowhere cheaper, I should say--and that, +after all, is the matter that concerns us most. The wind's rising +fast; I think we're in for a gale." + +It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast behind the island, +the waves were breaking with a short, sharp sound upon the beach, +white heads were beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing +craft were running in towards Portsmouth under reefed sails, the +men-of-war at Spithead could be seen sending down their topmasts, and +everything betokened that it would be a nasty night. + +"What time must you leave, Harry?" + +"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall cross the ferry, and +catch the coach as it goes along at eight. I promised that I would be +back on the following morning, and I would not fail in keeping my +appointment, for as the captain has been so good I should be sorry +that he should think that I had broken my word." + +In the course of the day Harry went over to the village and saw many +of his boy friends. Bill Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened +to be away, but his parents said that he would be back at nine in the +evening. He had gone over to Winchester to see a brother who was in a +regiment quartered there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock Harry +said to his father that he would just walk over to have a chat with +his friend, and be back in an hour or so. + +"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at once," Jane Langley said; +"if thou hast to start at three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed +now." + +"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said, laughing, "and I shall +be able to sleep long to-morrow." + +Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple, and went off at a run +into the darkness. + +The road was a wide one, and but little frequented, and the grass grew +thick over a considerable portion of the sides, therefore as he ran +along with a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was +deadened. As he came along by the cottage of which he had been +speaking to Peter Langley he heard the sound of voices within. Being +curious to see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry paused, +lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered the little garden. +He had intended to peep in at the window, and having satisfied his +curiosity to be off; but just as he reached the door the latter opened +suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw back behind the little porch +before two men came out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the +smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting English evidently +the foreigner. They stopped for a moment, looking out into the night. + +"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be a storm, and no +mistake. The _Lucy_ is a tight craft, and has weathered gales when +many a bigger ship has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into +it without necessity." + +"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have sought zat ze earning of +five hundred pounds was as urgent a necezity as was wanted." + +"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the smuggler said, "though one +does put one's head into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is +bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important." + +"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter about ze nooze? It +hasn't got over your zick neck or my zin one, and till it does we +needn't trouble about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch +we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand zey cannot grudge us +double pay. I have ridden from London wizout stopping, and have killed +a horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat matters not. Zis +letter should fetch us ze money to pay for a dozen horses and a dozen +of your _Lucys_." + +"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we will be off. Letters +like that in your pocket are best not kept on hand. You are sure that +the _Chasse Marée_ will put out to meet us in such weather as we are +likely to have?" + +"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the Frenchman said. "Zey +know ze importance of ze news, which is expected, and which I am +bringing zem. _Mon Dieu!_ what sums have been paid to get ze news +zat's in zis little dispatch!" + +"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said. + +"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but I believe it is ze +orders zat are to be sent to ze British fleet, and zat zey are about +to strike a great blow zomewhere." + +"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and tell the boys. I +warned them to be in readiness, and I will send them straight down to +the beach. In a quarter of an hour I will return for you." + +While this conversation had been going on Harry had been standing +against the porch, the sides of which were filled with latticework +over which a creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance of +the secret that he was hearing, and had been rapidly meditating in his +mind how this all-portant information which was about to be conveyed +to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up his mind that the +instant the smuggler moved out he would make his way down to the +village, tell the tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman +seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult, for the smuggler +and his gang were not men to be attacked with impunity, and the +fishers of the village would hesitate in taking part in such a +struggle merely on the information of a boy. However, Harry saw that +it was the only chance. + +In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so hide himself from +the view of the two men who were standing on the little garden-path in +front, he pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was rotten with +age, and suddenly with a crash it gave way. + +With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he and the Frenchman +dashed to the spot, and in an instant had collared the lad. In a +moment he was dragged into the room. + +"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler said, with a terrible +imprecation. "The scoundrel has heard what we've said, and our lives +won't be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free. Stand by +and I'll knock out his brains;" and he seized a heavy poker from the +side of the hearth. + +"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have blood. Zere might be +inquiries, and zese sings will sometimes be found. Better take him to +sea wis you in ze _Lucy_, and hand him over to ze _Chasse Marée_. Zey +will take care zat he does not come back again." + +"I will take care myself," the smuggler said. "I'm not going to risk +my neck on the chance of his blabbing. It's better, as you say, to +have no blood, but as soon as the _Lucy's_ at sea overboard he goes." + +"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm wis you zat he must be +silenced, but it may be better--my plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I +suppose, to ze village?" + +"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight. He's the son of an +old man-of-war's man who lives half a mile away." + +"Well, you see, some of your men might some day, if they quarreled wis +you, or in zeir drink, drop some words which might lead to inquiries. +Better put him on board ze _Chasse Marée_. I will see ze matter is +settled." + +Harry had spoken no word from the time he was grasped. He felt in an +instant that his life was forfeited, and was surprised that he had not +been instantly killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo, for he +knew that no cottagers were near, and was sure that an attempt to give +the alarm would insure his instant death. To struggle would have been +useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad, was but a child in +the grasp of a powerful man like the smuggler. He saw, too, that on +the instant the Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and +though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the tone of his voice +that he was as determined as his colleague that his silence should be +secured by death. + +In another minute he was bound and thrown into a corner. The Frenchman +then took his seat near him, assuring him in a low tone that he would +at his first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The smuggler +strolled off to summon his crew, and for a quarter of an hour silence +reigned in the cottage. + +"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last, as if he had been +thinking the matter over--"one meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen +at people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want to kill you, +but what are we to do? You make us kill you. You push your own head +into ze trap. Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling in +affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze trouble to kill zem. I +would give a hundred pounds if zis had not happened; but what can I +do? It is my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to have to do +it--_parbleu!_ my life is of much more value zan zat of a fishing boy. +Bah! you are one meddlesome fool." + +So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble which the prying of +this lad had brought upon him that he got up and angrily gave him a +kick. A few minutes later the smuggler returned. + +"The men have all gone down to the boat," he said briefly. "Come +along, mounseer. Bring that tin case with you, and those pistols." + +"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the Frenchman said. "As to +ze pistols--zey are not of much use. However, I will take zem;" and he +thrust them into the pockets of his coat. + +The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw him onto a sail which he +had laid on the ground, wrapped this round him, and then cast him over +his shoulder. + +"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the boat," he said, "but +should I do so I'm taking the mainsail of the _Lucy_ down to her." + +In another minute Harry heard the door slam, and then he felt himself +being carried steadily along, his weight being as nothing to the +smuggler. Not a word was spoken between the two men on their way down +to the shore. Presently Harry felt by the deadened sound of the +footsteps, and by the more uneven motion, that he was being carried +over the sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and through the +canvas he could hear the loud roar of the waves, which were now +breaking violently. + +Presently he was flung roughly down on the sands. A minute later he +was lifted by the head and feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was +spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers, and after ten +minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock, and knew that they were +alongside of the _Lucy_. He was hauled up on deck. He heard a few +words of command, and then felt the vessel was on her way. A minute or +two later the covering was unloosed. His cords were cut, and the +smuggler said to him, "You can't get away now, and may as well make +yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that rope." + +The _Lucy_ was, in fact, short-handed, two of the six men who composed +her crew being absent. She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons' +burden, built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but longer and +lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing when her crew were not +engaged upon other adventures. She was a remarkably fast craft, and +had more than once showed her heels with success when chased by the +revenue cutters. She owed her immunity from capture, however, chiefly +to her appearance, as from her size and build she generally passed +unsuspected as an innocent fisherman. + +The storm increased in violence, and the little lugger, although a +good sea-boat, had difficulty in making her way almost in the teeth of +the gale. She was bound, Harry gained from a word or two dropped by +the captain, for the mouth of the Loire, off which she was to be met +by the _Chasse Marée_. Long before morning the coast of England was +out of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel bravely +holding her way in the sou'westerly gale. + +"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman asked the smuggler. + +"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the wind holds as at +present. Two o'clock in the morning is the time named, and if your +people are as punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will be +gained. There's one thing--in such a gale as is blowing to-day none of +our cruisers who may be off the coast are likely to trouble themselves +about a boat like ours. They may wonder what we are doing at sea, but +are scarcely likely to chase us." + +Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels were seen in the +distance, which Harry knew, by the cut of their sails, to be English +cruisers. All were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas, and +Harry knew that any assistance from them was out of the question. +Towards evening the gale moderated, but the sea was still very high. +During the day Harry had turned over in his mind every possible plan +by which he might destroy the tin case which contained, as he knew, +such important documents. From what he had gathered he learned that +the success of some great undertaking upon which the British fleet +were about to embark would be marred if these papers were to find +their way into the hands of the French authorities. His own life he +regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure that no sooner was +he fairly on board the French _Chasse Marée_ than he would, at the +orders of the French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life had +been so preserved, not from any feeling of mercy, but in order that +his death might be accomplished with less risk to those whose safety +demanded it. + +He was determined, if opportunity presented, to seize the little case +and to leap overboard with it. The French spy never for one moment put +it down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the top, and some +eight inches long by three inches wide, and the same deep. Sometimes +the Frenchman put it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but +even then he took the precaution always to keep his hand upon it. +During the day Harry was constantly employed in work on board the +lugger, hauling at ropes and acting as if he were one of the regular +crew. He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond a curse now +and then not a word had been addressed to him by any on board. The +night came on; the wind was still going down, but the sea was very +heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the stars could be seen +shining brightly, and once or twice the moon broke through and spread +a light over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler became +anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead. + +"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the Frenchman, "and we are +nearly off the mouth of the river. When the moon shone out just now I +thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and I believe to +windward an English cruiser is lying. However, I will get ready the +lanterns." + +The next time the moon came out a vessel was clearly seen. The +smuggler raised the lantern above the bulwarks, held it there for half +a minute, and then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A moment +later a similar signal was made on the bows of the vessel. + +"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly, "and the five hundred +pounds is as good as in my pocket!" + +As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward. + +"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser has caught sight of +the Frenchman. However, we shall be on board in plenty of time, and +whether she gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me. I shall +have done my part of the work, and you, mounseer, will give me the +order for payment on London." + +"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said; "you've done your work +well. Here's the order." + +By this time the French craft was within a distance of a quarter of a +mile, running down at a great pace under her reefed sails. + +"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the smuggler said, "for the +sea is running tremendously. They will have to throw a rope, and you +will have to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose your +dispatch-box is water-tight?" + +"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked. + +"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler said, "and you can haul +him on board too. It won't make much matter whether I slip the noose +round his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest plan perhaps, +for then, if he happens not to be alive when you pull him out, it +would be an accident; and even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't +swear that it was purposely done." + +Harry was standing near, and heard the words. He was close to the helm +at the time, and watched with intense anxiety as the _Chasse Marée_ +ran rapidly down to them. It was clear that what had to be done must +be done quickly, for another flash came up from the cruiser; and +although in the din of the wind and the toss of the waves it could not +be seen where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash showed +that she had come up since the last shot was discharged. The _Chasse +Marée_ ran down, and as she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks +and shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady, and as I run +past I will throw a rope." + +"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are two to come on board." + +The course taken by the _Chasse Marée_ would bring her along at a +distance of some ten yards from the side of the lugger. At the moment +a squall came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards the +approaching craft. When she was just upon them Harry saw that his one +chance of escape had come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at +the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard. The lugger paid +off instantly. Black Jack, with an oath, turned round and sprang at +Harry. The lad leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the +Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him, and snatching the +tin box from his hand leaped overboard. + +Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it had been sufficient. +The vessel had paid off from the wind, and before the helmsman could +regain his feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay across +the course of the _Chasse Marée_; and in another moment the French +craft plunged down upon her, and with a crash the _Lucy_ sank under +her bows, and went down with all on board. + +As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a shout of dismay from those +on board the _Lucy_. When he came up a minute later he saw the _Chasse +Marée_ plowing her way from him, but no sign of the _Lucy_ was to be +seen. Harry was a good swimmer, and fortunately the dispatch-box which +he grasped was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket he felt +that it kept his head easily above the water. He swam as well as he +could away from the spot where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew +that if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being run down and +should see him, his death was certain--not indeed that his chances +were in any case good, but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he +clung to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as +possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he must have speedily +succumbed, for in so heavy a sea it was difficult in the extreme to +swim. However, after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and +suffered himself quietly to drift. + +Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense delight, morning +began to break. He saw on his right the low shores of the French +coast, and looking round beheld seaward the British cruiser which had +fired at the _Chasse Marée_. She was running quietly along the coast, +and was evidently on guard at the mouth of the river. The sea had now +gone down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost cloudless sky. + +Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at once swam towards her. +She was farther out by a mile than the spot where he was swimming, and +was some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but slowly, and he +hoped that by the time she came along he would be able to get within +a distance whence he might be seen. His fear was that she might run +back before she reached the spot where she would be nearer to him. + +With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping his eye fixed +steadily on the ship. Still she came onward, and was within half a +mile when she was abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he +could from the water, he shouted at the top of his voice. Again and +again he splashed with his hands to make as much spray and commotion +as possible in order to attract attention. His heart almost stood +still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a moment later he +saw the vessel come round into the wind, and lay there with her sails +back. Then a boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was hauled +in, his senses almost leaving him now that the time for exertion had +passed. It was not until he had been lifted onto the deck of the +_Viper_, and brandy had been poured down his throat, that he was able +to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently recovered he was sent for to +the captain's cabin. + +"And who are you, boy, and whence do you come?" the captain asked. "Do +you belong to the _Chasse Marée_, which we chased in the night?" + +The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry had fallen overboard +from that craft. + +"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped from a lugger which was +run down by the French craft just as you were firing at her." + +"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my eyes had not been wrong. +I was sure that I saw a small fishing-boat close to the _Chasse +Marée_. We lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon, and +thought we must have been mistaken. How came you there in an English +fishing-boat?" + +Harry modestly told the story, and produced the dispatch-box. + +"This is important news indeed," the officer said, "and your conduct +has been in every way most gallant. What is your name, lad?" + +"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice on board the Indiaman +_Dundas Castle_, and was to have sailed this week in the convoy for +the West Indies." + +"You will not be able to do that now," the captain said. "This is most +important. However, the steward will take charge of you, and I will +talk to you again presently." + +The steward was called, and was told to put Harry into a cot slung for +him, and to give him a bowl of warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad +was asleep. + +The _Viper_ shortly afterwards hauled her wind, and ran down to a +consort who was keeping watch with her over the mouth of the Loire. +The captain repaired on board the other ship, whose commander was his +senior officer, and a consultation was held between them, after which +the _Viper_ was again got under sail and shaped her course for +Portsmouth. + +The wind was fair, and the next morning the _Viper_ passed through +the Needles, and soon afterwards anchored at Spithead. Here a large +number of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and above two of the +largest floated the flags of admirals. The _Viper_ had made her signal +as she came in sight of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up +from the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain to come +on board immediately the anchor was dropped. The moment this was done +the captain's gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him the +captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and rowed for the admiral's +ship. Directing the lad to remain on deck, the captain at once entered +the admiral's cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's orderly +summoned Harry to enter. + +Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a breakfast party, for a +number of naval officers, including Admiral Nelson and most of the +captains of the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The admiral +turned to Harry. + +"So you are the lad who has brought this box of dispatches?" + +"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly. + +"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said. "It's a strange +one." + +Harry again repeated the account of his adventures from the time of +leaving his father's cottage. When he had done Admiral Nelson +exclaimed: + +"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted with more presence of +mind had you been a captain of the fleet. You showed great bravery +and did your duty nobly." + +"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said modestly, "for I knew +that they were going to kill me anyhow, so that it made no difference. +But I was determined, if possible, that the dispatches should be +destroyed." + +The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to hear his dicta even so +slightly questioned by a lad. + +"You are an apprentice in the merchant service, Captain Skinner tells +me," Sir Hyde Parker said, "and have been two years at sea." + +"Yes, sir," Harry said. + +"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one of his majesty's +vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?" + +Harry's eyes glistened at the question. + +"I should indeed, sir," he said. + +"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered. "Have any of you +gentlemen a vacancy in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him +ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship." + +"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of the captains said. +"Poor little De Lisle fell overboard the night before last as we came +round from Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and I'll +arrange for him to have his togs. I like his look, and I should be +glad to have him with me. I am sure he will be a credit to the +service." + +"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You are now, sir," he said, +turning to Harry again, "an officer in his majesty's service, and, as +Captain Ball remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service. A +lad who does his duty when death is staring him in the face, and +without a hope that the act of devotion will ever be known or +recognized, is sure to make a brave and worthy officer." + +Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece of paper, and said to +the admiral's servant, "Will you tell the midshipman of my gig to come +here?" + +A minute afterwards the midshipman entered. The captain gave him the +slip of paper and said, "Take this young gentleman on board the ship +with you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and with him give +this note. He will be your shipmate in future. See that he's made +comfortable." + +The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow him, gazing askance, +and with no slight astonishment in his face, at the appearance of his +new messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance with the +received ideas of that of a midshipman freshly joining a ship. His +clothes were all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his +trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves. Without a word the +midshipman took his place in the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to +sit beside him. + +"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly. + +"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said with a laugh. +"Before that from his majesty's ship _Viper_, and before that from the +sea." + +"You look like the sea," said the midshipman. "But what have you been +doing? Have you served before?" + +"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only just been appointed." + +The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's appearance to question him +further. He felt that there was some mystery in the affair, and that +it would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing upon which +Harry was placed. He had little doubt from the fact of his appointment +being made under such circumstances that there must be something at +once singular and noteworthy about it. + +Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at once led him up to the +first lieutenant, and presented the captain's note. The lieutenant +opened it and glanced at the contents. They were brief: + +"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman on board the _Cæsar_, and +has been promoted by Sir Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most +gallant action, and one of the greatest importance. Make him at home +at once, and let him have poor De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about +it." + +The senior midshipman was at once sent for by Mr. Francis, and Harry +handed over to him. The first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the +contents of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to make him +as comfortable as possible. + +Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival was greeted with +a storm of questions, as his appearance on the quarter-deck had +naturally excited a great deal of observation. The midshipman who had +come with him could, of course, furnish no information, and beyond the +brief fact mentioned by the captain and repeated by the first +lieutenant, his new conductor could say no more. + +"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got into his new clothes +and looks presentable. He's in my charge, and I am to make him +comfortable. As he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde +himself you may be sure he has done something out of the way." + +In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full midshipman's dress, and +being a very good-looking and gentlemanly lad, his appearance +favorably impressed his new messmates, who had at first been disposed +to resent the intrusion among themselves of a youngster whose +appearance was at least the reverse of reputable. + +"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting will resolve itself +into a committee. Let everyone who can, sit down; and let those who +can't, stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now, prisoner at +the bar," he said, "what is your name?" + +"Harry Langley." + +"And how came you here?" + +"I was brought in the captain's gig." + +"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what brought you onto the +quarter-deck?" + +"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent a very important +dispatch falling into the hands of the French." + +"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and how was that? That is to +say," he said, "if there's no secret about it?" + +"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very simple;" and for the +second time that morning he told the story. + +When he had done there was a general exclamation of approval among +those present, and the midshipmen crowded round him, shaking his hand, +patting him on the back, and declaring that he was a trump. + +"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said, "and is received as a +worthy member of this noble body. Boy!" + +"Yes, sir." + +"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two bottles of rum for this +honorable mess to drink the health of a new comrade." + +Presently the boy returned. + +"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the rum?" + +There was a roar of laughter among the middies, for the master's mate, +who had acted as president, was notoriously in the purser's books to +the full amount of his credit. However, a midshipman, who happened +that morning to have received a remittance, undertook to stand the +liquor to the mess, and Harry's health was drunk with all honors. + +"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that the contents of the +dispatch were with reference to the point to which we are all bound. I +wonder where it can be?" + +Here an animated discussion arose as to the various points against +which the attack of the fleet, now rapidly assembling at Spithead, +might be directed. So far no whisper of its probable course had been +made public, and it was believed indeed that even the captains of the +fleet were ignorant of its object. + +Upon the following day Harry at once obtained leave to go on shore for +twenty-four hours. Immediately he reached the Head he chartered a +wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he heard a well-known +voice among a group of sailors standing near him. + +"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley said. "My boy left me +merely to go down to the village, and was to have returned the first +thing in the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he never came +back no more. What he did with himself, unless he sailed in a +smuggling lugger which put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make +out. The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly, and I +can see no reason why he should have gone otherwise. He didn't cross +the ferry, and I can't help suspecting there was some foul play. When +Black Jack returns I will have it out of him if I kill him for it. He +has a strong party there, and I want half a dozen good tight hands to +come with me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a couple of days, +and if we tackle him directly he lands we may find out something about +him. Who will go with me?" + +Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were willing to assist their +old mate, when suddenly Harry stepped in among them, saying, "There's +no occasion for that. I can tell them all about him." + +Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment, and stared +open-mouthed at Harry. + +"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it isn't Harry himself, and +in a midshipman's rig. What means this, my boy?" + +"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on board his majesty's ship +_Cæsar_." + +Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with astonishment, and then +threw his tarpaulin high in the air with a shout of delight. It fell +into the water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no further +thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung it with enthusiastic +delight. + +"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To think of seeing you on the +quarter-deck, and that so soon!" + +It was some minutes before Harry could shake himself free from his +friends, all of whom were old chums of the boatswain, and had known +him in his childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him to a +quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment of the veteran, he +related to him the circumstances which had led to his elevation. The +old sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration, and it +was only the consideration that beyond doubt Black Jack and the +Frenchman had both perished in the _Lucy_ that restrained him from +instantly rushing off to take vengeance upon them. + +An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed to Hayling, where the +joy of Peter was rivaled by that of Harry's foster-mother. That +evening Peter went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the +seafaring population in honor of the event that the village was a +scene of rejoicing and festivity such as was unknown in its quiet +annals. + +The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and commenced his regular duties +as a midshipman on board. + +A week later the whole of the ships destined to take part in it had +arrived. The "Blue Peter" was hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun +firing from the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and the fleet +soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted of eighteen sail of the +line, with a number of frigates and gunboats. The expedition was +commanded by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson second in command. +Contrary to the general expedition they sailed eastward instead of +passing through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of England, +passed through the Straits of Dover and stood out into the North Sea. + +Harry had had an interview with his captain four days after he had +joined. The latter told him that the dispatch-box which he had taken +had been sent up to London, and that its contents proved to be of the +highest importance, and that the Lords of the Admiralty had themselves +written to the admiral expressing their extreme satisfaction at the +capture, saying that the whole of their plans would have been +disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of the enemy. They +were pleased to express their strong approval of the conduct of Harry +Langley, and gave their assurance that when the time came his claim +for promotion should not be ignored. + +"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure that when you have +passed your cadetship you will get your epaulette without loss of +time, and if you are steady and well conducted you may look out for a +brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter the navy under such +favorable conditions. I should advise you to study hard in order to +fit yourself for command when the time should come. From what you tell +me your education has not been neglected, and I have no doubt you know +as much as the majority of my midshipmen as to books. But books are +not all. An officer in his majesty's service should be a gentleman. +That you are that in manner, I am happy to see. But it is desirable +also that an officer should be able in all society to hold his own in +point of general knowledge with other gentlemen. Midshipmen, as a +class, are too much given to shirking their studies, and to think that +if an officer can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required. +It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you will find that the +men who have most made their mark are all something more than rough +sailors. I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at all times +and hazards doing your duty. That is a lesson that you have clearly +already learned." + +As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose higher and higher as to +the object of the expedition. Some supposed that a dash was to be made +on Holland. Others conceived that the object of the expedition must be +one of the North German or Russian forts, and the latter were +confirmed in their ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found to +be entering the Sound. Instead of passing through, however, the fleet +anchored here, out of gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great +was the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the fleet when +it became known that an ultimatum had been sent on shore, and that the +Danes (who had been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon at +once to surrender their fleet to the English. + +Upon the face of facts known to the world at large, this was indeed a +most monstrous breach of justice and right. The Danes had taken no +part in the great struggle which had been going on, and their +sympathies were generally supposed to be with the English rather than +the French. Thus, for a fleet to appear before the capital of Denmark, +and to summon its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed +act of brute force. + +In fact, however, the English government had learned that negotiations +had been proceeding between the Danish government and the French; and +that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which the Danes should +join the French at a given moment, and the united fleets being +augmented by ships of other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon +England. Had this secret confederation not been interfered with, the +position of England would have been seriously threatened. The fleet +which the allies would have been able to put onto the scene would have +greatly exceeded that which England could have mustered to defend her +coast, and although peace nominally prevailed between England and +Denmark the English ministry considered itself justified--and +posterity has agreed in the verdict--in taking time by the forelock, +and striking a blow before their seeming ally had time to throw off +the mask and to join in the projected attack upon them. + +It was the news of this secret resolve on the part of the cabinet +that, having in some way been obtained by a heavy bribe from a +subordinate in the admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to +France in the _Lucy_, and had it reached its destination the Danes +would have been warned in time, and the enterprise undertaken by +Parker and Nelson would have been impossible, for the forts of +Copenhagen, aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too strong to have +been attacked had they been thoroughly prepared for the strife. As all +these matters were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was the +astonishment when the captains of the ships assembled in the admiral's +cabin, and each received orders as to the position which his vessel +was to take up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This being +settled, the captains returned to their respective ships. + +Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the Danes finally +refused compliance with the English demands the long-looked-for signal +was hoisted and the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine +sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve line-of-battle +ships and a number of frigates under Admiral Nelson, steered on +through the Sound, followed at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker +with the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound cannonaded +them, but their fire was very ineffectual, and the fleet without +replying steered on until they had attained the position intended for +them. The Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of thirteen +men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported by floating batteries +mounting seventy heavy guns, was moored in a line four miles long in +front of the town, and was further supported by the forts on shore. + +This great force was to be engaged by the squadron of Admiral Nelson +alone, as that of Sir Hyde Parker remained outside menacing the +formidable Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding their fire +to that of the fleet and other shore batteries upon Nelson's squadron. + +The _Cæsar_, the leading ship of the fleet, had been directed to sail +right past the line of ships and to operate against a detached fort +standing on a spit of land on the right flank of the Danish position. +This fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of the Cæsar in +weight, but the crew were in high spirits at the prospect of a fight, +little as they understood the cause for which they were engaged. +Stripping to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer at +his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen, being upon the +quarter-deck near the captain to carry orders from him as might be +required to different parts of the ship. As the _Cæsar_ passed along +the line of ships to take up her position she was saluted by a storm +of fire from the Danish vessels, to which she made no reply. She +suffered, however, but little injury, although shot and shell whistled +between the masts and struck the water on all sides of her, several +striking the hull with a dull, crashing sound, while her sails were +pierced with holes. Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was +disgusted with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he +experienced. But there is nothing that tries the nerves more than +standing the fire of an enemy before it is time to set to work to +reply. As soon as orders were given for the _Cæsar's_ fire to be +opened, directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the roar of +her cannon answered those of the fort, the feeling of uneasiness on +Harry's part disappeared, and was succeeded by that of the excitement +of battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole line the British +fleet was engaged, and the boom of the heavy guns of the ships, forts, +and batteries, and the rattle of musketry from the tops of the ships, +kept up a deep roar like that of incessant thunder. + +"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant reported to the +captain. "There are but two fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is +dropping so much that we have scarcely steerage-way, and the current +is sweeping us along fast." + +"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain said. + +He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was a slight shivering +sensation in the ship, and it was known by all on board that she was +aground, and that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were +kept at work the men were called off from those of the port side, +boats were lowered and hawsers were got out, and every effort was made +to tow the ship off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of the +storm of shot and shell which fell round them from the fort and the +nearest Danish ships. But the _Cæsar_ was fast. Calling the men on +board again, the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft +and see what was going on in other parts of the line. He returned with +the news that four or five other ships were plainly aground, and that +things appeared to be going badly. In the meantime the _Cæsar_ was +suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well directed, and the +gunners, working their pieces under comparative shelter, were able to +pour their fire steadily into the _Cæsar_, while a floating battery +and two frigates also kept up an incessant fire. + +The number of killed and wounded was already large, but as only the +guns of the starboard side could be worked the fire was kept up with +unabated zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of the +fire. The parapet was in many places shot away and several of the guns +put out of action. But the _Cæsar_ was clearly overmatched, and the +captain hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the ship was +aground and was altogether overmatched, and begging that another +vessel might be dispatched to his aid, if one could be spared, in +order to partially relieve her of the enemy's fire. + +"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to the flagship +instantly." + +Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot and shell which was +flying, striking up the water in all directions, he made his way to +the admirals ship, which was lying nearly a mile away. + +Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it through. + +"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a ship to spare. +Several are aground, and all hard pressed. He must do the best he can. +Ah! you are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin, are you +not?" + +"Yes, sir." + +The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and Harry prepared to leave. +Suddenly a thought struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he +asked the steward for a small tablecloth. + +"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed. + +"Never mind. Give it me at once." + +Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat. As they returned +towards the _Cæsar_ they could see how hardly matters were going with +her. One of her masts was down. Her sides were battered and torn, and +several of her port-holes were knocked into one. Still her fire +continued unabated, but it was clear that she could not much longer +resist. + +"Do you think she must haul down her flag?" Harry said to the coxswain +of the boat. + +"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and iron can't stand such a +pounding as that much longer. Most captains would have hauled down the +flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand out much +longer. There won't be a man alive to fight her." + +"Will you do as I order?" Harry said. + +"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will do what you like;" +for the story of the conduct by which Harry had gained his +midshipman's promotion had been repeated through the ship, and the men +were all proud of the lad who had behaved so pluckily. + +"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it can't do harm. Where's +the boat-hook? Fasten this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort." + +The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise, but did as Harry told +him, and with the white flag flying the boat pulled straight towards +the fort. As he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had +been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the duel between the +battery and the _Cæsar_ continued with unabated vigor. Harry steered +direct to the steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of the +fort, where, on saying that he brought a message from the captain, he +was at once conducted to the commandant. + +"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain to beg of you to +surrender at once. Your guns have been nobly fought, but two more +ships are coming down to engage with you, and the captain would fain +save further effusion of life. You have done all that brave men could +do, but the fight everywhere goes against you, and further resistance +is vain. In a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your +guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain therefore begs you +to spare the brave men under your orders from further sacrifice." + +Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which was fortunately at the +moment backed up by two ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken +no part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor, after a +hasty consultation with his officers, resolved to surrender, and two +minutes afterwards the Danish flag was hauled down in the fort and the +white flag run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to return +with Harry to the ship to notify the captain of the surrender of the +fort. + +The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the course of his boat +suddenly altered, a white flag hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct +to the fort, had been extreme, and he could only suppose that Harry +had received some orders direct from the admiral and that a general +cessation of hostilities was ordered. His surprise became astonishment +when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white flag hoisted in +its place; and a shout of relief and exultation echoed from stem to +stern of the _Cæsar_, for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless +and that in a few minutes the _Cæsar_ must strike her flag. All sorts +of conjectures were rife as to the sudden and unexpected surrender of +the fort, and expectation was at its highest when the gig was seen +rowing out again with a Danish officer by the side of the midshipman. + +On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the ladder with the Danish +officer, and advancing to Captain Ball said: + +"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the summons which I took +to the commander of the fort in your name, come off to surrender." + +The Danish officer advanced and handed his sword to the captain, +saying: + +"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender." + +The captain handed him back his sword, and ordering Harry to follow +him at once entered his cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the +latter informed him what he had done, with many apologies for having +taken the matter into his own hands. + +"I saw," he said, "that the _Cæsar_ was being knocked to pieces, and +the coxswain told me that it was impossible she could much longer +resist. I therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling upon +the governor to surrender, and that it was possible that I might +succeed, as you see that I have." + +"You certainly have saved the _Cæsar_," Captain Ball said warmly, "and +we are all indeed indebted to you. It was a piece of astounding +impudence indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with which his +captain had not charged him; but success in the present case a +thousand times condones the offense. You have indeed done well, young +sir, and I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you. I will +report the matter to the admiral." + +A hundred men speedily took their places in the boats. Lieutenant +Francis was sent ashore to take possession, and a few minutes later +the British flag was flying upon the fort. + +Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball at once took his place +in his gig and rowed to the flagship. The battle was still raging, and +to the practiced eye there was no doubt that the English fleet was +suffering very severely. Captain Ball mounted the quarter-deck, and +saluting the admiral reported that the fort with which he was engaged +had struck, but that the _Cæsar_ being aground was unable to render +any assistance to the general attack. + +"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral Nelson said, "but I +congratulate you on having caused the fort to haul down its colors. +Several of the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot take +possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came off from shore, and their +fire has reopened. Our position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker +has signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no attention. I +fear that we shall have to haul off and leave some four or five ships +to the enemy." + +"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who made the fort haul +down its flag, but this midshipman of mine." + +"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who, at Captain Ball's +order, had left the boat and was standing a short distance off. "How +on earth did he do that?" + +"When you told him, sir, that you could give us no aid he took upon +himself, instead of returning to the ship, to row straight to the +fort with one of your tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and +summoned the commander in my name to surrender at once so as to save +all further effusion of life, seeing that more ships were bearing down +and that he had done all that a brave man could, and should now think +of the lives of his troops." + +"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed. "Midshipmen were +impudent enough in my days, but this boy beats everything. However, +his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I will adopt it +myself. A man should never be above learning, and we are in such a +sore strait that one catches at a straw." + +So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain, entered his cabin, +and at once indited a letter to the King of Denmark begging him to +surrender in order to save the blood of his subjects, expressing +admiration at the way in which they had fought, and saying that they +had done all that was possible to save honor, and might now surrender +with a full consciousness of having done their duty. This missive was +at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral awaited with anxiety its +result. + +A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with unabated fury. + +"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed, "there's the white +flag!" and a tremendous cheer broke along the whole of the British +ships as the flag of truce waved over the principal fort of +Copenhagen. Instantly the fire on both sides ceased. Boats passed +between the shore and the flagship with the proposals for surrender +and conditions. Nelson insisted that the Danish fleet should be +surrendered, in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king +that he had it in his power completely to destroy the town, and had +only so far desisted from motives of humanity. At length, to the +intense relief of the admiral and his principal officers, who knew how +sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors, the +negotiations were completed, and the victory of Copenhagen won. + +"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked. + +"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the quarter-deck. One of the +last shots fired from the Danish fleet had struck him above the knee, +carrying away his leg. He had at once been carried down to the +cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of the flagship. In the +excitement of an action men take but little heed of what is happening +around them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed by his +captain. Now, however, that the battle was over, Captain Ball looked +round for his midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing what +had happened. He hurried below to the wounded boy, whose leg had +already been amputated, above the point at which the ball had severed +it, by the surgeon. + +"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he said, "and Copenhagen +has been captured, and to you more than to anyone is this great +victory due. I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been shot." + +Harry smiled faintly. + +"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the navy has not been a +long one. It is but a fortnight since I got my commission, and now I +am leaving it altogether." + +"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said cheerfully, "but not +leaving life, I hope. I trust there's a long one before you; but +Admiral Nelson will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career +of a young officer, who promised to rise to the highest honors of his +profession and be a credit and glory to his country, has been cut +short." + +A short time later the admiral himself came down and shook hands with +the boy, and thanked him for his services, and cheered him up by +telling him that he would take care that his presence of mind and +courage should be known. + +For some days Harry lay between life and death, but by the time that +the ship sailed into Portsmouth harbor the doctors had considerable +hope that he would pull round. He was carried at once to the Naval +Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley was by his bedside. His +captain frequently came to see him, and upon one occasion came while +his foster-father was sitting by his bedside. + +"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told me that you had served +his majesty; but I didn't recognize the name as that of my old +boatswain on board the _Cleopatra_." + +"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but I wish it had been on +any other occasion. However, I think that the lad will not slip his +wind this time; but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at +an end." + +"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said; "but there are +many men who may live to a good age and will have done less for their +country than this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he +prevented the dispatch, which would have warned the enemy of what was +coming, from reaching them; and, in the second place, his sharpness +and readiness saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet, and +converted what threatened to be a defeat into a victory. You must be +proud of your son, old salt." + +"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my son?" the boatswain +said. + +"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised; "on the contrary, he +spoke of you as his father." + +In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances of the finding +of Harry when a baby. Captain Ball was silent for a while, and then +said, "Do you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by the +resemblance of that lad to an old friend and school-fellow of mine, a +Mr. Harper? They are as like as two peas--that is, he is exactly what +my friend was at his age. My friend never was married; but I remember +hearing a good many years ago--I should say some fifteen years ago, +which would be about in accordance with this lad's age--that he had +lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed to have +foundered, and was never heard of again. She was the wife of the +captain, and was taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may be +a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong that it would be +worth while making some inquiries. Have you anything by which the +child can be identified?" + +"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship for the most +part, and a locket. I will bring them over to your honor to-morrow if +you will let me." + +"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to London to-morrow, and +shall see my friend. Don't speak to the boy about it, for it's a +thousand to one against its being more than a coincidence. Still I +hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so." + +The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach to London, and the +following day called upon his friend, who was a rich retired +East-Indian director. He told the story as Peter had told it to him. + +"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously, although the ship was +lost in the West Indies, it's likely enough that the ornaments of my +poor sister would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of often +sending her home things from Calcutta." + +"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and produced the little +packet which Peter had given him. + +The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and then, taking the +locket, pressed the spring. He gave a cry as he saw the portrait +within it, and exclaimed, "Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as +she was when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery! Where is +the lad of whom you have been speaking? for surely he is my nephew, +the son of my sister Mary and Jack Peters." + +Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings from the time he +had known him, and the old gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of +bravery. The very next day he went down to Portsmouth with Captain +Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment, found himself claimed as nephew +by the friend of his captain. + +When Harry was well enough to be moved he went up to London with his +uncle, and a fortnight later received an official letter directing him +to attend at the Board of Admiralty. + +Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded thither in his uncle's +carriage, and walked with crutches--for his wound was not as yet +sufficiently healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg--to the +board-room. Here were assembled the first lord and his colleagues. +Admiral Nelson was also present, and at once greeted him kindly. + +A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then addressed him. "Mr. +Peters, Admiral Nelson has brought to our notice the clever stratagem +by which, on your own initiation and without instruction, you obtained +the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved the _Cæsar_ at a time when +she was aground and altogether overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also +been good enough to say that it was the success which attended your +action which suggested to him the course that he took which brought +the battle to a happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that the +victory which has been won is in no small degree due to you. Moreover, +we are mindful that it was your bravery and quickness which prevented +the news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching the +Continent, in which case the attack could not have been carried out. +Under such extraordinary and exceptional circumstances we feel that an +extraordinary and exceptional acknowledgment is due to you. We all +feel very deep regret that the loss of your leg will render you unfit +for active service at sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of +so meritorious and most promising a young officer. We are about, +therefore, to take a course altogether without precedent. You will be +continued on the full-pay list all your life, you will at once be +promoted to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to that of +commander, and again in another three years to the rank of post +captain. The board are glad to hear from Captain Ball that you are in +good hands, and wish you every good fortune in life." + +Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he could only stammer a word +or two of thanks, and the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral +Nelson having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken back to the +carriage, still in a state of bewilderment at the honor which had been +bestowed upon him. + +There is little more to tell. Having no other relations his uncle +adopted him as his heir, and the only further connection that Harry +had with the sea was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the +fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of an English port. +Later on he sat in Parliament, married, and to the end of his life +declared that, after all, the luckiest point in his career was the +cutting off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries, +for that, had this not happened, he should never have known who he +was, would never have met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would +have passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley, when not +at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in a snug cottage at Southsea, +and had never reason to the end of his life to regret the time when he +sighted the floating box from the tops of the _Alert_. + + + + +SURLY JOE. + + +"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir? No, as you say, I hope I +don't deserve the title now; but I did once, and a name like that +sticks to a man for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at +present, and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it." + +The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty years old, broad and +weather-beaten; he had but one arm. I had been spending a month's +well-earned holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the most of +it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my first arrival I had gone out +with the one-armed boatman, and as he was a cheery companion, and his +boat, the _Grateful Mary_, was the best and fastest on the strand, I +had stuck to him throughout. The boatmen at our watering-places soon +learn when a visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to +importune him with offers of a sail; consequently it became an +understood thing after a day or two that I was private property, and +as soon as I was seen making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which +is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough, a shout would at +once be raised for Surly Joe. The name seemed a singularly +inappropriate one; but it was not until the very day before I was +returning to town that I made any remark on the subject. By this time +we had become great allies; for what with a bathe in the morning +early, a sail before lunch, and a fishing expedition afterwards, I had +almost lived on board the _Grateful Mary_. The day had been too clear +and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted boy who assisted +Joe had grown tired of watching us catch nothing, and had fallen +asleep in the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose and +fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative of sleep that I +had nodded once or twice as I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then +the happy idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered why my +companion was called by a nickname which seemed so singularly +inappropriate. Joe's offer to tell me how he obtained it woke me at +once. I refilled my pipe,--an invariable custom, I observe, with +smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a story,--passed my +pouch to Joe, who followed my example; and when we had "lighted up" +Joe began: + +"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a strong, active chap +then--not that I aint strong now, for I can shove a boat over the +sandbar with any man on the shore--but I aint as active as I were. I +warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms like other men. My +nickname then was Curly; 'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight +on my head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned my own boat, +and the boys that worked with me warn't strangers, like Dick there, +but they were my own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the two +boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and as good-plucked uns +as any on the shore. I had lost their mother ten years, maybe, before +that, and I never thought of giving them another. One of 'em was about +twelve, just the size of Dick there; the other was a year older. Full +of tricks and mischief they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle +the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one thing they couldn't +do, sir--they couldn't swim. I used to tell 'em they ought to learn; +but there, you see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and +boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on 'em can swim. Rum, +aint it, sir? All their lives in the water or on the water, seeing all +these visitors as comes here either swimming or learning to swim, and +yet they won't try. They talks about instinks; I don't believe in +instinks, else everybody who's got to pass his life on the water would +learn to swim, instead of being just the boys as never does learn. +That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman and his wife +and darter used to use my boat regular; morning and afternoon they'd +go out for a sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put +out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared so much for it; +but they was just wrapped up in the girl, who was a pale, quiet sort +o' girl, who had come down to the sea for her health. She was +wonderful fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she warn't +like the same creature after she had been here two months. + +"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls from the east, but +not too rough to go out: they was to go out at four o'clock, and they +came down punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets down: + +"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a friend is coming down +by the five-o'clock train, and we must be at the station to meet her, +she being an invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so will +trust her with you.' + +"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring her back safe,' the +mother says, half laughing like; but I could see she were a little +anxious about lettin' her go alone, which had never happened before. + +"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may take your oath I'll +bring her back if I comes back myself.' + +"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on the plank; 'don't you +fidget: you know you can trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six +to dinner.' + +"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible like, and +although I'd told the boys before that one reef would be enough, I +made 'em put in another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't many +boats out, for there was more sea on than most visitors care to face; +but once fairly outside we went along through it splendid. When we got +within a mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or go on for a +bit farther. + +"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't we, Joe?' + +"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight on the shore.' + +"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she says, looking at her watch; +'I'd rather go a bit farther.' + +"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The wind was freshening, +and the gusts coming down strong; it was backing round rather to the +north too, and the sea was getting up. + +"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into Filey,' I says; 'and you +could go across by the coach.' + +"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?' + +"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall get a ducking before we +get back; there's rain in that squall to windward.' + +"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the coach won't get in +till half-past seven, and mamma would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd +so much rather go on!' + +"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and in another few +minutes the squall was down upon us. The rain came against us as if it +wanted to knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled again. A +sharper squall I don't know as ever I was put in. It was so black you +couldn't have seen two boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put +the helm up; but something went wrong, and--I don't know rightly how +it was, sir. I've thought it over hundreds and hundreds of times, and +I can't reason it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of +that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must somehow ha' lost my +head--I don't know, I can't account for it; but there it was, and in +less time than it takes me to tell you we were all in the water. +Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough now. I threw one arm +round the gal, as I felt her going, and with the other I caught hold +of the side of the boat. We was under water for a moment, and then I +made shift to get hold of the rudder as she floated bottom upwards. +The boys had stuck to her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel; +for you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing nigh a foot of +water there more than they does astern. However, after a bit, they +managed to get down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel about +halfway along. They couldn't come no nigher, because, as you know, the +keel of them boats only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I +shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have seen us from the +cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here for us in no time.' + +"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my heart that a lugger, to +get out with that wind on, would have to run right into t'other side +o' the bay before she could get room enough to weather the brig. The +girl hadn't spoken a word since the squall struck us, except that she +gave a little short cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she +got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as well as she could +with my help. The squall did not last five minutes; and when it +cleared off I could look round and judge of our chances. They weren't +good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and another on the +brig, who were making their way out as far as they could on the brig, +for it were about half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we went +into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over the brig, and there +was a man galloping on horseback along the sands to'rds Filey as hard +as he could go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the brig, and +I saw that we should drift down on it before a boat could beat out of +the bay and get round to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always +does break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and the spray +was flying up fifty feet in places where the waves hit the face of the +rock. There aint a worse place on all the coast than this, running as +it do nigh a mile out from the head, and bare at low water. The waves +broke over the boat heavy, and I had as much as I could do to hold on +by one hand to the rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with +every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't hold on if they +couldn't get onto the bottom of the boat; so I shouted to 'em to try +to climb up. But they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over +and over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm water; but with +the boat rolling and such waves going over her, and knocking them back +again when they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd ha' +been free I could have got 'em up by working round to the side +opposite 'em, and given them a hand to haul them up; but as it was, +with only one hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I +was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face round to me, and +spoke for the first time. + +"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your boys.' + +"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till we're both +drowned together.' + +"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe me, I was +actually beginning to hate that gal. There was my own two boys +a-struggling for their lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em, +because I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She saw it in my +face, for she gave a sort of little cry, and said: + +"'Oh, do--do let me go!' + +"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the harder. Presently +Bill--he was my youngest boy--sang out: + +"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand to get up? I can't +hold on much longer.' + +"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my promise to take this +young woman back, and I must keep my word. Her life's more precious to +her father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to be saved.' + +"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust, and I knew it was +when I said it, but I couldn't help it. I felt as if I had a devil in +me. I was just mad with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word +seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it was frozen. For a +moment she didn't move, and then, all of a sudden like, she gave a +twist out of my arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her, and +just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up again. She never moved +after that, but just lay quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head +was back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only by the tears +that run down sometimes through her eyelids, and by a little sob in +her breast, that I knew that she was sensible. + +"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God bless you!' and then he +let go his hold and went down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though +it seemed a week to me, Jack did the same. + +"There we was--the girl and I--alone. + +"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was mad then. I felt +somehow as that the gal had drowned my two boys; and the devil kept +whispering to me to beat her white face in, and then to go with her to +the bottom. I should ha' done it too, but my promise kept me back. I +had sworn she should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to me +that included the promise that I would do my best for us both to get +there. I was getting weak now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and +my thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if they could +hear me. Once or twice my hold had slipped, and I had hard work enough +to get hold again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't last +much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had told the boys I would +be with 'em in a minute or two, when a sound of shouting quite close +roused me up sudden. + +"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig. Some men had climbed +along, taking hold hand-in-hand when they passed across places where +the sea was already breaking over, and bringing with them the rope +which, as I afterwards heard, the man on horseback had brought back +from Filey. It was a brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was +rising fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could hear them they +shouted that they would throw me the rope, and that I must leave go of +the boat, which would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she had +struck the rocks with us. Where they were standing the rock was full +six feet above the sea; but a little farther it shelved down, and each +wave ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me could I swim; +and when I shook my head, for I was too far gone to speak now, one of +'em jumped in with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the two of +us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was time, for we weren't +much above a boat's length from the brig. Three of the chaps as had +the rope run down to the low part of the rock and pulled together, +while another two kept hold of the end of the rope and kept on the +rock, so as to prevent us all being washed across the brig together. I +don't remember much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at +once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of the rope, and +then, just as the water seemed choking me, a great smash, and I +remember nothing else. When I came to my right senses again I was in a +bed at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and my right arm, +which had been round the girl, was just splintered. They took it off +that night. The first thing as they told me when I came round was that +the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was glad or sorry to hear it. +I was glad, because I had kept my promise and brought her back alive. +I was sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should she have been +saved when my two boys was drowned? She was well-plucked, was that +gal, for she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment she had +got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike she wanted to get dry +clothes and to go straight on to Scarborough in a carriage. However, +the doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little letter saying +as she was all right; and a man galloped off with it on horseback, and +got there just as they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to +Filey to ask if there was any news there about the boat. They came +over and slept there, and she went back with them next day. I heard +all this afterwards, for I was off my head, what with the blow I had +got and one thing and another, before I had been there an hour. And I +raved and cussed at the girl, they tell me, so that they wouldn't let +her father in to see me. + +"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself, to find my arm gone, +and then I was another month before I was out of bed. They came over +to Filey when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the best doctor +over from Scarborough to see me, and paid everything for me till I was +well, but I wouldn't see them when they came. I was quite as bitter +against her as I had been when I was in the sea drowning; and I was so +fierce when they talked of coming in that the doctor told them it +would make me bad again if they came. So they went up to London, and +when I could get about they sent me a letter, the gal herself and her +father and mother, thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I +just tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a lawyer of the +town here came to me and said he'd 'struction to buy me a new boat, +and to buy a 'nuity for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my +boys back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money; and as +to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her and sink her if she came. A year +after that lawyer came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions; +and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was man enough still to +knock his head off his shoulders, and that I'd do it if he came to me +with his 'structions or anything else. + +"By this time I'd settled down to work on the shore, and had got the +name of Surly Joe. Rightly enough, too. I had one of them planks with +wheels that people use to get in and out of the boats; and as the +boatmen on the shore was all good to me, being sorry for my loss, and +so telling my story to people as went out with them, I got enough to +live on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable about me. I +wouldn't speak a word, good or bad, to a soul for days together, +unless it was to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I hated +everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was always cussing the rocks that +didn't kill me, and wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this +work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never cared for drink; but +sometimes I'd find my thoughts too hard for me, and I'd go and drink +glass after glass till I tumbled under the table. + +"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and made offers to me to +take a share in their boats, or to make one in a fishing voyage; but I +would not hear them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and left +me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a surlier, +wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all England, than I was. Well, +sir, one day--it was just at the beginning of the season, but was too +rough a day for sailing--I was a-sitting down on the steps of a +machine doing nothing, just wondering and wondering why things was as +they was, when two little gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the +other a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum away from the +side of a lady and gentleman. I never did notice nothing that didn't +just concern me; but I did see that they had a nurse not far off. The +biggest girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked up into +my face, and held out a broken wooden spade and a bit of string, and +says she, 'Sailor-man, please mend our spade.' I was struck all of a +heap like; for though I had been mighty fond of little children in the +old days, and was still always careful of lifting them into boats, my +name and my black looks had been enough, and none of them had spoken +to me for years. I felt quite strange like when that child spoke out +to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson Crusoe, he as was wrecked +on the island, felt when he saw the mark of a foot. + +"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it back, and says, +gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but one hand? Go to your nurse.' + +"I expected to see her run right off; but she didn't, but stood as +quiet as may be, with her eyes looking up into my face. + +"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when Nina digs. Nina will hold +spade together, sailor-man tie it up strong.' + +"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver, and it was plain +she had been crying just before; so I put my hand into my pocket and +brings out a bit of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was +of no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as I hardly +knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll tie it.' + +"So she held the broken pieces together, and I ties 'em up with the +aid of my hand and my teeth, and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it. +I did it sitting on the bottom step, with a child standing on each +side watching me. When I had done it the eldest took it, and felt it. + +"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you. Annie, say thank +you.' + +"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on my arm as a good-by, +the little ones trotted away to a nurse sitting some little distance +off. + +"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's talk to +a child; but it warn't a little thing to me. It seemed regularly to +upset me like; and I sat there thinking it over and wondering what was +come over me, till an hour afterwards they went past me with their +nurse; and the little things ran up to me and said, 'The spade's quite +good now--good-by, sailor-man!' and went on again. So I shook it off +and went to my work; for as the tide rose the wind dropped, and a few +boats went out; and thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and +surlier than ever. + +"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand painting a boat, when I saw +the two children coming along the sand again, and I wondered to +myself whether they would know me again, or think any more of me, and +though I wanted them to do so I turned my back to the way they was +coming, and went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful glad +when I heard their little feet come, pattering along the sand, and +they sang out: + +"'Good-morning, sailor-man!' + +"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't want no talk; and +I goes on with my work without turning round. + +"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me. + +"'Joe, there's a party coming down.' + +"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out yourself.' + +"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute or two, watching me at +work, and then the eldest says: + +"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never been inside a boat, and +we do want to so much.' + +"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making a fight with +myself against giving in. + +"Then the little one said: + +"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold round oor neck; then oo +stand up and we det in.' + +"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those soft little faces +against my cheeks as they got in fairly knocked me over, and it was +some time before I could see what I was doing. + +"Once in, they never stopped talking. They asked about everything, and +I had to answer them; and as I got accustomed to it the words came +freer, till I was talking away with them as if I had known 'em all my +life. Once I asked them didn't their papa and mamma ever take 'em out +for a sail, and they shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea, +and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she must have lost +someone dear to her by it. + +"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those children used to come +every day down to talk with me, and I got to look for it regular; and +if it was a wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put out by +it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in my pockets for them. +After a fortnight I took to carrying them across the wet sands and +putting them on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people to +the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their mother, and brought +back the message that she knew she could trust them with me. + +"All this time it never once struck me as strange that their nurse +should sit with a baby-brother of theirs at a distance, and let them +play with me by the hour together, without calling them away, for I +wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling stories to 'em +just as I'd do with children who came out sailing with me in the old +time, and in knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I couldn't +wonder at anything else. Natural like, I changed a good deal in other +respects, and I got to give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce +spoken with for years; and the moment the children turned down onto +the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of 'There's your little +ladies, Joe.' + +"I don't know why my mates should ha' been pleased to see me coming +round, for I had made myself onpleasant enough on the shore; but +they'd made 'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd cum +back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like, and would just say, +natural, 'Lend us a hand here, Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over +the bank, Joe,' and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was a +hard day for me when, after staying nigh two months, the little ladies +came to say good-by. It warn't as bad as might have been, though, for +they were going to stay with some friends near York, and were to come +back again in a fortnight before they went back to London. But they +kissed me, and cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I +was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they would be sure to +think of me, for they loved me very much. + +"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by my stage, Jim +Saunders--he'd been mate with me before I owned a boat of my own--says +out loud: + +"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've jammed my hand so as I +can't hoist a sail. Who'll come out and lend me a hand?' + +"Well, everyone says they were busy, and couldn't come; but I believe +now as the whole thing was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and +then Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him. + +"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old times; come along, old +chap.' + +"I was taken aback like, and could only say something about my stage; +but half a dozen chaps volunteers to look after my stage, and afore I +scarce knew what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and as the +party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every chap on the shore +runs in to help shove her off, and a score of hands was held out just +to give me a shake as we started. + +"I don't think I was much good on that vyage, for I went and sat up in +the bow, with my back to the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead. + +"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the ice I went regular +to the sea again, and handed my stage over to a poor fellow who had +lost his craft and a leg the winter before. + +"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two little figures upon the +sands, and it needed no word from anyone to tell me my little ladies +had come back. They jumped and clapped their hands when they saw me, +and would have run across the water to meet me hadn't I shouted to +them to wait just a minute till I should be with them. + +"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where have you been?' + +"'I've been out sailing, missy.' + +"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories? You told us you +should never go on sea any more.' + +"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I don't suppose I ever +should if I hadn't met you, though you won't understand that. However, +I've give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.' + +"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and mamma will be glad +too.' + +"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I asked. + +"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I know she will be glad +when I tells her.' + +"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk to them about their +mamma. Mamma very good, very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and +then they went on telling me about their home in London, and their +carriage and amusements. Presently they stopped, and I could see the +eldest wanted to say something particular, for she puckered up her +forehead as she always did when she was very serious; and then she +said, with her hands folded before her, almost as if she was saying a +lesson: + +"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two little girls and baby-brother, +and papa love her so much; but there's one thing keeps her from being +quite happy.' + +"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be happy with all these +things. What is it?' + +"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for her. If it hadn't been +for him Nina and sissy and little baby-brother could never have been +born, and papa would never have had dear mamma to love; but it cost +the man who did it a great deal--all he cared for; and now he won't +let mamma and papa and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma +unhappy when she thinks of it.' + +"Here she had evidently finished what she had heard her mamma say, for +her forehead got smooth again, and she began to fill my pockets with +sand. + +"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I says. 'It don't stand +to reason nohow. You can't have understood what mamma said.' + +"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of time,' Nina said. 'Nina +quite sure she said right.' + +"We didn't say no more about it then, though after the children had +gone I wondered to myself how a chap could go on so foolish as that. +Well, sir, three days after come round from Whitby this very boat, the +_Grateful Mary_. She was sent care of Joe Denton; and as that was me, +I had her hauled up on the beach till I should hear whose she was. +Several visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous like, +that they should like to have a boat of their own, and I supposed they +had bought her at Whitby and sent her down, though why they should +have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see. + +"Two days afterwards them children come down, and says: + +"'We want you to go through the town to the other cliff with us, Joe.' + +"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you here, missies; but I +shouldn't be a credit to you in the town, and your pa wouldn't be +best pleased if he was to see you walking about in the streets with a +boatman.' + +"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.' + +"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to their nurse, who +come back with them and says: + +"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler glad if you would go +with the young ladies.' + +"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object, and they wishes +it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You wait here a quarter of an hour, +while I goes and cleans myself, and I'll go with you.' + +"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand, and the oldest holds by +my jacket, and we goes up into High Street, and across to the other +cliff. We goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage looking +over the sea. There was a garden in front, new planted with flowers. + +"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I, when they turned in. + +"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned the handle. + +"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me into a parlor, where a +lady and gentleman was sitting. + +"The gentleman got up. + +"'My little girls have spoken so much to me about you, Joe, that I +feel that we know each other already.' + +"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I. + +"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great deal as to these +little girls?' + +"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the little missies; +they have made a changed man of me, they have; you ask anyone on the +shore.' + +"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got round your heart, and +led you to your better self, I could never have done what I have done, +for you would have rendered it useless.' + +"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither head nor tail of +what he was saying, and, I dessay, looked as surprised as might be. +Then he takes a step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder, and +says he: + +"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little girls were?' + +"I looked first at the children, and then at him, and then at the +lady, who had a veil down, but was wiping her eyes underneath it. I +was downright flummuxed. + +"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on. 'Well, Joe, it is time +you should know now. I owe to you all that is dear to me in this +world, and our one unhappiness has been that you would not hear us, +that you had lost everything and would not let us do anything to +lighten your blow.' + +"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant, and began to think +that I was mad, or that he was. Then the lady stood up and threw back +her veil, and come up in front of me with the tears a-running down +her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down suddenly in a chair, +for, sure enough, it was that gal. Different to what I had seen her +last, healthy-looking and well--older, in course; a woman now, and the +mother of my little ladies. + +"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before her, pleading +like. + +"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children stand between us. I +know what you have suffered, and, in all my happiness, the thought of +your loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell you. I so +often thought of you--a broken, lonely man. I have talked to the +children of you till they loved the man that saved their mother's +life. I cannot give you what you have lost, Joe--no one can do that; +but you may make us happy in making you comfortable. At least, if you +cannot help hating me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh +with you.' + +"As she spoke the children were hanging on me; and when she stopped +the little one said: + +"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate mamma, and make her cry!' + +"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about it. You can imagine +how I quite broke down, like a great baby, and called myself every +kind of name, saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so now, +that I had been somehow mad from the moment the squall struck the +_Kate_ till the time I first met the little girls. + +"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that poor gal to her drowning +heart with my words, I could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At +last, when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and its +furniture and the _Grateful Mary_ was all for me; and we'd a great +fight over it, and I only gave in when at last she says that if I +didn't do as she wanted she'd never come down to Scarborough with the +little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come down regular +every year, and that the little girls should go out sailing with me +regular in the _Grateful Mary_. + +"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that, was there? So here I +am; and next week I expect Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's +a Parliament man, as she was engaged to be married to at the time of +the upset, and my little ladies, who is getting quite big girls too. +And if you hadn't been going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle +tower, and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes, sir, I see +what you are going to ask. I found it lonely there; and I found the +widow of a old mate of mine who seemed to think as how she could make +me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir--no words could say how +comfortable I am; and do you know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe +up there at this identical time, only he's a very little one, and has +got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about as little right as +has any chap in this mortial world to the name of Surly Joe." + + + + +A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM. + + +Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place. Capitalists and +speculative builders have somehow left it alone, and, except for its +great hotel, standing in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled, +there have been comparatively few additions to it in the last quarter +of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should make Falmouth my +headquarters: blow high, blow low, there are shelter and plenty of +sailing room, while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along +which to cruise--something very different from the flat shores from +Southampton to Brighton. It is some six years since that I was lying +in the harbor, having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes. +Upon the day after we had come in my friend went into Truro, and I +landed, strolled up, and sat down on a bench high on the seaward face +of the hill that shelters the inner harbor. + +An old coastguardsman came along. I offered him tobacco, and in five +minutes we were in full talk. + +"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out there?" + +"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet." + +"Do they do well generally?" + +"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's an uncertain fish the +pilchard, and it's a rough life is fishing on this coast. There aint a +good harbor not this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a +gale from the southeast it goes hard with them. With a southwester +they can run back here." + +"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?" + +"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy well-nigh fifty +year back, but I got a sickener of it, and tramped to Plymouth and +shipped in a frigate there, and served all my time in queen's ships." + +"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships of the life, or +from any particular circumstance?" + +"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty boats lost that night, +and scarce a hand was saved. I shouldn't have been saved myself if it +had not been for a dream of mother's." + +"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind telling me about it?" + +The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two; and then, after a +sharp puff at his pipe, he told me the following story, of which I +have but slightly altered the wording: + +I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of a village now, as it +was then. My father had been washed overboard and drowned two years +before. I was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's, and +four men and myself worked her in shares. I was twenty-one, or maybe +twenty-two, years old then. It was one day early in October. We had +had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd agreed to start at eight +o'clock in the morning. I was up at five, and went down to the boats +to see as everything was ready. When I got back mother had made +breakfast; and when we sat down I saw that the old woman had been +crying, and looked altogether queer like. + +"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip." + +"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother! Why? What's happened? Your +share and mine didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would be +a talk if I didn't go out in the _Jane_. Why, what is it?" + +"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how you was drowned." + +"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be drowned, mother." + +But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us Cornishmen goes a +good deal on dreams and tokens; and sure enough mother had dreamed +father was going to be drowned before he started on that last trip of +his. + +"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of you in bed, and a chap +was leaning over you cutting your throat." + +I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast after that; but in a +minute or two I plucks up and says: + +"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for if I be drowned no one has no +call to cut my throat." + +"I didn't see you downright drowned in my dream," she said. "You was +in the sea--a terribly rough sea--at night, and the waves were +breaking down on you." + +"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit. "It's a fine day, +and it's our boat. All the lads and girls in the village would laugh +at me if I stayed at home." + +"That's just what your father said; and he went to his death." + +And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron over her head and +began to cry again. I'd more than half a mind to give way; but you +know what young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of the place +would say about my being afraid to go was too much for me. + +At last, when mother saw I was bent on going, she got up and said: + +"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back, will you do something +else I ask you?" + +"I will, mother," said I--"anything but stay back." + +She went off without a word into her bedroom, and she came back with +something in her arms. + +"Look here, Will, I made this for your father, and he wouldn't have +it; now I ask you to take it, and put it on if a storm comes on. You +see, you can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no one will +be any the wiser." + +The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch spirit-bottles, sewn +between two pieces of canvas. It had got strings sewed on for tying +round the body, and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle each +side of the chest, it lay pretty flat. + +"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for hours. A gentleman who +was staying in the village before you was born was talking about +wrecks, and he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked, would +keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I made it; but no words could get +your father to try it, though he was willing enough to say that it +would probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you, Will?" + +I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there wasn't much chance +of a storm, and that if I put it under my coat and hid it away down in +the forecastle, no one would see it; and so to please her I said I'd +take it, and that if a bad storm came on I would slip it on. + +"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the bottles," mother +said. "It may be useful to you; who can say?" + +I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays, on board without +its being seen, and stowed it away in my locker. I felt glad now I'd +got it, for mother's dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way down +old Dick Tremaine said to me: + +"I don't like the look of the sky, lad." + +"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough." + +"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look of it. I think +we're going to have a bad blow." + +I told the others what he had said; but they didn't heed much. Two +boats had come in that morning with a fine catch, and after the bad +time we'd been having it would have taken a lot to keep them in after +that. + +We thought no more about it after we had once started. The wind was +light and puffy; but we had great luck, and were too busy to watch the +weather. What wind there was, was northerly; but towards sunset it +dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped we looked round at the sky. + +"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper, who was skipper, +said, "and I wish we had taken more heed to his words. That's about as +wild a sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing our boat." + +Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old enough to read the signs +of a storm--the heavy bank of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken +light, the horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken +irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them. Instinctively we +looked round towards the coast. It was fully fifteen miles away, and +we were to the east of it. The great change in the appearance of the +sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous to that time there +had been nothing which would have struck any but a man grown old upon +the coast like Dick Tremaine. + +"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail too; take in the +mizzen. Like enough it will come with a squall, and we'd best be as +snug as may be. What do you say? shall we throw over some of the +fish?" + +It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute the sky was +changing. The scud was flying thicker and faster overhead, and the +land was lost in a black cloud that seemed to touch the water. + +"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if we get rid of half +she'll be about in her best trim; and she's as good a sea-boat as +there is on the coast. Come, lads, don't look at it." + +It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five minutes half our +catch of the day was overboard. The _Jane_ was a half-decked boat, +yawl-rigged; she wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round +from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft. He had used her +for two years, and had got tired of the sport, and my father had +bought her of him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used about +here, but we all liked her, and swore by her. + +"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few minutes, I reckon," +Jabez said after a while. "Lower down her sails altogether; get her +head to it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you stand ready to +hoist the foresail a few feet; and, Will, you and John stand by the +hoists of the mainsail. We must show enough to keep her laying-to as +long as we can. You'd best get your coats out and put 'em on, and +batten down the hatch." + +I let the others go down first, and when they came up I went in, tied +the life-belt round me, and put on my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle +of hollands from my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch. + +"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said. + +I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for our future use, and took +hold of the throat halyard. + +"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared under the cloud +of mist and darkness ahead, and then with a roar it was upon us. + +I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years, and I never remember +in these latitudes such a squall as that. For a few minutes I could +scarcely see or breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the +wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder ten +yards off. At first I thought we were going down bodily. It was lucky +we had taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun round, +the force of the wind against the masts and rigging all but capsized +her. In five minutes the first burst was over, and we were running +before it under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no occasion +for us to stand by the halyards now, and we all gathered in the stern, +and crouched down in the well. Although the sun had only gone down +half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white foam round us +gave a sort of dim light that made the sky look all the blacker. The +sea got up in less time than it takes in telling, and we were soon +obliged to hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves from +coming in over the stern. For three hours we tore on before the gale, +and then it lulled almost as suddenly as it had come on. There had +scarcely been a word spoken between us during this time. I was half +asleep in spite of the showers of spray. Jim Hackers, who was always +smoking, puffed away steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the +others were quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on our feet. + +"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked. + +"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember such a gale as this +since I was a boy. Pass that bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be +busy again directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with the wet. +We shall have it round from the south in a few minutes." + +There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she rolled so I thought she +would have turned turtle. + +"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her head round." + +We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from behind struck us, +and in five minutes we were running back as fast as we had come. The +wind was at first south, but settled round to southeast. We got up a +little more sail now, and made a shift to keep her to the west, for +with this wind we should have been ashore long before morning if we +had run straight before it. The sea had been heavy--it was tremendous +now; and, light and seaworthy as the _Jane_ was, we had to keep baling +as the sea broke into her. Over and over again I thought that it was +all over with us as the great waves towered above our stern, but they +slipped under us as we went driving on at twelve or fourteen knots an +hour. I stood up by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought +of it. + +"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we must run, and by +midnight we shall be among the Scillys. Then it's a toss-up." + +Jabez's calculations could not have been far out, for it was just +midnight, as far as I could tell, when we saw a flash right ahead. + +"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said. "I wish I knew +which it was." + +He tried to bring her a little more up into the wind, but she nearly +lay over onto her beam-ends, and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw +one more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship was burning a +blue light. She was not a mile ahead now, and we could see she was a +large vessel. I had often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as +well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land. It was as Jabez +had said--a toss-up. If we just missed one of them we might manage to +bring up under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of them +the _Jane_ would break up like an egg-shell. + +We were rapidly running down upon the wreck when the glare of a fire +on shore shone up. It was a great blaze, and we could faintly see the +land and a white cottage some hundred yards from the shore. + +"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the end of the island; we +may miss it yet. Hoist the mainsail a bit." + +I leapt up with another to seize the halyards, when a great wave +struck us; she gave a roll, and the next moment I was in the water. + +After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I knew the shore was +but half a mile ahead, and that the wind would set me dead upon it. I +loosened my tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with +mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat, though I was half +drowned with the waves as they swept in from behind me. My mother's +dream cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem as I was +to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards. I drifted past the +wreck within a hundred yards or so. They were still burning blue +lights; but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw that in a +very few minutes she would go to pieces. Many times as the seas broke +over me I quite gave up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair +swimmer, and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on. + +I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that broke against the +rocks showed a certain death if I made for it, and I tried hard to +work to the left, where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me +that the fire was built close to the end of the island. As I came +close I found that this was so. I drifted past the point of land not +fifty feet off, where the waves were sending their spray a hundred +feet up; then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee of the +point. There was a little bay with a shelving shore, and here I made a +shift to land. Five minutes to rest, and then I made my way towards +the fire. There was no one there, and I went to the edge of the rocks. +Here four or five men with ropes were standing, trying to secure some +of the casks, chests, and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of +floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of a crash against +those rocks. The water was deep alongside, and the waves, as they +struck, flew up in spray, which made standing almost impossible. + +The men came round me when they saw me. There was no hearing one speak +in the noise of the storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the +point, and that if they came with their ropes to the point they might +get something as it floated past. They went off, and I sat down by the +fire, wrung my clothes as well as I could,--I thought nothing of the +wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,--took off +mother's belt, and found one of the bottles had broke as I got ashore; +but luckily it was the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out +of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt pretty right +again. I had good hopes the boat was all right, for she would get +round the point easy, and Jabez would bring her up under the lee of +the island. I thought I would go and see if I could help the others, +and perhaps save someone drifting from the wreck; but I did not think +there was very much chance, for she lay some little distance to the +right, and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the shore. + +Just as I was going to move I saw two of them coming back. They had a +body between them, and they put it down a little distance from the +fire. I was on the other side, and they had forgotten all about me. +They stooped over the figure, and I could not see what they were +doing. I got up and went over, and they gave a start when they saw me. +"Is he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled; and I could see +pretty well that if I had not been there it would have gone hard with +the chap. He was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around him +one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of rings on his fingers, +and he had a belt round his waist that looked pretty well stuffed out. +I put my hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and then I +poured a few drops of brandy which remained in my bottle down his +throat. + +While I was doing this the two men had talked to each other aside. +"He's alive, all right," says I. "That's a good job," one of 'em said; +but I knew he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage. +You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must be past two o'clock by +this time." + +They took the chap up, and carried him to the cottage, and put him on +a bed. He was moaning a little, and between us we undressed him and +got him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said. + +"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink of whisky?" + +I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off my wet clothes, I +got into the other bed, for there were two in the room. + +The men said they were going down again to see what they could get. +They left the whisky bottle on the table, and as soon as I was alone I +jumped out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth, so as to +give him as good a chance as I could; but I didn't much think he'd get +round, and then I got into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off, +when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up. Mother's dream came right +across me. I was out of bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There +was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it. Then I took my +clasp-knife out of my pocket and opened it. I gave the other chap a +shake, but there was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I +thought to myself they would never risk a fight when they saw me armed +and ready. But I soon found that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up +and dressed in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it was +fastened on the outside. I soon opened the window and got out, but +before I did that I rolled up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and +made a sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in bed was +lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure that he would not live +till morning. The candle was a fresh one when they had first lighted +it, and I left it burning. + +When I had got out I shut the window, and went away fifty yards or so, +where I could hear them come back. Presently I heard some footsteps +coming from the opposite direction. Then I heard a voice I knew say, +"There is the fire; we shall soon know whether the poor lad has got +ashore." + +"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and the other were going to +break into a shout of welcome, "hush! Some wreckers are coming up +directly to cut my throat and that of another chap in that cottage." + +In a word or two I told them all about it; and they agreed to wait +with me and see the end of it. Jabez had brought the _Jane_ up under +the lee of the island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had come +on shore in the cobble with the other to look for me, but with very +faint hopes of finding me. + +"You had best get hold of something to fight with, if you mean to take +these fellows, Jabez." + +"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another," Jabez said. + +Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour later we heard footsteps +coming up from the shore again. Two men passed us, went into the +cottage, and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the window, +where we could see in, and John Redpath stood at the door. He was to +open it and rush in when he heard us shout. We stood a little back, +but we could see well into the room. Presently we saw the door open +very quietly, little by little. A hand came through and moved the +chairs, and then it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One, a big +fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards the bed, where, as +it seemed, I was sleeping, with my head covered up by the clothes. The +other had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other bed. + +"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me. + +The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it down into the figure, +throwing his weight onto it at the same moment, while the smaller man +snatched the pillow from under the other's head and clapped it over +his face, and threw his weight on it. As they did so we pushed the +casement open and leapt in. I seized the smaller man, who was +suffocating the other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had +him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The big fellow had leapt +up. He gave a howl of rage as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay +with his knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump of rock, as +big as a baby's head, right into his stomach. It just tumbled him over +like a cannon-shot. John burst in through the door, and we had 'em +both tied tightly before five minutes was over. Then we lit a big fire +in the kitchen, and with warm clothes and some hot whisky and water +we got the foreign chap pretty well round. + +In the morning I went off and found a village on the other side of the +island. I woke them up and told my story, and, to do 'em justice, +though there were some who would have shielded the fellows we had +caught, the best part were on our side. Some of 'em told me there had +been suspicion upon these men, and that they bore a bad name. There +was no magistrate in the island, and no one objected when I said we +would take them across to Penzance and give them in charge there. + +So we did; and they were tried and got transportation for life for +attempting to murder the foreign chap, who, it turned out, was a +Brazilian Jew, with diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but +we would have none; but that's neither here nor there. + +So you see, master, mother's dream saved me from drowning and from +having my throat cut. I gave up fishing after that and went into the +queen's service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live with a sister +of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands have changed since those times, +and you'll meet as much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will +anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those days, and I had a +pretty close shave of it, hadn't I? + + + + +Boys' Own Library. + + + BOUND IN CLOTH. + + Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers. + + A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular + Authors. + + Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold. + + THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED. + + Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Horatio Alger, Jr.# + + Adventures of a Telegraph Boy. + Dean Dunham. + Erie Train Boy. + Five Hundred Dollar Check. + From Canal Boy to President. + From Farm Boy to Senator. + Mark Stanton. + Ned Newton. + New York Boy. + Tom Brace. + Tom Tracy. + Walter Griffith. + Young Acrobat. + +#C. B. Ashley.# + + Gilbert, the Trapper + +#Annie Ashmore.# + + Smuggler's Cave, The. + +#Capt. Ralph Bonehill.# + + Neka, the Boy Conjurer. + Tour of the Zero Club. + +#Walter F. Burns.# + + In the Sunk Lands. + +#Frank H. Converse.# + + Gold of Flat Top Mountain. + Happy-Go-Lucky Jack. + Heir to a Million. + In Search of an Unknown Race. + In Southern Seas. + Mystery of a Diamond. + That Treasure. + Voyage to the Gold Coast. + +#Harry Collingwood.# + + Pirate Island. + +#George H. Coomer.# + + Boys In the Forecastle. + Old Man of the Mountain. + +#William Dalton.# + + Tiger Prince. + War Tiger. + White Elephant. + +#Edward S. Ellis.# + + Arthur Helmuth. + Check Number 2134. + From Tent to White House. + Golden Rock. + Land of Mystery. + On the Trail of Geronimo. + Perils of the Jungle. + White Mustang. + +#George Manville Fenn.# + + Commodore Junk. + Dingo Boys. + Golden Magnet. + Grand Chaco. + Weathercock. + +#Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.# + + Bound for Annapolis. + Cliff, the Naval Cadet. + Cruise of the Training Ship. + From Port to Port. + Strange Cruise, A. + +#William Murray Graydon.# + + Butcher of Cawnpore, The. + Camp In the Snow, The. + Campaigning with Braddock. + Cryptogram, The. + From Lake to Wilderness. + In Barracks and Wigwam. + In Fort and Prison. + Jungles and Traitors. + Rajah's Fortress, The. + White King of Africa, The. + With Boer and Britisher. + +#Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.# + + Cadet's Honor, A. + Off for West Point. + On Guard. + West Point Treasure, A. + West Point Rivals, The. + +#Headon Hill.# + + Spectre Gold. + +#Henry Harrison Lewis.# + + Centerboard Jim. + Ensign Merrill. + King of the Island. + Midshipman Merrill. + Sword and Pen. + Valley of Mystery, The. + Yankee Boys In Japan. + +#Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.# + + Cadet Kit Carey. + Capt. Carey. + Kit Carey's Protege. + Lieut. Carey's Luck. + Out with Commodore Decatur. + Randy, the Pilot. + Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip. + Tom Truxton's School Days. + Treasure of the Golden Crater. + Won at West Point. + +#Victor St. Clair.# + + Cast Away in the Jungle. + Comrades Under Castro. + For Home and Honor. + From Switch to Lever. + Little Snap, the Postboy. + Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror. + Zip, the Acrobat. + +#Arthur M. Winfield.# + + Mark Dale's Stage Venture. + Young Bank Clerk, The. + Young Bridge Tender, The. + +#Matthew White, Jr.# + + Adventures of a Young Athlete. + Eric Dane. + Guy Hammersley. + My Mysterious Fortune. + Tour of a Private Car. + Young Editor, The. + +#Gayle Winterton.# + + Young Actor, The. + +#Ernest A. Young.# + + Boats, Bats and Bicycles. + + + + +Splendid Books for Girls. + + + HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED. + + Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:# + + #Breakneck Farm.# + + The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her brothers, on + an old abandoned country place. + + #Jessica Trent.# + + Her Adventures on a Ranch. + + #Jessica, the Heiress.# + + This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published. A Charming + Story. + +#KATE TANNATT WOODS:# + + #A Fair Maid of Marblehead.# + + A book to please both young and old. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +BOYS' OWN LIBRARY + + + Bound in Cloth. + Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Brooks McCormick.# + + Giant Islanders, The. + How He Won. + Nature's Young Noblemen. + Rival Battalions. + +#Walter Morris.# + + Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy. + +#Stanley Norris.# + + Phil, the Showman. + Young Showman's Rivals, The. + Young Showman's Pluck, The. + Young Showman's Triumph, The. + +#Lieut. James K. Orton.# + + Beach Boy Joe. + Last Chance Mine. + Secret Chart, The. + Tom Havens with the White Squadron. + +#James Otis.# + + Chased Through Norway. + Inland Waterways. + Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale. + Unprovoked Mutiny, An. + Wheeling for Fortune. + +#Gilbert Patten.# + + Boy Boomers. + Boy Cattle King. + Boy from the West. + Don Kirk's Mine. + Jud and Joe. + +#St. George Rathborne.# + + Canoe and Camp Fire. + Chums of the Prairie. + Gulf Cruisers, The. + Paddling Under Palmettos. + Rival Canoe Boys. + Shifting Winds. + Sunset Ranch. + Young Range Riders. + +#Arthur Sewell.# + + Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days. + +#Capt. David Southwick.# + + Jack Wheeler. + +#Burt L. Standish.# + + Frank Merriwell's Bravery. + Frank Merriwell Down South. + Frank Merriwell's School Days. + Frank Merriwell's Chums. + Frank Merriwell's Foes. + Frank Merriwell's Trip West. + + + + +The New "Henty" Series. + + + With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS on each book. The + Illustrations are reproductions of paintings representing + scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover design is done in + Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth. These books are all + by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers. + + AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril. + BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden. + BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades. + BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain. + BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604). + BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic. + BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico. + BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War. + CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California. + CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt. + CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars. + DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred. + FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines. + FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia. + FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes. + FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem. + FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England. + GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico. + IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce. + IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy. + IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India. + JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea. + LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century. + LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of + Religion. + LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India. + MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War. + ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo. + ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick. + OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America. + ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers. + STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way. + THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots. + TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence. + UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main. + WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire. + WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War. + WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent. + YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War. + YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal. + YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa. + YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War. + YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria. + + _Any of the above books will be sent postpaid, upon receipt of + price, 50 cents._ + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +Boys' Popular Library. + + + BOUND IN CLOTH. + + An excellent series of books for boys by such popular authors + as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers. + + These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive cover + designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed from large + type, on good paper. Printed wrappers. + + Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Walter Aimwell.# + + Jerry. + Whistler. + +#Horatio Alger, Jr.# + + Brave and Bold. + Only an Irish Boy. + Paul, the Peddler. + Phil, the Fiddler. + Slow and Sure. + Strive and Succeed. + Strong and Steady. + Tom, the Bootblack. + Try and Trust. + +#Z. R. Bennett.# + + Young Vagabond, A. + +#Daniel Defoe.# + + Robinson Crusoe. + +#John De Morgan.# + + Always on Duty. + +#Richard Dowling.# + + Catmur's Cave. + +#George Manville Fenn.# + + In the Wilds of New Mexico. + +#Blanche Willis Howard.# + + Battle and a Boy, A. + +#W. H. G. Kingston.# + + Dick Cheveley. + From Powder Monkey to Admiral. + Hendricks, the Hunter. + Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean. + Peter Trawl. + Peter, the Whaler. + Shore and Ocean. + The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry. + +#Leon Lewis.# + + Diamond Seekers of Brazil. + Kit Carson's Last Trail. + Silver Ship, The. + Young Castaways, The. + +#Montleau & Wyse.# + + Swiss Family Robinson. + +#Alfred Oldfellow.# + + Joe Nichols. + Uncle Nat. + Way to Success. + +#Oliver Optic# + + All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club"). + Boat Club, The. + Little by Little. + Now or Never. + Try Again. + +#Capt. Mayne Reid.# + + Boy Tar, The. + Cliff Climber, The. + Lone Ranch, The. + Ran Away to Sea. + +#Gordon Stables.# + + Cruise of the Snowbird. + Life at Sea. + Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole. + Young Explorer, The. + +#Jefferys Taylor.# + + Boy Crusoes, The. + +#A Wolvertonian.# + + Three Years at Wolverton. + +#Ernest A. Young.# + + Toss Up for Luck. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +Girls' Popular Library. + + + ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH. + + LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers. Very attractive + cover design stamped in colors. Just the books that girls + delight to read--and can read with profit as well as pleasure. + Note the list of Authors--all well-known writers of the best + books for girls. + + Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Walter Aimwell.# + + Ella. + Jessie. + Marcus. + +#Mary D. Brine.# + + Echoes from Story Land. + Stories Grandma Told. + +#Alice Carey.# + + Clovernook Children. + Clovernook Tales. Vol. I. + Clovernook Tales. Vol. II. + +#Rosa Nouchette Carey.# + + Averil. + Our Bessie. + +#Cousin Virginia.# + + Cricket's Friends, The. + Dolls' Club, The. + 3 Vols. in 1. + Jo's Doll. + Katy's Christmas. + Patty's Pranks. + +#Lewis Carroll.# + + Alice's Adventures In Wonderland. + Through the Looking-Glass. + +#Maria S. Cummins.# + + Lamplighter, The. + +#Mary A. Denison.# + + Barbara's Triumphs. + Frenchman's Ward, The. + Guardian's Trust, The. + +#Maria Edgeworth.# + + Simple Susan. + +#Juliana Horatia Ewing.# + + Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A. + Great Emergency, A. + Jackanapes. + Jan of the Windmill. + Six to Sixteen. + We and the World. + +#Julia Goddard.# + + Fairy Tales In Other Lands. + +#Virginia F. Townsend.# + + Amy Deane. + While it Was Morning. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York. + + + + +TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE: All apparent printer's errors retained. + + + + + +End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + +***** This file should be named 33939-8.txt or 33939-8.zip ***** +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: + http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/ + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at +http://gutenberg.org/license). + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org. + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at +http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at +809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email +business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact +information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official +page at http://pglaf.org + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit http://pglaf.org + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + http://www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/33939-8.zip b/33939-8.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..2ac97d5 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-8.zip diff --git a/33939-h.zip b/33939-h.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..48482b3 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-h.zip diff --git a/33939-h/33939-h.htm b/33939-h/33939-h.htm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..020f2e9 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-h/33939-h.htm @@ -0,0 +1,10750 @@ +<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN" + "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd"> + +<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"> + <head> + <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=iso-8859-1" /> + <title> + The Project Gutenberg eBook of Sturdy And Strong, by G. A. Henty. + </title> + <style type="text/css"> + + p { margin-top: .75em; + text-align: justify; + margin-bottom: .75em; + } + h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 { + text-align: center; /* all headings centered */ + clear: both; + } + hr { width: 33%; + margin-top: 2em; + margin-bottom: 2em; + margin-left: auto; + margin-right: auto; + clear: both; + } + + table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;} + + body{margin-left: 10%; + margin-right: 10%; + } + + .pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */ + /* visibility: hidden; */ + position: absolute; + left: 92%; + font-size: smaller; + text-align: right; + } /* page numbers */ + + .blockquot{margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 10%;} + + .center {text-align: center;} + .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;} + .u {text-decoration: underline;} + + .caption {font-weight: bold;} + + .figcenter {margin: auto; text-align: center;} + + </style> + </head> +<body> + + +<pre> + +The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + +Title: Sturdy and Strong + How George Andrews Made His Way + +Author: G. A. Henty + +Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1 + +*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + + + + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + + + + + +</pre> + + + + +<div class="figcenter" style="width: 70%;"> +<img src="images/cover.jpg" width="100%" alt="" title="" /> +<span class="caption">STURDY AND STRONG<br /> +G. A. HENTY</span> +</div> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> + +<div class="figcenter" style="width: 70%;"> +<img src="images/frontis.jpg" width="100%" alt="" title="" /> +<span class="caption">"SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE, TELLING THEM +SEA STORIES."—<i>Frontispiece.</i><br /> +<i>Sturdy and Strong.</i></span> +</div> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h1>STURDY AND STRONG</h1> + +<h4>OR</h4> + +<h3><i>How George Andrews Made His Way</i></h3> + +<h3><small>BY</small><br /> + +<big>G. A. HENTY</big><br /> + +<small>AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE<br /> +IN INDIA," "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION<br /> +OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH,"<br /> +ETC., ETC., ETC.</small></h3> + +<h3>NEW YORK<br /> +<big>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY</big><br /> +PUBLISHERS</h3> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'>[Pg iii]</span></p> +<h2>PREFACE.</h2> + + +<p>Whatever may be said as to distinction of +classes in England, it is certain that in no country +in the world is the upward path more open to those +who brace themselves to climb it than in our own. +The proportion of those who remain absolutely +stationary is comparatively small. We are all living +on a hillside, and we must either go up or down. +It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who +fixes his eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb, +and determines with all his might and power to +win his way towards the top, is sure to find himself +at the end of his day at a far higher level than when +he started upon his journey. It may be said, and +sometimes foolishly is said, that luck is everything; +but in nineteen cases out of twenty what is called +luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of +the readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity +to advantage. The voyager must take +every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he +would make a favorable journey; and for success +in life it is necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast, +and true, but to have the faculty of turning +every opportunity to the best advantage; just as +a climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little +shrub, every projecting rock, as a hold for his hands +<span class='pagenum'>[Pg iv]</span> +or feet. George Andrews had what may be called +luck—that is, he had opportunities and took advantage +of them, and his rise in life was consequently +far more rapid than if he had let them pass +without grasping them; but in any case his steadiness, +perseverance, and determination to get on +would assuredly have made their way in the long +run. If similar qualities and similar determinations +are yours, you need not despair of similar success +in life.</p> + +<p style='text-align:right'><span class="smcap">G. A. Henty.</span></p> + + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'>[Pg v]</span></p> +<h2>CONTENTS.</h2> + + +<table border="0" cellpadding="5" cellspacing="0" summary="Table of Contents"> +<tr> + <td> </td> + <td><span class="smcap">Sturdy and Strong</span>:</td> + <td align="right"><small>PAGE</small></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_I"><b>I.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Alone</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_II"><b>II.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Two Friends</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_25">25</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_III"><b>III.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Work</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_48">48</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_IV"><b>IV.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Home</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_74">74</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_V"><b>V.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">An Adventure</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_97">97</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VI"><b>VI.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Fire!</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_117">117</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VII"><b>VII.</b></a></td> + <td><span class="smcap">Saved!</span>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_142">142</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td> </td> + <td><a href="#DO_YOUR_DUTY"><span class="smcap">Do Your Duty</span></a>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_165">165</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td> </td> + <td><a href="#SURLY_JOE"><span class="smcap">Surly Joe</span></a>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_231">231</a></td> +</tr> +<tr> + <td> </td> + <td><a href="#A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM"><span class="smcap">A Fish-wife's Dream</span></a>,</td> + <td align="right"><a href="#Page_257">257</a></td> +</tr> +</table> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[Pg 1]</a></span></p> +<h1>STURDY AND STRONG.</h1> +<hr style="width: 15%;" /> + + +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_I" id="CHAPTER_I"></a>CHAPTER I.</h2> + +<h3>ALONE.</h3> + + +<p>"You heard what he said, George?"</p> + +<p>"Oh, mother, mother!"</p> + +<p>"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen +it coming a long time, and, hard as it seems, it will +be better. There is no disgrace in it. I have tried +my best, and if my health had not broken down we +might have managed, but you see it was not to be. +I shall not mind it, dear; it is really only for your +sake that I care about it at all."</p> + +<p>The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a +white set face.</p> + +<p>"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I +cannot keep you from this. If we could only have +managed for a year or two I could have earned +more then; but to think of you—you in the workhouse!"</p> + +<p>"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother +said gently. "You see it is not as if it were from +any fault of ours. We have done our best. You +and I have managed for two years; but what with +<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[Pg 2]</a></span> +my health and my eyes breaking down we can do +so no longer. I hope it will not be for long, dear. +You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I +shall soon be able to be out again."</p> + +<p>"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought +not to use your eyes for months."</p> + +<p>"Even months pass quickly, George, when one +has hope. I have felt this coming so long that I +shall be easier and happier now it has come. After +all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital, +and it would not seem so very dreadful to you my +going into a hospital; the difference is only in +name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is +kept up out of subscriptions, the other from the +rates."</p> + +<p>His mother's words conveyed but little comfort +to George Andrews. He had just come in from his +work, and had heard what the parish doctor had +told his mother.</p> + +<p>"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews. +You must have rest and quiet for your eyes, and +not only that, but you must have strengthening +food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is +painful for you, I know. I can well understand +that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go +I won't answer for your life."</p> + +<p>"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly. +"I know that it will be best. It will be a blow to +my boy, but I see no other way."</p> + +<p>"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the +<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[Pg 3]</a></span> +world, ma'am, you will do as I advise you. I will +go round in the morning and get you the order of +admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I +will, if you like, take you myself."</p> + +<p>"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes, +I will be ready in the morning, and I thank you +for your offer."</p> + +<p>"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said +briskly. "At ten o'clock I will be here."</p> + +<p>Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries +was a kind-hearted and humane man.</p> + +<p>"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went +downstairs, "it is hard for her. It is easy to see +that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but +what can I do for her! I might get her a little +temporary help, but that would be of no use--she +is completely broken down with anxiety and insufficient +food, and unless her eyes have a long +holiday she will lose her sight. No, there's nothing +else for it, but it is hard."</p> + +<p>It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor +said, a lady. She had lost both her parents while +she was at school. She had no near relations, and +as she was sixteen when her mother died she had +remained at school finishing her education and +teaching the younger children. Then she had obtained +a situation as governess in a gentleman's +family, and two years afterwards had married a +young barrister who was a frequent visitor at the +house.</p> + +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[Pg 4]</a></span>Mr. +Andrews was looked upon as a rising man, +and for the first seven or eight years of her marriage +his wife's life had been a very happy one. +Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which +he caught in one of the midland towns while on +circuit, and although he partially recovered he was +never himself again. His power of work seemed +to be lost; a languor which he could not overcome +took possession of him. A troublesome cough +ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs. +Andrews was a widow, and her boy, then nine years +old, an orphan.</p> + +<p>During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews +had earned but little in his profession. The comfortable +house which he occupied had been given +up, and they had removed to one much smaller. +But in spite of this, debts mounted up, and when, +after his death, the remaining furniture was sold +and everything settled, there remained only about +two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get +some pupils among her late husband's friends, but +during the last two years she had lost sight of many +of these, and now met with but poor success among +the others. She was a quiet and retiring woman, +and shrank from continuous solicitations, and at +the end of three years she found her little store +exhausted.</p> + +<p>Hitherto she had kept George at school, but +could no longer do so, and, giving up her lodging +in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where some<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[Pg 5]</a></span>one +had told her that they thought she would have +a better chance of obtaining pupils, but the cards +which some of the tradesmen allowed her to put in +the window led to no result, and finding this to be +the case she applied at one of the milliner's for +work. This she obtained, and for a year supported +herself and her boy by needlework.</p> + +<p>From the time when George left school she had +gone on teaching him his lessons; but on the day +when he was thirteen years old he declared that he +would no longer submit to his mother working for +both of them, and, setting out, called at shop after +shop inquiring if they wanted an errand-boy. He +succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's +where he was to receive three shillings a week and +his meals, going home to sleep at night in the +closet-like little attic adjoining the one room which +his mother could now afford.</p> + +<p>For a while they were more comfortable than +they had been for some time; now that his mother +had no longer George to feed, her earnings and the +three shillings he brought home every Saturday +night enabled them to live in comparative ease, and +on Sunday something like a feast was always prepared. +But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt +her eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and +a dull aching pain settled in the eyeballs. Soon +she could only work for a short time together, her +earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers +presently told her that she kept the work<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[Pg 6]</a></span> +so long in hand that they could no longer employ +her. There was now only George's three shillings +a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by +the rent. In despair she had applied to the parish +doctor about her eyes. For a fortnight he attended +her, and at the end of that time had peremptorily +given the order of which she had told her +son.</p> + +<p>To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must +come. Piece by piece every article of clothing she +possessed, save those she wore, had been pawned +for food, and every resource was now exhausted. +She was worn out with the struggle, and the certainty +of rest and food overcame her repugnance +to the house. For George's sake too, much as she +knew he would feel her having to accept such a +refuge, she was glad that the struggle was at an +end. The lad had for the last six months suffered +greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat +down at his employer's seemed to choke him as he +contrasted it with the fare to which she was reduced, +although, as far as possible, she had concealed +from him how sore was her strait.</p> + +<p>George cried himself to sleep that night, and he +could scarce speak when he said good-by to his +mother in the morning, for he could not tell when +he should see her again.</p> + +<p>"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?"</p> + +<p>"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[Pg 7]</a></span> +what I shall do; but please don't ask me to promise +anything. You must let me do what I think best. +I have got to make a home for you when you are +cured. I am fourteen now, and am as strong as +most boys of my age. I ought to be able to earn +a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings +a week, mother, and you just working a little, you +know, so as not to hurt your eyes, we ought to be +able to do. Don't you bother about me, mother. +I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come +out. When you do, then I will do whatever you +tell me; that's fair, isn't it?"</p> + +<p>Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he +said:</p> + +<p>"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a +year's character from Dutton, so that if I can't get +anything else to do I can get the same sort of +place again, and as I am a year older than I was +when he took me, and can tie up parcels neatly +now, I ought to get a little more anyhow. You +see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never +grumbled, you know, mother—have I?—I think +I would rather do anything than be a grocer's boy. +I would rather, when I grow up, be a bricklayer's +laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's +work, than be pottering about behind a counter, +with a white apron on, weighing out sugar and +currants."</p> + +<p>"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews +said with a sigh. "It's natural, my boy. If I get<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[Pg 8]</a></span> +my eyesight and my health again, when you grow +up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and +you and I will go out together to one of the colonies. +It will be easier to rise again there than here, +and with hard work both of us might surely hope +to get on. There must be plenty of villages in +Australia and Canada where I could do well with +teaching, and you could get work in whatever way +you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set +that before us. It will be something to hope for +and work for, and will cheer us to go through whatever +may betide us up to that time."</p> + +<p>"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort +indeed to have something to look forward to. +Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but if +anything could it would be some such plan as +that."</p> + +<p>The last words he said to his mother as, blinded +with tears, he kissed her before starting to work, +were:</p> + +<p>"I shall think of our plan every day, and look +forward to that more than anything else in the +world—next to your coming to me again."</p> + +<p>At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews' +humble lodging in a brougham instead of +his ordinary gig, having borrowed the carriage +from one of the few of his patients who kept such +a vehicle, on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for +she was so weak and worn that he was sure she +would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[Pg 9]</a></span> +three miles that had to be traversed. He managed +in the course of his rounds to pass the workhouse +again in the afternoon, and brought George, before +he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf +torn from his pocketbook:</p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p>"My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything +is clean and nice, and the doctor and people +kind. Do not fret about me.—Your loving +mother."</p></div> + +<p>Although George's expressed resolution of leaving +his present situation, and seeking to earn his +living in some other way, caused Mrs. Andrews +much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade +him from it. No doubt it would be wiser +for him to stay in his present situation, where he +was well treated and well fed, and it certainly +seemed improbable to her that he would be able +to get a better living elsewhere. Still she could +not blame him for wishing at least to try. She herself +shared to some extent his prejudice against the +work in which he was employed. There is no +disgrace in honest work; but she felt that she would +rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than +as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed +he could come back again to Croydon, and, with a +year's character from his present employer, would +probably be able to obtain a situation similar to +that which he now held. She was somewhat com<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[Pg 10]</a></span>forted, +too, by a few words the doctor had said to +her during their drive.</p> + +<p>"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs. +Andrews. He seems to me a fine steady boy. If +I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you are +away from him, I will."</p> + +<p>George remained for another month in his situation, +for he knew that it would never do to start on +his undertaking penniless. At the end of that +time, having saved up ten shillings, and having +given notice to his employer, he left the shop for +the last time, and started to walk to London. It +was not until he began to enter the crowded streets +that he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking. +To be alone in London, a solitary atom in the busy +mass of humanity, is a trying situation even for a +man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying +a penny roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the +niches of a bridge over the river, and then kneeling +up watched the barges and steamers passing below +him.</p> + +<p>Had it not been for his mother, his first thought, +like that of most English boys thrown on the world, +would have been to go to sea; but this idea he had +from the first steadily set aside as out of the question. +His plan was to obtain employment as a boy +in some manufacturing work, for he thought that +there, by steadiness and perseverance, he might +make his way.</p> + +<p>On one thing he was resolved. He would make<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[Pg 11]</a></span> +his money last as long as possible. Three penny-worth +of bread a day would, he calculated, be sufficient +for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought +he might manage to sleep anywhere; it was summer +time and the nights were warm. He had no idea +what the price of a bed would be, or how to set +about getting a lodging. He did not care how +roughly he lived so that he could but make his +money last. The first few days he determined to +look about him. Something might turn up. If +it did not he would set about getting a place in +earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and, +keeping straight on, found himself in Covent Garden, +where he was astonished and delighted at the +quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers.</p> + +<p>Although he twice set out in different directions +to explore the streets, he each time returned to +Covent Garden. There were many lads of his own +age playing about there, and he thought that from +them he might get some hints as to how to set +about earning a living. They looked ragged and +poor enough, but they might be able to tell him +something—about sleeping, for instance. For although +before starting the idea of sleeping anywhere +had seemed natural enough, it looked more +formidable now that he was face to face with it.</p> + +<p>Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market +he bought two slices of plum-pudding. He rather +grudged the twopence which he paid; but he felt +that it might be well laid out. Provided with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[Pg 12]</a></span> +pudding he returned to the market, sat himself +down on an empty basket, and began to eat slowly +and leisurely.</p> + +<p>In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own +age watching him greedily.</p> + +<p>He was far from being a respectable-looking boy. +His clothes were ragged, and his toes could be seen +through a hole in his boot. He wore neither hat +nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been +combed since the day of his birth. There was a +sharp, pinched look on his face. But had he been +washed and combed and decently clad he would +not have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate +George liked his face better than most he had seen +in the market, and he longed for a talk with someone. +So he held out his other slice of pudding, +and said:</p> + +<p>"Have a bit?"</p> + +<p>"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?"</p> + +<p>"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?"</p> + +<p>"No larks?" asked the boy.</p> + +<p>"No; no larks. Here you are."</p> + +<p>Feeling assured now that no trick was intended +the boy approached, took without a word the pudding +which George held out, and, seating himself +on a basket close to him, took a great bite.</p> + +<p>"Where do you live?" George asked, when the +slice of pudding had half disappeared.</p> + +<p>"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand +round.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[Pg 13]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I mean, where do you sleep?"</p> + +<p>The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place +was included in the general description of his +domicile.</p> + +<p>"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired.</p> + +<p>"The beaks, they moves you on when they +ketches you; but ef yer get under a cart or +in among the baskets you generally dodges +'em."</p> + +<p>"And suppose you want to pay for a place to +sleep, where do you go and how much do you +pay?"</p> + +<p>"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a +first-rate, fourpence. Does yer want to find a +crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his companion.</p> + +<p>"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find +some quiet place where I can sleep, cheap, you +know."</p> + +<p>"Out of work?" the boy inquired.</p> + +<p>"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present. +I am looking for a place, you know."</p> + +<p>"Don't know no one about?"</p> + +<p>"No; I have just come in from Croydon."</p> + +<p>The boy shook his head.</p> + +<p>"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said. +"Why, yer'd get them clothes and any money yet +had walked off with the wery fust night."</p> + +<p>"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[Pg 14]</a></span> +even for fourpence?" George asked, making a +rapid calculation that this would come to two and +fourpence per week, as much as his mother had +paid for a comparatively comfortable room in +Croydon.</p> + +<p>The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his +companion requiring a room for himself.</p> + +<p>"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with +yer!"</p> + +<p>"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just +some place to sleep in. Just some straw in any +quiet corner."</p> + +<p>This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he +thought the matter over.</p> + +<p>"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place +where they puts up the hosses of the market carts. +I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when it's +wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it +warm and comfortable just! I helps him with the +hosses sometimes, and that's why. I will ax him if +yer likes."</p> + +<p>George assented at once. His ideas as to the +possibility of sleeping in the open air had vanished +when he saw the surroundings, and a bed in a quiet +loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in +a room with twenty others.</p> + +<p>"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and +what's your name?"</p> + +<p>"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather +proudly; "but my real name's Bill."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[Pg 15]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George +asked.</p> + +<p>"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands +on me," Bill replied.</p> + +<p>"But what do they want to lay hands on you +for?" George asked.</p> + +<p>"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied +calmly.</p> + +<p>"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?" +George said, greatly shocked.</p> + +<p>"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied; +"not wipes, yer know, nor tickers, nor them +kind of things. I aint never prigged nothing of +that kind."</p> + +<p>"Well, what is it then you do—prig?" George +asked, mystified.</p> + +<p>"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes, +onions sometimes, or 'taters. That aint regular +prigging, you know."</p> + +<p>"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing," +George said, after a pause.</p> + +<p>"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all," +the Shadow said angrily. "Everyone as aint a +fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no one can't +say as a apple and a ticker are the same."</p> + +<p>"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you +see one is just as much stealing as the other."</p> + +<p>"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the +same as money and t'other aint. I am hungry and +I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint the worse for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[Pg 16]</a></span> +it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here? +Why, there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is +rotten. Well, it aint no more if I takes one than +if it was rotten. Is it now?"</p> + +<p>George thought there was a difference, but he +did not feel equal to explaining it.</p> + +<p>"The policemen must think differently," he said +at last, "else they wouldn't be always trying to +catch you."</p> + +<p>"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously. +"I don't; and I don't want no more +jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer +leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I? +So now then."</p> + +<p>George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and +moreover he saw that in the event of a quarrel his +chance of finding a refuge for the night was small. +In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he +was loath to break with the only acquaintance he +had made.</p> + +<p>"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said; +"only I was sorry to hear you say you took things. +It seems to me you might get into trouble; and it +would be better after all to work for a living."</p> + +<p>"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively. +"Who's agoing to give me work? Does yer think +I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for +'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing +about my character, I suppose? nor where I had +worked before? nor where my feyther lived? nor<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[Pg 17]</a></span> +nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming +easy to get work about here; only got to ax for it, +that's all. Good wages and all found, that's your +kind."</p> + +<p>"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but +it seems to me people could get something to do +if they tried."</p> + +<p>"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think +we don't try! Why, we are always trying to earn +a copper or two. Why, we begins at three o'clock +in the morning when the market-carts come in, and +we goes on till they comes out of that there theater +at night, just trying to pick up a copper. Sometimes +one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's +a good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner +by the end of it. Don't tell me! And now as to +this ere stable; yer means it?"</p> + +<p>"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it."</p> + +<p>"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at +nine o'clock. I will go before that and square it +with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking of."</p> + +<p>"I had better give you something to give him," +George said. "Will a shilling do?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights. +Are you going to trust me with it?"</p> + +<p>"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure +you wouldn't be so mean as to do me out of it; besides, +you told me that you never stole money and +those sort of things."</p> + +<p>"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[Pg 18]</a></span> +for all that," Bill replied; "and yer are running a +risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer goes on with +that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore +yer've done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going +to bilk yer."</p> + +<p>The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of +confidence on the part of his companion really +touched him, and as he went off he said to himself, +"He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so +precious green. I must look arter him a bit and +see he don't get into no mischief."</p> + +<p>George, on his part, as he walked away down +into the Strand again, felt that he had certainly run +a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of his capital to his +new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner +had attracted him, and he felt that, although the +Shadow's notions of right and wrong might be of +a confused nature, he meant to act straight toward +him.</p> + +<p>George passed the intervening hours before the +time named for his meeting in Covent Garden in +staring into the shop windows in the Strand, and +in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles +and foot passengers flowing steadily out westward. +He was nearly knocked under the wheels of the +vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to +the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused +by the jostling and pushing that he was glad to +turn down a side street and to sit down for a time +on a doorstep.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[Pg 19]</a></span></p> + +<p>When nine o'clock approached he went into a +baker's shop and bought a loaf, which would, he +thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself +and his companion. Having further invested +threepence in cheese, he made his way up to the +market.</p> + +<p>The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling +loudly.</p> + +<p>"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along. +I have squared Ned, and it's all right."</p> + +<p>He led the way down two or three streets and +then stopped at a gateway.</p> + +<p>"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as +there aint no one but Ned about."</p> + +<p>He returned in a minute.</p> + +<p>"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a +hoss; he won't take no notice of yer as yer pass. +He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause in case +anyone comed and found yer up there he could +swear he never saw yer go in, and didn't know +nothing about yer. I will go with yer to the door, +and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer +whip up that yer'll find it all right up there."</p> + +<p>"But you are coming too, aint you?" George +asked.</p> + +<p>"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a +chap like me up there. I might pick yer pocket, +yer know; besides I aint your sort."</p> + +<p>"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like +to have you with me, Bill; I should really. Be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[Pg 20]</a></span>sides, +what's the difference between us? We have +both got to work for ourselves and make our way +in the world."</p> + +<p>"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the +way as I do; yer have been brought up different. +Don't tell me."</p> + +<p>"I may have been brought up differently, Bill. +I have been fortunate there; but now, you see, I +have got to get my living in the best way I can, +and if I have had a better education than you have, +you know ever so much more about London and +how to get your living than I do, so that makes us +quits."</p> + +<p>"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same +to this child. So if yer aint too proud, here +goes."</p> + +<p>He led the way down a stable yard, past several +doors, showing the empty stalls which would be all +filled when the market carts arrived. At the last +door on the right he stopped. George looked in. +At the further end a man was rubbing down a horse +by the faint light of a lantern, the rest of the stable +was in darkness.</p> + +<p>"This way," Bill whispered.</p> + +<p>Keeping close behind him, George entered the +stable. The boy stopped in the corner.</p> + +<p>"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give +yer a hand when yer gets to the top."</p> + +<p>George stood quiet until his companion had +mounted, and then ascended the ladder, which was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[Pg 21]</a></span> +fixed against the wall. Presently a voice whispered +in his ear:</p> + +<p>"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your +foot."</p> + +<p>In a minute he was standing in the loft. His +companion drew him along in the darkness, and in +a few steps arrived at a pile of hay.</p> + +<p>"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer +'ave only to make yourself comfortable there. +Now mind you don't fall down one of the holes +into the mangers."</p> + +<p>"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he +ensconced himself in the hay.</p> + +<p>"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill +said, as he left his side, and directly afterwards a +door opened and the light of a gaslight in the yard +streamed in.</p> + +<p>"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said +as he rejoined him. "I shuts it up afore I goes to +sleep, 'cause the master he comes out sometimes +when the carts comes in, and there would be a +blooming row if he saw it open; but we are all +right now."</p> + +<p>"That's much nicer," George said. "Now +here's a loaf I brought with me. We will cut it in +half and put by a half for the morning, and eat the +other half between us now, and I have got some +cheese here too."</p> + +<p>"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good +sort, I could see that, and I am pretty empty, I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[Pg 22]</a></span> +am, for I aint had nothing except that bit of duff +yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust +then. 'Cept for running against you I aint been +lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job nohows, and it +aint for want of trying neither."</p> + +<p>For some minutes the boys ate in silence. +George had given much the largest portion to his +companion, for he himself was too dead tired to be +very hungry. When he had finished, he said:</p> + +<p>"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning. +I am so dead beat I can scarcely keep my eyes +open, so I will just say my prayers and go off to +sleep."</p> + +<p>"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment. +"Do yer mean to say as yer says prayers!"</p> + +<p>"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?"</p> + +<p>"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly; +"don't know how, don't see as it would do no good +ef I did."</p> + +<p>"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I +hope some day you will think differently, and I will +teach you some you will like."</p> + +<p>"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively. +"A missionary chap, he came and prayed +with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not +make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same, +so you see what good did it do her?"</p> + +<p>But George was too tired to enter upon a theological +argument. He was already half asleep, and +Bill's voice sounded a long way off.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[Pg 23]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you +in the morning," and in another minute he was fast +asleep.</p> + +<p>Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly +over his companion; then he closed the door of the +loft and threw himself on the hay, and was soon +also sound asleep. When George woke in the +morning the daylight was streaming in through the +cracks of the door. His companion was gone. +He heard the voices of several men in the yard, +while a steady champing noise and an occasional +shout or the sound of a scraping on the stones told +him the stalls below were all full now.</p> + +<p>George felt that he had better remain where he +was. Bill had told him the evening before that +the horses and carts generally set out again at +about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better +wait till they had gone before he slipped down below. +Closing his eyes he was very soon off to +sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by +his side looking at him.</p> + +<p>"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said. +"Why, it's nigh ten o'clock, and it's time for us to +be moving. Ned will be going off in a few minutes, +and the stables will be locked up till the evening."</p> + +<p>"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?" +George asked.</p> + +<p>"No, we had better eat it when we get down to +the market; come along."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[Pg 24]</a></span></p> + +<p>George at once rose, shook the hay off his +clothes, and descended the ladder, Bill leading the +way. There was no one in the stable, and the yard +was also empty. On reaching the market they sat +down on two empty baskets, and at once began to +eat their bread and cheese.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[Pg 25]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_II" id="CHAPTER_II"></a>CHAPTER II.</h2> + +<h3>TWO FRIENDS.</h3> + + +<p>"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he +had eaten a few mouthfuls; "but you were out."</p> + +<p>"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to +come in," Bill said, "and a wery good morning I +have had. One old chap gave me twopence for +looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into +the market with his flowers. But the best move +was just now. A chap as was driving off with +flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect, +by the look of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't +see it till I ran after him with it, then he gave me a +tanner; that was something like. Have yer finished +yer bread and cheese?"</p> + +<p>"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink +of water if I could get one."</p> + +<p>"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you +come along with me, I am agoing to stand two cups +of coffee if yer aint too proud to take it;" and he +looked doubtfully at his companion.</p> + +<p>"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he +saw that the slightest hesitation would hurt his +companion's feelings.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[Pg 26]</a></span></p> + +<p>"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a +brightened look on his face he turned and led the +way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's hot and sweet, +and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny."</p> + +<p>George found the coffee really better than he had +expected, and Bill was evidently very much gratified +at his expression of approval.</p> + +<p>"Now," he said, when they had both finished, +"for a draw of 'baccy," and he produced a short +clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?"</p> + +<p>"No, I haven't begun yet."</p> + +<p>"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is," +Bill said. "Why, when yer are cold and hungry +and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful thing, +and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer +thirty pipes if yer don't squeeze it in too hard. +Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs threepence halfpenny, +so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a +penny; and now," he went on when he had filled +and lit his pipe, "let's know what's yer game."</p> + +<p>"You mean what am I going to do?" George +asked.</p> + +<p>Bill nodded.</p> + +<p>"I want to get employment in some sort of works. +I have been an errand-boy in a grocer's for more +than a year, and I have got a written character from +my master in my pocket; but I don't like the sort of +thing; I would rather work with my own hands. +There are plenty of works where they employ boys, +and you know one might get on as one gets older.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[Pg 27]</a></span> +The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of +that sort are."</p> + +<p>"There are lots of works at the East End, I have +heard tell," Bill said; "and then there's Clerkenwell +and King's Cross, they aint so far off, and there are +works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but I +don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The +only work as I have done is holding hosses and carrying +plants into the market, and sometimes when +I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out +what I got in <i>Echoes</i>, or <i>Globes</i>, or <i>Evening Standards</i>; +that pays yer, that does, for if yer can sell them +all yer will get a bob for eight penn'orth of papers, +that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and I +calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out +for a bob! Oh, no, I should think not! Well, +what shall it be? I knows the way out to Whitechapel +and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I +can show yer."</p> + +<p>"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try +that first," George said, "and I shall be much +obliged to you for showing the way."</p> + +<p>The two boys spent the whole day in going from +workshop to workshop for employment; but the answers +to his application were unvarying: either he +was too young or there was no place vacant. +George took the disappointment quietly, for he had +made up his mind that he would have difficulty in +getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf +of his companion.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[Pg 28]</a></span></p> + +<p>"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A +chap can pick up a few coppers there, and here we +have been a-tramping about all day and aint done +nothing."</p> + +<p>Day after day George set out on his quest, but all +was without success. He and Bill still slept in the +loft, and after the first day he took to getting up at +the same time as his companion, and going out with +him to try and pick up a few pence from the men +with the market-carts. Every other morning they +were able to lie later, as there were only regular +marketdays three mornings a week.</p> + +<p>On market mornings he found that he earned +more than Bill, his better clothes giving him an advantage, +as the men were more willing to trust their +carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking +boy than to that of the arabs who frequented +the Garden. But all that was earned was laid out in +common between the two boys, and George found +himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence +on his private stock. He had by this time told the +Shadow exactly how much money he had, and the +boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting +work, was most averse to the store being +trenched upon, and always gave his vote against the +smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread +and cheese being purchased, except from their earnings +of the day. This George felt was the more +creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the latter had, +in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[Pg 29]</a></span> +petty thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned +his dry crusts.</p> + +<p>George had learned now what Bill knew of his +history, which was little enough. He supposed he +had had a father, but he knew nothing of him; +whether he had died, or whether he had cut away +and left mother, Bill had no idea. His mother he +remembered well, though she had died when he was, +as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in +a hushed voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior +being.</p> + +<p>"We was poor, you know," he said to George, +"and I know mother was often short of grub, but +she was just kind. I don't never remember her +whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she +was good, she was. She used to pray, you know, +and what I remember most is as the night afore she +was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live +honest, Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't +you take to stealing, however poor you may be;' +and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and over again. +"When I has seed any chap going along with a +ticker handy, which I could have boned and got +away among the carts as safe as ninepence, or when +I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of +them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to +bless myself with, and perhaps nothing to eat all day, +I have felt it hard not to make a grab; but I just +thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I +told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[Pg 30]</a></span> +out of the baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as +that was stealing, but as you says it is, I aint going +to do so no more. Now look yer here, George; they +tells me as the parsons says as when people die and +they are good they goes up there, yer know."</p> + +<p>George nodded, for there was a question in his +companion's tone.</p> + +<p>"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there. +Now it aint likely as ever I should see her again, +'cause, you know, there aint nothing good about +me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I +might be, and was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been +a-stealing?' do yer think she would feel very bad +about them 'ere apples and things?"</p> + +<p>"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see +you didn't quite know that was stealing, and you +kept from stealing the things that you thought she +spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking +even little things you are not going to take them +any more."</p> + +<p>"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said; +"not if I never gets another apple between my +teeth."</p> + +<p>"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it, +not only to please your mother, but to please God. +That's what my mother has told me over and over +again."</p> + +<p>"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest, +"and did you use to prig apples and sichlike sometimes?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[Pg 31]</a></span></p> + +<p>"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but +she was talking of things in general. Of doing +things that were wrong, such as telling lies and deceiving, +and that sort of thing."</p> + +<p>"And your mother thinks as God knows all about +it?"</p> + +<p>George nodded.</p> + +<p>"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done +bad?"</p> + +<p>George nodded again.</p> + +<p>"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill +said in solemn wonder. "Why, I heard a woman +say last week as six children was enough to worrit +anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of +us!" and Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive +way and repeated, "What a time he must have +of it!"</p> + +<p>For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill +wondering over the problem that had presented +itself to him, and George trying to find some appropriate +explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had +started. At last he said:</p> + +<p>"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to +you, for I am not accustomed to talk about such +things. My mother talks to me sometimes, and of +course I went to church regularly; but that's different +from my talking about it; but you know what +we have got to do is to try and please God, and love +him because he loves us."</p> + +<p>"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[Pg 32]</a></span> +heard fellows say beats 'em. If he loves a chap like +me how is it he don't do something for him? why +don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint +been a-prigging apples or a-putting him out. +That's what I wants to know."</p> + +<p>"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it +would be very hard to understand if this world were +the only one; but you see we are only here a little +time, and after that there's on and on and on, right +up without any end, and what does it matter if we +are poor or unhappy in this little time if we are +going to be ever so happy afterwards? This is only +a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were, +and if we do the best we can, even though that best +is very little, then you see we get a tremendous reward. +For instance, you would not think a man +was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his +horse on a cold day, if he were going to give you +enough to get you clothes and good lodging for the +rest of your life."</p> + +<p>"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so +it's like that, is it?"</p> + +<p>George nodded. "Like that, only more."</p> + +<p>"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in +astonishment at this new view of things.</p> + +<p>After that there were few evenings when, before +they nestled themselves down in the hay, the boys +did not talk on this subject. At first George felt +awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the +generality of English boys, however earnest their<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[Pg 33]</a></span> +convictions may be, he was shy of speaking what he +felt; but his companion's eagerness to know more +of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak, +and having in his bundle a small Bible which his +mother had given him, he took to reading to Bill a +chapter or two in the mornings when they had not +to go out to the early market.</p> + +<p>It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled +him. The boy saw things in a light so wholly different +from that in which he himself had been accustomed +to regard them that he found a great +difficulty in replying to them.</p> + +<p>George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her +exactly what he was doing, for he knew that if he +only said that he had not yet succeeded in getting +work she would be very anxious about him, and although +he had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at +least he could tell her that he had sufficient to eat +and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he received +replies from her, directed to him at a little +coffee-house, which, when they had had luck, the +boys occasionally patronized. As time went on +without his succeeding in obtaining employment +George's hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate; +"I will try for another fortnight, Bill, and if at the +end of that time I don't get anything to do I shall go +back to Croydon again."</p> + +<p>"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated.</p> + +<p>"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[Pg 34]</a></span> +but that is all, Bill. I came up to London in hopes +of getting something to do by which I might some +day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this +I should be going down, and a nice sight I should be +to mother if, when she gets well enough to come out +of the infirmary, I were to go back all in rags."</p> + +<p>"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked. +"Is there any chance of picking up a living there? +'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I goes with yer. +I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we +might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer +wouldn't mind that?"</p> + +<p>"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a +good friend to me, and I should be sorry to think of +you all alone here."</p> + +<p>"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied. +"I aint done nothing except put yer in the +way of getting a sleeping-place, and as it's given me +one too I have had the best of that job. It's been +good of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't +know how to read or write or nothing, and as aint +no good anyway. But you will let me go with yer +to Croydon, won't yer?"</p> + +<p>"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to +see much of me. I shall have to get a place like the +last. The man I was with said he would take me +back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am +all day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of +course you would have to be busy too at something."</p> + +<p>"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[Pg 35]</a></span> +can hold a hoss, but that aint much for a living. +One may go for days without getting a chance."</p> + +<p>"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would +be to try and get work either in a brickfield or with a +market-gardener. At any rate we should be able +to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was +always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in +work we could take a room together."</p> + +<p>Bill shook his head.</p> + +<p>"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it, +George. I knows as I aint fit company for yer, and +if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he would think +yer was going to run off with the money if he knew +yer kept company with a chap like me. No, the +'greement must be as yer goes yer ways and I goes +mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to do up +here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this +place of yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on +getting work here."</p> + +<p>A week later the two boys were out late in Covent +Garden trying to earn a few pence by fetching +up cabs and carriages for people coming out from a +concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded +in earning threepence, and had returned to +the entrance to the hall, and was watching the people +come out, and trying to get another job. Presently +a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years +old, came out and took their place on the footpath.</p> + +<p>"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked.</p> + +<p>"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[Pg 36]</a></span></p> + +<p>George fell back and stood watching the girl, who +was in a white dress, with a little hood trimmed with +swansdown over her head.</p> + +<p>Presently his eye fell on something on which the +light glittered as it hung from her neck. Just as he +was looking a hand reached over her shoulder, +there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child, +then a boy dived into the crowd, and at the same +moment George dashed after him. There was a +cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab +at George as he dived through the crowd; but he +slipped through them and was soon in the roadway.</p> + +<p>Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy +running. He turned up Bow Street and then +dashed down an alley. He did not know that he +was followed until suddenly George sprang upon +his back, and the two fell with a crash, the young +thief undermost. George seized his right hand, and +kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and +forced him to open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise, +and not knowing who was his assailant, making +but slight resistance.</p> + +<p>George seized the gold locket and dashed back at +full speed into the market, and was soon in the thick +of the crowd round the entrance. The gentleman +was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking +a note of the description of the lost trinket. +The girl was standing by crying.</p> + +<p>"Here is your locket," George said, putting it<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[Pg 37]</a></span> +into her hand. "I saw the boy take it, and have +got it from him."</p> + +<p>"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my +locket again."</p> + +<p>"Why, where did you get it from?" her father +asked in astonishment.</p> + +<p>"This boy has just given it to me," she replied. +"He says he took it from the boy who stole it."</p> + +<p>"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who +brought it back?"</p> + +<p>The girl looked round, but George was gone.</p> + +<p>"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her +father said. "Of course I should wish to thank +and reward him, for the locket was a very valuable +one, and the more so to us from its having belonged +to your mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?"</p> + +<p>"No, sir, I did not see him at all."</p> + +<p>"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?"</p> + +<p>"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied. +"At least I don't think so; but I only looked +at his face. He didn't speak like a poor boy at +all."</p> + +<p>"Would you know him again?"</p> + +<p>"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking +boy with a nice face."</p> + +<p>"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my +dear. Evidently he does not want a reward, but at +any rate I should have liked to thank him. Are you +always on this beat, policeman?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[Pg 38]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are +on."</p> + +<p>"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables +who are about here in the daytime. I wish you +would mention the fact to them, and ask them if +they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me +this service, to let me know. Here is a card with +my name and address."</p> + +<p>After restoring the locket George made his way +to the entrance to the stables, where he generally met +Bill after the theater had closed and there was no +farther chance of earning money. It was not till +half an hour later that the boy came running up.</p> + +<p>"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is +something like luck. I got three jobs. One stood +me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence each. +What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee +afore we turns in?"</p> + +<p>"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence. +We will put that by, with the sixpence we +saved the other day, for the hostler. We haven't +given him anything for some time. Your eightpence +will get us a good breakfast in the morning."</p> + +<p>When they had comfortably nestled themselves +in the hay George told his companion how he had +rescued and restored the locket.</p> + +<p>"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd +tell of such a scaly trick as that. I should ha' said it +ought to have been good for a bob anyway."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[Pg 39]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given +the little girl her locket I bolted."</p> + +<p>"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have +waited to have seen what the bloke meant to give +yer?"</p> + +<p>"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as +that," George replied. "I don't mind being paid +when I have done a job for anyone; but this was +different altogether."</p> + +<p>Bill meditated for a minute or two.</p> + +<p>"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last. +"Yer did him a good turn, and got the thing back. +I dare say it were worth five bob."</p> + +<p>"A good deal more than that, Bill."</p> + +<p>"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have +come down handsome. Didn't yer run like winking, +and didn't yer jump on the chap's back and +knock him down, and didn't yer run back again? +And warn't there a chance, ef one of the bobbies +had got hold of yer collar and found it in yer hand, +of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer +walks off and don't give him a chance of giving yer +nuffin. My eye, but yer are a flat!"</p> + +<p>"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill. +But when people do a thing to oblige somebody, and +not as a piece of regular work, they don't expect to +be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered +me money for such a thing."</p> + +<p>"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill +rejoined; "but it seems a rum sort of notion to me.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[Pg 40]</a></span> +When people loses things they expects to pay to get +'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice +station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so +much for giving back things as is lost. I can't read +'em myself, yer know; but chaps have read 'em to +me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being +offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies +coming out of theayters, and I have often thought +what a turn of luck it would be to light on one of +'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the +money ef I found it."</p> + +<p>"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing +and saw a reward offered, and you wanted the +money, you would have good right to take it. But, +you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at +losing her locket, and I went after it to please her, +and I was quite content that I got it back for +her."</p> + +<p>Bill tried again to think the matter over in his +mind, but he was getting warm and sleepy, and in +a few minutes was sound off.</p> + +<p>Two or three days later the lads had, to their great +satisfaction, obtained a job. Walnuts were just +coming in, and the boys were engaged to take off the +green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he +had never before been taken on for such a job, and +he considered it a sort of promotion. Five or six +women were also employed, and as the group were +standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly +nudged his friend:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[Pg 41]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?"</p> + +<p>George looked up from his work and at once +recognized the girl to whom he had restored the +locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment.</p> + +<p>"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if +you brought me down to the market I felt sure I +should know the boy again if I saw him. That's +him, the one looking down into the basket. But he +knew me again, for I saw him look surprised when +he noticed me."</p> + +<p>The gentleman made his way through the women +to George.</p> + +<p>"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket +to my daughter three evenings ago?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked +up. "I was standing close by when the boy took it, +so I gave chase and brought it back, and that's all."</p> + +<p>"You were off again in such a hurry that we +hadn't time to thank you. Just come across to my +daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for +a minute?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George +said, and looking rather shamefaced he followed the +gentleman to the sidewalk.</p> + +<p>"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie."</p> + +<p>"I was sure I should know him again," the child +said, "though I only saw him for a moment. We +are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and me, because +it had been mamma's locket, and we should +have been very sorry to have lost it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[Pg 42]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I am glad I was able to get it back for you," +George said; "but I don't want to be thanked for +doing it; and I don't want to be paid either, thank +you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his +hand into his pocket.</p> + +<p>"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise. +"You have done me a great service, and +there is no reason why I should not pay you for it. +If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to +get it back."</p> + +<p>"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all +the same I would rather not be paid for a little thing +like that."</p> + +<p>"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said +again. "One does not expect to find a boy in the +market here refusing money when he has earned it."</p> + +<p>"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George +said; "but I don't call getting back a locket for a +young lady who has lost it earning money."</p> + +<p>"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a +boy who has been brought up in the market here."</p> + +<p>"I have only been here three months," George +said. "I came up to London to look for work, but +could not get any. Most days I go about looking +for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's +a chance."</p> + +<p>"What sort of work do you want? Have you +been accustomed to any work? Perhaps I could +help you."</p> + +<p>"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[Pg 43]</a></span> +answered; "but I didn't like it, and I thought I +would rather get some sort of work that I could +work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking +in a shop."</p> + +<p>"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman +asked.</p> + +<p>"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an +infirmary, and so as I was alone I thought I would +come to London and try to get the sort of work I +liked; but I have tried almost all over London."</p> + +<p>"And are you all alone here?"</p> + +<p>"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in +that boy there, and we have worked together since I +came up."</p> + +<p>"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it +you."</p> + +<p>"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently.</p> + +<p>"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some +works down at Limehouse and employ a good many +boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card +from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of +it, and handed it to George.</p> + +<p>"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he +will arrange for you to begin work on Monday. +Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the fruit for +to-morrow, you know."</p> + +<p>So saying he took his daughter's hand, and +George, wild with delight, ran off to tell Bill that he +had obtained work for them both.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[Pg 44]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa; +didn't he look pleased? Wasn't it funny his saying +he wouldn't have any money?"</p> + +<p>"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal +in Covent Garden; but you were right, child, +and you are a better judge of character than I gave +you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad, +and spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is +really a very good style of boy. Of course he is +shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an +errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better +brought up than the generality of such lads. +The one he called his friend looked a wild sort of +specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I +should say he was one of the regular arabs hanging +about this place. If so, I expect a very few days' +work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be surprised +if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it."</p> + +<p>The next morning the two boys presented themselves +at Mr. Penrose's works at Limehouse. These +were sawing and planing works, and the sound of +many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws +innumerable, came out through the open windows +of the building as they entered the yard.</p> + +<p>"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said +as he appeared at one of the doors.</p> + +<p>"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I +have a card for him from Mr. Penrose."</p> + +<p>"I will let him know," the man replied.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[Pg 45]</a></span></p> + +<p>Two minutes later the foreman came out, and +George handed him the card. He read what Mr. +Penrose had written upon it and said:</p> + +<p>"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay, +eight shillings a week; seven o'clock; there, that will +do. Oh, what are your names?" taking out a +pocket-book. "George Andrews and William +Smith;" and then, with a nod, he went back into his +room, while the boys, almost bewildered at the +rapidity with which the business had been arranged, +went out into the street again.</p> + +<p>"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in +delight.</p> + +<p>"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more +doubtful tone; "it's a rum start, aint it? I don't +expect I shall make much hand of it, but I am wery +glad for you, George."</p> + +<p>"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it? +You are as strong as I am."</p> + +<p>"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed +to work regular, and I expect I shan't like it—not +at first; but I am going to try. George, don't +yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort; +still I expects I shall get the sack afore long."</p> + +<p>"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once +get accustomed to it, and it's a thousand times better +having to draw your pay regularly at the end of the +week than to get up in the morning not knowing +whether you are going to have breakfast or not. +Won't mother be pleased when I write and tell her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[Pg 46]</a></span> +I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said +that she was a great deal better, and the doctor +thought she would be out in the spring, and then I +hope she will be coming up here, and that will be +jolly."</p> + +<p>"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it +is; you and I will get on fust-rate, but it aint likely +as your mother would put up with a chap like me."</p> + +<p>"My mother knows that you have been a good +friend to me, Bill, and that will be quite enough +for her. You wait till you see her."</p> + +<p>"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about +here!" Bill said, "just all the same pattern; and +how wide the streets is to what they is up Drury +Lane!"</p> + +<p>"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a +room here, Bill, now that we shall have money to +pay for it; only think, we shall have sixteen shillings +a week between us!"</p> + +<p>"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen +bob! My eye, there aint no saying what it +will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more respectable," +he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies +of his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden; +but to go to work with a lot of other chaps, these +togs aint what you may call spicy."</p> + +<p>"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with +a laugh. "We must see what we can manage."</p> + +<p>George's own clothes were worn and old, but they +looked respectable indeed by the side of those of his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[Pg 47]</a></span> +companion. Bill's elbows were both out, the jacket +was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his +trousers were far too large for him, and were kept +up by a single brace, and were patched in a dozen +places.</p> + +<p>When George first met him he was shoeless, but +soon after they had set up housekeeping together +George had bought from a cobbler's stall a pair of +boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost +falling to pieces, were still the best part of +Bill's outfit.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[Pg 48]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_III" id="CHAPTER_III"></a>CHAPTER III.</h2> + +<h3>WORK.</h3> + + +<p>The next morning George went out with the +bundle containing his Sunday clothes, which had +been untouched since his arrival in town, and going +to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit +of working clothes in fair condition, and then returning +hid his bundle in the hay and rejoined Bill, +who had from early morning been at work shelling +walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised +at his companion not beginning work at the usual +time he asked no questions, for his faith in George +was so unbounded that everything he did was right +in his eyes.</p> + +<p>"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill," +George said as they reached their loft that evening.</p> + +<p>"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no +doubt; but I expects it aint mine by a long way. I +have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and I don't +think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint +fit to go to such a place, and they are sure to make +it hot for me."</p> + +<p>"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish +sort of boys in works of that sort, and you will soon +be at home with the rest."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[Pg 49]</a></span></p> + +<p>"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the +interruption, "I shall be getting into some blooming +row or other afore I have been there a week, and +they will like enough turn you out as well as me. +That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If +they chucks me the chances are as they chucks you +too; and if they did that arter all the pains you have +had to get a place I should go straight off and make +a hole in the water. That's how I looks at it."</p> + +<p>"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance +of your getting into a row. Of course at first we +must both expect to be blown up sometimes, but if +we do our best and don't answer back again we shall +do as well as the others."</p> + +<p>"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I +am pretty well used to getting blown up. Every +one's always at it, and I know well enough as it +don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a +market-cart between you and a clear road for a bolt. +I wasn't born yesterday. Yer've been wery good to +me, you have, George, and before any harm should +come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself +under a market-wagon."</p> + +<p>"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say, +you have been a far greater help to me than I have +to you. Anyhow we are not going to part now. +You are coming to work with me to start with, and +I know you will do your best to keep your place. +If you fail, well, so much the worse, it can't be +helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Pen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[Pg 50]</a></span>rose +I feel quite sure that the foreman would not +turn me off even if he had to get rid of you."</p> + +<p>"D'yer think so?"</p> + +<p>"I do, indeed, Bill."</p> + +<p>"Will yer take yer davey?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will +take my davey that I do not think that they would +turn me off even if they sent you away."</p> + +<p>"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help +yer?"</p> + +<p>"Really and truly, Bill."</p> + +<p>"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer, +it's 'cause yer wishes me."</p> + +<p>So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and +George soon heard by his regular breathing that he +was sound asleep.</p> + +<p>The next morning, before anyone was stirring, +they went down into the yard, as was their custom +on Sunday mornings, for a good wash, stripping to +the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each +other. Bill had at first protested against the +fashion, saying as he did very well and did not see +no use in it; but seeing that George really enjoyed it +he followed his example. After a morning or two, +indeed, and with the aid of a piece of soap which +George had bought, Bill got himself so bright and +shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and remark +from his former companions, which led to +more than one pugilistic encounter.</p> + +<p>That morning George remained behind in the loft<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[Pg 51]</a></span> +for a minute or two after Bill had run down, attired +only in his trousers. When Bill went up the ladder +after his ablutions he began hunting about in the +hay.</p> + +<p>"What are you up to, Bill?"</p> + +<p>"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of +yourn knocking about, but I can't see where's mine, +nor my jacket neither."</p> + +<p>"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find +them, and even if you found them you couldn't put +'em on. I have torn them up."</p> + +<p>"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation. +"What lark are yer up to now, George?"</p> + +<p>"No lark at all. We are going together to work +to-morrow, and you could not go as you were; so +you put on that shirt and those things," and he +threw over the clothes he had procured the day +before.</p> + +<p>Bill looked in astonishment.</p> + +<p>"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows +yer only had four bob with what we got yesterday. +Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't—no, in course +yer didn't—nip 'em."</p> + +<p>"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said, +laughing. "I swapped my Sunday clothes for them +yesterday. I can do without them very well till we +earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say +anything about it, Bill, else I will punch your +head."</p> + +<p>Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[Pg 52]</a></span> +and then threw himself down in the hay and burst +into tears.</p> + +<p>"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed. +"What have you to cry about?"</p> + +<p>"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed, +"to find a chap doing things for him like that? I +wish I may die if I don't feel as if I should bust. +It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one +side; that's the wust of it."</p> + +<p>"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill; +so don't let's say anything more about it, but put +on your clothes. We will have a cup of coffee each +and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will +go for a walk into the park, the same as we did last +Sunday, and hear the preaching."</p> + +<p>The next morning they were up at their accustomed +hour and arrived at the works at Limehouse +before the doors were opened. Presently some men +and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the +two boys followed the others in.</p> + +<p>"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate +asked.</p> + +<p>George gave their names, and the man looked at +his time-book.</p> + +<p>"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You +are to go into that planing-shop," and he pointed to +one of the doors opening into the yard.</p> + +<p>The boys were not long before they were at work. +Bill was ordered to take planks from a large pile +and to hand them to a man, who passed them under<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[Pg 53]</a></span> +one of the planing-machines. George was told to +take them away as fast as they were finished and +pile them against a wall. When the machines +stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were +to sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags, +in which they were carried to the engine-house.</p> + +<p>For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the +whirl of the machinery, the rapid motion of the +numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of the +broad bands which carried the power from them to +the machinery on the floor, by the storm of shavings +which flew from the cutters, and the unceasing +activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving +an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone—for +conversation in an ordinary voice would have +been inaudible—nothing occurred till the bell rang +at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery +suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded +the din which had prevailed.</p> + +<p>"How long have we got now?" George asked the +man from whose bench he had been taking the +planks.</p> + +<p>"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried +away.</p> + +<p>"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George +asked when they had got outside.</p> + +<p>"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill +replied. "Why, talk about the Garden! Lor', +why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what I +was a-doing at first."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[Pg 54]</a></span></p> + +<p>"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you +do and not touch any of those straps and wheels and +things. I know when I was at Croydon there was a +man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the +strap; they said it drew him up and smashed him +against the ceiling. And now we had better look +out for a baker's."</p> + +<p>"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere +handy?"</p> + +<p>"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we +have no time to spare to look for one. There's a +pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of water +as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem +very hard, Bill," George said as they ate their +bread.</p> + +<p>"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't +for all them rattling wheels. But I expect it aint +going to be like that regular. They've just gived +us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be +worse presently."</p> + +<p>"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill, +and I don't think we shall find the work any harder. +They don't put boys at hard work, but just jobs like +we are doing, to help the men."</p> + +<p>"What shall we do about night, George?"</p> + +<p>"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the +man we work for. He looks a good-natured sort +of chap. He may know of someone he could +recommend us to."</p> + +<p>They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[Pg 55]</a></span> +they came out George said to the man with whom +they were working:</p> + +<p>"We want to get a room. We have been lodging +together in London, and don't know anyone +down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of +some quiet, respectable people who have a room to +let?"</p> + +<p>The man looked at George more closely than he +had hitherto done.</p> + +<p>"Well, there aint many people as would care +about taking in two boys, but you seem a well-spoken +young chap and different to most of 'em. Do you +think you could keep regular hours, and not come +clattering in and out fifty times in the evening, and +playing tom-fools' tricks of all sorts?"</p> + +<p>"I don't think we should be troublesome," +George said; "and I am quite sure we shouldn't be +noisy."</p> + +<p>"You would want to be cooked for, in course?"</p> + +<p>"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond +hot water for a cup of tea in the evening, we should +not want much cooking done, especially if there is +a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in +the morning."</p> + +<p>"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?"</p> + +<p>George looked puzzled.</p> + +<p>"I mean bed and chairs, and so on."</p> + +<p>George shook his head.</p> + +<p>"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't +any now."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[Pg 56]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows. +I have got a bedroom in my place empty. A brother +of mine who lodged and worked with me has just +got a job as foreman down in the country. At any +rate I will try you for a week, and if at the end of +that time you and my missis don't get on together +you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that +will about suit you?"</p> + +<p>George said that would suit very well, and expressed +his thanks to the man for taking them in.</p> + +<p>They had been walking briskly since they left the +works, and now stopped suddenly before the door of +a house in a row. It was just like its neighbor, except +that George noticed that the blinds and windows +were cleaner than the others, and that the door +had been newly painted and varnished.</p> + +<p>"Here we are," the man said. "You had best +come in and see the missis and the room. Missis!" +he shouted, and a woman appeared from the backroom. +"I have let Harry's room, mother," he said, +"and these are the new lodgers."</p> + +<p>"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't +mean to say that you let the room to them two boys. +I should have thought you had better sense. Why, +they will be trampling up and down the stairs like +young hosses, wear out the oil cloth, and frighten +the baby into fits. I never did hear such a +thing!"</p> + +<p>"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't +give much trouble. At any rate I have agreed to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[Pg 57]</a></span> +try them for a week, and if you don't get on with +them at the end of that time, of course they must +go. They have only come to work at the shop to-day; +they work with me, and as far as I can see they +are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads, +I will show you your room."</p> + +<p>It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the +house, over the kitchen, which was built out there. +It was a comfortable little room, not large, but sufficiently +so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest +of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a +strip of carpet ran alongside the bed, and there was, +moreover, a small fireplace.</p> + +<p>"Will that do for you?" the man asked.</p> + +<p>"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;" +while Bill was so taken aback by its comfort and +luxury that he was speechless.</p> + +<p>"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If +you have got any things you can bring 'em in when +you like."</p> + +<p>"We have not got any to speak of," George said, +flushing a little. "I came up from the country +three months ago to look for work, and beyond odd +jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything +I had is pretty well gone; but I can pay a +week's rent in advance," he said, putting his hand +in his pocket.</p> + +<p>"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as +you work in the shop it's safe enough. Now I must +get my dinner, else I shall be late for work."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[Pg 58]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George +asked as they left the house.</p> + +<p>"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it +nice just! Why, yer couldn't get a room like that, +not furnished, anywhere near the market, not at +four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if +the house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down +every day! What a woman that must be for washing!"</p> + +<p>"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and +make as little mess as we can in going in and out."</p> + +<p>"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to +me as if it could be true as we're to have such a room +as that to ourselves, and to walk into a house bold +without being afraid as somebody would have his +eye on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week +for grub regular."</p> + +<p>"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill; +pretty near half our time must be gone, and mind +we must be very saving at first. There will be several +things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot, +and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a +gridiron for frying rashers of bacon upon."</p> + +<p>"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in.</p> + +<p>"And we shall want some towels," George went +on with his enumeration.</p> + +<p>"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they +like?"</p> + +<p>"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face +after you have washed."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[Pg 59]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of +course we must get 'em; but I've always found my +hands dried quick enough by themselves, especially +if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers."</p> + +<p>"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I +want to save every penny we can, so as to get some +things to furnish two rooms by the time mother +comes out."</p> + +<p>"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly, +though a slight shade passed over his face at the +thought that they were not to be always alone together. +"Well, yer know, George, I am game for +anythink. I can hold on with a penn'orth of bread +a day. I have done it over and over, and if yer says +the word I am ready to do it again."</p> + +<p>"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed. +"Still, we must live as cheap as we can. We will +stick to bread for breakfast, and bread and cheese +for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a +rasher as a great treat. At any rate we will try to +live on six shillings a week."</p> + +<p>"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently; +"and then two shillings for rent, and that will leave +us eight shillings a week to put by."</p> + +<p>"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she +would be able to come out 'til the spring. We are +just at the beginning of November, so if she comes +out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two +weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings, +let me see. That's eight pounds in twenty weeks,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[Pg 60]</a></span> +eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would furnish +two rooms very well, I should think."</p> + +<p>"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for +to his mind eight pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of +sum, and the fact that his companion had +been able to calculate it increased if possible his admiration +for him.</p> + +<p>It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs. +Grimstone to her new lodgers.</p> + +<p>"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of +the week to a neighbor, "as two boys could have +been that quiet. They comes in after work as regular +as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat, +and you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't +hear no more of 'em till they goes out agin in the +morning. They don't come back here to breakfast +or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing +like."</p> + +<p>"But what do they do with themselves all the +evening, Mrs. Grimstone?"</p> + +<p>"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can +hear a voice going regular over the kitchen."</p> + +<p>"And how's their room?"</p> + +<p>"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't +lock the door when they goes out, and I looked in +yesterday, expecting to find it like a pigsty; but +they had made the bed afore starting for work, and +set everything in its place, and laid the fire like for +when they come back."</p> + +<p>Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[Pg 61]</a></span> +six pence in as many old books at a bookstall. One +of them was a spelling-book, and he had at once set +to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first +protested. "He had done very well without reading, +and didn't see much good in it." However, as +George insisted he gave way, as he would have done +to any proposition whatever upon which his friend +had set his mind. So for an hour every evening +after they had finished tea Bill worked at his letters +and spelling, and then George read aloud to him +from one of the other books.</p> + +<p>"You must get on as fast as you can this winter, +Bill," he said; "because when the summer evenings +come we shall want to go for long walks."</p> + +<p>They found that they did very well upon the sum +they agreed on. Tea and sugar cost less than +George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in for +them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for +tea they were generally able to afford a bloater between +them, or a very thin rasher of bacon. Their +enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed +frequently protested that they were spending too +much money; but George said as long as they kept +within the sum agreed upon, and paid their rent, +coal, candles, and what little washing they required +out of the eight shillings a week, they were doing +very well.</p> + +<p>They had by this time got accustomed to the din +of the machinery, and were able to work in comfort. +Mr. Penrose had several times come through the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[Pg 62]</a></span> +room, and had given them a nod. After they had +been there a month he spoke to Grimstone.</p> + +<p>"How do those boys do their work?"</p> + +<p>"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys +we have ever had. No skylarking about, and I +never have to wait a minute for a plank. They +generally comes in a few minutes before time and +gets the bench cleared up. They are first-rate boys. +They lodge with me, and two quieter and better-behaved +chaps in a house there never was."</p> + +<p>"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am +interested in them, and am pleased to hear so good +an account."</p> + +<p>That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went +to get their money they received ten shillings apiece.</p> + +<p>"That's two shillings too much," George said as +the money was handed to them.</p> + +<p>"That's all right," the foreman said. "The +governor ordered you both to have a rise."</p> + +<p>"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What +do you think of that, George? Four bob a week +more to put by regularly. How much more will +that make by the time your mother comes?"</p> + +<p>"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other +will be enough. This four shillings a week we will +put aside at present for clothes. We want two more +shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall +want some shoes before long, and another suit of +clothes each. We must keep ourselves decent, you +know."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[Pg 63]</a></span></p> + +<p>From the time when they began work the boys +had gone regularly every Sunday morning to a small +iron church near their lodging, and they also went +to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too, +at home was often on religion, for Bill was extremely +anxious to learn, and although his questions +and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he +was always ready to explain things as far as he +could.</p> + +<p>February came, and to George's delight he heard, +from his mother that she was so much better that +the doctor thought that when she came out at the +end of April she would be as strong as she had ever +been. Her eyes had benefited greatly by her long +rest, and she said that she was sure she should be +able to do work as before. She had written several +times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing +her great pleasure at hearing that George was so +well and comfortable. At Christmas, the works +being closed for four days, George had gone down +to see her, and they had a delightful talk together. +Christmas had indeed been a memorable occasion to +the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had left a +basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews." +The boys had prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting +of some fine rashers of bacon and sixpenny-worth +of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and +had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs. +Grimstone had that afternoon invited them to dine +downstairs. George was reading from a book<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[Pg 64]</a></span> +which he bought for a penny that morning when +there was a knock at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone +said:</p> + +<p>"Here is a hamper for you, George."</p> + +<p>"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment, +opening the door. "Why, whoever could +have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake."</p> + +<p>"That's your name on the direction, anyhows," +Mrs. Grimstone said.</p> + +<p>"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George +agreed, and at once began to unknot the string +which fastened down the lid.</p> + +<p>"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he +shouted. He turned it over. On the back were the +words:</p> + +<p>"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose."</p> + +<p>"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a +husky voice; and indeed it was the kindness that +prompted the gift rather than the gift itself that +touched him.</p> + +<p>"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never +mind that there card, let's see what's inside."</p> + +<p>The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain +a cold goose, a Christmas pudding, and some +oranges and apples. These were all placed on the +table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill +executed a war-dance in triumph and delight.</p> + +<p>"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as +he sat down exhausted. "There's a Christmas din<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[Pg 65]</a></span>ner +for yer! Why, it's like them stories of the genii +you was a-telling me about—chaps as come whenever +yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought +a tuck-out or whatever yer asked for. Of course +that wasn't true; yer told me it wasn't, and I +shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere +is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was +right and what I said was wrong. I thought yer +were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take nothing for getting +back that there locket, and now yer see what's +come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas +dinner fit for a king. Now what are we going to +do with it, 'cause yer know we dines with them +downstairs to-morrow?"</p> + +<p>"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered, +"will be to invite all of them downstairs, +Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three young uns, +to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after, +because I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but +say the evening after."</p> + +<p>"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking +round the room.</p> + +<p>"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I +dare say they will let us have the feed in their parlor. +There will be nothing to get, you know, but some +bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs. +Grimstone don't take it, so we must have plenty of +tea."</p> + +<p>"I should like some beer too, just for once, +George, with such a blow-out as that."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[Pg 66]</a></span></p> + +<p>"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You +know we agreed that we wouldn't take beer. If we +begin it once we shall want it again, so we are not +going to alter from what we agreed to. We see +plenty of the misery which drink causes all round +and the way in which money is wasted over it. I +like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I +get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with +my dinner regularly, though I won't do even that if +I find it makes me want to take more; but anyhow at +present we can do without it."</p> + +<p>Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and +the supper two nights afterwards came off in due +course, and were both most successful.</p> + +<p>The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter +of some trouble to George, but he had finally +bought a pretty New Year's card and had written +on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George +Andrews," and had sent it to the daughter of his +employer.</p> + +<p>At the beginning of April George had consulted +Grimstone and his wife as to the question of preparing +a home for his mother.</p> + +<p>"How much would two rooms cost?" he had +asked; "one a good-sized one and the other the same +size as ours."</p> + +<p>"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs. +Grimstone replied.</p> + +<p>"And supposing we had a parlor and two little +bedrooms?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[Pg 67]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say," +Mrs. Grimstone replied.</p> + +<p>"And how much for a whole house?"</p> + +<p>"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings +a week, but you might get one without the +kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six shillings."</p> + +<p>"That would be much the nicest," George said, +"only it would cost such a lot to furnish it."</p> + +<p>"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs. +Grimstone suggested. "Just a kitchen and two +bedrooms for a start, and you can put things into +the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when +we first married. But you must have some furniture."</p> + +<p>"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and +two bedrooms?"</p> + +<p>"Of course going cheaply to work and buying +the things secondhand, I should say I could pick up +the things for you, so that you could do very well," +Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds."</p> + +<p>"That will do capitally," George said, "for by +the end of this month Bill and I will have more than +ten pounds laid by."</p> + +<p>"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed +in astonishment. "Do you mean to say +you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife +put in.</p> + +<p>"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[Pg 68]</a></span></p> + +<p>"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I +am sure Bill is a stone heavier than when he came +here."</p> + +<p>"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit," +Bob Grimstone said. "It isn't every boy, by a long +way, would stint himself as you must have done for +the last five months to make a comfortable home for +his mother, for I know lots of men who are earning +their two quid a week and has their old people in +the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that if I or +the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a +house we shall be right down glad."</p> + +<p>"Thank you," George said. "We will look +about for a house, and when we have fixed on one +if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for +us I shall be much obliged, for I don't think +landlords would be inclined to let a house to two +boys."</p> + +<p>"All right, George! we will do that for you with +pleasure. Besides, you know, there are things, +when you are going to take a house, that you stand +out for; such as papering and painting, or putting +in a new range, and things of that sort."</p> + +<p>After their dinner on the following Sunday the +two boys set out house-hunting.</p> + +<p>"If it's within a mile that will do," George said. +"It doesn't matter about our going home in the +breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a basket +and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do; +but if it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[Pg 69]</a></span> +there and back for dinner. Still there are plenty of +houses in a mile."</p> + +<p>There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular +rows, bare and hard-looking, but George wanted +to find something more pleasant and homelike than +these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he +wanted. It was just about a mile from the works +and beyond the lines of regular streets. Here he +found a turning off the main road with but eight +houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the +man who built them had intended to run a street +down for some distance, but had either been unable +to obtain enough ground or had changed his mind.</p> + +<p>They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front, +with a bow-window and little portico. They appeared +to be inhabited by a different class to those +who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the +gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and +spotless, muslin curtains hung in the windows, and +fancy tables with pretty ornaments stood between +them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the +left-hand side, was to let.</p> + +<p>"What do you think of this, Bill?"</p> + +<p>"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the +rent, George? I should think they were awful +dear."</p> + +<p>"I don't suppose they are any more than the +houses in the rows, Bill. They are very small, you +see, and I don't suppose they would suit workmen as +well as the others; at any rate we will see."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[Pg 70]</a></span></p> + +<p>Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of +paper the name of the agent of whom inquiry was to +be made.</p> + +<p>"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the +street? Oh, there it is. Laburnum Villas. No. +8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate, doesn't +it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the +agent to-morrow."</p> + +<p>This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she +was asked. After speaking to her husband she said, +"I will get the key from the agent's and will be there +just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there +straight when you get out you will be able to see the +rooms and what state it's in."</p> + +<p>"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked.</p> + +<p>"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will +set it out for him before I start."</p> + +<p>"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you +very much. It would be just the thing."</p> + +<p>Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the +following day the two boys arrived breathless at No. +8 Laburnum Villas.</p> + +<p>"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs. +Grimstone at the window."</p> + +<p>The door was opened and they rushed in.</p> + +<p>"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said; +"and it's in good order and won't want any money +laying out upon it."</p> + +<p>The house was certainly small, but the boys were +delighted with it. On the ground-floor were two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[Pg 71]</a></span> +little rooms opening with folding doors, and a little +kitchen built out behind. There was a room over +this, and two rooms above the sitting rooms.</p> + +<p>"That's just the right number," George said, "a +bedroom each for us; it couldn't be nicer; and what +pretty paper!"</p> + +<p>"And there is a good long slip of garden behind," +Mrs. Grimstone said, "where you could grow lots +of vegetables. Of course in the front you would +have flowers."</p> + +<p>"And how much do they want for it?"</p> + +<p>"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and +taxes. I call it dear for its size, but then of course +it's got the garden and it looks pretty and nice. +The agent says it's been painted and papered from +top to bottom since the last people left, but he says +the owner won't let it unless somebody comes who +is likely to stop, and he will want references of respectability."</p> + +<p>"All right!" George said; "I can manage that," +for he had already been thinking of the question in +his mind; "and we can manage seven and sixpence +a week; can't we, Bill?"</p> + +<p>"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he +was as much pleased with the cottage as George +was.</p> + +<p>They explored the garden behind the house. +This was about a hundred feet long by twenty-five +wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a +plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[Pg 72]</a></span> +had evidently been dug up by the last tenants ready +for planting.</p> + +<p>"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow +all our own potatoes here!" George exclaimed in +delight.</p> + +<p>Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head.</p> + +<p>"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if +you gave it all up to potatoes; but if you planted the +further end with potatoes you might get a good +many, and then, you know, at this end you might +have three or four rows of peas and French beans, +and lettuces and such like, but you will have to get +some manure to put in. Things won't grow without +manure even in the country, and I am sure they +won't here; and then you know you can have flowers +in the front of the house. But it's time for you to +be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure +it's more than half an hour since you came in. I +will take the key back and tell them they shall have +an answer by Wednesday or Thursday."</p> + +<p>George did not think they could have been a quarter +of an hour; however, he and Bill started at a trot, +which they increased into a run at the top of their +speed when the first clock they saw pointed to seven +minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached +the works; it stopped when they were +within fifty yards, and the gate was just closing as +they rushed up.</p> + +<p>"Too late," the man said.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[Pg 73]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's +the first time we have ever been late, and we have +run a mile to be here in time!"</p> + +<p>"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the +gate a few inches to look through. "Ah, well I +will let you in this time, 'cause you are well-behaved +young chaps; but don't you run it so close another +time, else you will have to lose your hour."</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[Pg 74]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IV" id="CHAPTER_IV"></a>CHAPTER IV.</h2> + +<h3>HOME.</h3> + + +<p>That evening George wrote a letter to Dr. +Jeffries at Croydon, saying that he had taken a +little house for his mother to come to when she +came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said +that he would render her help if he could, would he +be good enough to write to the agent whose address +he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was +about taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person +of respectability.</p> + +<p>The following evening he received a letter from +the doctor saying that he had written to the agent, +and that he was glad indeed to hear that George +was getting on so well that he was able to provide +a home for his mother.</p> + +<p>On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone +handed George a key.</p> + +<p>"There you are, George. You are master of +the house now. The agent said the reference was +most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and sixpence +you gave me for a week's rent in advance, +and you can go in when you like. We shall be +sorry to lose you both, for I don't want two better +lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[Pg 75]</a></span> +been quiet and pleasant in the house; and to think +what a taking I was in that day as Bob brought +you here for the first time, to think as he had let +the room to two boys. But there, one never +knows, and I wouldn't have believed it as boys could +be so quiet in a house."</p> + +<p>"Now we must begin to see about furniture," +Bob Grimstone said. "The best plan, I think, +will be for you two to go round of an evening to +all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just +what you think will suit you. You put down the +prices stuck on them, and just what they are, and +then the missis can go in the morning and bargain +for them. She will get them five shillings in the +pound cheaper than you would. It's wonderful +how women do beat men down, to be sure. When +a man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves +it or takes it just as he likes, but a woman begins +by offering half the sum. Then the chap says no, +and she makes as if she was going away; he lets +her go a little way and then he hollers after her, +and comes down a goodish bit in the price. Then +she says she don't particularly want it and +shouldn't think of giving any such price as that. +Then he tries again, and so they gets on till they +hit on a figure as suits them both. You see that +little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just +three weeks buying that caddy. The chap wanted +seven and six for it, and she offered him half a +crown. He came down half a crown at the end of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[Pg 76]</a></span> +the first week, and at last she got it for three and +nine. Now, the first thing you have got to do is +to make out a list. First of all you have got to +put down the things as you must have, and then +the things you can do without, though you will +get them if you can afford it. Mother will help +you at that."</p> + +<p>So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with +paper and a pencil, and George was absolutely horrified +at the list of things which Mrs. Grimstone +declared were absolutely indispensable. However, +after much discussion, some few items were +marked as doubtful. When the list was finished +the two boys started on an exploring expedition, +and the next week all their evenings were fully occupied. +In ten days after they began the three +bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly furnished, +Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand +at bargaining, and making the ten pounds go farther +than George had believed possible. On the +Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to +inspect the house.</p> + +<p>"It's a very comfortable little place," he said, +"and that front bedroom with the chintz curtains +the missis made up is as nice a little room as you +want to see. As to the others they will do well +enough for you boys."</p> + +<p>The only articles of furniture in the sitting room +were two long muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone +had bought a bargain at a shop selling off;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[Pg 77]</a></span> +for it was agreed that this was necessary to give +the house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone +was so much pleased at what had been done +that he shared George's feeling of regret that one +of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished, +and on the walk home said:</p> + +<p>"Look here, George. I know you would like +to have the house nice for your mother. You +couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable +not under a five-pound note, not even with +the missis to market for you, but you might for +that. I have got a little money laid by in the +savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and +welcome, if you like to take it. I know it will be +just as safe with you as it will be there."</p> + +<p>"Thank you very much, Bob—thank you very +much, but I won't take it. In the first place, I +should like mother to know that the furniture is all +ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and +in the next place, I should find it hard at first to +pay back anything. I think we can just manage +on our money, but that will be all. I told you +mother does work, but she mayn't be able to get +any at first, so we can't reckon on that. When +she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to +buy the furniture."</p> + +<p>"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man +said after a pause. "You would have been welcome +to the money: but perhaps you are right not +to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[Pg 78]</a></span> +went into housekeeping, and it took a wonderful +trouble to pay off, and if there's illness or anything +of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I should +be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me, +but it would worry you."</p> + +<p>A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary, +and on Saturday George asked for a day +off to go down to fetch her. Every evening +through the week he and Bill had worked away at +digging up the garden. Fortunately there was +a moon, for it was dark by the time they came out +from the works. Bill was charged with the commission +to lay in the store of provisions for the +Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a capital +fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which +George calculated he would be back.</p> + +<p>Very delighted was George as in his best suit—for +he and Bill had two suits each now—he stepped +out of the train at Croydon and walked to the +workhouse. His mother had told him that she +would meet him at the gate at half-past two, and +punctually at the time he was there. A few minutes +later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as +he had seen her at Christmas, in the infirmary garb, +but in her own clothes. George gave a cry of delight +as he ran forward to meet her.</p> + +<p>"My darling mother! and you are looking quite +yourself again."</p> + +<p>"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a +long nine months, but the rest and quiet have done<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[Pg 79]</a></span> +wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind; +and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you +had got work that you liked helped me to get +strong again. And you are looking well too; and +your friend, I hope he is well?"</p> + +<p>"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about +you. He is glad you are coming because I am +glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up his +mind that you won't like him and you won't think +him a fit companion for me. I told him over and +over again that you are not that sort; but nothing +can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't +talk good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions; +but he is very much changed in that way +since I first knew him, and he tries very hard, and +don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he +is beginning to read easy words quite well; and +he is one of the best-hearted fellows in the +world."</p> + +<p>"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you, +that's enough for me," Mrs. Andrews said; "but +I have no doubt I shall soon like him for himself. +You could not like him as much as you do if there +were not something nice about him. And you +have succeeded in getting a room for me in the +house in which you lodge?" for George had never +mentioned a word in his letter about taking a +house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if he should see +his mother to say nothing to her about his application +to him.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[Pg 80]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied +briskly.</p> + +<p>"And you have got some new clothes since I +saw you last, George. You wanted them; yours +were getting rather shabby when I saw you at +Christmas."</p> + +<p>"Yes, mother, they were."</p> + +<p>"I suppose you had to part with your best suit +while you were so long out of work?"</p> + +<p>"That was it, mother; but you see I have been +able to get some more things. They are only +cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well +until I can afford better ones. I am not walking +too fast for you, am I? But we shall just catch +the train. Or look here, would you mind going +straight by yourself to the railway station? Then +you can walk slowly. I will go round and get your +box. I went into our old place as I came along, +and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs +for me as I came back."</p> + +<p>"No, I would rather go round with you, George. +I want to thank her for having kept it for me so +long. Even if we do miss the train it will not matter +much, as it will make no difference whether we +get in town an hour earlier or later."</p> + +<p>As George could not explain his special reason +for desiring to catch that train he was obliged to +agree, and they stopped a quarter of an hour at +their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon +their having a cup of tea which she had prepared<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[Pg 81]</a></span> +for them. However, when they reached the station +they found that a train was going shortly, and +when they reached town they were not so very +much later than George had calculated upon.</p> + +<p>They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews' +box was not heavy, it was too much for George to +carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews herself +was tired from her walk to the station from the +infirmary, having had no exercise for so long. +When they got into the neighborhood of Limehouse +George got outside to direct the cabman. +It was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up +at No. 8 Laburnum Villas.</p> + +<p>"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked +in surprise as George jumped down and opened the +door. "Why, you told me in one of your letters +it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place! +It is really here, George?"</p> + +<p>"It is here, mother; we moved the other day. +There is Bill at the door;" but Bill, having opened +the door, ran away out into the garden, and +George, having paid the cabman, carried his +mother's box in and entered the house with her.</p> + +<p>"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the +end."</p> + +<p>"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews +said as she entered it; "and tea all laid and ready! +What, have they lent you the room for this evening?"</p> + +<p>"My dear mother," George said, throwing his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[Pg 82]</a></span> +arms round her neck, "this is your kitchen and +your house, all there is of it, only the sitting room +isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you +know."</p> + +<p>"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy! +that is very nice; but can we afford it, George? It +seems too good to be true."</p> + +<p>"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear +little house, and will be splendid when we have got +it all furnished. Now come up and see the bedrooms. +This is Bill's, you know," and he opened +the door on the staircase, "and this is mine, and +this is yours."</p> + +<p>"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews +said: "but, my dear George, the rent of this house +and the hire of the furniture will surely be more +than we can afford to pay. I know what a good +manager you are, my boy, but I have such a horror +of getting into debt that it almost frightens +me."</p> + +<p>"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a +week, mother, with rates and taxes, and we can +afford that out of Bill's earnings and mine, even +if you did not do any work at all; and as to the +furniture, it is every bit paid for out of our savings +since we went to work."</p> + +<p>On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms +round George's neck and burst into tears of happiness. +She was not very strong, and the thought +of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[Pg 83]</a></span> +get a house together for her completely overpowered +her.</p> + +<p>"It seems impossible, George," she said when +she had recovered herself. "Why, you have only +been earning ten shillings a week each, and you +have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and +all sorts of things; it seems impossible."</p> + +<p>"It has not cost so much as you think, mother, +and Bill and I had both learned to live cheap in +Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs; you +have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be +ready."</p> + +<p>But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to +go out into the garden to fetch him.</p> + +<p>"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything. +She won't eat you, you know."</p> + +<p>"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will +think me an out-and-out sort of 'ottentot," which +word had turned up in a book the boys had been +reading on an evening previously.</p> + +<p>"Well, wait till she says so; come along."</p> + +<p>So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him +along, and brought him shamefaced and bashful +into the kitchen.</p> + +<p>"This is Bill, mother."</p> + +<p>"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said, +holding out her hand. "I have heard so much of +you from George that I seem to know you quite +well."</p> + +<p>Bill put his hand out shyly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[Pg 84]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs. +Andrews went on. "I shall never forget that you +were a friend to my boy when he was friendless in +London."</p> + +<p>"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said +eagerly; "don't you go for to think it. Why, just +look what George has done for me! There was I, +a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving, +and sure to get quadded sooner or later; and now +here I am living decent, and earning a good wage; +and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know +about things, and aint been ashamed of me, though +I am so different to what he is. I tell you, ma'am, +there aint no saying what a friend he's been to me, +and I aint done nothing for him as I can see."</p> + +<p>"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other +something," Mrs. Andrews said: "and I owe you +something as well as my son, for George tells me +that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own +that I owe this delightful surprise of finding a home +ready for me; and now," she went on, seeing how +confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you +two ought to make tea this evening, for you are the +hosts, and I am the guest. In future it will be my +turn."</p> + +<p>"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair; +Bill, you do the rashers, and I will pour the +water into the pot and then toast the muffins."</p> + +<p>Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as +they had hitherto attempted had generally fallen to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[Pg 85]</a></span> +his share, as he had a greater aptitude for the work +than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a +turn was soon upon the table.</p> + +<p>Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely, +and was pleased with the result of her observation. +Bill was indeed greatly improved in appearance +since he had first made George's acquaintance. +His cheeks had filled out, and his face had lost its +hardness of outline; the quick, restless, hunted expression +of his eyes had nearly died out, and he no +longer looked as if constantly on the watch to +dodge an expected cuff; his face had always had +a large share of that merriment and love of fun +which seem the common portion of the London +arabs, and seldom desert them under all their hardships; +but it was a happier and brighter spirit now, +and had altogether lost its reckless character. A +similar change is always observable among the +waifs picked up off the streets by the London +refuges after they have been a few months on board +a training ship.</p> + +<p>When all was ready the party sat down to their +meal. Mrs. Andrews undertook the pouring out +of the tea, saying that although she was a guest, +as the only lady present she should naturally preside. +George cut the bread, and Bill served the +bacon. The muffins were piled on a plate in the +front of the fire as a second course.</p> + +<p>It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the +three had ever sat down to. Mrs. Andrews was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[Pg 86]</a></span> +not only happy at finding so comfortable a home +prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of +pride and thankfulness at the evidence of the +love, steadiness, and self-sacrifice of her son. +George was delighted at having his mother with +him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment +at the home he had prepared for her. Bill +was delighted because George was so, and he was +moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews +less terrible than he had depicted her.</p> + +<p>After tea was cleared away they talked together +for a while, and then Bill—feeling with instinctive +delicacy that George and his mother would like to +talk together for a time—said he should take a turn +for an hour, and on getting outside the house executed +so wild a war-dance of satisfaction that it was +fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas would +have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle.</p> + +<p>"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews +said when she was alone with George. "I +was sure from what you told me that he must be +a good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been, +poor boy, I feared a little that he would scarcely +be a desirable companion in point of manners. Of +course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar; +but his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice, +considering all."</p> + +<p>"Look what an example he's had, mother," +George laughed; "but really he has taken great<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[Pg 87]</a></span> +pains ever since he knew that you were coming +home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything +he does which is not right, especially about +eating and that sort of thing. You see he had +never used a fork till we came down here, and he +made me show him directly how it should be held +and what to do with it. It has been quite funny to +me to see him watching me at meals, and doing +exactly the same."</p> + +<p>"And you have taught him to read, George?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, mother."</p> + +<p>"And something of better things, George?" she +asked.</p> + +<p>"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't +know anything when I met him; but he goes to +church with me now regularly, and says his prayers +every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it. +More, I think, than I ever did," he added honestly.</p> + +<p>"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you +have done him, George."</p> + +<p>"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When +you see a chap so very earnest for a thing you can't +help being earnest yourself; besides, you know, +mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had +not been accustomed to talk much of these matters +with his mother—"you see when one's down in +the world and hard up, and not quite sure about +the next meal, and without any friend, one seems +to think more of these things than one does when +one is jolly at school with other fellows."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[Pg 88]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know +why it should be so, for the more blessings one has +the more reason for love and gratitude to the giver. +However, dear, I think we have both reason to be +grateful now, have we not?"</p> + +<p>"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference +since we said good-by to each other last +summer! Now here you are strong and well +again, and we are together and don't mean to be +separated, and I have got a place I like and have +a good chance of getting on in, and we have got a +pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be +able to live a little like a lady again,—I mean as +you were accustomed to,—and everything is so +nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every reason +to be grateful!"</p> + +<p>"We have indeed, George, and I even more than +you, in the proofs you have given me that my son +is likely to turn out all that even I could wish him."</p> + +<p>Bill's hour was a very long one.</p> + +<p>"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to +get out of our way," Mrs. Andrews said when he +returned, "else I shall think that I am in your way. +It was kind of you to think of it the first evening, +and George and I are glad to have had a long talk +together, but in future I hope you won't do it. +You see there will be lots to do of an evening. +There will be your lessons and George's, for I hope +now that he's settled he will give up an hour or two +every evening to study. Not Latin and Greek,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[Pg 89]</a></span> +George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something +like dismay in George's face, "that will be +only a waste of time to you now, but a study of +such things as may be useful to you in your present +work and in your future life, and a steady course +of reading really good books by good authors. +Then perhaps when you have both done your work, +you will take it by turns to read out loud while I +do my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who +knows, if we get on very flourishingly, after we +have furnished our sitting room, we may be able +to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have +a little music of an evening."</p> + +<p>"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be +really like old times, when you used to sing to +me!"</p> + +<p>Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the +thought of the old times, but she kept them back +bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment, the +happiness of this first evening. So they chatted +till nine o'clock, when they had supper. After it +was over Mrs. Andrews left the room for a minute +and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned +with a Bible in her hand.</p> + +<p>"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this +first happy evening in our new home by thanking +God together for his blessings."</p> + +<p>"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and +Bill's face expressed his approval.</p> + +<p>So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[Pg 90]</a></span> +knelt and thanked God for his blessings, and the +custom thus begun was continued henceforth in +No. 8 Laburnum Villas.</p> + +<p>Hitherto George and his companion had found +things much more pleasant at the works than they +had expected. They had, of course, had principally +to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were +many other men in the shop, and at times, when +his bench was standing idle while some slight alterations +or adjustment of machinery were made, +they were set to work with others. Men are quick +to see when boys are doing their best, and, finding +the lads intent upon their work and given neither +to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp +word addressed to them. But after Mrs. Andrews +had come home they found themselves addressed +in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men. +Bob Grimstone had told two or three of his mates +of the sacrifices the boys had made to save up +money to make a home for the mother of one of +them when she came out of hospital. They were +not less impressed than he had been, and the story +went the round of the workshops and even came +to the ears of the foreman, and there was not a man +there but expressed himself in warm terms of surprise +and admiration that two lads should for six +months have stinted themselves of food in order +to lay by half their pay for such a purpose.</p> + +<p>"There's precious few would have done such a +thing," one of the older workmen said, "not one<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[Pg 91]</a></span> +in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred, +even when he's going to be married, will stint himself +like that to make a home for the gal he is going +to make his wife, so as to start housekeeping out +of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will +you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as +much for his mother as for the gal who is agoing to +be his wife, seeing how much he owes her; but how +many does it, that's what I says, how many does +it?"</p> + +<p>So after that the boys were surprised to find how +many of the men, when they met them at the gate, +would give them a kindly nod or a hearty, "Good-morning, +young chaps!"</p> + +<p>A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in +Laburnum Villas she went up to town and called +upon a number of shops, asking for work. As she +was able to give an excellent reference to the firm +for whom she had worked at Croydon she succeeded +before the end of the week in obtaining millinery +work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard, +and as she had excellent taste and was very quick +at her needle she was soon able to earn considerably +more than she had done at Croydon.</p> + +<p>The three were equally determined that they +would live as closely as possible until the sitting-rooms +were furnished, and by strict management +they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews' +earnings being devoted to the grand purpose. +The small articles were bought first, and each week<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[Pg 92]</a></span> +there was great congratulation and pleasure as +some new article was placed in the rooms. Then +there was a pause for some time, then came the +chairs, then after an interval a table, and lastly the +carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until +the end of July. After this they moved solemnly +into the sitting-room, agreeing that the +looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added +at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs. +Andrews' earnings need no longer be devoted.</p> + +<p>"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable +evening, "I want you in future, when you +come in, to change your working clothes before +you come in here to your teas. So long as we +lived in the kitchen I have let things go on, but I +think there's something in the old saying, 'Company +clothes, company manners,' and I think it is +good when boys come in that they should lay aside +their heavy-nailed shoes and their working clothes. +Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render +people clumsy in their movements, and the difference +of walk which you observe between men of +different classes arises very greatly from the clumsy, +heavy boots which workingmen must wear."</p> + +<p>"But what does it matter, mother?" George +urged, for it seemed to him that it would be rather +a trouble to change his clothes every day. "These +little things don't make any real difference to a +man."</p> + +<p>"Not any vital difference, George, but a real<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[Pg 93]</a></span> +difference for all that. Manners make the man, +you know! that is, they influence strangers and +people who only know him in connection with business. +If two men apply together for a place the +chances are strongly in favor of the man with the +best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think +the observance of little courtesies of this kind make +home pleasanter and brighter. You see I always +change my dress before tea, and I am sure you +prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat +with a fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place +in my working dress with odds and ends of threads +and litter clinging to it."</p> + +<p>"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you +mean now. Certainly I will change my things in +future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?"</p> + +<p>Bill would not have minded in the least any +amount of trouble by which he could give the +slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had +now a place in his affections closely approximating +to that which George occupied.</p> + +<p>During the summer months the programme for +the evening was not carried out as arranged, for at +the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared that +there must be a change.</p> + +<p>"The evenings are getting light enough now for +a walk after tea, boys, and you must therefore cut +short our reading and studies till the days close in +again in the autumn. It would do you good to +get out in the air a bit."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[Pg 94]</a></span></p> + +<p>"But will you come with us, mother?"</p> + +<p>"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get +longer we may make little excursions together: go +across the river to Greenwich and spend two or +three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go +up the river to Kew; but as a general thing you +had better take your rambles together. I have my +front garden to look after, the vegetables are your +work, you know, and if I like I can go out and do +whatever shopping I have to do while you two are +away."</p> + +<p>So the boys took to going out walks, which got +longer and longer as the evenings drew out, and +when they were not disposed for a long ramble they +would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and +watch the barges drifting down the river or tacking +backwards and forwards, if there was a wind, +with their great brown and yellow sails hauled +tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly +down the river, and the little busy tugs dragging +great ships after them. There was an endless +source of amusement in wondering from what ports +the various craft had come or what was their destination.</p> + +<p>"What seems most wonderful to me, George," +Bill said one day, "when one looks at them big +steamers——"</p> + +<p>"Those," George corrected.</p> + +<p>"Thank ye—at those big steamers, is to think +that they can be tossed about, and the sea go over<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[Pg 95]</a></span> +them, as one reads about, just the same way as the +wave they make when they goes down——"</p> + +<p>"Go down, Bill."</p> + +<p>"Thank ye—go down the river, tosses the little +boats about; it don't seem possible that water can +toss itself about so high as that, does it?"</p> + +<p>"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that +it is so because there are constantly wrecks; but +looking at the water it does not seem possible that +it should rise up into waves large enough to knock +one of those great steamers in pieces. Some day, +Bill, not this year, of course, because the house +isn't finished, but next year, I hope we shall be able +all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have +seen it stuck up you can go to Margate and back +for three or four shillings; and though Bob Grimstone +says that isn't regular sea, it would be enough +to show us something of what it's like."</p> + +<p>The garden occupied a good deal of the boys' +time. Bill's long experience in the market had +given him an interest in vegetables, and he was always +ready for an hour's work in the garden after +tea. The results of much labor and plenty of +manure were not unsatisfactory, and Mrs. Andrews +was delighted with her regular supply of fresh vegetables. +Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount +that could be grown in a limited space were by no +means fulfilled, and seeing the small amount which +could be daily gathered, and recalling the countless +piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[Pg 96]</a></span> +see in Covent Garden, he was continually expressing +his astonishment at the enormous quantity of +ground which must be employed in keeping up the +supply of the market.</p> + +<p>They did not that year get the trip to Margate; +but in the autumn, after the great work of furnishing +was finished, they did get several long +jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus, +once in a steamer up to Kew, and several times +across to Greenwich Park. Mrs. Andrews found +it a very happy summer, free from the wear of +anxiety, which, more even than the work, had +brought on her long illness. She grew stronger +and better than she had ever expected to be again, +and those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking +needlewoman of Croydon would not have +recognized her now; indeed, as George said sometimes, +his mother looked younger and younger every +day. She had married very young, and was still +scarcely five-and-thirty, and although she laughed +and said that George was a foolish boy when he said +that people always took her for his sister, she really +looked some years younger than she was. Her +step had regained its elasticity, and there was a ring +of gladness and happiness in her voice which was +very attractive, and even strangers sometimes +looked round as they passed the bright, pleasant-looking +woman chatting gayly with the two healthy, +good-looking young fellows.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[Pg 97]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_V" id="CHAPTER_V"></a>CHAPTER V.</h2> + +<h3>AN ADVENTURE.</h3> + + +<p>In August the annual outing, or, as it was called, +the bean-feast, at the works took place. Usually +the men went in vans down into Epping Forest; +but this year it was determined that a steamer +should be engaged to take the whole party with +their wives and families down to Gravesend. They +were to make an early start, and on arriving there +all were to do as they pleased until they assembled +to dine in a pavilion at one of the hotels. After +this they were to go to the gardens and amuse +themselves there until the steamer started in the +evening. The party embarked at Blackwell at ten +o'clock in the morning. George and Bill got together +up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted +with their voyage down, their only regret +being that Mrs. Andrews had declined to accompany +them, saying that she would far rather go +with them alone than with so large a party.</p> + +<p>"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when +they landed. "We are not to dine till two, so we +have two good hours before us. I vote we hire a +boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here +as up in that crowded river by London."</p> + +<p>This was said in reference to various short rows<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[Pg 98]</a></span> +which they had had in boats belonging to barges +which had been sometimes lent them for half an +hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as +they hung about the wharves.</p> + +<p>"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the +waterman, whom they hired the boat of, said.</p> + +<p>"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the +confidence of youth.</p> + +<p>"Mind the tide is running out strong," the +waterman said.</p> + +<p>"All right, we will mind," George answered, +scarce heeding his words; and getting out the oars +they pushed off.</p> + +<p>For some little time they rowed among the anchored +vessels, both being especially filled with delight +at the yachts moored opposite the clubhouses. +These were new craft to them, and the +beauty and neatness of everything struck them with +surprise and admiration. Tide had only turned a +short time before they got into their boat, and +while keeping near the shore they had no difficulty +in rowing against it.</p> + +<p>Presently they determined to have a look at a +fine East-Indiaman moored well out in the stream +a short distance below Gravesend. They ceased +rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on +their oars talking over the distant voyage on which +she was probably about to start, and the country +she might visit, George was telling his companion +the ports she would touch if her destination was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[Pg 99]</a></span> +China, and absorbed in their conversation they paid +no attention to anything else, until George gave a +sudden exclamation.</p> + +<p>"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so +far behind. It is two miles, I should think, from +the town. We must set to work or we shan't be +back in time for dinner."</p> + +<p>The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the +Thames was not sufficient to tell them that to row +against tide it is necessary to keep close inshore, +and turning the boat's head they set to work to +row back in the middle of the river. Their knowledge +of rowing was but slight, and the mere operation +of their oars took up all their attention. They +rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration +ran down their faces.</p> + +<p>After half an hour of this George looked round, +thinking that he ought to be near to the vessel by +this time. He uttered an exclamation of surprise +and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were +visible. Their puny efforts had availed nothing +against the sweeping tide. They had already, +without knowing it, swept round the turn in the +river, and were now entering Sea Reach.</p> + +<p>"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just +look at that buoy; we are going past it as fast as +a horse could trot. Look what a width the river +is. What on earth are we to do?"</p> + +<p>"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall +we go to if we go on like this?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[Pg 100]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Right out to sea, I should think," George said. +"I do not know how far it is; but the river seems +to get wider and wider in front."</p> + +<p>"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn +again and take us back."</p> + +<p>"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you +know, all the way down, and could only have +turned a little while before we got in the boat. +Look at that line of barges sailing down on the +right-hand side. I vote we pull to them and ask +the men what we had better do. Anyhow we could +row to the land and get out there and wait till tide +turns. It turned at about eleven, so that it will +turn again somewhere about five. The steamer is +not to start till eight, so we shall be back in plenty +of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and +the fun in the gardens, but that can't be helped."</p> + +<p>"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully; +"this is a regular venture, this is; but I say, shan't +we have to pay a lot for the boat?"</p> + +<p>"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps +the man will let us off cheap when he sees we +couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered sort +of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute +it is taking us further away."</p> + +<p>They set steadily to work. The boat was a large +and heavy one, and their progress was by no means +rapid.</p> + +<p>"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed +suddenly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[Pg 101]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye, +George, I can't see the barges!"</p> + +<p>Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily +creeping up the river. They were just at its edge +when they made the discovery. Another two +minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they +could not see ten yards away. They looked at +each other in silent bewilderment.</p> + +<p>"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at +length in awe-struck tones.</p> + +<p>"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no +use rowing, that I see, for we don't know which +way the boat's head is pointing."</p> + +<p>"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically. +"I am going to have a pipe. Oh, I say, +aint my hands blistered!"</p> + +<p>"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but +keep your oar in your hand to be ready to row."</p> + +<p>"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you +said it warn't no use rowing!"</p> + +<p>"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for +those big buoys. If the tide were to sweep us +against one of them we should capsize to a certainty. +That must have been a big steamer," he +went on, as the boat rolled suddenly. "It's lucky +we were pretty well over towards the side of the +river, before the fog came on. Listen—there's another. +I can hear the beat of her engines. I have +an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed suddenly. "We +know the steamers were passing to the left of us<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[Pg 102]</a></span> +when the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles +and the sound of their paddles, and then row +to the right, we shall get to the bank at last."</p> + +<p>"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying +down the pipe he had just lighted. "There's a +whistle over there."</p> + +<p>"Yes, and another the other way," George said, +puzzled. "Why, how can that be! Oh, I suppose +one is coming up the river and one down, +but it's awfully confusing."</p> + +<p>It was so, but by dint of listening intently the +boys gained some idea of the proper direction; but +they could only row a few strokes at a time, being +obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance.</p> + +<p>Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water, +and the upper spars of the steamers were above it, +and men placed there were able to direct those on +deck as to their course. Had it not been for this +the steamers must all have anchored. As it was +they proceeded slowly and cautiously on their way, +whistling freely to warn any small craft, that might +be hidden in the fog, of their coming.</p> + +<p>Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous +exclamation. The boat had quietly +grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could +not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it +was. Bill at once offered to get overboard and +reconnoiter, but George would not hear of it.</p> + +<p>"You might not be able to find your way back,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[Pg 103]</a></span> +Bill, or you might sink in the mud and not be able +to get out again. No, we won't separate; and, look +here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge +of the mud. If we were to get left here we should +not float again till tide comes up to us, and that +wouldn't be till about two hours before high tide, +and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock +at night."</p> + +<p>"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking +round at the wall of white vapor which surrounded +them. "It regular confuses a chap. I +say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at +present. I feel awfully hungry."</p> + +<p>"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall +be a good deal more hungry before we are done; +but I am so glad we have found the land and +stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being +hungry."</p> + +<p>"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are +we to find our way back to Gravesend?"</p> + +<p>"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to +the edge of the mud—just as close as the boat will +swim. That way, you know, we must come to +Gravesend at last."</p> + +<p>"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have +got a good head, George, you have. I should never +have thought about the way to find the bank if it +hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating +and floating till we was starved."</p> + +<p>"This fog can't last forever, Bill."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[Pg 104]</a></span></p> + +<p>"No, but I have known them last a week in +London."</p> + +<p>"Yes, but not in August, Bill."</p> + +<p>"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you +see these here fogs may last just as long down +here in August as they do in London in November."</p> + +<p>"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter +to us; we have got the land for a guide, and I +hope we shall be back in Gravesend before it's quite +dark."</p> + +<p>"But if we don't, George?"</p> + +<p>"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before +it gets too dark, and wait till it is morning. We +shall be all right if we keep quite cool and use our +senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind +a bit, except that mother will be getting anxious +about us. It's a regular adventure, and we shall +have something to talk about for a long time. Look +out, Bill, we must push her further off—she's getting +aground!"</p> + +<p>For an hour they sat and chatted.</p> + +<p>"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last. +"That's the rattle of a chain. I expect it's a barge +anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can hear +voices. I vote we hollo."</p> + +<p>George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The +shout was repeated not very far off, and was followed +by the shout of "Who are you?"</p> + +<p>"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[Pg 105]</a></span> +our way," George shouted back. "We will come +on board if you will let us."</p> + +<p>"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on +shouting and you row to my voice."</p> + +<p>It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close +at hand said sharply:</p> + +<p>"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain."</p> + +<p>Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw +that they were close to the bows of a barge. Half +a dozen more strokes and they were alongside. Bill +seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and +the boat was soon towing astern.</p> + +<p>"Well, young men, however did you manage to +get here?" one of the bargemen asked. "It's lucky +for you you weren't taken out to sea with the tide."</p> + +<p>George related the history of their voyage and +how they had managed to reach the shore.</p> + +<p>"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the +man said; "aint they, Jack? Most chaps your age +would just have sat in the boat and howled, and +a good many longshoremen too. You have done +the best thing you could under the circumstances."</p> + +<p>"Where are we?" George asked.</p> + +<p>"You are on board the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> topsail +barge, that's where you are, about three parts down +Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well even in a +fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the +Swashway with it as thick as this, so we brought +up."</p> + +<p>"Where is the Swashway?" George asked.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[Pg 106]</a></span></p> + +<p>"The Swashway is a channel where the barges +go when they are making for Sheerness. It's well +buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the help +of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs +are worse than anything. It aint no use groping +about for the buoy when you can't see ten yards +ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on +the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap +this fog will clear off before evening, and we shall +be able to work in; and now I expect you two young +uns would like some grub. Come below."</p> + +<p>The two boys joyfully followed into the little +cabin, and were soon satisfying their hunger on +bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug of +water from the breaker and placed it before them.</p> + +<p>"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would +give yer a cup of tea—that's our tipple; we don't +keep spirits on board the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>. I like a +drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge, +where you wants your senses handy at all times. +And now what are you thinking of doing?" he asked +when the boys had finished.</p> + +<p>"What we had made up our minds to do was to +lie where we were at the edge of the mud till tide +turned, and then to keep as close to the shore as we +could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer +we came by does not go back till late, and we +thought we should be back by that time."</p> + +<p>"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the +middle of the stream you would be back in two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[Pg 107]</a></span> +hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide don't +help you much there, and half your time you are in +eddies and back-currents. No, you wouldn't be +back in Gravesend by eight noway."</p> + +<p>"Then what would you advise us to do?"</p> + +<p>"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at +all. We will see how things are going after a bit. +Now let's take a look round."</p> + +<p>So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed +by the boys. The white fog still shut the +boat in like a curtain.</p> + +<p>"What do you think of it, Jack?"</p> + +<p>"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just +now there was a puff of air coming down the river. +I wish it would, or we shan't make Sheerness to-night, +much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure +enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like +enough in half an hour there will be a brisk wind +blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before it."</p> + +<p>Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples +swept across the oil-like face of the water.</p> + +<p>"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said. +"I'd bet a pot of beer as the fog will have lifted in +a quarter of an hour."</p> + +<p>Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind.</p> + +<p>The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand. +It was no longer a dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark +shadows seemed to flit across it, and sometimes the +view of the water extended here and there.</p> + +<p>"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[Pg 108]</a></span> +but ere George could turn round to look it was gone +again.</p> + +<p>"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now +I tell you what will be the best thing for you if the +wind holds, as I expect it will. We shall be at +Sheerness in little over an hour—that will make it +four o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and +the young flood will be coming up soon afterwards, +and I shall go up with the first of it to Rochester. +We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven +o'clock. Now the best thing I can do for you is to +tow that ere boat up to Rochester with me, and you +can get a train there that will take you up to town +in goodish time."</p> + +<p>"You are very kind," George said; "but what are +we to do about the boat?"</p> + +<p>"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more +likely next morning, and I will take her along and +hand her over to her rightful owner at Gravesend."</p> + +<p>"James Kitson."</p> + +<p>"Yes, I know him."</p> + +<p>"But how about paying for it?" George said. +"I am afraid he will expect a great deal of money, +for it has been away all the time, and we have only +got six shillings between us."</p> + +<p>"You will want that to get up to town. Never +mind about the boat. I will put that square for you. +I will tell Kitson as how you have been shipwrecked, +and he will think himself precious lucky in getting +the boat without being damaged. If I take the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[Pg 109]</a></span> +trouble to tow it up to Rochester and back, he +needn't grumble about getting no fare."</p> + +<p>"I would rather pay something," George said; +"though, you see, we can't afford to pay +much."</p> + +<p>"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for +five bob. I will tell him you are going to send him +that, and he will thank his stars he has got so well +out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he expects +you have by this time, and the boat didn't get +smashed by a steamer, you would likely enough have +been taken off by one of them; but the captain +wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub. +I looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so +don't you worry about him. There, the mist's driving +off fast. We will up with the kedge."</p> + +<p>The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the +anchor was soon hanging from the bow. Then the +brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great sail +shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few +minutes the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> was running before a +brisk wind down Sea Reach.</p> + +<p>The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear +astern, though a thick bank still hung over the river +ahead, but this was rapidly melting away; and the +bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins, +pointed out a large building low down on the water +ahead.</p> + +<p>"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can +lend Jack a hand to get up the topsail. The wind is<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[Pg 110]</a></span> +rising every minute, and we shall soon be bowling +along hand over hand."</p> + +<p>Both ahead and astern of them were a line of +barges, which had, like the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>, anchored +when the fog was thickest, and were, like her, +making their way to Sheerness. The wind was +blowing briskly now, and the barge made her way +through the water at a rate which surprised the boys.</p> + +<p>"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George +said.</p> + +<p>"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins +replied. "With a breeze so strong that they +can only just carry their topsails, they will hold their +own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are +mighty few yachts can keep alongside us when we +are doing our best."</p> + +<p>As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour +they brought up just inside the mouth of the Medway, +and dropped the anchor to wait till the tide +turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock +they were again under way. The wind had fortunately +veered round somewhat to the north of west, +and they were able for the most part to lay their +course, so that soon after seven they were abreast +of the dockyard, and a few minutes later dropped +anchor off Rochester.</p> + +<p>"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured +bargeman said; "I will put you ashore at once. +There is the station close to the end of the bridge."</p> + +<p>With many very hearty thanks for his kindness<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[Pg 111]</a></span> +the lads jumped ashore and hurried up to the station. +They found that there would be a train in half +an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in +town.</p> + +<p>Before they had landed the bargeman had +scrawled on a piece of paper, "Your boat was picked +up by the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>. Will bring her back on +return trip. No damage done. William Atkins." +This he had handed to the boys, and they now got +an envelope and directed it to "James Kitson, +Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set +out to walk home.</p> + +<p>"It's not been the sort of day we expected," +George said; "but it's been good fun, hasn't it?"</p> + +<p>"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so +when we were in the middle of that fog listening to +them whistles and trying to find out the way. I +didn't say much, George, but I felt downright +funky."</p> + +<p>"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a +horribly lonely feeling, lost in the fog there; but it +was all right as soon as we touched the mouth, and +got an idea where we were. I was worrying most +about mother getting anxious if we did not get back +to-night, and a little about what we should have to +pay for the boat. It was lucky that bargeman took +the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should +have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully +good fellow, wasn't he?"</p> + +<p>"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[Pg 112]</a></span> +was a good un, and no mistake. It aint cost us so +very much either, considering."</p> + +<p>"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece +railway fare, that's four and sixpence, and five bob +we are to send down for the boat, nine shillings and +sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings +for the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have +spent another shilling apiece in things at the gardens, +perhaps more; that would make four shillings +anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings +more than we calculated. And haven't we got a lot +to talk about! It's been a regular adventure."</p> + +<p>"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think +I want many more of them kind of adventures. +It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't jolly at +the time. I always thought as adventures was +jolly; but that didn't seem to me to have no jolliness +about it, not when we was out there. It's all very +well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with savages, +but I expect there aint no larks about it at the +time. I suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow, +and get it off your mind?"</p> + +<p>"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for +another three or four days. The man will have got +his boat back all right then, and the five bob would +come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell +Kitson that he had arranged with us that was what +we were to pay, as we couldn't afford more; but he +will never expect to get it, so when it comes he will +be only too glad to receive it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[Pg 113]</a></span></p> + +<p>They were met at the door of the house by Bob +Grimstone, who was just coming out.</p> + +<p>"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said +angrily. "I have been wondering all day what has +become of you, and the missis has done nothing but +worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day. +What have you been up to? I haven't seen you +since we got ashore at Gravesend, and I have just +come round to ask your mother if she has heard of +you."</p> + +<p>"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at +least it was not altogether our fault. We went for +a row, and the tide took us down, and then the fog +came on and we got lost."</p> + +<p>"I expected better of you," Grimstone said +angrily. "Foggy, indeed! I've been anxious and +worried all day. I did think as you warn't like +other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go +and play such a prank as this. Well, go in; your +mother is in a nice taking about you."</p> + +<p>"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I +am so sorry you have been uneasy about us, awfully +sorry; but really it hasn't been our fault altogether."</p> + +<p>"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews +said, throwing her arms round his neck. "Fortunately +I did not know anything about it till Mr. +Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been +expecting you in for some little time, but I supposed +the steamer was late, and I was not at all uneasy +till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[Pg 114]</a></span> +seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend, +and that you had not come back with the rest. +Is Bill with you?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to +Bob."</p> + +<p>"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs. +Andrews said. "He has been most kind, and he +had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first +train in the morning if you did not come home to-night, +and to make inquiries about you there. He +tried to cheer me up by saying that as you were together +nothing could very well happen to you and +that probably you had only got into some boyish +scrape—perhaps, he suggested, only gone out into +the country and had helped yourselves to some +apples, and had so got locked up."</p> + +<p>Bob, however, would not come in again, but went +off saying he would hear all about it in the morning, +but would go off to tell his wife at once that they +had returned safely, for "that she was in such a +worry as never was."</p> + +<p>Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat +since two o'clock, Mrs. Andrews at once laid the +table for supper; and when they had finished it +listened to George's account of their adventure.</p> + +<p>"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said +when they had finished. "You might have been +swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the +fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you +forget to thank God for his protection through the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[Pg 115]</a></span> +danger you have run; and I do hope, my dear boys, +that you will be more careful in future."</p> + +<p>The next evening, after work was over, George +went in to Bob Grimstone's and told them all that +had happened. When the story was told, Bob +agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault, +and that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified +his opinion of them. Mrs. Grimstone, however, +was not so easily pacified. They had come back, +she said; but it was more than likely that they +wouldn't have come back at all, but might have been +drifting out far at sea, perhaps cutting each other's +throats and eating each other alive, which was, as +the good woman said, what she had heard happened +when boats were lost at sea.</p> + +<p>Two days later they sent off the money to the +waterman, and received in reply a letter from him +saying that the boat had been brought safely back +by the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> and that he was glad to get +the five shillings.</p> + +<p>"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send +it; but knowing what boys is, I say fair as I didn't +expect to see the color of your money. It aint +everyone as would have paid up when they got safe +away, and I consider as you have behaved handsome."</p> + +<p>They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off +which the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> might generally be found +moored, between her cruises, and after one or two +ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[Pg 116]</a></span> +there when they rowed up to the spot. She had but +just returned from a trip to Rochester and Bill Atkins +was still on board. He was very glad to see +the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading +him to accept a pound of tobacco which their mother +had sent off to him with her compliments as a token +of gratitude for his kindness to them.</p> + +<p>"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of +the sort, but seeing as your mother has got it for +me it wouldn't be manners to say no. Well, look +here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down +to Rochester and back you're free of the <i>Sarah and +Jane</i>, and heartily glad shall I be to have you with +me."</p> + +<p>The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as +they were still at work there was but small chance +of their being able to accept it, but that they should +be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes +when he was in the Pool.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[Pg 117]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VI" id="CHAPTER_VI"></a>CHAPTER VI.</h2> + +<h3>FIRE!</h3> + + +<p>One Saturday evening early in October the boys +had been for a long walk down among the marshes. +They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be late, +and it was past eight o'clock when they came along +past the works.</p> + +<p>"We shan't get home at this hour again for some +time, I expect," George said, "for they say that we +are going to begin to work overtime on Monday, +and that the orders are so heavy that it will very +likely have to be kept up all through the winter."</p> + +<p>"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied; +"it would have been horrid if we had lost all our +walks while the weather was fine. How dark the +place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still +it is after the rattle we are accustomed to!"</p> + +<p>"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand +on his arm.</p> + +<p>"What is it, George?"</p> + +<p>"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment, +as if I saw the big stack clearly and then it was +dark again."</p> + +<p>"How could that be, George?"</p> + +<p>"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a re<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[Pg 118]</a></span>flection +of light from one of the windows at the +back there. There it is again."</p> + +<p>"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it +be?"</p> + +<p>"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back. +There might be—it's awful to think of—but there +might be a fire."</p> + +<p>The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of +the works onto a piece of waste ground behind.</p> + +<p>"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room. +There must be fire. Here, help to put this +bit of old timber against the wall."</p> + +<p>The piece of wood was placed into position, the +two lads climbed up it onto the wall, and dropped +into the yard within. Just as they did so there was +a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light +as a body of flame burst out from one of the windows.</p> + +<p>"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call +people's attention, and then we must do the best we +can."</p> + +<p>They ran along until they reached the front gate, +and then, seizing the bell-rope, rang it violently.</p> + +<p>In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside, +and shouts of "What's the matter?"</p> + +<p>"There is a fire in the molding-room," George +shouted; "run for the engines, someone, and break +the gate open. Now come on, Bill."</p> + +<p>The two boys ran towards that part of the building +where the flames had been seen, broke a window,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[Pg 119]</a></span> +and climbed in. There was an almost stifling smell +of burning wood and at a door at the end of the +planing-room they could see a light flame flickering +through the cracks of the door leading into the +molding-room, which was next to it.</p> + +<p>"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the +hydrant. We must stop it from getting through +here till the engines come."</p> + +<p>The hydrant communicated with the great tank at +the top of the building, and as soon as the hose was +screwed on and Bill stood with the nozzle directed +towards the burning door, George turned the cock +and volumes of water flew out.</p> + +<p>The first result seemed disastrous. The door was +already nearly burned through, and, as the powerful +jet flew against it, it seemed to crumble away and a +mass of flame darted out from the molding-room. +The joists and timbers supporting the floor above +the planing-room would have caught at once, but +the boys deluged them with water, as also the framework +of the door, and then, throwing the stream of +water into the blazing workshop, they kept down +the flames near the door. The smoke was stifling.</p> + +<p>"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped.</p> + +<p>"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always +better near the ground."</p> + +<p>This they found to be the case, and they were still +able to direct the jet of water. But three or four +minutes had elapsed when the outer door of the +planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[Pg 120]</a></span> +several other men rushed in, but were at once driven +back by the smoke. George had recognized Grimstone's +voice, and shouted:</p> + +<p>"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet. +Come and lend a hand, for it's gaining on us in +spite of the water. You can breathe if you kneel +down."</p> + +<p>Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled +in and joined the boys.</p> + +<p>"What! is it you, George? How on earth did +you get here?" Bob exclaimed.</p> + +<p>"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in +from behind. When we saw what it was we rang +the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do what we +could till help came."</p> + +<p>"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone +said admiringly; "but I am afraid it's not much +good."</p> + +<p>"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters +drenched there. Bill and I will crawl forward and +clear the shavings out of the way if we can. They +have caught half a dozen times already."</p> + +<p>The two boys crawled forward, and although the +heat was tremendous they managed to clear away +the shavings for a considerable distance. The +smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged +to crawl back into the outer air, where for a while +they lay almost insensible. There were crowds of +men in the yard now, but most of them were round +at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[Pg 121]</a></span> +watching the flames as they roared through the +whole of the windows of the molding-room.</p> + +<p>Men were hurrying past with buckets of water, +and one of them, seeing the condition of the boys, +dashed some over their heads and faces, and they +presently staggered to their feet. It was now a +quarter of an hour since they had first given the +alarm, and they were just about to re-enter the +planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and +his comrades coming out.</p> + +<p>"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines +aint here in a minute or two it will be too late."</p> + +<p>But just at that moment there was a cheer outside, +and immediately afterwards a fire-engine +dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to the +firemen as they leaped off.</p> + +<p>"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it +spreading from that shop into this. We have been +keeping it back till now, but the tank has just run +dry."</p> + +<p>While the other firemen were fitting the hose to +the fire-plug just outside the gates one of them made +his way into the planing-room to ascertain the exact +position of affairs.</p> + +<p>"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be +lost; the fire is making its way through. Another +five minutes and we should have been too late to +save any of this block. Is there any communication +through the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone.</p> + +<p>"Yes, there is a door on each floor,"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[Pg 122]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Have you got any empty sacks about the +place?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, there is a pile of them in there."</p> + +<p>The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades, +while he himself made his way into the planing-room +with the hose; the other got out the sacks, +and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands +drenched them with water, and then proceeding to +the door on the first floor piled them against it.</p> + +<p>"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand +upon it. "Now, do you men bring me buckets of +water. Keep the sacks drenched till another engine +comes up."</p> + +<p>George and Bill, finding they could be of no more +use, made their way out to the back and joined the +crowd watching the flames, which had already +spread to the first floor. They were, however, with +the rest of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the +yard by the police, who, having now arrived in +sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear the +premises of all save a score or two of men who were +engaged in assisting the firemen.</p> + +<p>As the boys went out through the front gate another +engine dashed up at full speed, dropping +lighted cinders on its way.</p> + +<p>"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect +they will do now."</p> + +<p>Then the boys made their way round again to the +back, and by means of the pieces of timber established +themselves on the wall, where they were soon<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[Pg 123]</a></span> +joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle +with the flames.</p> + +<p>In half an hour six engines were on the spot; +but even this force had no visible effect upon the +flames in that portion of the building in which they +had taken possession, and the firemen turned the +whole of their efforts to prevent it from spreading.</p> + +<p>The party wall dividing it from the main building +was a very strong one; but so hot had it become that +the floor boards touching it were over and over again +in flames.</p> + +<p>A score of men with saws and axes cut away the +flooring adjoining the doors on the first and second +stories. The planing-room was fortunately not +boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade +worked unceasingly in preventing the spread of the +flames in this direction, the rest turned their attention +to the great wood piles, which were repeatedly +ignited by the fragments of burning wood.</p> + +<p>Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up +high into the air, but grand as the sight was, the +boys did not wait any longer looking on. Their +faces smarted severely from the heat to which they +had been exposed; their hands had been a good deal +burned by the shavings; their hair, eyebrows, and +eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs ached with +the glare.</p> + +<p>"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely +enough hear of the fire, and as we said we should +be back soon after eight she will be getting anxious."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[Pg 124]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and +see the end of it here."</p> + +<p>But this George would not hear of.</p> + +<p>"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must +get some grease or something to put on my face and +hands; they are smarting awfully."</p> + +<p>Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise +and alarm as the boys entered. The irritation of +the wood smoke had so much inflamed their eyes +that they could scarcely see out of them, and their +faces looked like pieces of raw beef.</p> + +<p>"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed.</p> + +<p>"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it +broke out just as we were passing, so we stopped to +help for a bit, and then came home to tell you, thinking +that you might be anxious."</p> + +<p>"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed; +"that is dreadful. Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and +for all of you who work there; more, perhaps, for +you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and +you may be out of work for months. Thank God I +have plenty of work, so I dare say we shall be able +to tide it over."</p> + +<p>"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop +and the floors above it are on fire at present, +and as there are six fire-engines at work, and they +keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will +save the rest; and now, mother, what can we +do to our faces and hands, they are smarting +awfully?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[Pg 125]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought +you were only dreadfully hot."</p> + +<p>"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were +being roasted."</p> + +<p>"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing," +Mrs. Andrews said, hurrying away to the kitchen, +and coming back with a piece of cotton-wool, and +some olive-oil in a cup.</p> + +<p>"You are burned, George. Why, child, your +hair is all singed, and your eyebrows and eyelashes. +Why, what have you been doing to yourselves? +There could have been no occasion to put your heads +into the flames like that. Why, your hands are +worse still; they are quite blistered. I had better +wrap them up in cotton-wool."</p> + +<p>"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps +if you put a bit of cotton-wool there and tie it round +the back it will do; we can't go out with our hands +all swaddled round like that. And now, please, directly +you have done we want to go down again to +see the fire. Just you go up to the road corner, +mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell you."</p> + +<p>"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly; +"everything has been ready except pouring +the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a quarter +past nine now. After we have done I will put on +my bonnet and walk down with you as near as I can +get. I am not going to lose you out of my sight +again."</p> + +<p>So after their meal they went down together, but<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[Pg 126]</a></span> +could not get anywhere near the works, all the approaches +now being guarded by the police. It was +a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was +a general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it +would spread no further. A dozen engines were at +work now. Some of the firemen were on the roof, +some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot +from the deep glow from the fire. The flames were +intermittent now, sometimes leaping up high above +the shell of the burned-out buildings, then dying +down again.</p> + +<p>"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said +fervently. "It would have been a bad winter for a +great many down here if the fire had spread; as it +is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned."</p> + +<p>"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a +tenth, I should say. It's lucky that there was a +strong wall between that and the next shops, or it +must all have gone. I have heard them say that +part was added on five or six years ago, so that the +wall at the end of the planing-shop was an outside +wall before; that accounts for its being so thick."</p> + +<p>After looking on for about half an hour they went +back home. But neither of the boys got much sleep +that night, the excitement they had gone through +and the pain of their burns keeping them wide +awake till nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard +no movement in their rooms—whereas they were +usually up and about almost as early on Sundays as +on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[Pg 127]</a></span> +hour for rising—she did not disturb them. George +was the first to awake, and looking out of the window +felt sure by the light that it was later than +usual. He put his head out of the door and +shouted:</p> + +<p>"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer. +"Mother, are you up; what o'clock is it?"</p> + +<p>"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past +eleven!"</p> + +<p>George gave an exclamation of astonishment and +rushed into Bill's room. The latter had woke at +his shout.</p> + +<p>"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up +for hours;" and he dashed off again to his room to +dress. It was but a few minutes before they came +downstairs just at the same moment.</p> + +<p>"Why didn't you wake us, mother?"</p> + +<p>"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on, +George. I guessed that your burns had kept you +awake for some time."</p> + +<p>"That they did. I thought I was never going to +get to sleep," George said; and Bill gave a similar +account of himself. "Still, mother, a short night +does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to +get to church."</p> + +<p>"It does not matter for once, George. What +figures you both are!"</p> + +<p>"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I +hardly knew myself when I looked in the glass. +My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is peeling<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[Pg 128]</a></span> +off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby; +and Bill looks as bad as I do. You are a figure, +Bill!" and George burst into a fit of laughter.</p> + +<p>"He's no worse than you, George; but come +along, breakfast is waiting."</p> + +<p>"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope, +mother?"</p> + +<p>"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys, +and had a slice of bread and butter, for I thought +you might not be down for some time; but I am +quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put +them down directly you called."</p> + +<p>"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother; +and I am glad too you didn't have your regular +breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit down +on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only +regular breakfast we get in the week."</p> + +<p>Just as they had finished their meal there was a +knock at the door. It was Bob Grimstone. Bill +opened the door.</p> + +<p>"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I +would just come round and see. You look pretty +badly burned; and so do you, George," he added, as +he followed Bill into the sitting room.</p> + +<p>"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews."</p> + +<p>"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews +said. Since her coming the Grimstones had several +times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum +Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished +them to come in more frequently, for she felt much<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[Pg 129]</a></span> +indebted to them for their kindness to George, and, +moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were +good specimens of their class.</p> + +<p>"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone; +your face looks scorched; but you did not +manage to get yourself burned as these silly boys +did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did +not spread!"</p> + +<p>"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two +lads can have told you what they did, for if they had +you would hardly call them silly boys."</p> + +<p>Mrs. Andrews looked surprised.</p> + +<p>"They told me they lent a hand to put out the +fire—I think those were George's words—but they +did not tell me anything else."</p> + +<p>"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't +been for them there would not have been a stick or +stone of Penrose's standing now; the shops and the +wood piles would all have gone, and we should all +have been idle for six months to come; there is no +doubt about that at all."</p> + +<p>"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How +was it they did more than anyone else?"</p> + +<p>"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and +rung the alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found +out for another five minutes, and five minutes would +have been enough for the fire. In the next place, +when they had given the alarm they did the only +thing that could have saved the place: they got +into the planing-shop and turned on the hose there,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[Pg 130]</a></span> +and fought the fire from spreading through the door +till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was +all we could do to stop it then; but if they hadn't +done what they did the planing-shop would have +been alight from end to end, and the floors above it +too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing +could have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs. +Andrews, that there isn't a man on the works, nor +the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that they owe +these two lads their living through the winter. I +don't know what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I +know what we all feel."</p> + +<p>"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her +eyes were filled with happy tears at the praises of +her son, "why did you not tell me about it?"</p> + +<p>"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell," +George said, "and Bob has made a great fuss about +nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as we came +along and when we went round behind and got on +the wall we saw the place was on fire, so we rang +the alarm-bell, and then turned on the hose and +flooded the place with water till Bob and some more +came to help us."</p> + +<p>"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can +tell you it wasn't so. When we opened the door of +the planing-shop it was so full of smoke that it didn't +seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute, +and as we could see the glare of the flames at the +other end we thought the place was gone. We +should have gone out and waited for the engines if<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[Pg 131]</a></span> +we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were +there; and even though we knelt down and crawled +in, as they shouted to us to do, we were pretty nearly +stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward +and got the shavings cleared away; that was +how they burned their hands, I expect; and I hear +they tumbled down insensible when they got out. +Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever +two young chaps behaved like heroes they did, and +you have every right to be proud of them—I say of +them, because although Bill's no son of yours I know +he is what you and your boy have made him. He +was telling me about it one day."</p> + +<p>"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?" +George asked, in order to change the subject.</p> + +<p>"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob +said; "but in our shop and the floors above it it will +take a day or two to clear up. I saw the foreman +just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters +will be put on, for both the floors are burned +away at the end of the wall and pretty near twenty +feet of the roof are charred. Two surveyors are +coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and +say whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that +are burned out must come down, of course. The +surveyor says that if the wall at the end of the planing-room +looks pretty strong they will build up another +wall against it as soon as it gets cold enough +and the rubbish is cleared away for men to work; +that will make a strong job of it, and there won't be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[Pg 132]</a></span> +any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to +come down there can't be much work done in the +shops till it's finished. The governor got down +about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up +to him almost directly after the fire broke out, but +he was out at dinner, and by the time he got down +here all danger of it spreading was over. He had +a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall +with him. He is as anxious as we are that there +should be no delay, for there are some heavy orders +in, and, of course, he doesn't want them taken anywhere +else."</p> + +<p>"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I +don't know much about it, but they seem to be badly +burned."</p> + +<p>"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said +when he had examined them; "pretty nigh raw. If +I might give an opinion, I should say as the doctor +had better see them; they are precious painful, aint +they, George?"</p> + +<p>"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I +don't see any use in a doctor. I don't suppose he +can do more than mother has."</p> + +<p>"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them +for all that; he may give you some cooling lotion for +them, and I can tell you burns on the hand are apt +to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers +may get stiffened. I have known two or three cases +like that. You had better go at once to Dr. Maxwell; +he always attends if there are any accidents at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[Pg 133]</a></span> +the works. You know the house, George; it is +about halfway between this and the works."</p> + +<p>"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews +said; "there, put on your hats and be off."</p> + +<p>"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway, +for the missis will be waiting dinner for me."</p> + +<p>"Are we to pay, mother?"</p> + +<p>"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say +you will have to have your hands dressed several +times."</p> + +<p>"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs. +Andrews. The firm always pays the doctor in case +of accidents, and you may be very sure that in this +case they will be only too glad."</p> + +<p>"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said, +"you can tell the doctor that you will pay when he +says that you need not come to him again. If Mr. +Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should +not think of refusing, as you have been burned in +his service; but certainly I should not assume that +he will do so."</p> + +<p>"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when +they reached the door. "I know the doctor; he attended +me two years ago when I pretty nigh had my +finger taken off by one of the cutters."</p> + +<p>"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would."</p> + +<p>They were shown into the surgery, where the +doctor soon joined them.</p> + +<p>"I've brought these two young chaps for you to +look at their hands, Dr. Maxwell. They got them<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[Pg 134]</a></span> +burnt last night at the fire. Mrs. Andrews, the +mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would +pay the charges when you have done with them; but +as if it hadn't been for them the works would have +been burnt down as sure as you are standing there, +I expect the firm will take the matter in their own +hands."</p> + +<p>"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining +the boys' hands. "Can you open and shut +them, boy?"</p> + +<p>"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but +I shouldn't like to try, for if I move my fingers at +all it hurts them awfully."</p> + +<p>"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your +hands."</p> + +<p>"Yes."</p> + +<p>"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on +some soothing poultices. Tell your mother to get +some linseed and mix it with olive-oil. I will give +you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about twenty +drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with +the linseed. Every four or five hours change the +poultices. I think you will find that will relieve the +pain a good deal. I see your faces are scorched too. +You can do nothing better than keep them moistened +with sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet +as possible for three or four days."</p> + +<p>"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George +said.</p> + +<p>"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[Pg 135]</a></span> +use your hands in another fortnight. I will send +in the usual certificate to the works."</p> + +<p>"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said +when they left the doctor's, "how it is we can't come +to work? You tell him we wanted to, and that we +hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right; +because, you see, the men and boys at the shops +which have been burnt down will be all out of work, +and it would be awful if we found our places filled +up when we went to work again."</p> + +<p>"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of +your being out of work after what you have +done."</p> + +<p>"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews' +first question when they returned home.</p> + +<p>"He didn't say much, mother, except that we +must not think of going to work for a fortnight anyhow, +and we are to have poultices made with linseed +mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from +this bottle, and it must be put on fresh every three +or four hours. I am afraid it will be an awful +trouble."</p> + +<p>"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said +brightly. "Did he say you were to go to bed?"</p> + +<p>"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we +could."</p> + +<p>"Then in that case, George, I think you had better +go to bed."</p> + +<p>"No; I am sure we had better not," George said. +"I should toss and fidget about there horridly. The<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[Pg 136]</a></span> +best thing will be for us to sit here, and then we +shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and +perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much. +What are you going to do, mother?" he asked five +minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came down +with her bonnet on.</p> + +<p>"I am going to get some linseed, George, of +course. I haven't got any in the house."</p> + +<p>"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be +shut."</p> + +<p>"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They +will always supply things that are needed even on +Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as well as any +other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than +a quarter of an hour. You must keep very quiet +till I come back."</p> + +<p>The boys found a good deal of relief from the +effect of the poultices, and were very much better +after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock the next +morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work, +with the boys both on the hearthrug in front of the +fire, there was a knock at the door. It was a loud +double knock, quite unlike the ordinary summons of +the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller. +The boys jumped up in surprise.</p> + +<p>"Who can that be, mother?"</p> + +<p>"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly.</p> + +<p>She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see +a gentleman standing there, whom, by the description +the boys had given of him, she guessed to be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[Pg 137]</a></span> +their employer. A little girl was standing by his +side.</p> + +<p>"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked.</p> + +<p>"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly.</p> + +<p>"My name is Penrose. I have called with my +daughter to inquire after the two lads—one of them +your son, I believe—who so gallantly saved my place +from being burned down on Saturday evening. I +only heard about it late yesterday evening, when I +came down to arrange about some matters with the +foreman. He did not know the facts of the case +on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday, +and there can be no doubt whatever, from what he +says, that had it not been for the presence of mind +and bravery of these two lads nothing could have +saved the entire works and all the wood piles from +destruction. I told my daughter this morning, and +she insisted on coming down with me. You know +she is already indebted to your son for saving a +locket which we both greatly valued."</p> + +<p>"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews +showed them into the sitting room.</p> + +<p>Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by +Mrs. Andrews' manner, although the foreman, in +telling him of the boys' conduct, had also stated +what he knew about them.</p> + +<p>"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he +said. "There was quite a talk about them in the +shops in the spring. They lodged with Grimstone, +and it seems that after they had been here at work<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[Pg 138]</a></span> +five months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was +coming to them, and they got Grimstone to take a +house for them, and it turned out that ever since +they had been at work here they had been putting by +half their wages to furnish a place for her, so they +must have lived on about five shillings a week each +and got clothes for themselves out of it. Now, sir, +boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there +was quite a talk among the men about it. I hear +from Grimstone that Mrs. Andrews is a superior +sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does work, +I believe, for some London shop."</p> + +<p>Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the +boys in a more comfortable abode than usual, and +their mother what the foreman called a superior sort +of woman; but he perceived at once by her address +that Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one, +and that she was indeed a lady. The prettiness of +the little sitting room, with its comfortable furniture, +its snowy curtains and pretty belongings, +heightened this feeling.</p> + +<p>"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to +tell you how indebted I feel to you for your exertions +on Saturday. There is no doubt that had it +not been for you the place would have been entirely +burned. It was fully insured, but it would have +been a serious matter for me, as I should have lost +four or five months' work, and it would have been +still more serious for the men to have been thrown +out of employment at this time of the year, so we all<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[Pg 139]</a></span> +feel very much indebted to you. I hope you are not +much burned."</p> + +<p>"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they +will be all right in a few days. Bill and I are very +glad, sir, that we happened to be passing, and were +able to give the alarm and do something to stop the +flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that +it was anything out of the way. It was just a piece +of fun and excitement to us."</p> + +<p>"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose, +when they came home, and it was only when one of +the men came in next day to ask after them that I +heard that they had really been of use."</p> + +<p>"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose +replied; "but there is no doubt you showed a great +deal of courage, as well as presence of mind, and +you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And +now, Mrs. Andrews," he said, turning round to her, +"I feel rather in a false position. I came round to +see the lads, who, when I last saw them, were not +in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going +to make them a present for the service they had done +me, and my daughter has brought them a basket +with some wine, jelly, and other things such as are +good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them, +in your care and in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty +about it altogether."</p> + +<p>"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the +kindness of your intention; but my boys—for although +one is in no way related to me I feel towards<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[Pg 140]</a></span> +him as if he were my own—would not like to take +money for doing their duty towards their employer."</p> + +<p>"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously.</p> + +<p>"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were +good enough to give the boys and to my needle,"—and +she glanced towards the articles on the table,—"we +are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys +will be very glad to accept the things which your +daughter has been so kind as to bring down for +them, and will feel very much obliged for her +thoughtfulness."</p> + +<p>"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved. +"Nelly, you may as well leave the basket as it is. +I am sure you don't want to carry it back again?"</p> + +<p>"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the +empty basket would have been more than the child +could well have carried. It had come on the top of +the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had +accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum +Villas.</p> + +<p>"You would have hardly known your young +friend. Would you, Nelly?"</p> + +<p>"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her +head. "He looks dreadfully burned, and his hair +is all funny and frizzled."</p> + +<p>"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling. +"The doctor says our faces will be all right when +the skin is peeled off. Thank you very much, Miss +Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[Pg 141]</a></span> +day indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing +your locket."</p> + +<p>"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr. +Penrose responded. "Now, Mrs. Andrews, we will +say good-by. You will not mind my calling again +to see how the boys are getting on?"</p> + +<p>"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be +glad to see you," Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope +in a few days they will both be out of the doctor's +hands."</p> + +<p>"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said, +patting the boys on the shoulder, "but I hope next +time I see you to be able to do so. Good-morning, +Mrs. Andrews."</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[Pg 142]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VII" id="CHAPTER_VII"></a>CHAPTER VII.</h2> + +<h3>SAVED!</h3> + + +<p>"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother," +George said as Mrs. Andrews returned into the +room after seeing her two visitors off. "It's very +kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us +money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?"</p> + +<p>"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose +is evidently a gentleman of delicacy and refinement +of feeling, and he saw that he would give pain +if he did so."</p> + +<p>"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked. +"You know you thought I was a fool not to take +money when he offered it for getting back the locket; +but you see it in the same way now, don't you?"</p> + +<p>"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money," +Bill said. "I sees——"</p> + +<p>"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected.</p> + +<p>"Thank you. I see things different—differently," +he corrected himself, seeing that George was +about to speak, "to what I did then."</p> + +<p>"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the +basket; it's almost as big as a clothes-basket, +isn't it?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[Pg 143]</a></span></p> + +<p>The cover was lifted and the contents, which had +after much thought been settled by Nelly herself, +were disclosed. There were two bottles of port-wine, +a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen +oranges, some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some +almonds and raisins, two packets of Everton toffee, +a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of black-currant +jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a +sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in +a tumbler of water for a drink at night."</p> + +<p>"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a +jolly collection, isn't it? I think Miss Penrose must +have chosen it herself, don't you?"</p> + +<p>"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews +replied, smiling. "I do not think any grownup +person would have chosen mince-pies and toffee +as appropriate for sick boys."</p> + +<p>"Yes; but she must have known we were not +badly burned, mother; and besides, you see, she put +in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there are the +oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and +some toffee at once, Bill."</p> + +<p>"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them +in the market, but I never tasted toffee."</p> + +<p>"It's first-rate, I can tell you."</p> + +<p>"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the +packet was opened.</p> + +<p>George burst into a laugh.</p> + +<p>"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you +peel that off, Bill, and you will find the toffee inside.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[Pg 144]</a></span> +Now, mother, you have a glass of wine and a piece +of cake."</p> + +<p>"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am +not going to open the wine. We will put that by in +case of illness or of any very extraordinary occasion."</p> + +<p>"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother, +or I expect you would be wanting to put them all +away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?"</p> + +<p>"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made +of?"</p> + +<p>"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire."</p> + +<p>"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews +laughed, "instead of boys getting on for sixteen +years old. Now I must clear this table again and +get to work; I promised these four bonnets should +be sent in to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be +done to them yet."</p> + +<p>It was three weeks before the boys were able to +go to work again. The foreman came round on +Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called +again; this time they were out, but he chatted for +some time with Mrs. Andrews.</p> + +<p>"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews," +he said, after asking about the boys; "but +I have a motive for asking if your son has, as I suppose +he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair +education."</p> + +<p>"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs. +Andrews said quietly; "circumstances at that time<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[Pg 145]</a></span> +obliged me to remove him; but I have since done +what I could myself towards continuing his education, +and he still works regularly of an evening."</p> + +<p>"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should +like in time to place him in the counting-house. I +say in time, because I think it will be better for him +for the next two or three years to continue to work +in the shops. I will have him moved from shop to +shop so as to learn thoroughly the various branches +of the business. That is what I should do had I a +son of my own to bring into the business. It will +make him more valuable afterwards, and fit him to +take a good position either in my shops or in any +similar business should an opening occur."</p> + +<p>"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews +said gratefully; "though I say it myself, a better +boy never lived."</p> + +<p>"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him, +and I shall be only too glad, after the service he has +rendered me, to do everything in my power to push +him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the +same advantages. At the time I first saw him he +looked a regular young arab."</p> + +<p>"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow. +He was very kind to my boy when he was alone in +London, and gave up his former life to be with him. +George taught him to read before I came here, and +he has worked hard ever since. No one could be +nicer in the house than he is, and had I been his own +mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[Pg 146]</a></span> +please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for +my home here as much to him as to my own +boy."</p> + +<p>"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for +of course I should wish to do something for him too. +At any rate, I will give him, like your son, every +opportunity of learning the business, and he will in +time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop—by +no means a bad one for a lad who has had such a +beginning as he has had. After that, of course, it +must depend upon himself. I think, if you will +allow me to suggest, it would be as well that you +should not tell them the nature of our conversation. +Of course it is for you to decide; but, however steady +boys they are, it might make them a little less able +to get on well with their associates in a shop if they +know that they are going to be advanced."</p> + +<p>"I don't think it would make any difference to +them, sir; but at the same time I do think it would +be as well not to tell them."</p> + +<p>One day Bill was out by himself as the men were +coming out of the shop, and he stopped to speak to +Bob Grimstone.</p> + +<p>"Oh! I am glad to find you without George," +Bob said; "'cause I want to talk to you. Look +here! the men in all the shops have made a subscription +to give you and George a present. Everyone +feels that it's your doing that we have not got to +idle all this winter, and when someone started the +idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that didn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[Pg 147]</a></span> +agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's +come to just thirty pounds. Now I don't know +what you two boys would like, whether you would +like it in money, or whether you would like it in +something else, so I thought I would ask you first. +I thought you would know what George would like, +seeing what friends you are, and then you know it +would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do +you say?"</p> + +<p>"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure +George would like anything better than money, and +so should I."</p> + +<p>"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know +in a day or two. We were thinking of a watch for +each of you, with an inscription, saying it was presented +to you by your shopmates for having saved +the factory, and so kept them at work for months +just at the beginning of winter. That's what +seemed to me that you would like; but if there is +anything you would like better, just you say so. +You come down here to-morrow or next day, when +you have thought it over, and give me an answer. +Of course you can consult George if you think +best."</p> + +<p>Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day.</p> + +<p>"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know +what George and me would like better than any +possible thing you could get."</p> + +<p>"Well, what is it, Bill?"</p> + +<p>"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[Pg 148]</a></span> +we were going to save up our money to get, was a +piano for George's mother. I heard her say that we +could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds, +and it would be splendid if you were all to give it +her."</p> + +<p>"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know +a chap as works at Kirkman's, and I expect he will +be able to give us a good one for the money."</p> + +<p>Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the +boys were going to work again, Mrs. Andrews and +George were astonished at seeing a cart stop before +the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and +four other men coming up to the door.</p> + +<p>Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered. +He had been apprised of the time that they might +be expected, and at once showed them in.</p> + +<p>"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my +mates here are a deputation from the hands employed +in the shop, and we have come to offer you a +little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your +son and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving +the shops. If it hadn't been for them it would +have been a bad winter for us all. So after thinking +it over and finding out what form of testimonial +the lads would like best, we have got you a piano, +which we hope you may live long to play on and +enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch +each; but we found that they would rather that it +took the form of a piano."</p> + +<p>"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. An<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[Pg 149]</a></span>drews +said, much affected. "I shall indeed be +proud of your gift, both for itself and for the kind +feeling towards my boys which it expresses."</p> + +<p>"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just +bring it in;" and the deputation retired to assist with +the piano.</p> + +<p>"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling +me!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed.</p> + +<p>George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise.</p> + +<p>"But I didn't know anything about it, mother. +I don't know what they mean by saying that we +would rather have it than watches. Of course we +would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they +knew it."</p> + +<p>"Then it must have been your kind thought, +Bill."</p> + +<p>"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but +they spoke to me about it, and I knew that a piano +was what we should like better than anything else, +and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob +Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise +to George as well as to you."</p> + +<p>"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking +Bill by the hand; "why, there never was such a good +idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?"</p> + +<p>The men now appeared at the door with the +piano. This was at once placed in the position +which had long ago been decided upon as the best +place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. An<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[Pg 150]</a></span>drews +opened it, and there on the front was a silver +plate with the inscription:</p> + +<p>"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at +Messrs. Penrose & Co., in token of their gratitude to +George Andrews and William Smith for their courage +and presence of mind, by which the factory was +saved from being destroyed by fire on Saturday the +23d of October, 1857."</p> + +<p>The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered +it difficult for her to read the inscription.</p> + +<p>"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps +you would like to hear its tones." So saying +she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home." +"It has a charming touch," she said as she rose, +"and, you see, the air was an appropriate one, for +your gift will serve to make home even sweeter than +before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those +of my boys, to all who have subscribed."</p> + +<p>The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had +long been a subject of considerable discussion +and interest to their neighbors, for the appearance +of the boys as they came home of an evening +in their working clothes seemed altogether incongruous +with that of their mother and with the +neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was, indeed, +considered derogatory to the respectability of +Laburnum Villas in general. Upon this evening +they were still further mystified at hearing +the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness, +accompanied by a piano, played evidently by<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[Pg 151]</a></span> +an accomplished musician, issuing from the house. +As to the boys, they thought that, next only to that +of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was +such a happy evening spent in the world.</p> + +<p>I do not think that in all London there was a +household that enjoyed that winter more than did +the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their total +earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week, +much less than that of many a mechanic, but ample +for them not only to live, but to live in comfort and +even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into +the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have +dreamed that the lady at the piano worked as a +milliner for her living, or that the lads were boys in +a manufactory.</p> + +<p>When spring came they began to plan various +trips and excursions which could be taken on bank +holidays or during the long summer evenings, when +an event happened which, for a time, cut short all +their plans. The word had been passed round the +shops the first thing in the morning that Mr. Penrose +was coming down with a party of ladies and +gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were +to be made as tidy as possible.</p> + +<p>Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and +vast quantities of shavings and sawdust were swept +up from the floors, although when the machines had +run again for a few hours no one would have +thought that a broom had been seen in the place for +weeks.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[Pg 152]</a></span></p> + +<p>George was now in a shop where a number of +machines were at work grooving, mortising, and +performing other work to prepare the wood for +builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work +had recommenced after dinner.</p> + +<p>There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many +ladies. Nelly Penrose, with two girls about her +own age, accompanied the party. They stopped for +a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the +nature of the work and the various points of the +machinery.</p> + +<p>They had passed through most of the other rooms +before they entered that in which George was engaged, +and the young girls, taking but little interest +in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat +away from the rest of the party, chatting among +themselves. George had his eye upon them, and +was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round and +speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly +and not paying sufficient heed to the machinery.</p> + +<p>Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward +with a shout; but he was too late, a revolving-band +had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In an instant +she was dragged forward and in another moment +would have been whirled into the middle of +the machinery.</p> + +<p>There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden +crash and a harsh grating sound, and then the whole +of the machinery on that side of the room came to +a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[Pg 153]</a></span> +happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends +rushed forward to raise Nelly. Her hand was held +fast between the band and the pulley, and the band +had to be cut to relieve it.</p> + +<p>"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose +murmured, as he lifted her. "Another second and +nothing could have saved her. But what stopped +the machinery?" and for the first time he looked +round the shop. There was a little group of men a +few yards away, and, having handed Nelly, who was +crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised, to +one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The +foreman came forward to meet him.</p> + +<p>"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of +the shop. I am afraid young Andrews is badly hurt."</p> + +<p>"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked.</p> + +<p>"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter +was in, and shoved his foot in between two of the +cog-wheels."</p> + +<p>"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as +he pushed forward among the men.</p> + +<p>Two of them were supporting George Andrews, +who, as pale as death, lay in their arms. One of his +feet was jammed in between two of the cog-wheels. +He was scarcely conscious.</p> + +<p>"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a +low tone, "his foot must be completely crushed! +Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[Pg 154]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Yes, sir, I did that first thing."</p> + +<p>"That's right; now work away for your lives, +lads." This was said to two men who had already +seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts of +the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to +be lifted and the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr. +Penrose returned to his friends.</p> + +<p>"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down +into the office. There's been a bad accident; a noble +young fellow has sacrificed himself to save Nelly's +life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off +a man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump +into one of the cabs he will find waiting at the gate, +and tell the man to drive as hard as he can go. If +Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone +else."</p> + +<p>George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly +Penrose. When he saw the band catch her dress he +had looked round for an instant for something with +which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing +at hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had +thrust his foot between the cog-wheels. He had on +very heavy, thickly nailed working boots, and the +iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent +the shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George +felt a dull, sickening pain, which seemed to numb +and paralyze him all over, and he remembered little +more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot +was extricated and he was laid gently down on a +heap of shavings. The first thing he realized when<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[Pg 155]</a></span> +he was conscious was that someone was pouring +some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat.</p> + +<p>When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling +beside him, was supporting his head, while on the +other side knelt Bill Smith, the tears streaming down +his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs.</p> + +<p>"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then +the remembrance of what had passed flashed upon +him.</p> + +<p>"Is she safe; was I in time?"</p> + +<p>"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your +noble sacrifice was not in vain," Mr. Penrose answered +with quivering lips, for he too had the +greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion.</p> + +<p>"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a +pause, "because, if so, will you please send home for +mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I feel strange +and weak."</p> + +<p>"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly +crushed, but otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot +threw the machinery out of gear."</p> + +<p>In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already +been informed of the nature of the accident.</p> + +<p>"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr. +Penrose asked in a low voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped +over George's leg.</p> + +<p>"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the +same tone. "The foot is crushed to a pulp. It +must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save it. +He had better be taken home at once. You had best<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[Pg 156]</a></span> +send to Guy's and get an operating surgeon for him. +I would rather it were done by someone whose hand +is more used than mine to this sort of work."</p> + +<p>"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said, +"and will send off at once for one of their best men. +You are not afraid of the case, I hope, Dr. Maxwell?"</p> + +<p>"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied; +"but the shock to the system of such a smash is very +severe. However, he has youth, strength, and a +good constitution, so we must hope for the best. +The chances are all in his favor. We are thinking +of taking you home, my boy," he went on, speaking +aloud to George. "Are you in any great pain?"</p> + +<p>"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully +cold, and, please, will someone go on before and +tell mother. Bill had better not go; he would +frighten her to death and make her think it was +much worse than it is."</p> + +<p>"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will +prepare her for your coming."</p> + +<p>"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor +said; "that will warm you and give you strength for +your journey."</p> + +<p>There was a stretcher always kept at the works +in case of emergency, and George was placed on +this and covered with some rugs. Four of the men +raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose +at once driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews.</p> + +<p>Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[Pg 157]</a></span> +it neared home he fell behind and wandered away, +not being able to bring himself to witness the grief +of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about, +sitting down in waste places and crying as if his +heart would break. "If it had been me it wouldn't +have mattered," he kept on exclaiming—"wouldn't +have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no odds +one way or the other. There, we have always been +together in the shops till this week, and now when +we get separated this is what comes of it. Here am +I, walking about all right, and George all crushed +up, and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I +would rather a hundred times that they had smashed +me up all over than have gone and hurt George like +that!"</p> + +<p>It was dark before he made his way back, and, +entering at the back door, took off his boots, and was +about to creep upstairs when Mrs. Andrews came +out of the kitchen.</p> + +<p>"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the +tears again burst from him.</p> + +<p>"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and +the doctors have every hope that he will recover. +They are upstairs with him now, with a nurse whom +Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital. +He will have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added +with a sob that she could not repress, "but we +should feel very thankful that it is no worse after +such an accident as that. The doctor says that his +thick boots saved him. If it hadn't been for that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[Pg 158]</a></span> +his whole leg would have been drawn into the machinery, +and then nothing could have saved him. +Now I must go upstairs, as I only came down for +some hot water."</p> + +<p>"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?"</p> + +<p>"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here +for the present for both your sakes. I will let you +know when you can go up to him."</p> + +<p>So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He +heard movements upstairs and wondered what they +were doing and why they didn't keep quiet, and +when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice +the nurse came down for hot water, but Bill did not +speak to her; but in half an hour Mrs. Andrews herself +returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler than +before.</p> + +<p>"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy, +that it's all over. They gave him chloroform, and +have taken his foot off."</p> + +<p>"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an +awed voice.</p> + +<p>"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it, +and the first thing he asked when he came to was +when they were going to begin. They will be going +away directly, and then you can come up and sit +quietly in his room if you like. The doctors say he +will probably drop asleep."</p> + +<p>Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle +with himself before he felt that he was fit to go up +into George's room. It was a long struggle, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[Pg 159]</a></span> +had George caught his muttered remonstrances to +himself he would have felt that Bill had suffered a +bad relapse into his former method of talking. It +came out in jerks between his sobs.</p> + +<p>"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of +yerself, a-howling and a-blubbering like a gal! Call +yerself a man!—you are a babby, that's what +you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more +of it."</p> + +<p>But it was a long time before he again mastered +himself; then he went to the scullery and held his +head under the tap till the water took away his +breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then +went and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came +in and told him that he could go upstairs to George. +He went up to the bedside and took George's hand, +but he could not trust himself to speak.</p> + +<p>"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in +a somewhat lower voice than usual, "this is a sudden +go, isn't it?"</p> + +<p>Bill nodded. He was still speechless.</p> + +<p>"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said, +feeling that the lad was shaking from head to foot. +"It won't make much odds, you know. I shall soon +be about again all right. I expect they will be able +to put on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping +about as well as ever, though I shouldn't be much +good at a race."</p> + +<p>"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I +would have jammed my head in between them<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[Pg 160]</a></span> +wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you +should have gone and done it."</p> + +<p>"Fortunately there was no time," George said +with a smile. "Don't you fret yourself, Bill; one +can get on well enough without a foot, and it didn't +hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze +either, not regular hurting; it was just a sort of +scrunch, and then I didn't feel anything more. +Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at +play and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked +much worse to you than it felt to me."</p> + +<p>"We will talk of it another time," Bill said +huskily. "Your mother said I wasn't to talk, and +I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit down here +quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So +saying he sat down by the bedside. George asked +one or two more questions, but Bill only shook his +head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a short +time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed +that he was asleep.</p> + +<p>The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to +George. Every day hampers containing flowers +and various niceties in the way of food were sent +down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself +very frequently called in for a chat with him. As +soon as the wound had healed an instrument-maker +came down from town to measure him for an artificial +foot, but before he was able to wear this he +could get about on crutches.</p> + +<p>The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Pen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[Pg 161]</a></span>rose +brought Nelly down to see him. The child +looked pale and awed as he came in.</p> + +<p>"My little girl has asked me to thank you for +her, George," Mr. Penrose said as she advanced +timidly and placed her hand in his. "I have not +said much to you about my own feelings and I won't +say much about hers; but you can understand what +we both feel. Why, my boy, it was a good Providence, +indeed, which threw you in my way! I +thought so when you saved the mill from destruction. +I feel it tenfold more now that you have +saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed, +strange. Who would have thought that all this +could have sprung from that boy snatching the +locket from Helen as we came out of the theater! +And now about the future, George. I owe you a +great debt, infinitely greater than I can ever repay; +but what I can do I will. In the future I shall regard +you as my son, and I hope that you will look +to me as to a father. I have been talking to your +mother, and she says that she thinks your tastes lie +altogether in the direction of engineering. Is that +so?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather +be an engineer than anything else, but I don't +like——"</p> + +<p>"Never mind what you like and what you don't +like," Mr. Penrose said quietly. "You belong to +me now, you know and must do as you are told. +What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[Pg 162]</a></span> +school for another three years, and I will then apprentice +you to a first-class engineer, either mechanical +or civil as you may then prefer, and when you +have learned your business I will take good care +that you are pushed on. What do you say to +that?"</p> + +<p>"I think it is too much altogether," George +said.</p> + +<p>"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said, +"that is my business. If that is the only objection +we can imagine it settled. There is another thing. +I know how attached you are to your friend Bill, +and I am indebted to him, too, for the part he played +at the fire, so I propose, if he is willing, to put him +to a good middle-class school for a bit. In the +course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient +education to get on fairly with, and then I propose, +according as you may choose to be a civil or mechanical +engineer, to place him with a mason or +smith; then by the time that you are ready to start +in business he will be ready to take a place under +you, so that you may again work together."</p> + +<p>"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even +more pleased at the news relating to Bill than at his +own good fortune, great as was the delight which +the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused +him.</p> + +<p>As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose +sent him with his mother and Bill down to the seaside. +Here George rapidly regained strength, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[Pg 163]</a></span> +when, after a stay there of two months, he returned +to town, he was able to walk so well with his artificial +foot that his loss would not have been noticed +by a stranger.</p> + +<p>The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were +all in due time carried out. George went for three +years to a good school, and was then apprenticed to +one of the leading civil engineers. With him he +remained five years and then went out for him to +survey a railroad about to be constructed in Brazil, +and remained there as one of the staff who superintended +its construction. Bill, who was now a +clever young mason, accompanied him, and through +George's interest with the contractor obtained the +sub-contract for the masonry of some of the bridges +and culverts.</p> + +<p>This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is +now one of the most rising engineers of the day, and +whatever business he undertakes his friend Bill is +still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in +all respects as good as his word, and has been ready +to assist George with his personal influence in all +his undertakings, and in all respects has treated him +as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the +affection of a sister.</p> + +<p>Both George and Bill have been married some +years, and Mrs. Andrews the elder is one of the +proudest and happiest of mothers. She still lives +with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who +is often left alone during George's frequent ab<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[Pg 164]</a></span>sence +abroad on professional duties. As for Bill, he +has not even yet got over his wonder at his own +good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first +met George in Covent Garden.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[Pg 165]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="DO_YOUR_DUTY" id="DO_YOUR_DUTY"></a>DO YOUR DUTY.</h2> + + +<p>Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor +was sitting on a bench gazing over the stretch of sea +which lies between Hayling Island and the Isle of +Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those +days ships of war were constantly running in and +out, and great convoys of merchantmen sailed under +the protection of our cruisers; and the traffic between +Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a much +frequented road.</p> + +<p>Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's +service, and had settled down in his old age on a pension, +and lived in a small cottage near the western +extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see +what was going on at Spithead, and when he needed +a talk with his old "chums" could get into his boat, +which was lying hauled up on the sand, and with +a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was +sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up +by a very high tide on the sandy slope, when his +meditations were disturbed by a light step behind +him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen years +of age, with a bright honest face, came running +down behind him.</p> + +<p>"Hallo, dad!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[Pg 166]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought +o' seeing you!" and the old man clasped the boy in +his arms in a way that showed the close relationship +between the two. "I didn't expect you for another +week."</p> + +<p>"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy +said; "fine wind all the way up, with a gale or two +in the right quarter. We only arrived in the river +on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I +got leave to run down to see you."</p> + +<p>"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old +sailor said. "It's the duty of every hand to stop +by the ship till she's cleared out."</p> + +<p>"I have always stayed before till the crew were +paid off; but no sooner had we cast anchor than one +of the owners came on board, and told the captain +that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to +be unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and +sail again in a fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was +on the point of sailing for the West Indies under a +strong convoy."</p> + +<p>"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old +sailor said. "And the goods will have to be bundled +out and in again with double speed. I know what +it will be. You will be going out with the paint all +wet, and those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off +as fast as it's put on. Well, a few days at sea will +shake all down into its place. But how did you get +leave?"</p> + +<p>"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[Pg 167]</a></span> +lad said. "The men who desired to leave were to +be discharged at once and a fresh gang taken on +board, so I asked him directly the news came round +if I might have four days away. He agreed at once, +and I came down by the night coach; and here I am +for eight-and-forty hours."</p> + +<p>"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after +more than a year away, but we mustn't waste the +time in regretting it. You've grown, Harry, and +are getting on fast. In another couple of years +you'll be fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've +got over your silly idea about sticking to the merchant +service. It's all very well to learn your business +there as a boy, and I grant that in some things +a merchantman is a better school than a king's ship. +They have fewer hands, and each man has to do +more and to learn to think for himself. Still, after +all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement +and happiness."</p> + +<p>"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been +learning a little navigation. The first officer has +been very kind to me, and I hope in the course of +two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third +mate. Still, I should like three or four years on +board a man-of-war."</p> + +<p>"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a +man ought to do his duty to his country."</p> + +<p>"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to +their country," the boy said.</p> + +<p>"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[Pg 168]</a></span> +a great difficulty in finding hands for the navy. +Everyone wants to throw their duty upon everyone +else. They all hanker after the higher wages and +loafing life on board a merchantman, and hate to +keep themselves smart and clean as they must do in +a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should +serve at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war. +It is above all things essential, Harry, that +you should do your duty."</p> + +<p>"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said, +"when the time comes. I do it now to the best of +my power, and I have in my pocket a letter from the +first officer to you. He told you when you went +down with me to see me off on my last voyage +that he would keep an eye upon me, and he has +done so."</p> + +<p>"That's right," the old man said. "As you say, +Harry, a man may do his duty anywhere; still, for +all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a sailor, to help +his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies. +Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh +fifty years, and was in action one way and another +over a hundred times, and here I am now with a +snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious +majesty himself. What can you want more +than that?"</p> + +<p>"I don't know that I can want more," the boy +said, "in its way, at least; but there are other ways +in the merchant service. I might command a ship +by the time I am thirty, and be my own master in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[Pg 169]</a></span>stead +of being a mere part of a machine. I have +heard the balls flying too," he said, laughing.</p> + +<p>"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?" +the old tar said, greatly interested.</p> + +<p>"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer +off the coast of Spain. Fortunately the old +bark carries a long eighteen, as well as her twelves, +and when the Frenchman found that we could play +at long bowls as well as himself he soon drew off, +but not before we had drilled a few holes in his sails +and knocked away a bit of his bulwarks."</p> + +<p>"Were you hit, Harry?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did +little damage beyond knocking away a few of the +fittings and frightening the lady passengers. We +had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that +the skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman +come close before he opened fire. We should +like to have towed him up the river with our flag +over the tricolor."</p> + +<p>"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said, +"you were just as ready to fight as if you had been +on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing ship you +only get a chance if one of these privateers happens +to see you, in a king's ship you go looking about for +an enemy, and when you see one the chances are he +is bigger, instead of smaller, than yourself."</p> + +<p>"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it, +I expect," the boy said; "but for all that, I do mean +to serve for a few years in a man-of-war. I expect<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[Pg 170]</a></span> +that we may have a chance of seeing some fighting +in the West Indies. There are, they say, several +French cruisers in that direction, and although we +shall have a considerable convoy the Frenchmen +generally have the legs of our ships. I believe that +some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out +troops, and that we are going to have a slap at some +of the French islands. Has there been any news +here since I went?"</p> + +<p>"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers. +The revenue officers have a busy time here. There's +no such place for smuggling on the coast as between +Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just +the places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic +in the Channel that a solitary lugger does not attract +the attention of the coastguard as it does where the +sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself +one way or the other about it. I may know a +good deal of the smuggling, or I may not, but it's +no business of mine. If it were my duty to lend a +hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it +isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am +content enough to get my spirits cheap."</p> + +<p>"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the +king being cheated?" Harry said with a smile.</p> + +<p>"If the king himself were going to touch the +money," the old sailor said sturdily, "I would lend +a hand to see that he got it, but there's no saying +where this money would have gone. Besides, if the +spirits hadn't been run, they would not have been<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[Pg 171]</a></span> +brought over here at all, so after all the revenue is +none the worse for the smuggling."</p> + +<p>The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad, +when you like, but you know as well as I do that +smuggling's dishonest, and that those who smuggle +cheat the revenue."</p> + +<p>"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I +don't clearly see that it's my duty to give information +in the matter. If I did feel as it were going to +be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it, +and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything +within earshot of me, that I might feel called +on to repeat. And now, let's go up to the cottage +and see the old woman."</p> + +<p>"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said, +"as I passed. Mother looks as hale and hearty as +she did when I left, and so do you, dad."</p> + +<p>"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old +man said. "I have been so thoroughly seasoned +with salt water that it would take a long time for +me to decay."</p> + +<p>When they got up to the cottage they found that +Jane Langley had got breakfast prepared. Rashers +of bacon were smoking on the table, and a large +tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of +tea had not become general in this country.</p> + +<p>"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said, +"that the boy is to leave us again in forty-eight +hours?"</p> + +<p>"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span> +hard news. I had hoped that you would be with us +for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast in life, +and may not be here when you return."</p> + +<p>"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing +as that," Harry said. "Father was just saying that +he's so seasoned that even time cannot make much +of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as +he is."</p> + +<p>"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when +old oak does come down, he generally falls sudden. +However, we won't make our first meal sad by talking +of what might be."</p> + +<p>Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents +of Harry's voyage to India and back. It +was his second trip. The lad had had a much better +education than most boys in his rank of life at that +time, the boatswain having placed him at the age of +ten in charge of a schoolmaster at Portsmouth. +When Harry had reached that age Peter had retired +from the service, and had settled down at Hayling, +but for two years longer he had kept Harry at +school. Then he had apprenticed him to a firm of +shipowners in London, and one of the officers under +whom Peter had served had spoken to the heads of +the firm, so that the boy was put in a ship commanded +by a kind and considerate officer, and to +whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus +he had not forgotten what he had learned at school, +as is too often the case with lads in his position. +His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span> +he knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each +day such subjects as would be useful to him in his +career.</p> + +<p>After breakfast the pair again went out onto the +sandhills, Peter, as usual, carrying a huge telescope +with him, with which he was in the habit of surveying +every ship as she rounded the west of the island +and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth. +Most of the men-of-war he knew in an instant, +and the others he could make a shrewd guess +at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full +of talk of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's +future bearing, and of suggestions and hints as to +the best course to be adopted in various emergencies. +But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and +smoked his pipe, and looked out in silence over the +sea, scarcely even lifting his telescope to his eye.</p> + +<p>"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last, +"that as you are going away again, and, as the old +woman says, you may not find us both here when +you come back, it is right that I should tell you a +little more about yourself. I once told you, years +ago, that you were not my son, and that I would give +you more particulars some day."</p> + +<p>The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It +was a matter which he had often thought over in +his mind, for although he loved the honest tar and +his good wife as much as he could have done his +natural parents, still, since he had known that he +was their adopted son only, he had naturally won<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span>dered +much as to who his parents were, and what +was their condition in life.</p> + +<p>"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not +to tell you this here yarn until you were getting on. +Boys' heads get upset with a little breeze, especially +if they have no ballast, and though it isn't likely now +that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and +it will make no difference whether it was a duke or +a ship's caulker who was your father, still it's right +that you should know the facts, as no one can say +when they start on a voyage in life what craft they +may fall aboard before they've done. It may be, +Harry, that as you intends to stick to the merchant +service—saving, of course, that little time you mean +to serve on board a king's ship—you may rise to be +a skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy, +that as a skipper you may fall in love with some taut +craft sailing in your convoy. I've seen such things +before now, and then the fact that you might be, for +aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of +being that of a boatswain, might score in your favor. +Women have curious notions, and though, for my +part, I can't see that it makes much difference where +the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and +well-built, there are those who thinks different.</p> + +<p>"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen +years ago that I was boatswain aboard the +<i>Alert</i> frigate, as taut a craft as ever sailed. We +had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd +want to see. We were cruising in the West<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[Pg 175]</a></span> +Indies, and had for months been, off and on, in +chase of a craft that had done much damage +there. She carried a black flag, and her skipper +was said to be the biggest villain that ever even +commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed +but some ship was missing. It mattered little +to him whether she sailed under the English, the +French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to him. +Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never +reached Europe. Sometimes a few charred timbers +would be thrown up on the shore of the islands, +showing that the ship to which they belonged had +been taken and burned before she had gone many +days on her way. Often and often had the pirate +been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in +itself a very unusual thing with pirates—indeed, I +never knew of one before. But she had been, I believe, +a merchantman captured by the pirate, and +was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her, +and handed his own schooner over to his mate. +Somehow or other he had altered her ballast, and +maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have +a rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are +so strong that they can, if need be, build a ship of +their own. Anyhow, she was the fastest ship of her +class that ever was seen on those seas, and though +our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she +laughed at them, and would for a whole day keep +just out of reach of their bow-chasers with half her +sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[Pg 176]</a></span> +every rag they could put on their masts. Then +when she was tired of that game she would hoist her +full canvas and leave the king's vessel behind as if +she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got +caught by cruisers coming up in different directions, +but each time she managed to slip away without ever +having a rope or stay started by a shot. We in the +<i>Alert</i> had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but +had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the +mere name of the <i>Seamew</i> was sufficient to put any +one of us into a passion. There wasn't one of the +ship's company, from the captain down to the +powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully +given a year's pay to get alongside the <i>Seamew</i>. +The <i>Alert</i> carried thirty-two guns, and our crew was +stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there +was a good deal of boat service, and it was considered +that at any moment 'Yellow Jack' might lay +a good many hands up—or down, as the case may +be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto +Rico, and the first lieutenant had strolled up with +two of the middies to the top of a hill just before the +sun went down. He had taken a glass with him. +Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck, +who was looking at the shore with a glass, +said to the second lieutenant, who was on watch:</p> + +<p>"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen +and Hobart down that hill as if he were running a +race. He isn't likely to be racing the middies. +What can he be after?'<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span></p> + +<p>"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile; +'Mr. Jones is hardly likely to be racing the middies'; +which, indeed, was true enough, for the first lieutenant +was as stiff as a ramrod—a good officer, but +as strict a martinet as ever I sailed under.</p> + +<p>"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw +that, whatever the reason might be, it was as the midshipman +had said. The news that Mr. Jones was +coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was +after him, soon spread, and there was quite an excitement +on the quarter-deck as to what could be +the matter.</p> + +<p>"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming +off to the ship, and it was evident, by the way +the spray was flying and the oars bending, that the +men were pulling as if for life or death. By this +time the news had spread through the ship, and the +captain himself was on the quarter-deck.</p> + +<p>"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as +the boat came within call he shouted, 'What's the +matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?'</p> + +<p>"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up +and making a trumpet with his two hands, 'two +craft together round the point of the island some +fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line, +but by their look I think that one is the <i>Seamew</i> +and the other a merchantman she has captured.'</p> + +<p>"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the +orders sharp and quick. The men, who were all +standing about, were in a minute clustering on the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span> +yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster +than it was on the <i>Alert</i> that evening. Before the +boat was fairly run up to the davits the anchor was +at the cat-head, and the <i>Alert's</i> bows were pointing +seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every +stitch of canvas set, we were running out of the harbor. +The first lieutenant had taken the bearings +pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk evening +breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By +this time it was dark, and we had every hope that +we might come upon the pirate before she had +finished transferring the cargo of her prize under +her own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as +the moon was not up we hoped to get within gunshot +before being seen, as the pirate, seeing no craft +within sight before the sun went down, would not +suspect that the <i>Alert</i> could be on his traces. We +had to sail close to the wind till we were round the +point of the island, and then to run nearly before it +towards the spot where the vessels had been seen. +In two hours from the time of starting we reckoned +that we must be getting close to them if they still +remained hove-to.</p> + +<p>"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point +or two off the starboard bow, a great flame shot up. +Every moment it grew and grew until we could see +a large ship in flames, while another lay about a +quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were +pulling from the ship in flames towards the other, +and as this was a bark we had no doubt that we had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[Pg 179]</a></span> +caught the <i>Seamew</i> at her villainous work. The +pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman, +so that while her spars stood out clear +and distinct against the glare of light we must have +been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly +forward for the men to go to quarters. Every gun +was double-shotted and run out, and then, all being +ready for the fight, the men stripped to their waists, +cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we +waited with breathless anxiety. We were already +within range of our bow-chasers, and as yet there +was no sign that the pirate was conscious of our +presence. The boats were now near him, and no +doubt those on board were looking rather in their +direction than to windward. Rapidly the <i>Alert</i> +tore through the water, the sail trimmers were all +ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's +notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck, +and the men stood by their guns with every eye +strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer we came, +and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were +within a mile now, when suddenly a great movement +was seen on board the pirate. The breeze was +steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command +could be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran +up the rattlins. It was clear we were seen. There +was no further need of concealment, and the captain +gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as +the pirate got her canvas spread—and I do think that +sharp as we had been on board the <i>Alert</i>, the <i>Sea<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[Pg 180]</a></span>mew</i> +was even quicker in getting under canvas—we +were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she +got fairly under way. Up to this moment not a +gun had spoken save the two bow-chasers, as the +captain would not yaw her until the last moment +Then round she came and poured a broadside into +the <i>Seamew</i>. Orders had been given to fire high, +and every man was on his mettle. The maintop-mast +of the <i>Seamew</i> fell, snapped at the cap; the +peak halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a +number of holes were drilled through her sails. A +loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as the <i>Seamew</i> +was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent +her getting away, and at last she was to show +whether she could fight as well as run, and I must +say for her she did.</p> + +<p>"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two, +but they were of far heavier metal, and after +ten minutes the <i>Alert</i> was as much bruised and battered +as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of +equal size for an hour. However, we had not been +idle, and as our shot had been principally directed +against the enemy's rigging, as our great object was +to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away, +she was by this time a mere wreck above, although +her sides were scarcely touched; whereas two of our +ports had been knocked into one, and some thirty of +our men had been struck down either by shot or by +splinters. Pouring a last broadside into her, the +captain ordered the <i>Alert</i> to be brought alongside<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[Pg 181]</a></span> +the <i>Seamew</i>. There was no need to call upon the +boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared, +and as the vessels came alongside our men rushed to +the assault. But the crew of the <i>Seamew</i> were as +eager to board us as we were them, and upon the +very bulwarks a desperate combat ensued. Strong +as we were, the <i>Seamew</i> carried fully as many hands, +and as they were fighting with halters round their +necks it's little wonder that they fought so well.</p> + +<p>"I've been in a good many fights, but never did +I see one like that. Each man hacked, and hewed, +and wielded his boarding-pike as if the whole fight +depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the +men whose places were at the guns on the starboard +side left their places and joined in the fight, while +those on the port side continued to pour a fire of +grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour +before we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and +then steadily and gradually we fought our way forward. +But it was another half-hour after the +pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and +fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered.</p> + +<p>"On board the <i>Alert</i> we had fully one-third of +our complement killed or wounded. Mr. Jones had +been shot through the head; the second and third +lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain +himself had had his jaw broken by a pistol fired +in his face. I got this scar on my cheek, which +spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[Pg 182]</a></span> +had been over thirty years married to the old woman +that made but little difference. Never were a crew +more glorious than we were that night. Even the +wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply purchased. +We had captured the scourge of these seas, +which had for ten years laughed at all the fastest +cruisers of our navy, and we felt as proud as if we +had captured a French first-rate.</p> + +<p>"All hands were at work next day in repairing +damages. I was up aloft seeing to the fitting of fresh +gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw something +floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed +to me like a box, and an empty one, for it floated +high on the water. Its lid seemed to be open, and I +thought once or twice that I saw something inside. +I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I +had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty +with his arm in a sling, was not disposed to take the +men off their work to lower a boat; but as I pointed +out that the box might have belonged to the merchantman +which had been burned overnight, and +that it might afford some clew as to the name of the +ship, he consented, and with four hands I was soon +rowing towards the box.</p> + +<p>"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I +was never more surprised than when, getting there, +I found that it was a trunk, and that in it, sitting +up, was a child about eighteen months old. That +was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were +a locket with a woman's likeness in it, a curious In<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span>dian +bangle, and a few other articles of jewelry. +How you got there we never knew, but the supposition +was that when the pirate was overhauling the +merchantman, and her true nature was ascertained, +some mother, knowing the fate that awaited all on +board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in +what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped +the trunk overboard, in hopes that it might drift +away and be picked up by some passing ship. It +was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against +its success, but the Lord had watched over it, and +there you were as snug and comfortable as if you +had been laying in your own cot, though, by the +way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens, +and I expect had missed your breakfast considerably. +You were sitting up, and it was lucky that you were +backward of your age, for, although by your size +we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still +unable to walk. If you had been as active as some +chaps of that age you would have scrambled onto +your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat.</p> + +<p>"Well, we brought you on board, and there was +a great talk as to what was to be done with you; but +as I was your discoverer I claimed you as a lawful +prize, and I thought you would amuse the old +woman while I was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort +to me when I got laid up in ordinary, as indeed you +have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every +inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship +which exactly answered to the description. You<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[Pg 184]</a></span> +see, beyond the fact that she was a square-rigged +ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments +found in the box seemed to show that she had +come from the East Indies, but of course that could +not be, for what would she be doing there? But at +any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and +who was no doubt your mother, had been to the East +Indies, or at least had been given those ornaments +by someone who had, for there was no doubt where +they were turned out.</p> + +<p>"Well, on board the <i>Alert</i> everyone got promoted. +There was enough valuable property found on board +the <i>Seamew</i> to give us a handsome sum all round, +and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled +me to buy this little cottage, and went no small way +towards paying for your schooling and board. As +no one else claimed you, and your friends could not +be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship; +and so, my boy, here you have been cruising +about the world as Harry Langley ever since."</p> + +<p>The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some +time before he spoke.</p> + +<p>"Well, dad, you may not have been my real +father, but no one could have been a better father to +me than you have, and as it isn't likely now that I +shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to +discover who I am, I shall continue to regard you as +my real father. Still, as you say, it may perhaps in +life be some advantage to me to be able to claim that +I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[Pg 185]</a></span> +They talked the matter over for some time, and then +Harry changed the subject.</p> + +<p>"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked.</p> + +<p>"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his +cable six months since, and his wife, poor old soul, +is gone to some friends near Winchester."</p> + +<p>"Who's living in the cottage?"</p> + +<p>"Black Jack has taken it."</p> + +<p>"What! has he moved from his old place, then?"</p> + +<p>"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy, +who comes down off and on. They say he's in the +smuggling business with Black Jack, and that he +disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over +in the <i>Lucy</i>, and that Jack trades over in France +with his friends. The lieutenant at the coast-guard +station has his eye upon him, and I believe that some +day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo; +but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day +for Hayling if they could do so, for he and his crew +do a lot of harm to the place. They look more like +men who have belonged to the <i>Seamew</i> I was talking +to you about than honest English fishermen."</p> + +<p>"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman +should be coming backwards and forwards here, +and I wonder that the revenue people don't inquire +into it."</p> + +<p>"I don't suppose that they know very much about +it, Harry. He comes off and on, generally arriving +at night, and leaving a few hours afterwards. I hear +about these things because everyone knows that old<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[Pg 186]</a></span> +Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into +other people's business. I don't like these goings +on, I must say, and consider they will end badly. +However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our +brandy cheap in Hayling—nowhere cheaper, I +should say—and that, after all, is the matter that +concerns us most. The wind's rising fast; I think +we're in for a gale."</p> + +<p>It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast +behind the island, the waves were breaking with a +short, sharp sound upon the beach, white heads were +beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing +craft were running in towards Portsmouth under +reefed sails, the men-of-war at Spithead could be +seen sending down their topmasts, and everything +betokened that it would be a nasty night.</p> + +<p>"What time must you leave, Harry?"</p> + +<p>"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall +cross the ferry, and catch the coach as it goes along +at eight. I promised that I would be back on the +following morning, and I would not fail in keeping +my appointment, for as the captain has been so good +I should be sorry that he should think that I had +broken my word."</p> + +<p>In the course of the day Harry went over to the +village and saw many of his boy friends. Bill +Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened to be +away, but his parents said that he would be back at +nine in the evening. He had gone over to Winchester +to see a brother who was in a regiment quar<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[Pg 187]</a></span>tered +there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock +Harry said to his father that he would just walk +over to have a chat with his friend, and be back in +an hour or so.</p> + +<p>"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at +once," Jane Langley said; "if thou hast to start at +three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed now."</p> + +<p>"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said, +laughing, "and I shall be able to sleep long to-morrow."</p> + +<p>Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple, +and went off at a run into the darkness.</p> + +<p>The road was a wide one, and but little frequented, +and the grass grew thick over a considerable +portion of the sides, therefore as he ran along with +a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was +deadened. As he came along by the cottage of +which he had been speaking to Peter Langley he +heard the sound of voices within. Being curious to +see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry +paused, lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered +the little garden. He had intended to peep in +at the window, and having satisfied his curiosity to +be off; but just as he reached the door the latter +opened suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw +back behind the little porch before two men came +out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the +smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting +English evidently the foreigner. They stopped for +a moment, looking out into the night.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be +a storm, and no mistake. The <i>Lucy</i> is a tight craft, +and has weathered gales when many a bigger ship +has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into +it without necessity."</p> + +<p>"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have +sought zat ze earning of five hundred pounds was as +urgent a necezity as was wanted."</p> + +<p>"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the +smuggler said, "though one does put one's head +into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is +bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important."</p> + +<p>"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter +about ze nooze? It hasn't got over your zick +neck or my zin one, and till it does we needn't trouble +about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch +we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand +zey cannot grudge us double pay. I have ridden +from London wizout stopping, and have killed a +horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat +matters not. Zis letter should fetch us ze money to +pay for a dozen horses and a dozen of your <i>Lucys</i>."</p> + +<p>"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we +will be off. Letters like that in your pocket are best +not kept on hand. You are sure that the <i>Chasse +Marée</i> will put out to meet us in such weather as we +are likely to have?"</p> + +<p>"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the +Frenchman said. "Zey know ze importance of ze<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span> +news, which is expected, and which I am bringing +zem. <i>Mon Dieu!</i> what sums have been paid to get +ze news zat's in zis little dispatch!"</p> + +<p>"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said.</p> + +<p>"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but +I believe it is ze orders zat are to be sent to ze +British fleet, and zat zey are about to strike a great +blow zomewhere."</p> + +<p>"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and +tell the boys. I warned them to be in readiness, and +I will send them straight down to the beach. In a +quarter of an hour I will return for you."</p> + +<p>While this conversation had been going on Harry +had been standing against the porch, the sides of +which were filled with latticework over which a +creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance +of the secret that he was hearing, and had +been rapidly meditating in his mind how this all-portant +information which was about to be conveyed +to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up +his mind that the instant the smuggler moved out +he would make his way down to the village, tell the +tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman +seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult, +for the smuggler and his gang were not men to be +attacked with impunity, and the fishers of the village +would hesitate in taking part in such a struggle +merely on the information of a boy. However, +Harry saw that it was the only chance.</p> + +<p>In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span> +hide himself from the view of the two men who were +standing on the little garden-path in front, he +pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was +rotten with age, and suddenly with a crash it gave +way.</p> + +<p>With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he +and the Frenchman dashed to the spot, and in an +instant had collared the lad. In a moment he was +dragged into the room.</p> + +<p>"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler +said, with a terrible imprecation. "The scoundrel +has heard what we've said, and our lives won't +be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free. +Stand by and I'll knock out his brains;" and he +seized a heavy poker from the side of the hearth.</p> + +<p>"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have +blood. Zere might be inquiries, and zese sings will +sometimes be found. Better take him to sea wis +you in ze <i>Lucy</i>, and hand him over to ze <i>Chasse +Marée</i>. Zey will take care zat he does not come +back again."</p> + +<p>"I will take care myself," the smuggler said. +"I'm not going to risk my neck on the chance of his +blabbing. It's better, as you say, to have no blood, +but as soon as the <i>Lucy's</i> at sea overboard he goes."</p> + +<p>"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm +wis you zat he must be silenced, but it may be better—my +plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I suppose, +to ze village?"</p> + +<p>"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span> +He's the son of an old man-of-war's man who lives +half a mile away."</p> + +<p>"Well, you see, some of your men might some +day, if they quarreled wis you, or in zeir drink, drop +some words which might lead to inquiries. Better +put him on board ze <i>Chasse Marée</i>. I will see ze +matter is settled."</p> + +<p>Harry had spoken no word from the time he was +grasped. He felt in an instant that his life was forfeited, +and was surprised that he had not been instantly +killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo, +for he knew that no cottagers were near, and was +sure that an attempt to give the alarm would insure +his instant death. To struggle would have been +useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad, +was but a child in the grasp of a powerful man like +the smuggler. He saw, too, that on the instant the +Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and +though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the +tone of his voice that he was as determined as his +colleague that his silence should be secured by death.</p> + +<p>In another minute he was bound and thrown into +a corner. The Frenchman then took his seat near +him, assuring him in a low tone that he would at his +first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The +smuggler strolled off to summon his crew, and for a +quarter of an hour silence reigned in the cottage.</p> + +<p>"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last, +as if he had been thinking the matter over—"one +meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[Pg 192]</a></span> +people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want +to kill you, but what are we to do? You make us +kill you. You push your own head into ze trap. +Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling +in affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze +trouble to kill zem. I would give a hundred pounds +if zis had not happened; but what can I do? It is +my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to +have to do it—<i>parbleu!</i> my life is of much more +value zan zat of a fishing boy. Bah! you are one +meddlesome fool."</p> + +<p>So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble +which the prying of this lad had brought upon him +that he got up and angrily gave him a kick. A few +minutes later the smuggler returned.</p> + +<p>"The men have all gone down to the boat," he +said briefly. "Come along, mounseer. Bring that +tin case with you, and those pistols."</p> + +<p>"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the +Frenchman said. "As to ze pistols—zey are not of +much use. However, I will take zem;" and he +thrust them into the pockets of his coat.</p> + +<p>The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw +him onto a sail which he had laid on the ground, +wrapped this round him, and then cast him over his +shoulder.</p> + +<p>"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the +boat," he said, "but should I do so I'm taking the +mainsail of the <i>Lucy</i> down to her."</p> + +<p>In another minute Harry heard the door slam,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span> +and then he felt himself being carried steadily along, +his weight being as nothing to the smuggler. Not +a word was spoken between the two men on their +way down to the shore. Presently Harry felt by +the deadened sound of the footsteps, and by the more +uneven motion, that he was being carried over the +sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and +through the canvas he could hear the loud roar of +the waves, which were now breaking violently.</p> + +<p>Presently he was flung roughly down on the +sands. A minute later he was lifted by the head and +feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was +spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers, +and after ten minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock, +and knew that they were alongside of the <i>Lucy</i>. He +was hauled up on deck. He heard a few words of +command, and then felt the vessel was on her way. +A minute or two later the covering was unloosed. +His cords were cut, and the smuggler said to him, +"You can't get away now, and may as well make +yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that +rope."</p> + +<p>The <i>Lucy</i> was, in fact, short-handed, two of the +six men who composed her crew being absent. +She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons' burden, +built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but +longer and lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing +when her crew were not engaged upon other adventures. +She was a remarkably fast craft, and had +more than once showed her heels with success when<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span> +chased by the revenue cutters. She owed her immunity +from capture, however, chiefly to her appearance, +as from her size and build she generally +passed unsuspected as an innocent fisherman.</p> + +<p>The storm increased in violence, and the little +lugger, although a good sea-boat, had difficulty in +making her way almost in the teeth of the gale. She +was bound, Harry gained from a word or two +dropped by the captain, for the mouth of the Loire, +off which she was to be met by the <i>Chasse Marée</i>. +Long before morning the coast of England was out +of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel +bravely holding her way in the sou'westerly gale.</p> + +<p>"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman +asked the smuggler.</p> + +<p>"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the +wind holds as at present. Two o'clock in the morning +is the time named, and if your people are as +punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will +be gained. There's one thing—in such a gale as is +blowing to-day none of our cruisers who may be off +the coast are likely to trouble themselves about a +boat like ours. They may wonder what we are +doing at sea, but are scarcely likely to chase us."</p> + +<p>Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels +were seen in the distance, which Harry knew, +by the cut of their sails, to be English cruisers. All +were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas, +and Harry knew that any assistance from them was +out of the question. Towards evening the gale<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[Pg 195]</a></span> +moderated, but the sea was still very high. During +the day Harry had turned over in his mind every +possible plan by which he might destroy the tin case +which contained, as he knew, such important documents. +From what he had gathered he learned that +the success of some great undertaking upon which +the British fleet were about to embark would be +marred if these papers were to find their way into +the hands of the French authorities. His own life +he regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure +that no sooner was he fairly on board the French +<i>Chasse Marée</i> than he would, at the orders of the +French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life +had been so preserved, not from any feeling of +mercy, but in order that his death might be accomplished +with less risk to those whose safety demanded +it.</p> + +<p>He was determined, if opportunity presented, +to seize the little case and to leap overboard with +it. The French spy never for one moment put it +down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the +top, and some eight inches long by three inches wide, +and the same deep. Sometimes the Frenchman put +it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but even +then he took the precaution always to keep his hand +upon it. During the day Harry was constantly employed +in work on board the lugger, hauling at ropes +and acting as if he were one of the regular crew. +He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond +a curse now and then not a word had been addressed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[Pg 196]</a></span> +to him by any on board. The night came on; the +wind was still going down, but the sea was very +heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the +stars could be seen shining brightly, and once or +twice the moon broke through and spread a light +over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler +became anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead.</p> + +<p>"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the +Frenchman, "and we are nearly off the mouth of +the river. When the moon shone out just now I +thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and +I believe to windward an English cruiser is lying. +However, I will get ready the lanterns."</p> + +<p>The next time the moon came out a vessel was +clearly seen. The smuggler raised the lantern above +the bulwarks, held it there for half a minute, and +then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A +moment later a similar signal was made on the bows +of the vessel.</p> + +<p>"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly, +"and the five hundred pounds is as good as in my +pocket!"</p> + +<p>As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward.</p> + +<p>"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser +has caught sight of the Frenchman. However, we +shall be on board in plenty of time, and whether she +gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me. +I shall have done my part of the work, and you, +mounseer, will give me the order for payment on +London."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[Pg 197]</a></span></p> + +<p>"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said; +"you've done your work well. Here's the order."</p> + +<p>By this time the French craft was within a distance +of a quarter of a mile, running down at a great +pace under her reefed sails.</p> + +<p>"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the +smuggler said, "for the sea is running tremendously. +They will have to throw a rope, and you will have +to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose +your dispatch-box is water-tight?"</p> + +<p>"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked.</p> + +<p>"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler +said, "and you can haul him on board too. It won't +make much matter whether I slip the noose round +his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest +plan perhaps, for then, if he happens not to be alive +when you pull him out, it would be an accident; and +even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't swear +that it was purposely done."</p> + +<p>Harry was standing near, and heard the words. +He was close to the helm at the time, and watched +with intense anxiety as the <i>Chasse Marée</i> ran rapidly +down to them. It was clear that what had to be +done must be done quickly, for another flash came +up from the cruiser; and although in the din of the +wind and the toss of the waves it could not be seen +where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash +showed that she had come up since the last shot was +discharged. The <i>Chasse Marée</i> ran down, and as +she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span> +shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady, +and as I run past I will throw a rope."</p> + +<p>"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are +two to come on board."</p> + +<p>The course taken by the <i>Chasse Marée</i> would +bring her along at a distance of some ten yards from +the side of the lugger. At the moment a squall +came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards +the approaching craft. When she was just upon +them Harry saw that his one chance of escape had +come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at +the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard. +The lugger paid off instantly. Black Jack, with an +oath, turned round and sprang at Harry. The lad +leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the +Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him, +and snatching the tin box from his hand leaped overboard.</p> + +<p>Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it +had been sufficient. The vessel had paid off from +the wind, and before the helmsman could regain his +feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay +across the course of the <i>Chasse Marée</i>; and in another +moment the French craft plunged down upon +her, and with a crash the <i>Lucy</i> sank under her bows, +and went down with all on board.</p> + +<p>As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a +shout of dismay from those on board the <i>Lucy</i>. +When he came up a minute later he saw the <i>Chasse +Marée</i> plowing her way from him, but no sign of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[Pg 199]</a></span> +<i>Lucy</i> was to be seen. Harry was a good swimmer, +and fortunately the dispatch-box which he grasped +was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket +he felt that it kept his head easily above the water. +He swam as well as he could away from the spot +where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew that +if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being +run down and should see him, his death was certain—not +indeed that his chances were in any case good, +but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he clung +to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as +possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he +must have speedily succumbed, for in so heavy a sea +it was difficult in the extreme to swim. However, +after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and +suffered himself quietly to drift.</p> + +<p>Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense +delight, morning began to break. He saw on his +right the low shores of the French coast, and looking +round beheld seaward the British cruiser which +had fired at the <i>Chasse Marée</i>. She was running +quietly along the coast, and was evidently on guard +at the mouth of the river. The sea had now gone +down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost +cloudless sky.</p> + +<p>Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at +once swam towards her. She was farther out by a +mile than the spot where he was swimming, and was +some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but +slowly, and he hoped that by the time she came along<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span> +he would be able to get within a distance whence he +might be seen. His fear was that she might run +back before she reached the spot where she would be +nearer to him.</p> + +<p>With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping +his eye fixed steadily on the ship. Still she came +onward, and was within half a mile when she was +abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he +could from the water, he shouted at the top of his +voice. Again and again he splashed with his hands +to make as much spray and commotion as possible in +order to attract attention. His heart almost stood +still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a +moment later he saw the vessel come round into the +wind, and lay there with her sails back. Then a +boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was +hauled in, his senses almost leaving him now that +the time for exertion had passed. It was not until +he had been lifted onto the deck of the <i>Viper</i>, and +brandy had been poured down his throat, that he +was able to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently +recovered he was sent for to the captain's cabin.</p> + +<p>"And who are you, boy, and whence do you +come?" the captain asked. "Do you belong to the +<i>Chasse Marée</i>, which we chased in the night?"</p> + +<p>The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry +had fallen overboard from that craft.</p> + +<p>"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped +from a lugger which was run down by the French +craft just as you were firing at her."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my +eyes had not been wrong. I was sure that I saw a +small fishing-boat close to the <i>Chasse Marée</i>. We +lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon, +and thought we must have been mistaken. How +came you there in an English fishing-boat?"</p> + +<p>Harry modestly told the story, and produced the +dispatch-box.</p> + +<p>"This is important news indeed," the officer said, +"and your conduct has been in every way most gallant. +What is your name, lad?"</p> + +<p>"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice +on board the Indiaman <i>Dundas Castle</i>, and was +to have sailed this week in the convoy for the West +Indies."</p> + +<p>"You will not be able to do that now," the captain +said. "This is most important. However, +the steward will take charge of you, and I will talk +to you again presently."</p> + +<p>The steward was called, and was told to put Harry +into a cot slung for him, and to give him a bowl of +warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad was asleep.</p> + +<p>The <i>Viper</i> shortly afterwards hauled her wind, +and ran down to a consort who was keeping watch +with her over the mouth of the Loire. The captain +repaired on board the other ship, whose commander +was his senior officer, and a consultation was held +between them, after which the <i>Viper</i> was again got +under sail and shaped her course for Portsmouth.</p> + +<p>The wind was fair, and the next morning the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span> +<i>Viper</i> passed through the Needles, and soon afterwards +anchored at Spithead. Here a large number +of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and +above two of the largest floated the flags of admirals. +The <i>Viper</i> had made her signal as she came in sight +of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up from +the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain +to come on board immediately the anchor was +dropped. The moment this was done the captain's +gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him +the captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and +rowed for the admiral's ship. Directing the lad to +remain on deck, the captain at once entered the admiral's +cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's +orderly summoned Harry to enter.</p> + +<p>Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a +breakfast party, for a number of naval officers, including +Admiral Nelson and most of the captains of +the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The +admiral turned to Harry.</p> + +<p>"So you are the lad who has brought this box of +dispatches?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly.</p> + +<p>"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said. +"It's a strange one."</p> + +<p>Harry again repeated the account of his adventures +from the time of leaving his father's cottage. +When he had done Admiral Nelson exclaimed:</p> + +<p>"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted +with more presence of mind had you been a captain<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span> +of the fleet. You showed great bravery and did +your duty nobly."</p> + +<p>"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said +modestly, "for I knew that they were going to kill +me anyhow, so that it made no difference. But I +was determined, if possible, that the dispatches +should be destroyed."</p> + +<p>The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to +hear his dicta even so slightly questioned by a +lad.</p> + +<p>"You are an apprentice in the merchant service, +Captain Skinner tells me," Sir Hyde Parker said, +"and have been two years at sea."</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir," Harry said.</p> + +<p>"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one +of his majesty's vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?"</p> + +<p>Harry's eyes glistened at the question.</p> + +<p>"I should indeed, sir," he said.</p> + +<p>"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered. +"Have any of you gentlemen a vacancy +in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him +ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship."</p> + +<p>"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of +the captains said. "Poor little De Lisle fell overboard +the night before last as we came round from +Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and +I'll arrange for him to have his togs. I like his +look, and I should be glad to have him with me. I +am sure he will be a credit to the service."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[Pg 204]</a></span></p> + +<p>"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You +are now, sir," he said, turning to Harry again, "an +officer in his majesty's service, and, as Captain Ball +remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service. +A lad who does his duty when death is staring him +in the face, and without a hope that the act of devotion +will ever be known or recognized, is sure to +make a brave and worthy officer."</p> + +<p>Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece +of paper, and said to the admiral's servant, "Will +you tell the midshipman of my gig to come here?"</p> + +<p>A minute afterwards the midshipman entered. +The captain gave him the slip of paper and said, +"Take this young gentleman on board the ship with +you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and +with him give this note. He will be your shipmate +in future. See that he's made comfortable."</p> + +<p>The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow +him, gazing askance, and with no slight astonishment +in his face, at the appearance of his new +messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance +with the received ideas of that of a midshipman +freshly joining a ship. His clothes were +all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his +trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves. +Without a word the midshipman took his place in +the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to sit beside +him.</p> + +<p>"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly.</p> + +<p>"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[Pg 205]</a></span> +with a laugh. "Before that from his majesty's +ship <i>Viper</i>, and before that from the sea."</p> + +<p>"You look like the sea," said the midshipman. +"But what have you been doing? Have you served +before?"</p> + +<p>"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only +just been appointed."</p> + +<p>The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's +appearance to question him further. He felt that +there was some mystery in the affair, and that it +would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing +upon which Harry was placed. He had little +doubt from the fact of his appointment being made +under such circumstances that there must be something +at once singular and noteworthy about it.</p> + +<p>Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at +once led him up to the first lieutenant, and presented +the captain's note. The lieutenant opened it and +glanced at the contents. They were brief:</p> + +<p>"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman +on board the <i>Cæsar</i>, and has been promoted by Sir +Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most +gallant action, and one of the greatest importance. +Make him at home at once, and let him have poor +De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about it."</p> + +<p>The senior midshipman was at once sent for by +Mr. Francis, and Harry handed over to him. The +first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the contents +of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to +make him as comfortable as possible.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span></p> + +<p>Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival +was greeted with a storm of questions, as his +appearance on the quarter-deck had naturally excited +a great deal of observation. The midshipman who +had come with him could, of course, furnish no information, +and beyond the brief fact mentioned by +the captain and repeated by the first lieutenant, his +new conductor could say no more.</p> + +<p>"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got +into his new clothes and looks presentable. He's in +my charge, and I am to make him comfortable. As +he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde +himself you may be sure he has done something out +of the way."</p> + +<p>In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full +midshipman's dress, and being a very good-looking +and gentlemanly lad, his appearance favorably impressed +his new messmates, who had at first been disposed +to resent the intrusion among themselves of a +youngster whose appearance was at least the reverse +of reputable.</p> + +<p>"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting +will resolve itself into a committee. Let everyone +who can, sit down; and let those who can't, +stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now, +prisoner at the bar," he said, "what is your +name?"</p> + +<p>"Harry Langley."</p> + +<p>"And how came you here?"</p> + +<p>"I was brought in the captain's gig."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span></p> + +<p>"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what +brought you onto the quarter-deck?"</p> + +<p>"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent +a very important dispatch falling into the hands of +the French."</p> + +<p>"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and +how was that? That is to say," he said, "if there's +no secret about it?"</p> + +<p>"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very +simple;" and for the second time that morning he +told the story.</p> + +<p>When he had done there was a general exclamation +of approval among those present, and the midshipmen +crowded round him, shaking his hand, patting +him on the back, and declaring that he was a +trump.</p> + +<p>"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said, +"and is received as a worthy member of this noble +body. Boy!"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir."</p> + +<p>"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two +bottles of rum for this honorable mess to drink the +health of a new comrade."</p> + +<p>Presently the boy returned.</p> + +<p>"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the +rum?"</p> + +<p>There was a roar of laughter among the middies, +for the master's mate, who had acted as president, +was notoriously in the purser's books to the full +amount of his credit. However, a midshipman,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[Pg 208]</a></span> +who happened that morning to have received a remittance, +undertook to stand the liquor to the mess, +and Harry's health was drunk with all honors.</p> + +<p>"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that +the contents of the dispatch were with reference to +the point to which we are all bound. I wonder +where it can be?"</p> + +<p>Here an animated discussion arose as to the various +points against which the attack of the fleet, now +rapidly assembling at Spithead, might be directed. +So far no whisper of its probable course had been +made public, and it was believed indeed that even the +captains of the fleet were ignorant of its object.</p> + +<p>Upon the following day Harry at once obtained +leave to go on shore for twenty-four hours. Immediately +he reached the Head he chartered a +wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he +heard a well-known voice among a group of sailors +standing near him.</p> + +<p>"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley +said. "My boy left me merely to go down to the +village, and was to have returned the first thing in +the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he +never came back no more. What he did with himself, +unless he sailed in a smuggling lugger which +put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make out. +The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly, +and I can see no reason why he should have +gone otherwise. He didn't cross the ferry, and I +can't help suspecting there was some foul play.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[Pg 209]</a></span> +When Black Jack returns I will have it out of him +if I kill him for it. He has a strong party there, and +I want half a dozen good tight hands to come with +me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a +couple of days, and if we tackle him directly he +lands we may find out something about him. Who +will go with me?"</p> + +<p>Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were +willing to assist their old mate, when suddenly Harry +stepped in among them, saying, "There's no occasion +for that. I can tell them all about him."</p> + +<p>Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment, +and stared open-mouthed at Harry.</p> + +<p>"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it +isn't Harry himself, and in a midshipman's rig. +What means this, my boy?"</p> + +<p>"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on +board his majesty's ship <i>Cæsar</i>."</p> + +<p>Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with +astonishment, and then threw his tarpaulin high in +the air with a shout of delight. It fell into the +water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no +further thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung +it with enthusiastic delight.</p> + +<p>"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To +think of seeing you on the quarter-deck, and that so +soon!"</p> + +<p>It was some minutes before Harry could shake +himself free from his friends, all of whom were old +chums of the boatswain, and had known him in his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[Pg 210]</a></span> +childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him +to a quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment +of the veteran, he related to him the circumstances +which had led to his elevation. The old +sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration, +and it was only the consideration that beyond +doubt Black Jack and the Frenchman had both perished +in the <i>Lucy</i> that restrained him from instantly +rushing off to take vengeance upon them.</p> + +<p>An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed +to Hayling, where the joy of Peter was rivaled by +that of Harry's foster-mother. That evening Peter +went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the +seafaring population in honor of the event that the +village was a scene of rejoicing and festivity such +as was unknown in its quiet annals.</p> + +<p>The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and +commenced his regular duties as a midshipman on +board.</p> + +<p>A week later the whole of the ships destined to +take part in it had arrived. The "Blue Peter" was +hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun firing from +the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and +the fleet soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted +of eighteen sail of the line, with a number of +frigates and gunboats. The expedition was commanded +by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson +second in command. Contrary to the general expedition +they sailed eastward instead of passing +through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[Pg 211]</a></span> +England, passed through the Straits of Dover and +stood out into the North Sea.</p> + +<p>Harry had had an interview with his captain four +days after he had joined. The latter told him that +the dispatch-box which he had taken had been sent +up to London, and that its contents proved to be of +the highest importance, and that the Lords of the +Admiralty had themselves written to the admiral +expressing their extreme satisfaction at the capture, +saying that the whole of their plans would have been +disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of +the enemy. They were pleased to express their +strong approval of the conduct of Harry Langley, +and gave their assurance that when the time came +his claim for promotion should not be ignored.</p> + +<p>"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure +that when you have passed your cadetship you will +get your epaulette without loss of time, and if you +are steady and well conducted you may look out for +a brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter +the navy under such favorable conditions. I should +advise you to study hard in order to fit yourself for +command when the time should come. From what +you tell me your education has not been neglected, +and I have no doubt you know as much as the majority +of my midshipmen as to books. But books +are not all. An officer in his majesty's service +should be a gentleman. That you are that in manner, +I am happy to see. But it is desirable also that +an officer should be able in all society to hold his own<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span> +in point of general knowledge with other gentlemen. +Midshipmen, as a class, are too much given to +shirking their studies, and to think that if an officer +can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required. +It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you +will find that the men who have most made their +mark are all something more than rough sailors. +I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at +all times and hazards doing your duty. That is a +lesson that you have clearly already learned."</p> + +<p>As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose +higher and higher as to the object of the expedition. +Some supposed that a dash was to be made on +Holland. Others conceived that the object of the +expedition must be one of the North German or +Russian forts, and the latter were confirmed in their +ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found +to be entering the Sound. Instead of passing +through, however, the fleet anchored here, out of +gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great was +the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the +fleet when it became known that an ultimatum had +been sent on shore, and that the Danes (who had +been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon +at once to surrender their fleet to the English.</p> + +<p>Upon the face of facts known to the world at large, +this was indeed a most monstrous breach of justice +and right. The Danes had taken no part in the +great struggle which had been going on, and their +sympathies were generally supposed to be with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span> +English rather than the French. Thus, for a fleet +to appear before the capital of Denmark, and to summon +its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed +act of brute force.</p> + +<p>In fact, however, the English government had +learned that negotiations had been proceeding between +the Danish government and the French; and +that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which +the Danes should join the French at a given moment, +and the united fleets being augmented by ships of +other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon +England. Had this secret confederation not been +interfered with, the position of England would have +been seriously threatened. The fleet which the allies +would have been able to put onto the scene would +have greatly exceeded that which England could +have mustered to defend her coast, and although +peace nominally prevailed between England and +Denmark the English ministry considered itself +justified—and posterity has agreed in the verdict—in +taking time by the forelock, and striking a blow +before their seeming ally had time to throw off the +mask and to join in the projected attack upon them.</p> + +<p>It was the news of this secret resolve on the part +of the cabinet that, having in some way been obtained +by a heavy bribe from a subordinate in the +admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to +France in the <i>Lucy</i>, and had it reached its destination +the Danes would have been warned in time, and +the enterprise undertaken by Parker and Nelson<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[Pg 214]</a></span> +would have been impossible, for the forts of Copenhagen, +aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too +strong to have been attacked had they been thoroughly +prepared for the strife. As all these matters +were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was +the astonishment when the captains of the ships +assembled in the admiral's cabin, and each received +orders as to the position which his vessel was to take +up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This +being settled, the captains returned to their respective +ships.</p> + +<p>Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the +Danes finally refused compliance with the English +demands the long-looked-for signal was hoisted and +the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine +sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve +line-of-battle ships and a number of frigates under +Admiral Nelson, steered on through the Sound, followed +at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker with +the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound +cannonaded them, but their fire was very ineffectual, +and the fleet without replying steered on until they +had attained the position intended for them. The +Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of +thirteen men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported +by floating batteries mounting seventy heavy +guns, was moored in a line four miles long in front +of the town, and was further supported by the forts +on shore.</p> + +<p>This great force was to be engaged by the squad<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[Pg 215]</a></span>ron +of Admiral Nelson alone, as that of Sir Hyde +Parker remained outside menacing the formidable +Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding +their fire to that of the fleet and other shore batteries +upon Nelson's squadron.</p> + +<p>The <i>Cæsar</i>, the leading ship of the fleet, had been +directed to sail right past the line of ships and to +operate against a detached fort standing on a spit of +land on the right flank of the Danish position. This +fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of +the Cæsar in weight, but the crew were in high spirits +at the prospect of a fight, little as they understood +the cause for which they were engaged. Stripping +to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer +at his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen, +being upon the quarter-deck near the captain to carry +orders from him as might be required to different +parts of the ship. As the <i>Cæsar</i> passed along the +line of ships to take up her position she was saluted +by a storm of fire from the Danish vessels, to which +she made no reply. She suffered, however, but +little injury, although shot and shell whistled between +the masts and struck the water on all sides of +her, several striking the hull with a dull, crashing +sound, while her sails were pierced with holes. +Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was disgusted +with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he +experienced. But there is nothing that tries the +nerves more than standing the fire of an enemy before +it is time to set to work to reply. As soon as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[Pg 216]</a></span> +orders were given for the <i>Cæsar's</i> fire to be opened, +directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the +roar of her cannon answered those of the fort, the +feeling of uneasiness on Harry's part disappeared, +and was succeeded by that of the excitement of +battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole +line the British fleet was engaged, and the boom of +the heavy guns of the ships, forts, and batteries, and +the rattle of musketry from the tops of the +ships, kept up a deep roar like that of incessant +thunder.</p> + +<p>"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant +reported to the captain. "There are but two +fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is dropping +so much that we have scarcely steerage-way, +and the current is sweeping us along fast."</p> + +<p>"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain +said.</p> + +<p>He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was +a slight shivering sensation in the ship, and it was +known by all on board that she was aground, and +that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were +kept at work the men were called off from those of +the port side, boats were lowered and hawsers were +got out, and every effort was made to tow the ship +off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of +the storm of shot and shell which fell round them +from the fort and the nearest Danish ships. But the +<i>Cæsar</i> was fast. Calling the men on board again, +the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[Pg 217]</a></span> +and see what was going on in other parts of the line. +He returned with the news that four or five other +ships were plainly aground, and that things appeared +to be going badly. In the meantime the <i>Cæsar</i> was +suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well +directed, and the gunners, working their pieces under +comparative shelter, were able to pour their fire +steadily into the <i>Cæsar</i>, while a floating battery and +two frigates also kept up an incessant fire.</p> + +<p>The number of killed and wounded was already +large, but as only the guns of the starboard side +could be worked the fire was kept up with unabated +zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of +the fire. The parapet was in many places shot away +and several of the guns put out of action. But the +<i>Cæsar</i> was clearly overmatched, and the captain +hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the +ship was aground and was altogether overmatched, +and begging that another vessel might be dispatched +to his aid, if one could be spared, in order to partially +relieve her of the enemy's fire.</p> + +<p>"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to +the flagship instantly."</p> + +<p>Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot +and shell which was flying, striking up the water +in all directions, he made his way to the admirals +ship, which was lying nearly a mile away.</p> + +<p>Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it +through.</p> + +<p>"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[Pg 218]</a></span> +ship to spare. Several are aground, and all hard +pressed. He must do the best he can. Ah! you +are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin, +are you not?"</p> + +<p>"Yes, sir."</p> + +<p>The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and +Harry prepared to leave. Suddenly a thought +struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he +asked the steward for a small tablecloth.</p> + +<p>"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed.</p> + +<p>"Never mind. Give it me at once."</p> + +<p>Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat. +As they returned towards the <i>Cæsar</i> they could see +how hardly matters were going with her. One of +her masts was down. Her sides were battered and +torn, and several of her port-holes were knocked into +one. Still her fire continued unabated, but it was +clear that she could not much longer resist.</p> + +<p>"Do you think she must haul down her flag?" +Harry said to the coxswain of the boat.</p> + +<p>"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and +iron can't stand such a pounding as that much +longer. Most captains would have hauled down the +flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand +out much longer. There won't be a man alive to +fight her."</p> + +<p>"Will you do as I order?" Harry said.</p> + +<p>"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will +do what you like;" for the story of the conduct by<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[Pg 219]</a></span> +which Harry had gained his midshipman's promotion +had been repeated through the ship, and the men +were all proud of the lad who had behaved so +pluckily.</p> + +<p>"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it +can't do harm. Where's the boat-hook? Fasten +this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort."</p> + +<p>The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise, +but did as Harry told him, and with the white flag +flying the boat pulled straight towards the fort. As +he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had +been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the +duel between the battery and the <i>Cæsar</i> continued +with unabated vigor. Harry steered direct to the +steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of +the fort, where, on saying that he brought a message +from the captain, he was at once conducted to the +commandant.</p> + +<p>"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain +to beg of you to surrender at once. Your guns have +been nobly fought, but two more ships are coming +down to engage with you, and the captain would +fain save further effusion of life. You have done all +that brave men could do, but the fight everywhere +goes against you, and further resistance is vain. In +a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your +guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain +therefore begs you to spare the brave men under your +orders from further sacrifice."</p> + +<p>Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[Pg 220]</a></span> +was fortunately at the moment backed up by two +ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken no +part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor, +after a hasty consultation with his officers, resolved +to surrender, and two minutes afterwards the Danish +flag was hauled down in the fort and the white flag +run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to +return with Harry to the ship to notify the captain +of the surrender of the fort.</p> + +<p>The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the +course of his boat suddenly altered, a white flag +hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct to the fort, +had been extreme, and he could only suppose that +Harry had received some orders direct from the +admiral and that a general cessation of hostilities +was ordered. His surprise became astonishment +when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white +flag hoisted in its place; and a shout of relief and +exultation echoed from stem to stern of the <i>Cæsar</i>, +for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless and that +in a few minutes the <i>Cæsar</i> must strike her flag. +All sorts of conjectures were rife as to the sudden +and unexpected surrender of the fort, and expectation +was at its highest when the gig was seen rowing +out again with a Danish officer by the side of the +midshipman.</p> + +<p>On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the +ladder with the Danish officer, and advancing to +Captain Ball said:</p> + +<p>"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[Pg 221]</a></span> +summons which I took to the commander of the fort +in your name, come off to surrender."</p> + +<p>The Danish officer advanced and handed his +sword to the captain, saying:</p> + +<p>"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender."</p> + +<p>The captain handed him back his sword, and +ordering Harry to follow him at once entered his +cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the +latter informed him what he had done, with many +apologies for having taken the matter into his own +hands.</p> + +<p>"I saw," he said, "that the <i>Cæsar</i> was being +knocked to pieces, and the coxswain told me that it +was impossible she could much longer resist. I +therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling +upon the governor to surrender, and that it was possible +that I might succeed, as you see that I +have."</p> + +<p>"You certainly have saved the <i>Cæsar</i>," Captain +Ball said warmly, "and we are all indeed indebted +to you. It was a piece of astounding impudence +indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with +which his captain had not charged him; but success +in the present case a thousand times condones the +offense. You have indeed done well, young sir, and +I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you. +I will report the matter to the admiral."</p> + +<p>A hundred men speedily took their places in the +boats. Lieutenant Francis was sent ashore to take<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span> +possession, and a few minutes later the British flag +was flying upon the fort.</p> + +<p>Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball +at once took his place in his gig and rowed to the +flagship. The battle was still raging, and to the +practiced eye there was no doubt that the English +fleet was suffering very severely. Captain Ball +mounted the quarter-deck, and saluting the admiral +reported that the fort with which he was engaged +had struck, but that the <i>Cæsar</i> being aground was +unable to render any assistance to the general attack.</p> + +<p>"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral +Nelson said, "but I congratulate you on having +caused the fort to haul down its colors. Several of +the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot +take possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came +off from shore, and their fire has reopened. Our +position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker has +signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no +attention. I fear that we shall have to haul off and +leave some four or five ships to the enemy."</p> + +<p>"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who +made the fort haul down its flag, but this midshipman +of mine."</p> + +<p>"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who, +at Captain Ball's order, had left the boat and was +standing a short distance off. "How on earth did +he do that?"</p> + +<p>"When you told him, sir, that you could give us +no aid he took upon himself, instead of returning to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[Pg 223]</a></span> +the ship, to row straight to the fort with one of your +tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and summoned +the commander in my name to surrender at +once so as to save all further effusion of life, seeing +that more ships were bearing down and that he had +done all that a brave man could, and should now +think of the lives of his troops."</p> + +<p>"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed. +"Midshipmen were impudent enough in +my days, but this boy beats everything. However, +his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I +will adopt it myself. A man should never be above +learning, and we are in such a sore strait that one +catches at a straw."</p> + +<p>So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain, +entered his cabin, and at once indited a letter to the +King of Denmark begging him to surrender in order +to save the blood of his subjects, expressing admiration +at the way in which they had fought, and saying +that they had done all that was possible to save +honor, and might now surrender with a full consciousness +of having done their duty. This missive +was at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral +awaited with anxiety its result.</p> + +<p>A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with +unabated fury.</p> + +<p>"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed, +"there's the white flag!" and a tremendous cheer +broke along the whole of the British ships as the flag +of truce waved over the principal fort of Copen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[Pg 224]</a></span>hagen. +Instantly the fire on both sides ceased. +Boats passed between the shore and the flagship with +the proposals for surrender and conditions. Nelson +insisted that the Danish fleet should be surrendered, +in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king +that he had it in his power completely to destroy the +town, and had only so far desisted from motives of +humanity. At length, to the intense relief of the +admiral and his principal officers, who knew how +sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors, +the negotiations were completed, and the victory of +Copenhagen won.</p> + +<p>"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked.</p> + +<p>"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the +quarter-deck. One of the last shots fired from the +Danish fleet had struck him above the knee, carrying +away his leg. He had at once been carried down to +the cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of +the flagship. In the excitement of an action men +take but little heed of what is happening around +them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed +by his captain. Now, however, that the +battle was over, Captain Ball looked round for his +midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing +what had happened. He hurried below to the +wounded boy, whose leg had already been amputated, +above the point at which the ball had severed +it, by the surgeon.</p> + +<p>"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he +said, "and Copenhagen has been captured, and to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[Pg 225]</a></span> +you more than to anyone is this great victory due. +I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been +shot."</p> + +<p>Harry smiled faintly.</p> + +<p>"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the +navy has not been a long one. It is but a fortnight +since I got my commission, and now I am leaving +it altogether."</p> + +<p>"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said +cheerfully, "but not leaving life, I hope. I trust +there's a long one before you; but Admiral Nelson +will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career +of a young officer, who promised to rise to the +highest honors of his profession and be a credit and +glory to his country, has been cut short."</p> + +<p>A short time later the admiral himself came down +and shook hands with the boy, and thanked him for +his services, and cheered him up by telling him that +he would take care that his presence of mind and +courage should be known.</p> + +<p>For some days Harry lay between life and death, +but by the time that the ship sailed into Portsmouth +harbor the doctors had considerable hope that he +would pull round. He was carried at once to the +Naval Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley +was by his bedside. His captain frequently came to +see him, and upon one occasion came while his +foster-father was sitting by his bedside.</p> + +<p>"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told +me that you had served his majesty; but I didn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span> +recognize the name as that of my old boatswain on +board the <i>Cleopatra</i>."</p> + +<p>"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but +I wish it had been on any other occasion. However, +I think that the lad will not slip his wind this time; +but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at +an end."</p> + +<p>"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said; +"but there are many men who may live to a good +age and will have done less for their country than +this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he +prevented the dispatch, which would have warned +the enemy of what was coming, from reaching them; +and, in the second place, his sharpness and readiness +saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet, +and converted what threatened to be a defeat into a +victory. You must be proud of your son, old +salt."</p> + +<p>"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my +son?" the boatswain said.</p> + +<p>"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised; +"on the contrary, he spoke of you as his father."</p> + +<p>In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances +of the finding of Harry when a baby. Captain +Ball was silent for a while, and then said, "Do +you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by +the resemblance of that lad to an old friend and +school-fellow of mine, a Mr. Harper? They are as +like as two peas—that is, he is exactly what my +friend was at his age. My friend never was married;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[Pg 227]</a></span> +but I remember hearing a good many years ago—I +should say some fifteen years ago, which would be +about in accordance with this lad's age—that he had +lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed +to have foundered, and was never heard of +again. She was the wife of the captain, and was +taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may +be a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong +that it would be worth while making some inquiries. +Have you anything by which the child can be identified?"</p> + +<p>"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship +for the most part, and a locket. I will +bring them over to your honor to-morrow if you +will let me."</p> + +<p>"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to +London to-morrow, and shall see my friend. Don't +speak to the boy about it, for it's a thousand to one +against its being more than a coincidence. Still I +hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so."</p> + +<p>The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach +to London, and the following day called upon his +friend, who was a rich retired East-Indian director. +He told the story as Peter had told it to him.</p> + +<p>"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously, +although the ship was lost in the West Indies, it's +likely enough that the ornaments of my poor sister +would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of +often sending her home things from Calcutta."</p> + +<p>"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[Pg 228]</a></span> +produced the little packet which Peter had given +him.</p> + +<p>The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and +then, taking the locket, pressed the spring. He gave +a cry as he saw the portrait within it, and exclaimed, +"Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as she was +when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery! +Where is the lad of whom you have been +speaking? for surely he is my nephew, the son of my +sister Mary and Jack Peters."</p> + +<p>Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings +from the time he had known him, and the old +gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of bravery. +The very next day he went down to Portsmouth +with Captain Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment, +found himself claimed as nephew by the friend of +his captain.</p> + +<p>When Harry was well enough to be moved he +went up to London with his uncle, and a fortnight +later received an official letter directing him to attend +at the Board of Admiralty.</p> + +<p>Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded +thither in his uncle's carriage, and walked with +crutches—for his wound was not as yet sufficiently +healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg—to the +board-room. Here were assembled the first lord +and his colleagues. Admiral Nelson was also +present, and at once greeted him kindly.</p> + +<p>A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then +addressed him. "Mr. Peters, Admiral Nelson has<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[Pg 229]</a></span> +brought to our notice the clever stratagem by which, +on your own initiation and without instruction, you +obtained the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved +the <i>Cæsar</i> at a time when she was aground and altogether +overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also been +good enough to say that it was the success which +attended your action which suggested to him the +course that he took which brought the battle to a +happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that +the victory which has been won is in no small degree +due to you. Moreover, we are mindful that it was +your bravery and quickness which prevented the +news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching +the Continent, in which case the attack could not +have been carried out. Under such extraordinary +and exceptional circumstances we feel that an extraordinary +and exceptional acknowledgment is due +to you. We all feel very deep regret that the loss of +your leg will render you unfit for active service at +sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of so +meritorious and most promising a young officer. +We are about, therefore, to take a course altogether +without precedent. You will be continued on the +full-pay list all your life, you will at once be promoted +to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to +that of commander, and again in another three years +to the rank of post captain. The board are glad to +hear from Captain Ball that you are in good hands, +and wish you every good fortune in life."</p> + +<p>Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span> +could only stammer a word or two of thanks, and +the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral Nelson +having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken +back to the carriage, still in a state of bewilderment +at the honor which had been bestowed upon him.</p> + +<p>There is little more to tell. Having no other relations +his uncle adopted him as his heir, and the +only further connection that Harry had with the sea +was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the +fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of +an English port. Later on he sat in Parliament, +married, and to the end of his life declared that, after +all, the luckiest point in his career was the cutting +off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries, +for that, had this not happened, he should +never have known who he was, would never have +met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would have +passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley, +when not at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in +a snug cottage at Southsea, and had never reason to +the end of his life to regret the time when he sighted +the floating box from the tops of the <i>Alert</i>.</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[Pg 231]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="SURLY_JOE" id="SURLY_JOE"></a>SURLY JOE.</h2> + + +<p>"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir? +No, as you say, I hope I don't deserve the title now; +but I did once, and a name like that sticks to a man +for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at present, +and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it."</p> + +<p>The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty +years old, broad and weather-beaten; he had but one +arm. I had been spending a month's well-earned +holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the +most of it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my +first arrival I had gone out with the one-armed boatman, +and as he was a cheery companion, and his +boat, the <i>Grateful Mary</i>, was the best and fastest on +the strand, I had stuck to him throughout. The +boatmen at our watering-places soon learn when a +visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to importune +him with offers of a sail; consequently it +became an understood thing after a day or two that +I was private property, and as soon as I was seen +making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which +is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough, +a shout would at once be raised for Surly Joe. The +name seemed a singularly inappropriate one; but it<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[Pg 232]</a></span> +was not until the very day before I was returning to +town that I made any remark on the subject. By +this time we had become great allies; for what with +a bathe in the morning early, a sail before lunch, and +a fishing expedition afterwards, I had almost lived +on board the <i>Grateful Mary</i>. The day had been too +clear and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted +boy who assisted Joe had grown tired of +watching us catch nothing, and had fallen asleep in +the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose +and fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative +of sleep that I had nodded once or twice as +I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then the happy +idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered +why my companion was called by a nickname which +seemed so singularly inappropriate. Joe's offer to +tell me how he obtained it woke me at once. I refilled +my pipe,—an invariable custom, I observe, with +smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a +story,—passed my pouch to Joe, who followed my +example; and when we had "lighted up" Joe began:</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a +strong, active chap then—not that I aint strong now, +for I can shove a boat over the sandbar with any +man on the shore—but I aint as active as I were. I +warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms +like other men. My nickname then was Curly; +'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight on my +head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned +my own boat, and the boys that worked with me<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[Pg 233]</a></span> +warn't strangers, like Dick there, but they were my +own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the +two boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and +as good-plucked uns as any on the shore. I had +lost their mother ten years, maybe, before that, and +I never thought of giving them another. One of +'em was about twelve, just the size of Dick there; +the other was a year older. Full of tricks and mischief +they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle +the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one +thing they couldn't do, sir—they couldn't swim. I +used to tell 'em they ought to learn; but there, you +see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and +boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on +'em can swim. Rum, aint it, sir? All their lives +in the water or on the water, seeing all these visitors +as comes here either swimming or learning to swim, +and yet they won't try. They talks about instinks; +I don't believe in instinks, else everybody who's got +to pass his life on the water would learn to swim, +instead of being just the boys as never does learn. +That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman +and his wife and darter used to use my boat +regular; morning and afternoon they'd go out for a +sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put +out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared +so much for it; but they was just wrapped up in the +girl, who was a pale, quiet sort o' girl, who had come +down to the sea for her health. She was wonderful +fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[Pg 234]</a></span> +warn't like the same creature after she had been here +two months.</p> + +<p>"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls +from the east, but not too rough to go out: they +was to go out at four o'clock, and they came down +punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets +down:</p> + +<p>"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a +friend is coming down by the five-o'clock train, and +we must be at the station to meet her, she being an +invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so +will trust her with you.'</p> + +<p>"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring +her back safe,' the mother says, half laughing like; +but I could see she were a little anxious about lettin' +her go alone, which had never happened before.</p> + +<p>"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may +take your oath I'll bring her back if I comes back +myself.'</p> + +<p>"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on +the plank; 'don't you fidget: you know you can +trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six to dinner.'</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible +like, and although I'd told the boys before +that one reef would be enough, I made 'em put in +another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't +many boats out, for there was more sea on than most +visitors care to face; but once fairly outside we went +along through it splendid. When we got within a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[Pg 235]</a></span> +mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or +go on for a bit farther.</p> + +<p>"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't +we, Joe?'</p> + +<p>"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight +on the shore.'</p> + +<p>"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she +says, looking at her watch; 'I'd rather go a bit +farther.'</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The +wind was freshening, and the gusts coming down +strong; it was backing round rather to the north +too, and the sea was getting up.</p> + +<p>"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into +Filey,' I says; 'and you could go across by the +coach.'</p> + +<p>"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?'</p> + +<p>"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall +get a ducking before we get back; there's rain in that +squall to windward.'</p> + +<p>"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the +coach won't get in till half-past seven, and mamma +would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd so much +rather go on!'</p> + +<p>"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and +in another few minutes the squall was down upon +us. The rain came against us as if it wanted to +knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled +again. A sharper squall I don't know as ever I was +put in. It was so black you couldn't have seen two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[Pg 236]</a></span> +boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put the +helm up; but something went wrong, and—I don't +know rightly how it was, sir. I've thought it over +hundreds and hundreds of times, and I can't reason +it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of +that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must +somehow ha' lost my head—I don't know, I can't +account for it; but there it was, and in less time than +it takes me to tell you we were all in the water. +Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough +now. I threw one arm round the gal, as I felt her +going, and with the other I caught hold of the side +of the boat. We was under water for a moment, +and then I made shift to get hold of the rudder as +she floated bottom upwards. The boys had stuck to +her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel; for +you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing +nigh a foot of water there more than they does +astern. However, after a bit, they managed to get +down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel +about halfway along. They couldn't come no +nigher, because, as you know, the keel of them boats +only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I +shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have +seen us from the cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here +for us in no time.'</p> + +<p>"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my +heart that a lugger, to get out with that wind on, +would have to run right into t'other side o' the bay +before she could get room enough to weather the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[Pg 237]</a></span> +brig. The girl hadn't spoken a word since the +squall struck us, except that she gave a little short +cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she +got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as +well as she could with my help. The squall did not +last five minutes; and when it cleared off I could look +round and judge of our chances. They weren't +good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and +another on the brig, who were making their way out +as far as they could on the brig, for it were about +half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we +went into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over +the brig, and there was a man galloping on horseback +along the sands to'rds Filey as hard as he could +go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the +brig, and I saw that we should drift down on it before +a boat could beat out of the bay and get round +to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always does +break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and +the spray was flying up fifty feet in places where the +waves hit the face of the rock. There aint a worse +place on all the coast than this, running as it do nigh +a mile out from the head, and bare at low water. +The waves broke over the boat heavy, and I had as +much as I could do to hold on by one hand to the +rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with +every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't +hold on if they couldn't get onto the bottom of the +boat; so I shouted to 'em to try to climb up. But +they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[Pg 238]</a></span> +over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm +water; but with the boat rolling and such waves +going over her, and knocking them back again when +they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd +ha' been free I could have got 'em up by working +round to the side opposite 'em, and given them a +hand to haul them up; but as it was, with only one +hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I +was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face +round to me, and spoke for the first time.</p> + +<p>"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your +boys.'</p> + +<p>"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till +we're both drowned together.'</p> + +<p>"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe +me, I was actually beginning to hate that gal. +There was my own two boys a-struggling for their +lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em, because +I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She +saw it in my face, for she gave a sort of little cry, +and said:</p> + +<p>"'Oh, do—do let me go!'</p> + +<p>"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the +harder. Presently Bill—he was my youngest boy—sang +out:</p> + +<p>"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand +to get up? I can't hold on much longer.'</p> + +<p>"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my +promise to take this young woman back, and I must +keep my word. Her life's more precious to her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[Pg 239]</a></span> +father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to +be saved.'</p> + +<p>"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust, +and I knew it was when I said it, but I couldn't help +it. I felt as if I had a devil in me. I was just mad +with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word +seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it +was frozen. For a moment she didn't move, and +then, all of a sudden like, she gave a twist out of my +arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her, +and just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up +again. She never moved after that, but just lay +quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head was +back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only +by the tears that run down sometimes through her +eyelids, and by a little sob in her breast, that I knew +that she was sensible.</p> + +<p>"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God +bless you!' and then he let go his hold and went +down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though it +seemed a week to me, Jack did the same.</p> + +<p>"There we was—the girl and I—alone.</p> + +<p>"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was +mad then. I felt somehow as that the gal had +drowned my two boys; and the devil kept whispering +to me to beat her white face in, and then to go +with her to the bottom. I should ha' done it too, +but my promise kept me back. I had sworn she +should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to +me that included the promise that I would do my<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[Pg 240]</a></span> +best for us both to get there. I was getting weak +now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and my +thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if +they could hear me. Once or twice my hold had +slipped, and I had hard work enough to get hold +again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't +last much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had +told the boys I would be with 'em in a minute or +two, when a sound of shouting quite close roused me +up sudden.</p> + +<p>"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig. +Some men had climbed along, taking hold hand-in-hand +when they passed across places where the sea +was already breaking over, and bringing with them +the rope which, as I afterwards heard, the man on +horseback had brought back from Filey. It was a +brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was rising +fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could +hear them they shouted that they would throw me +the rope, and that I must leave go of the boat, which +would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she +had struck the rocks with us. Where they were +standing the rock was full six feet above the sea; +but a little farther it shelved down, and each wave +ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me +could I swim; and when I shook my head, for I was +too far gone to speak now, one of 'em jumped in +with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the +two of us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was +time, for we weren't much above a boat's length from<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[Pg 241]</a></span> +the brig. Three of the chaps as had the rope run +down to the low part of the rock and pulled together, +while another two kept hold of the end of the rope +and kept on the rock, so as to prevent us all being +washed across the brig together. I don't remember +much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at +once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of +the rope, and then, just as the water seemed choking +me, a great smash, and I remember nothing else. +When I came to my right senses again I was in a bed +at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and +my right arm, which had been round the girl, was +just splintered. They took it off that night. The +first thing as they told me when I came round was +that the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was +glad or sorry to hear it. I was glad, because I had +kept my promise and brought her back alive. I was +sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should +she have been saved when my two boys was +drowned? She was well-plucked, was that gal, for +she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment +she had got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike +she wanted to get dry clothes and to go straight +on to Scarborough in a carriage. However, the +doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little +letter saying as she was all right; and a man galloped +off with it on horseback, and got there just as +they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to +Filey to ask if there was any news there about the +boat. They came over and slept there, and she went<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[Pg 242]</a></span> +back with them next day. I heard all this afterwards, +for I was off my head, what with the blow I +had got and one thing and another, before I had been +there an hour. And I raved and cussed at the girl, +they tell me, so that they wouldn't let her father in to +see me.</p> + +<p>"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself, +to find my arm gone, and then I was another month +before I was out of bed. They came over to Filey +when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the +best doctor over from Scarborough to see me, and +paid everything for me till I was well, but I wouldn't +see them when they came. I was quite as bitter +against her as I had been when I was in the sea +drowning; and I was so fierce when they talked of +coming in that the doctor told them it would make +me bad again if they came. So they went up to +London, and when I could get about they sent me a +letter, the gal herself and her father and mother, +thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I just +tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a +lawyer of the town here came to me and said he'd +'struction to buy me a new boat, and to buy a 'nuity +for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my boys +back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money; +and as to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her +and sink her if she came. A year after that lawyer +came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions; +and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was +man enough still to knock his head off his shoulders,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[Pg 243]</a></span> +and that I'd do it if he came to me with his 'structions +or anything else.</p> + +<p>"By this time I'd settled down to work on the +shore, and had got the name of Surly Joe. Rightly +enough, too. I had one of them planks with wheels +that people use to get in and out of the boats; and +as the boatmen on the shore was all good to me, +being sorry for my loss, and so telling my story to +people as went out with them, I got enough to live +on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable +about me. I wouldn't speak a word, good +or bad, to a soul for days together, unless it was +to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I +hated everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was +always cussing the rocks that didn't kill me, and +wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this +work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never +cared for drink; but sometimes I'd find my thoughts +too hard for me, and I'd go and drink glass after +glass till I tumbled under the table.</p> + +<p>"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and +made offers to me to take a share in their boats, or to +make one in a fishing voyage; but I would not hear +them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and +left me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a +surlier, wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all +England, than I was. Well, sir, one day—it was just +at the beginning of the season, but was too rough a +day for sailing—I was a-sitting down on the steps of +a machine doing nothing, just wondering and won<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[Pg 244]</a></span>dering +why things was as they was, when two little +gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the other +a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum +away from the side of a lady and gentleman. I never +did notice nothing that didn't just concern me; but I +did see that they had a nurse not far off. The biggest +girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked +up into my face, and held out a broken wooden spade +and a bit of string, and says she, 'Sailor-man, please +mend our spade.' I was struck all of a heap like; for +though I had been mighty fond of little children in +the old days, and was still always careful of lifting +them into boats, my name and my black looks had +been enough, and none of them had spoken to me +for years. I felt quite strange like when that child +spoke out to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson +Crusoe, he as was wrecked on the island, felt +when he saw the mark of a foot.</p> + +<p>"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it +back, and says, gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but +one hand? Go to your nurse.'</p> + +<p>"I expected to see her run right off; but she +didn't, but stood as quiet as may be, with her eyes +looking up into my face.</p> + +<p>"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when +Nina digs. Nina will hold spade together, sailor-man +tie it up strong.'</p> + +<p>"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver, +and it was plain she had been crying just before; so +I put my hand into my pocket and brings out a bit<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[Pg 245]</a></span> +of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was of +no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as +I hardly knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll +tie it.'</p> + +<p>"So she held the broken pieces together, and I +ties 'em up with the aid of my hand and my teeth, +and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it. I did it sitting +on the bottom step, with a child standing on +each side watching me. When I had done it the +eldest took it, and felt it.</p> + +<p>"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you. +Annie, say thank you.'</p> + +<p>"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on +my arm as a good-by, the little ones trotted away to +a nurse sitting some little distance off.</p> + +<p>"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's +talk to a child; but it warn't a little thing +to me. It seemed regularly to upset me like; and I +sat there thinking it over and wondering what was +come over me, till an hour afterwards they went +past me with their nurse; and the little things ran +up to me and said, 'The spade's quite good now—good-by, +sailor-man!' and went on again. So I +shook it off and went to my work; for as the tide rose +the wind dropped, and a few boats went out; and +thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and surlier +than ever.</p> + +<p>"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand +painting a boat, when I saw the two children coming +along the sand again, and I wondered to myself<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[Pg 246]</a></span> +whether they would know me again, or think any +more of me, and though I wanted them to do so I +turned my back to the way they was coming, and +went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful +glad when I heard their little feet come, pattering +along the sand, and they sang out:</p> + +<p>"'Good-morning, sailor-man!'</p> + +<p>"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't +want no talk; and I goes on with my work without +turning round.</p> + +<p>"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me.</p> + +<p>"'Joe, there's a party coming down.'</p> + +<p>"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out +yourself.'</p> + +<p>"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute +or two, watching me at work, and then the eldest +says:</p> + +<p>"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never +been inside a boat, and we do want to so much.'</p> + +<p>"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making +a fight with myself against giving in.</p> + +<p>"Then the little one said:</p> + +<p>"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold +round oor neck; then oo stand up and we det in.'</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those +soft little faces against my cheeks as they got in +fairly knocked me over, and it was some time before +I could see what I was doing.</p> + +<p>"Once in, they never stopped talking. They +asked about everything, and I had to answer them;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[Pg 247]</a></span> +and as I got accustomed to it the words came freer, +till I was talking away with them as if I had known +'em all my life. Once I asked them didn't their papa +and mamma ever take 'em out for a sail, and they +shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea, +and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she +must have lost someone dear to her by it.</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those +children used to come every day down to talk with +me, and I got to look for it regular; and if it was a +wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put +out by it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in +my pockets for them. After a fortnight I took to +carrying them across the wet sands and putting them +on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people +to the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their +mother, and brought back the message that she knew +she could trust them with me.</p> + +<p>"All this time it never once struck me as strange +that their nurse should sit with a baby-brother of +theirs at a distance, and let them play with me by +the hour together, without calling them away, for I +wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling +stories to 'em just as I'd do with children who +came out sailing with me in the old time, and in +knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I +couldn't wonder at anything else. Natural like, I +changed a good deal in other respects, and I got to +give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce spoken +with for years; and the moment the children turned<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[Pg 248]</a></span> +down onto the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of +'There's your little ladies, Joe.'</p> + +<p>"I don't know why my mates should ha' been +pleased to see me coming round, for I had made myself +onpleasant enough on the shore; but they'd made +'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd +cum back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like, +and would just say, natural, 'Lend us a hand here, +Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over the bank, Joe,' +and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was +a hard day for me when, after staying nigh two +months, the little ladies came to say good-by. It +warn't as bad as might have been, though, for they +were going to stay with some friends near York, and +were to come back again in a fortnight before they +went back to London. But they kissed me, and +cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I +was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they +would be sure to think of me, for they loved me very +much.</p> + +<p>"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by +my stage, Jim Saunders—he'd been mate with me +before I owned a boat of my own—says out loud:</p> + +<p>"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've +jammed my hand so as I can't hoist a sail. Who'll +come out and lend me a hand?'</p> + +<p>"Well, everyone says they were busy, and +couldn't come; but I believe now as the whole thing +was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and then +Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[Pg 249]</a></span></p> + +<p>"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old +times; come along, old chap.'</p> + +<p>"I was taken aback like, and could only say something +about my stage; but half a dozen chaps volunteers +to look after my stage, and afore I scarce knew +what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and +as the party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every +chap on the shore runs in to help shove her off, and +a score of hands was held out just to give me a shake +as we started.</p> + +<p>"I don't think I was much good on that vyage, +for I went and sat up in the bow, with my back to +the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead.</p> + +<p>"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the +ice I went regular to the sea again, and handed my +stage over to a poor fellow who had lost his craft +and a leg the winter before.</p> + +<p>"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two +little figures upon the sands, and it needed no word +from anyone to tell me my little ladies had come +back. They jumped and clapped their hands when +they saw me, and would have run across the water +to meet me hadn't I shouted to them to wait just a +minute till I should be with them.</p> + +<p>"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where +have you been?'</p> + +<p>"'I've been out sailing, missy.'</p> + +<p>"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories? +You told us you should never go on sea any +more.'<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[Pg 250]</a></span></p> + +<p>"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I +don't suppose I ever should if I hadn't met you, +though you won't understand that. However, I've +give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.'</p> + +<p>"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and +mamma will be glad too.'</p> + +<p>"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I +asked.</p> + +<p>"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I +know she will be glad when I tells her.'</p> + +<p>"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk +to them about their mamma. Mamma very good, +very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and then +they went on telling me about their home in London, +and their carriage and amusements. Presently they +stopped, and I could see the eldest wanted to say +something particular, for she puckered up her forehead +as she always did when she was very serious; +and then she said, with her hands folded before her, +almost as if she was saying a lesson:</p> + +<p>"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two +little girls and baby-brother, and papa love her so +much; but there's one thing keeps her from being +quite happy.'</p> + +<p>"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be +happy with all these things. What is it?'</p> + +<p>"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for +her. If it hadn't been for him Nina and sissy and +little baby-brother could never have been born, and +papa would never have had dear mamma to love;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[Pg 251]</a></span> +but it cost the man who did it a great deal—all he +cared for; and now he won't let mamma and papa +and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma +unhappy when she thinks of it.'</p> + +<p>"Here she had evidently finished what she had +heard her mamma say, for her forehead got smooth +again, and she began to fill my pockets with sand.</p> + +<p>"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I +says. 'It don't stand to reason nohow. You can't +have understood what mamma said.'</p> + +<p>"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of +time,' Nina said. 'Nina quite sure she said right.'</p> + +<p>"We didn't say no more about it then, though +after the children had gone I wondered to myself +how a chap could go on so foolish as that. Well, sir, +three days after come round from Whitby this very +boat, the <i>Grateful Mary</i>. She was sent care of Joe +Denton; and as that was me, I had her hauled up on +the beach till I should hear whose she was. Several +visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous +like, that they should like to have a boat of +their own, and I supposed they had bought her at +Whitby and sent her down, though why they should +have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see.</p> + +<p>"Two days afterwards them children come down, +and says:</p> + +<p>"'We want you to go through the town to the +other cliff with us, Joe.'</p> + +<p>"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you +here, missies; but I shouldn't be a credit to you in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[Pg 252]</a></span> +the town, and your pa wouldn't be best pleased if he +was to see you walking about in the streets with a +boatman.'</p> + +<p>"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.'</p> + +<p>"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to +their nurse, who come back with them and says:</p> + +<p>"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler +glad if you would go with the young ladies.'</p> + +<p>"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object, +and they wishes it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You +wait here a quarter of an hour, while I goes and +cleans myself, and I'll go with you.'</p> + +<p>"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand, +and the oldest holds by my jacket, and we goes up +into High Street, and across to the other cliff. We +goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage +looking over the sea. There was a garden in front, +new planted with flowers.</p> + +<p>"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I, +when they turned in.</p> + +<p>"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned +the handle.</p> + +<p>"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me +into a parlor, where a lady and gentleman was sitting.</p> + +<p>"The gentleman got up.</p> + +<p>"'My little girls have spoken so much to me +about you, Joe, that I feel that we know each other +already.'</p> + +<p>"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[Pg 253]</a></span></p> + +<p>"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great +deal as to these little girls?'</p> + +<p>"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the +little missies; they have made a changed man of me, +they have; you ask anyone on the shore.'</p> + +<p>"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got +round your heart, and led you to your better self, I +could never have done what I have done, for you +would have rendered it useless.'</p> + +<p>"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither +head nor tail of what he was saying, and, I dessay, +looked as surprised as might be. Then he takes a +step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder, +and says he:</p> + +<p>"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little +girls were?'</p> + +<p>"I looked first at the children, and then at him, +and then at the lady, who had a veil down, but was +wiping her eyes underneath it. I was downright +flummuxed.</p> + +<p>"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on. +'Well, Joe, it is time you should know now. I owe +to you all that is dear to me in this world, and our +one unhappiness has been that you would not hear +us, that you had lost everything and would not let us +do anything to lighten your blow.'</p> + +<p>"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant, +and began to think that I was mad, or that he was. +Then the lady stood up and threw back her veil, and +come up in front of me with the tears a-running<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[Pg 254]</a></span> +down her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down +suddenly in a chair, for, sure enough, it was that gal. +Different to what I had seen her last, healthy-looking +and well—older, in course; a woman now, and the +mother of my little ladies.</p> + +<p>"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before +her, pleading like.</p> + +<p>"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children +stand between us. I know what you have suffered, +and, in all my happiness, the thought of your +loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell +you. I so often thought of you—a broken, lonely +man. I have talked to the children of you till they +loved the man that saved their mother's life. I cannot +give you what you have lost, Joe—no one can do +that; but you may make us happy in making you +comfortable. At least, if you cannot help hating +me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh +with you.'</p> + +<p>"As she spoke the children were hanging on me; +and when she stopped the little one said:</p> + +<p>"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate +mamma, and make her cry!'</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about +it. You can imagine how I quite broke down, like +a great baby, and called myself every kind of name, +saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so +now, that I had been somehow mad from the moment +the squall struck the <i>Kate</i> till the time I first +met the little girls.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[Pg 255]</a></span></p> + +<p>"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that +poor gal to her drowning heart with my words, I +could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At last, +when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and +its furniture and the <i>Grateful Mary</i> was all for me; +and we'd a great fight over it, and I only gave in +when at last she says that if I didn't do as she wanted +she'd never come down to Scarborough with the +little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come +down regular every year, and that the little girls +should go out sailing with me regular in the <i>Grateful +Mary</i>.</p> + +<p>"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that, +was there? So here I am; and next week I expect +Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's a Parliament +man, as she was engaged to be married to +at the time of the upset, and my little ladies, who is +getting quite big girls too. And if you hadn't been +going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle tower, +and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes, +sir, I see what you are going to ask. I found it +lonely there; and I found the widow of a old mate of +mine who seemed to think as how she could make +me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir—no +words could say how comfortable I am; and do you +know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe up there at +this identical time, only he's a very little one, and +has got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about +as little right as has any chap in this mortial world +to the name of Surly Joe."</p> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[Pg 256]</a></span></p> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[Pg 257]</a></span></p> +<h2><a name="A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM" id="A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM"></a>A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM.</h2> + + +<p>Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place. +Capitalists and speculative builders have somehow +left it alone, and, except for its great hotel, standing +in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled, there have +been comparatively few additions to it in the last +quarter of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should +make Falmouth my headquarters: blow high, blow +low, there are shelter and plenty of sailing room, +while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along +which to cruise—something very different from the +flat shores from Southampton to Brighton. It is +some six years since that I was lying in the harbor, +having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes. +Upon the day after we had come in my friend went +into Truro, and I landed, strolled up, and sat down +on a bench high on the seaward face of the hill that +shelters the inner harbor.</p> + +<p>An old coastguardsman came along. I offered +him tobacco, and in five minutes we were in full talk.</p> + +<p>"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out +there?"</p> + +<p>"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet."</p> + +<p>"Do they do well generally?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[Pg 258]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's +an uncertain fish the pilchard, and it's a rough life is +fishing on this coast. There aint a good harbor not +this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a +gale from the southeast it goes hard with them. +With a southwester they can run back here."</p> + +<p>"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?"</p> + +<p>"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy +well-nigh fifty year back, but I got a sickener of it, +and tramped to Plymouth and shipped in a frigate +there, and served all my time in queen's ships."</p> + +<p>"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships +of the life, or from any particular circumstance?"</p> + +<p>"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty +boats lost that night, and scarce a hand was saved. +I shouldn't have been saved myself if it had not been +for a dream of mother's."</p> + +<p>"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind +telling me about it?"</p> + +<p>The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two; +and then, after a sharp puff at his pipe, he told me +the following story, of which I have but slightly +altered the wording:</p> + +<p>I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of +a village now, as it was then. My father had been +washed overboard and drowned two years before. I +was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's, +and four men and myself worked her in shares. I +was twenty-one, or maybe twenty-two, years old<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[Pg 259]</a></span> +then. It was one day early in October. We had +had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd +agreed to start at eight o'clock in the morning. I +was up at five, and went down to the boats to see as +everything was ready. When I got back mother +had made breakfast; and when we sat down I saw +that the old woman had been crying, and looked +altogether queer like.</p> + +<p>"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip."</p> + +<p>"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother! +Why? What's happened? Your share and mine +didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would +be a talk if I didn't go out in the <i>Jane</i>. Why, what +is it?"</p> + +<p>"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how +you was drowned."</p> + +<p>"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be +drowned, mother."</p> + +<p>But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us +Cornishmen goes a good deal on dreams and tokens; +and sure enough mother had dreamed father was +going to be drowned before he started on that last +trip of his.</p> + +<p>"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of +you in bed, and a chap was leaning over you cutting +your throat."</p> + +<p>I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast +after that; but in a minute or two I plucks up +and says:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[Pg 260]</a></span></p> + +<p>"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for +if I be drowned no one has no call to cut my +throat."</p> + +<p>"I didn't see you downright drowned in my +dream," she said. "You was in the sea—a terribly +rough sea—at night, and the waves were breaking +down on you."</p> + +<p>"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit. +"It's a fine day, and it's our boat. All the lads and +girls in the village would laugh at me if I stayed at +home."</p> + +<p>"That's just what your father said; and he went +to his death."</p> + +<p>And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron +over her head and began to cry again. I'd more +than half a mind to give way; but you know what +young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of +the place would say about my being afraid to go was +too much for me.</p> + +<p>At last, when mother saw I was bent on going, +she got up and said:</p> + +<p>"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back, +will you do something else I ask you?"</p> + +<p>"I will, mother," said I—"anything but stay +back."</p> + +<p>She went off without a word into her bedroom, +and she came back with something in her arms.</p> + +<p>"Look here, Will, I made this for your father, +and he wouldn't have it; now I ask you to take it, +and put it on if a storm comes on. You see, you<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[Pg 261]</a></span> +can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no +one will be any the wiser."</p> + +<p>The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch +spirit-bottles, sewn between two pieces of canvas. +It had got strings sewed on for tying round the body, +and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle +each side of the chest, it lay pretty flat.</p> + +<p>"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for +hours. A gentleman who was staying in the village +before you was born was talking about wrecks, and +he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked, +would keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I +made it; but no words could get your father to try +it, though he was willing enough to say that it would +probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you, +Will?"</p> + +<p>I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there +wasn't much chance of a storm, and that if I put it +under my coat and hid it away down in the forecastle, +no one would see it; and so to please her I +said I'd take it, and that if a bad storm came on I +would slip it on.</p> + +<p>"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the +bottles," mother said. "It may be useful to you; +who can say?"</p> + +<p>I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays, +on board without its being seen, and stowed it away +in my locker. I felt glad now I'd got it, for mother's +dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way +down old Dick Tremaine said to me:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[Pg 262]</a></span></p> + +<p>"I don't like the look of the sky, lad."</p> + +<p>"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough."</p> + +<p>"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look +of it. I think we're going to have a bad blow."</p> + +<p>I told the others what he had said; but they didn't +heed much. Two boats had come in that morning +with a fine catch, and after the bad time we'd been +having it would have taken a lot to keep them in +after that.</p> + +<p>We thought no more about it after we had once +started. The wind was light and puffy; but we had +great luck, and were too busy to watch the weather. +What wind there was, was northerly; but towards +sunset it dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped +we looked round at the sky.</p> + +<p>"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper, +who was skipper, said, "and I wish we had taken +more heed to his words. That's about as wild a +sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing +our boat."</p> + +<p>Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old +enough to read the signs of a storm—the heavy bank +of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken light, the +horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken +irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them. +Instinctively we looked round towards the coast. +It was fully fifteen miles away, and we were to the +east of it. The great change in the appearance of +the sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous +to that time there had been nothing which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[Pg 263]</a></span> +would have struck any but a man grown old upon +the coast like Dick Tremaine.</p> + +<p>"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail +too; take in the mizzen. Like enough it will +come with a squall, and we'd best be as snug as may +be. What do you say? shall we throw over some +of the fish?"</p> + +<p>It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute +the sky was changing. The scud was flying thicker +and faster overhead, and the land was lost in a black +cloud that seemed to touch the water.</p> + +<p>"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if +we get rid of half she'll be about in her best trim; +and she's as good a sea-boat as there is on the coast. +Come, lads, don't look at it."</p> + +<p>It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five +minutes half our catch of the day was overboard. +The <i>Jane</i> was a half-decked boat, yawl-rigged; she +wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round +from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft. +He had used her for two years, and had got +tired of the sport, and my father had bought her of +him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used +about here, but we all liked her, and swore by her.</p> + +<p>"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few +minutes, I reckon," Jabez said after a while. +"Lower down her sails altogether; get her head to +it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you +stand ready to hoist the foresail a few feet; and, +Will, you and John stand by the hoists of the main<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[Pg 264]</a></span>sail. +We must show enough to keep her laying-to +as long as we can. You'd best get your coats out +and put 'em on, and batten down the hatch."</p> + +<p>I let the others go down first, and when they came +up I went in, tied the life-belt round me, and put on +my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle of hollands from +my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch.</p> + +<p>"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said.</p> + +<p>I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for +our future use, and took hold of the throat halyard.</p> + +<p>"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared +under the cloud of mist and darkness ahead, +and then with a roar it was upon us.</p> + +<p>I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years, +and I never remember in these latitudes such a squall +as that. For a few minutes I could scarcely see or +breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the +wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder +ten yards off. At first I thought we +were going down bodily. It was lucky we had +taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun +round, the force of the wind against the masts and +rigging all but capsized her. In five minutes the +first burst was over, and we were running before it +under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no +occasion for us to stand by the halyards now, and +we all gathered in the stern, and crouched down in +the well. Although the sun had only gone down +half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white +foam round us gave a sort of dim light that made the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[Pg 265]</a></span> +sky look all the blacker. The sea got up in less time +than it takes in telling, and we were soon obliged to +hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves +from coming in over the stern. For three hours we +tore on before the gale, and then it lulled almost as +suddenly as it had come on. There had scarcely +been a word spoken between us during this time. I +was half asleep in spite of the showers of spray. +Jim Hackers, who was always smoking, puffed away +steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the others were +quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on +our feet.</p> + +<p>"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked.</p> + +<p>"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember +such a gale as this since I was a boy. Pass that +bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be busy again +directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with +the wet. We shall have it round from the south in +a few minutes."</p> + +<p>There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she +rolled so I thought she would have turned turtle.</p> + +<p>"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her +head round."</p> + +<p>We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from +behind struck us, and in five minutes we were running +back as fast as we had come. The wind was +at first south, but settled round to southeast. We +got up a little more sail now, and made a shift to +keep her to the west, for with this wind we should +have been ashore long before morning if we had run<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[Pg 266]</a></span> +straight before it. The sea had been heavy—it was +tremendous now; and, light and seaworthy as the +<i>Jane</i> was, we had to keep baling as the sea broke into +her. Over and over again I thought that it was all +over with us as the great waves towered above our +stern, but they slipped under us as we went driving +on at twelve or fourteen knots an hour. I stood up +by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought +of it.</p> + +<p>"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we +must run, and by midnight we shall be among the +Scillys. Then it's a toss-up."</p> + +<p>Jabez's calculations could not have been far out, +for it was just midnight, as far as I could tell, when +we saw a flash right ahead.</p> + +<p>"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said. +"I wish I knew which it was."</p> + +<p>He tried to bring her a little more up into the +wind, but she nearly lay over onto her beam-ends, +and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw one +more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship +was burning a blue light. She was not a mile ahead +now, and we could see she was a large vessel. I had +often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as +well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land. +It was as Jabez had said—a toss-up. If we just +missed one of them we might manage to bring up +under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of +them the <i>Jane</i> would break up like an egg-shell.</p> + +<p>We were rapidly running down upon the wreck<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[Pg 267]</a></span> +when the glare of a fire on shore shone up. It was +a great blaze, and we could faintly see the land and a +white cottage some hundred yards from the shore.</p> + +<p>"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the +end of the island; we may miss it yet. Hoist the +mainsail a bit."</p> + +<p>I leapt up with another to seize the halyards, +when a great wave struck us; she gave a roll, and +the next moment I was in the water.</p> + +<p>After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I +knew the shore was but half a mile ahead, and that +the wind would set me dead upon it. I loosened my +tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with +mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat, +though I was half drowned with the waves as they +swept in from behind me. My mother's dream +cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem +as I was to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards. +I drifted past the wreck within a hundred +yards or so. They were still burning blue lights; +but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw +that in a very few minutes she would go to pieces. +Many times as the seas broke over me I quite gave +up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair swimmer, +and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on.</p> + +<p>I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that +broke against the rocks showed a certain death if I +made for it, and I tried hard to work to the left, +where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me +that the fire was built close to the end of the island.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[Pg 268]</a></span> +As I came close I found that this was so. I drifted +past the point of land not fifty feet off, where the +waves were sending their spray a hundred feet up; +then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee +of the point. There was a little bay with a shelving +shore, and here I made a shift to land. Five minutes +to rest, and then I made my way towards the fire. +There was no one there, and I went to the edge of +the rocks. Here four or five men with ropes were +standing, trying to secure some of the casks, chests, +and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of +floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of +a crash against those rocks. The water was deep +alongside, and the waves, as they struck, flew up in +spray, which made standing almost impossible.</p> + +<p>The men came round me when they saw me. +There was no hearing one speak in the noise of the +storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the point, +and that if they came with their ropes to the point +they might get something as it floated past. They +went off, and I sat down by the fire, wrung my +clothes as well as I could,—I thought nothing of the +wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,—took +off mother's belt, and found one of the +bottles had broke as I got ashore; but luckily it was +the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out +of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt +pretty right again. I had good hopes the boat was +all right, for she would get round the point easy, and +Jabez would bring her up under the lee of the island.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[Pg 269]</a></span> +I thought I would go and see if I could help the +others, and perhaps save someone drifting from the +wreck; but I did not think there was very much +chance, for she lay some little distance to the right, +and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the +shore.</p> + +<p>Just as I was going to move I saw two of them +coming back. They had a body between them, and +they put it down a little distance from the fire. I +was on the other side, and they had forgotten all +about me. They stooped over the figure, and I could +not see what they were doing. I got up and went +over, and they gave a start when they saw me. "Is +he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled; +and I could see pretty well that if I had not been +there it would have gone hard with the chap. He +was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around +him one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of +rings on his fingers, and he had a belt round his +waist that looked pretty well stuffed out. I put my +hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and +then I poured a few drops of brandy which remained +in my bottle down his throat.</p> + +<p>While I was doing this the two men had talked +to each other aside. "He's alive, all right," says I. +"That's a good job," one of 'em said; but I knew +he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage. +You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must +be past two o'clock by this time."</p> + +<p>They took the chap up, and carried him to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[Pg 270]</a></span> +cottage, and put him on a bed. He was moaning a +little, and between us we undressed him and got +him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said.</p> + +<p>"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink +of whisky?"</p> + +<p>I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off +my wet clothes, I got into the other bed, for there +were two in the room.</p> + +<p>The men said they were going down again to see +what they could get. They left the whisky bottle +on the table, and as soon as I was alone I jumped +out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth, +so as to give him as good a chance as I could; but I +didn't much think he'd get round, and then I got +into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off, +when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up. +Mother's dream came right across me. I was out of +bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There +was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it. +Then I took my clasp-knife out of my pocket and +opened it. I gave the other chap a shake, but there +was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I +thought to myself they would never risk a fight when +they saw me armed and ready. But I soon found +that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up and dressed +in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it +was fastened on the outside. I soon opened the +window and got out, but before I did that I rolled +up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and made a +sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[Pg 271]</a></span> +bed was lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure +that he would not live till morning. The candle was +a fresh one when they had first lighted it, and I left +it burning.</p> + +<p>When I had got out I shut the window, and went +away fifty yards or so, where I could hear them +come back. Presently I heard some footsteps coming +from the opposite direction. Then I heard a +voice I knew say, "There is the fire; we shall soon +know whether the poor lad has got ashore."</p> + +<p>"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and +the other were going to break into a shout of welcome, +"hush! Some wreckers are coming up directly +to cut my throat and that of another chap in +that cottage."</p> + +<p>In a word or two I told them all about it; and +they agreed to wait with me and see the end of it. +Jabez had brought the <i>Jane</i> up under the lee of the +island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had +come on shore in the cobble with the other to +look for me, but with very faint hopes of finding +me.</p> + +<p>"You had best get hold of something to fight +with, if you mean to take these fellows, Jabez."</p> + +<p>"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another," +Jabez said.</p> + +<p>Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour +later we heard footsteps coming up from the shore +again. Two men passed us, went into the cottage, +and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[Pg 272]</a></span> +window, where we could see in, and John Redpath +stood at the door. He was to open it and rush in +when he heard us shout. We stood a little back, +but we could see well into the room. Presently we +saw the door open very quietly, little by little. A +hand came through and moved the chairs, and then +it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One, +a big fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards +the bed, where, as it seemed, I was sleeping, +with my head covered up by the clothes. The other +had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other +bed.</p> + +<p>"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me.</p> + +<p>The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it +down into the figure, throwing his weight onto it at +the same moment, while the smaller man snatched +the pillow from under the other's head and clapped +it over his face, and threw his weight on it. As they +did so we pushed the casement open and leapt in. +I seized the smaller man, who was suffocating the +other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had +him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The +big fellow had leapt up. He gave a howl of rage +as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay with his +knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump +of rock, as big as a baby's head, right into his +stomach. It just tumbled him over like a cannon-shot. +John burst in through the door, and we had +'em both tied tightly before five minutes was over. +Then we lit a big fire in the kitchen, and with warm<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[Pg 273]</a></span> +clothes and some hot whisky and water we got the +foreign chap pretty well round.</p> + +<p>In the morning I went off and found a village on +the other side of the island. I woke them up and +told my story, and, to do 'em justice, though there +were some who would have shielded the fellows we +had caught, the best part were on our side. Some +of 'em told me there had been suspicion upon these +men, and that they bore a bad name. There was no +magistrate in the island, and no one objected when +I said we would take them across to Penzance and +give them in charge there.</p> + +<p>So we did; and they were tried and got transportation +for life for attempting to murder the foreign +chap, who, it turned out, was a Brazilian Jew, with +diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but +we would have none; but that's neither here nor +there.</p> + +<p>So you see, master, mother's dream saved me +from drowning and from having my throat cut. I +gave up fishing after that and went into the queen's +service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live +with a sister of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands +have changed since those times, and you'll meet as +much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will +anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those +days, and I had a pretty close shave of it, hadn't I?</p> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>Boys' Own Library.</h2> + +<h4>BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4> + + +<p>Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.</p> + +<p>A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular Authors.</p> + +<p>Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold.</p> + +<p>THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED.</p> + +<h4>Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4> + + +<p><b>Horatio Alger, Jr.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Adventures of a Telegraph Boy.<br /> +Dean Dunham.<br /> +Erie Train Boy.<br /> +Five Hundred Dollar Check.<br /> +From Canal Boy to President.<br /> +From Farm Boy to Senator.<br /> +Mark Stanton.<br /> +Ned Newton.<br /> +New York Boy.<br /> +Tom Brace.<br /> +Tom Tracy.<br /> +Walter Griffith.<br /> +Young Acrobat.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>C. B. Ashley.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Gilbert, the Trapper<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Annie Ashmore.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Smuggler's Cave, The.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Capt. Ralph Bonehill.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Neka, the Boy Conjurer.<br /> +Tour of the Zero Club.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Walter F. Burns.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +In the Sunk Lands.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Frank H. Converse.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Gold of Flat Top Mountain.<br /> +Happy-Go-Lucky Jack.<br /> +Heir to a Million.<br /> +In Search of an Unknown Race.<br /> +In Southern Seas.<br /> +Mystery of a Diamond.<br /> +That Treasure.<br /> +Voyage to the Gold Coast.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Harry Collingwood.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Pirate Island.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>George H. Coomer.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Boys In the Forecastle.<br /> +Old Man of the Mountain.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>William Dalton.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Tiger Prince.<br /> +War Tiger.<br /> +White Elephant.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<p><b>Edward S. Ellis.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Arthur Helmuth.<br /> +Check Number 2134.<br /> +From Tent to White House.<br /> +Golden Rock.<br /> +Land of Mystery.<br /> +On the Trail of Geronimo.<br /> +Perils of the Jungle.<br /> +White Mustang.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>George Manville Fenn.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Commodore Junk.<br /> +Dingo Boys.<br /> +Golden Magnet.<br /> +Grand Chaco.<br /> +Weathercock.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Bound for Annapolis.<br /> +Cliff, the Naval Cadet.<br /> +Cruise of the Training Ship.<br /> +From Port to Port.<br /> +Strange Cruise, A.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>William Murray Graydon.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Butcher of Cawnpore, The.<br /> +Camp In the Snow, The.<br /> +Campaigning with Braddock.<br /> +Cryptogram, The.<br /> +From Lake to Wilderness.<br /> +In Barracks and Wigwam.<br /> +In Fort and Prison.<br /> +Jungles and Traitors.<br /> +Rajah's Fortress, The.<br /> +White King of Africa, The.<br /> +With Boer and Britisher.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Cadet's Honor, A.<br /> +Off for West Point.<br /> +On Guard.<br /> +West Point Treasure, A.<br /> +West Point Rivals, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Headon Hill.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Spectre Gold.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Henry Harrison Lewis.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Centerboard Jim.<br /> +Ensign Merrill.<br /> +King of the Island.<br /> +Midshipman Merrill.<br /> +Sword and Pen.<br /> +Valley of Mystery, The.<br /> +Yankee Boys In Japan.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Cadet Kit Carey.<br /> +Capt. Carey.<br /> +Kit Carey's Protege.<br /> +Lieut. Carey's Luck.<br /> +Out with Commodore Decatur.<br /> +Randy, the Pilot.<br /> +Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip.<br /> +Tom Truxton's School Days.<br /> +Treasure of the Golden Crater.<br /> +Won at West Point.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Victor St. Clair.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Cast Away in the Jungle.<br /> +Comrades Under Castro.<br /> +For Home and Honor.<br /> +From Switch to Lever.<br /> +Little Snap, the Postboy.<br /> +Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror.<br /> +Zip, the Acrobat.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Arthur M. Winfield.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Mark Dale's Stage Venture.<br /> +Young Bank Clerk, The.<br /> +Young Bridge Tender, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Matthew White, Jr.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Adventures of a Young Athlete.<br /> +Eric Dane.<br /> +Guy Hammersley.<br /> +My Mysterious Fortune.<br /> +Tour of a Private Car.<br /> +Young Editor, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Gayle Winterton.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Young Actor, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Ernest A. Young.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Boats, Bats and Bicycles.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>Splendid Books for Girls.</h2> + +<h4>HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED.</h4> + +<h4>Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4> + + +<p><b>EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p><b>Breakneck Farm.</b></p> + +<p>The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her +brothers, on an old abandoned country place.</p> + +<p><b>Jessica Trent.</b></p> + +<p>Her Adventures on a Ranch.</p> + +<p><b>Jessica, the Heiress.</b></p> + +<p>This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published. +A Charming Story.</p></div> + + +<p><b>KATE TANNATT WOODS:</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p><b>A Fair Maid of Marblehead.</b></p> + +<p>A book to please both young and old.</p></div> + +<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>BOYS' OWN LIBRARY—Continued</h2> + +<h4>Bound in Cloth. Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4> + + +<p><b>Brooks McCormick.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Giant Islanders, The.<br /> +How He Won.<br /> +Nature's Young Noblemen.<br /> +Rival Battalions.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Walter Morris.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Stanley Norris.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Phil, the Showman.<br /> +Young Showman's Rivals, The.<br /> +Young Showman's Pluck, The.<br /> +Young Showman's Triumph, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Lieut. James K. Orton.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Beach Boy Joe.<br /> +Last Chance Mine.<br /> +Secret Chart, The.<br /> +Tom Havens with the White Squadron.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>James Otis.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Chased Through Norway.<br /> +Inland Waterways.<br /> +Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale.<br /> +Unprovoked Mutiny, An.<br /> +Wheeling for Fortune.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Gilbert Patten.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Boy Boomers.<br /> +Boy Cattle King.<br /> +Boy from the West.<br /> +Don Kirk's Mine.<br /> +Jud and Joe.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>St. George Rathborne.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Canoe and Camp Fire.<br /> +Chums of the Prairie.<br /> +Gulf Cruisers, The.<br /> +Paddling Under Palmettos.<br /> +Rival Canoe Boys.<br /> +Shifting Winds.<br /> +Sunset Ranch.<br /> +Young Range Riders.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Arthur Sewell.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Capt. David Southwick.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Jack Wheeler.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Burt L. Standish.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Frank Merriwell's Bravery.<br /> +Frank Merriwell Down South.<br /> +Frank Merriwell's School Days.<br /> +Frank Merriwell's Chums.<br /> +Frank Merriwell's Foes.<br /> +Frank Merriwell's Trip West.<br /> +</p></div> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>The New "Henty" Series.</h2> + + +<p>With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS +on each book. The Illustrations are reproductions of paintings +representing scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover +design is done in Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth. +These books are all by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed +Wrappers.</p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p>AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril.<br /> +BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden.<br /> +BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades.<br /> +BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain.<br /> +BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604).<br /> +BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic.<br /> +BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico.<br /> +BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War.<br /> +CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California.<br /> +CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt.<br /> +CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars.<br /> +DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred.<br /> +FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines.<br /> +FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia.<br /> +FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes.<br /> +FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem.<br /> +FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England.<br /> +GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico.<br /> +IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce.<br /> +IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy.<br /> +IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India.<br /> +JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea.<br /> +LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century.<br /> +LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of Religion.<br /> +LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India.<br /> +MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War.<br /> +ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo.<br /> +ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick.<br /> +OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America.<br /> +ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers.<br /> +STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way.<br /> +THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots.<br /> +TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence.<br /> +UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main.<br /> +WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire.<br /> +WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War.<br /> +WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent.<br /> +YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War.<br /> +YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal.<br /> +YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa.<br /> +YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War.<br /> +YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria.</p></div> + +<h4><i>Any of the above books will be sent postpaid, +upon receipt of price, 50 cents.</i></h4> + +<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>Boys' Popular Library.</h2> + +<h4>BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4> + + +<p>An excellent series of books for boys by such popular +authors as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers.</p> + +<p>These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive +cover designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed +from large type, on good paper. Printed wrappers.</p> + +<h4>Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4> + +<p><b>Walter Aimwell.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Jerry.<br /> +Whistler.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Horatio Alger, Jr.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Brave and Bold.<br /> +Only an Irish Boy.<br /> +Paul, the Peddler.<br /> +Phil, the Fiddler.<br /> +Slow and Sure.<br /> +Strive and Succeed.<br /> +Strong and Steady.<br /> +Tom, the Bootblack.<br /> +Try and Trust.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Z. R. Bennett.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Young Vagabond, A.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Daniel Defoe.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Robinson Crusoe.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>John De Morgan.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Always on Duty.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Richard Dowling.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Catmur's Cave.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>George Manville Fenn.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +In the Wilds of New Mexico.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Blanche Willis Howard.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Battle and a Boy, A.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>W. H. G. Kingston.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Dick Cheveley.<br /> +From Powder Monkey to Admiral.<br /> +Hendricks, the Hunter.<br /> +Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean.<br /> +Peter Trawl.<br /> +Peter, the Whaler.<br /> +Shore and Ocean.<br /> +The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Leon Lewis.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Diamond Seekers of Brazil.<br /> +Kit Carson's Last Trail.<br /> +Silver Ship, The.<br /> +Young Castaways, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Montleau & Wyse.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Swiss Family Robinson.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Alfred Oldfellow.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Joe Nichols.<br /> +Uncle Nat.<br /> +Way to Success.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Oliver Optic</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club").<br /> +Boat Club, The.<br /> +Little by Little.<br /> +Now or Never.<br /> +Try Again.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Capt. Mayne Reid.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Boy Tar, The.<br /> +Cliff Climber, The.<br /> +Lone Ranch, The.<br /> +Ran Away to Sea.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Gordon Stables.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Cruise of the Snowbird.<br /> +Life at Sea.<br /> +Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole.<br /> +Young Explorer, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Jefferys Taylor.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Boy Crusoes, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>A Wolvertonian.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Three Years at Wolverton.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Ernest A. Young.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Toss Up for Luck.<br /> +</p></div> + +<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4> + + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<h2>Girls' Popular Library.</h2> + +<h4>ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4> + + +<p>LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers. +Very attractive cover design stamped in colors. Just the +books that girls delight to read—and can read with profit +as well as pleasure. Note the list of Authors—all well-known +writers of the best books for girls.</p> + +<h4>Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4> + +<p><b>Walter Aimwell.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Ella.<br /> +Jessie.<br /> +Marcus.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Mary D. Brine.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Echoes from Story Land.<br /> +Stories Grandma Told.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Alice Carey.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Clovernook Children.<br /> +Clovernook Tales. Vol. I.<br /> +Clovernook Tales. Vol. II.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Rosa Nouchette Carey.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Averil.<br /> +Our Bessie.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Cousin Virginia.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Cricket's Friends, The.<br /> +Dolls' Club, The.<br /> +3 Vols. in 1.<br /> +<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Jo's Doll.</span><br /> +<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Katy's Christmas.</span><br /> +<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Patty's Pranks.</span><br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Lewis Carroll.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Alice's Adventures In Wonderland.<br /> +Through the Looking-Glass.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Maria S. Cummins.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Lamplighter, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Mary A. Denison.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Barbara's Triumphs.<br /> +Frenchman's Ward, The.<br /> +Guardian's Trust, The.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Maria Edgeworth.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Simple Susan.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Juliana Horatia Ewing.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A.<br /> +Great Emergency, A.<br /> +Jackanapes.<br /> +Jan of the Windmill.<br /> +Six to Sixteen.<br /> +We and the World.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Julia Goddard.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Fairy Tales In Other Lands.<br /> +</p></div> + +<p><b>Virginia F. Townsend.</b></p> + +<div class="blockquot"><p> +Amy Deane.<br /> +While it Was Morning.<br /> +</p></div> + +<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York.</h4> + + +<hr style="width: 65%;" /> +<p><b>TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE:</b> All apparent printer's errors retained.</p> + + + + + + + + +<pre> + + + + + +End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + +***** This file should be named 33939-h.htm or 33939-h.zip ***** +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: + http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/ + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at +http://gutenberg.org/license). + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org. + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at +http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at +809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email +business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact +information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official +page at http://pglaf.org + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit http://pglaf.org + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + http://www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. + + +</pre> + +</body> +</html> diff --git a/33939-h/images/cover.jpg b/33939-h/images/cover.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..309e0a8 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-h/images/cover.jpg diff --git a/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg b/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..72b53dd --- /dev/null +++ b/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg diff --git a/33939.txt b/33939.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..07c9bf3 --- /dev/null +++ b/33939.txt @@ -0,0 +1,8474 @@ +The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + + +Title: Sturdy and Strong + How George Andrews Made His Way + +Author: G. A. Henty + +Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939] + +Language: English + +Character set encoding: ASCII + +*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + + + + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + + + + + + + + + STURDY AND STRONG + + G. A. HENTY + + + [Illustration: "SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE, + TELLING THEM SEA STORIES."--_Frontispiece._ + _Sturdy and Strong._] + + + + STURDY AND STRONG + OR + _How George Andrews Made His Way_ + + BY + G. A. HENTY + + AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE IN INDIA," + "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH," + ETC., ETC., ETC. + + + NEW YORK + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY + PUBLISHERS + + + + +PREFACE. + + +Whatever may be said as to distinction of classes in England, it is +certain that in no country in the world is the upward path more open +to those who brace themselves to climb it than in our own. The +proportion of those who remain absolutely stationary is comparatively +small. We are all living on a hillside, and we must either go up or +down. It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who fixes his +eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb, and determines with all +his might and power to win his way towards the top, is sure to find +himself at the end of his day at a far higher level than when he +started upon his journey. It may be said, and sometimes foolishly is +said, that luck is everything; but in nineteen cases out of twenty +what is called luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of the +readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity to advantage. The +voyager must take every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he +would make a favorable journey; and for success in life it is +necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast, and true, but to have the +faculty of turning every opportunity to the best advantage; just as a +climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little shrub, every +projecting rock, as a hold for his hands or feet. George Andrews had +what may be called luck--that is, he had opportunities and took +advantage of them, and his rise in life was consequently far more +rapid than if he had let them pass without grasping them; but in any +case his steadiness, perseverance, and determination to get on would +assuredly have made their way in the long run. If similar qualities +and similar determinations are yours, you need not despair of similar +success in life. + + G. A. HENTY. + + + + +CONTENTS. + + + STURDY AND STRONG: PAGE + I. ALONE, 1 + II. TWO FRIENDS, 25 + III. WORK, 48 + IV. HOME, 74 + V. AN ADVENTURE, 97 + VI. FIRE! 117 + VII. SAVED! 142 + DO YOUR DUTY, 165 + SURLY JOE, 231 + A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM, 257 + + + + +STURDY AND STRONG. + + + + +CHAPTER I. + +ALONE. + + +"You heard what he said, George?" + +"Oh, mother, mother!" + +"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen it coming a long time, +and, hard as it seems, it will be better. There is no disgrace in it. +I have tried my best, and if my health had not broken down we might +have managed, but you see it was not to be. I shall not mind it, dear; +it is really only for your sake that I care about it at all." + +The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a white set face. + +"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I cannot keep you from +this. If we could only have managed for a year or two I could have +earned more then; but to think of you--you in the workhouse!" + +"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother said gently. "You see it +is not as if it were from any fault of ours. We have done our best. You +and I have managed for two years; but what with my health and my eyes +breaking down we can do so no longer. I hope it will not be for long, +dear. You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I shall soon be +able to be out again." + +"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought not to use your eyes for +months." + +"Even months pass quickly, George, when one has hope. I have felt this +coming so long that I shall be easier and happier now it has come. After +all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital, and it would not seem +so very dreadful to you my going into a hospital; the difference is only +in name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is kept up out of +subscriptions, the other from the rates." + +His mother's words conveyed but little comfort to George Andrews. He had +just come in from his work, and had heard what the parish doctor had +told his mother. + +"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews. You must have rest and +quiet for your eyes, and not only that, but you must have strengthening +food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is painful for you, I know. +I can well understand that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go +I won't answer for your life." + +"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly. "I know that it will be +best. It will be a blow to my boy, but I see no other way." + +"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the world, ma'am, you will do +as I advise you. I will go round in the morning and get you the order of +admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I will, if you like, +take you myself." + +"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes, I will be ready in the +morning, and I thank you for your offer." + +"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said briskly. "At ten +o'clock I will be here." + +Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries was a kind-hearted and +humane man. + +"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went downstairs, "it is hard for +her. It is easy to see that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but +what can I do for her! I might get her a little temporary help, but that +would be of no use--she is completely broken down with anxiety and +insufficient food, and unless her eyes have a long holiday she will lose +her sight. No, there's nothing else for it, but it is hard." + +It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor said, a lady. She had lost +both her parents while she was at school. She had no near relations, and +as she was sixteen when her mother died she had remained at school +finishing her education and teaching the younger children. Then she had +obtained a situation as governess in a gentleman's family, and two years +afterwards had married a young barrister who was a frequent visitor at +the house. + +Mr. Andrews was looked upon as a rising man, and for the first seven or +eight years of her marriage his wife's life had been a very happy one. +Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which he caught in one of the +midland towns while on circuit, and although he partially recovered he +was never himself again. His power of work seemed to be lost; a languor +which he could not overcome took possession of him. A troublesome cough +ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs. Andrews was a widow, and +her boy, then nine years old, an orphan. + +During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews had earned but +little in his profession. The comfortable house which he occupied had +been given up, and they had removed to one much smaller. But in spite +of this, debts mounted up, and when, after his death, the remaining +furniture was sold and everything settled, there remained only about +two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get some pupils among her +late husband's friends, but during the last two years she had lost +sight of many of these, and now met with but poor success among the +others. She was a quiet and retiring woman, and shrank from continuous +solicitations, and at the end of three years she found her little +store exhausted. + +Hitherto she had kept George at school, but could no longer do so, +and, giving up her lodging in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where +someone had told her that they thought she would have a better chance +of obtaining pupils, but the cards which some of the tradesmen allowed +her to put in the window led to no result, and finding this to be the +case she applied at one of the milliner's for work. This she obtained, +and for a year supported herself and her boy by needlework. + +From the time when George left school she had gone on teaching him his +lessons; but on the day when he was thirteen years old he declared +that he would no longer submit to his mother working for both of them, +and, setting out, called at shop after shop inquiring if they wanted +an errand-boy. He succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's +where he was to receive three shillings a week and his meals, going +home to sleep at night in the closet-like little attic adjoining the +one room which his mother could now afford. + +For a while they were more comfortable than they had been for some +time; now that his mother had no longer George to feed, her earnings +and the three shillings he brought home every Saturday night enabled +them to live in comparative ease, and on Sunday something like a feast +was always prepared. But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt her +eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and a dull aching pain +settled in the eyeballs. Soon she could only work for a short time +together, her earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers +presently told her that she kept the work so long in hand that they +could no longer employ her. There was now only George's three +shillings a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by the rent. +In despair she had applied to the parish doctor about her eyes. For a +fortnight he attended her, and at the end of that time had +peremptorily given the order of which she had told her son. + +To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must come. Piece by piece +every article of clothing she possessed, save those she wore, had been +pawned for food, and every resource was now exhausted. She was worn +out with the struggle, and the certainty of rest and food overcame her +repugnance to the house. For George's sake too, much as she knew he +would feel her having to accept such a refuge, she was glad that the +struggle was at an end. The lad had for the last six months suffered +greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat down at his +employer's seemed to choke him as he contrasted it with the fare to +which she was reduced, although, as far as possible, she had concealed +from him how sore was her strait. + +George cried himself to sleep that night, and he could scarce speak +when he said good-by to his mother in the morning, for he could not +tell when he should see her again. + +"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?" + +"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet what I shall do; but +please don't ask me to promise anything. You must let me do what I +think best. I have got to make a home for you when you are cured. I am +fourteen now, and am as strong as most boys of my age. I ought to be +able to earn a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings a +week, mother, and you just working a little, you know, so as not to +hurt your eyes, we ought to be able to do. Don't you bother about me, +mother. I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come out. When you +do, then I will do whatever you tell me; that's fair, isn't it?" + +Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he said: + +"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a year's character from +Dutton, so that if I can't get anything else to do I can get the same +sort of place again, and as I am a year older than I was when he took +me, and can tie up parcels neatly now, I ought to get a little more +anyhow. You see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never +grumbled, you know, mother--have I?--I think I would rather do +anything than be a grocer's boy. I would rather, when I grow up, be a +bricklayer's laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's work, +than be pottering about behind a counter, with a white apron on, +weighing out sugar and currants." + +"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews said with a sigh. "It's +natural, my boy. If I get my eyesight and my health again, when you +grow up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and you and I will +go out together to one of the colonies. It will be easier to rise +again there than here, and with hard work both of us might surely hope +to get on. There must be plenty of villages in Australia and Canada +where I could do well with teaching, and you could get work in +whatever way you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set that +before us. It will be something to hope for and work for, and will +cheer us to go through whatever may betide us up to that time." + +"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort indeed to have +something to look forward to. Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but +if anything could it would be some such plan as that." + +The last words he said to his mother as, blinded with tears, he kissed +her before starting to work, were: + +"I shall think of our plan every day, and look forward to that more +than anything else in the world--next to your coming to me again." + +At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews' humble lodging +in a brougham instead of his ordinary gig, having borrowed the +carriage from one of the few of his patients who kept such a vehicle, +on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for she was so weak and worn that he +was sure she would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the three +miles that had to be traversed. He managed in the course of his rounds +to pass the workhouse again in the afternoon, and brought George, +before he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf torn from his +pocketbook: + + "My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything is clean and + nice, and the doctor and people kind. Do not fret about + me.--Your loving mother." + +Although George's expressed resolution of leaving his present +situation, and seeking to earn his living in some other way, caused +Mrs. Andrews much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade him +from it. No doubt it would be wiser for him to stay in his present +situation, where he was well treated and well fed, and it certainly +seemed improbable to her that he would be able to get a better living +elsewhere. Still she could not blame him for wishing at least to try. +She herself shared to some extent his prejudice against the work in +which he was employed. There is no disgrace in honest work; but she +felt that she would rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than +as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed he could come +back again to Croydon, and, with a year's character from his present +employer, would probably be able to obtain a situation similar to that +which he now held. She was somewhat comforted, too, by a few words +the doctor had said to her during their drive. + +"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs. Andrews. He seems to me a +fine steady boy. If I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you +are away from him, I will." + +George remained for another month in his situation, for he knew that +it would never do to start on his undertaking penniless. At the end of +that time, having saved up ten shillings, and having given notice to +his employer, he left the shop for the last time, and started to walk +to London. It was not until he began to enter the crowded streets that +he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking. To be alone in London, +a solitary atom in the busy mass of humanity, is a trying situation +even for a man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying a penny +roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the niches of a bridge over +the river, and then kneeling up watched the barges and steamers +passing below him. + +Had it not been for his mother, his first thought, like that of most +English boys thrown on the world, would have been to go to sea; but +this idea he had from the first steadily set aside as out of the +question. His plan was to obtain employment as a boy in some +manufacturing work, for he thought that there, by steadiness and +perseverance, he might make his way. + +On one thing he was resolved. He would make his money last as long as +possible. Three penny-worth of bread a day would, he calculated, be +sufficient for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought he might manage +to sleep anywhere; it was summer time and the nights were warm. He had +no idea what the price of a bed would be, or how to set about getting +a lodging. He did not care how roughly he lived so that he could but +make his money last. The first few days he determined to look about +him. Something might turn up. If it did not he would set about getting +a place in earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and, keeping +straight on, found himself in Covent Garden, where he was astonished +and delighted at the quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers. + +Although he twice set out in different directions to explore the +streets, he each time returned to Covent Garden. There were many lads +of his own age playing about there, and he thought that from them he +might get some hints as to how to set about earning a living. They +looked ragged and poor enough, but they might be able to tell him +something--about sleeping, for instance. For although before starting +the idea of sleeping anywhere had seemed natural enough, it looked +more formidable now that he was face to face with it. + +Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market he bought two slices +of plum-pudding. He rather grudged the twopence which he paid; but he +felt that it might be well laid out. Provided with the pudding he +returned to the market, sat himself down on an empty basket, and began +to eat slowly and leisurely. + +In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own age watching him +greedily. + +He was far from being a respectable-looking boy. His clothes were +ragged, and his toes could be seen through a hole in his boot. He wore +neither hat nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been combed +since the day of his birth. There was a sharp, pinched look on his +face. But had he been washed and combed and decently clad he would not +have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate George liked his face better +than most he had seen in the market, and he longed for a talk with +someone. So he held out his other slice of pudding, and said: + +"Have a bit?" + +"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?" + +"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?" + +"No larks?" asked the boy. + +"No; no larks. Here you are." + +Feeling assured now that no trick was intended the boy approached, +took without a word the pudding which George held out, and, seating +himself on a basket close to him, took a great bite. + +"Where do you live?" George asked, when the slice of pudding had half +disappeared. + +"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand round. + +"I mean, where do you sleep?" + +The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place was included in +the general description of his domicile. + +"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired. + +"The beaks, they moves you on when they ketches you; but ef yer get +under a cart or in among the baskets you generally dodges 'em." + +"And suppose you want to pay for a place to sleep, where do you go and +how much do you pay?" + +"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a first-rate, fourpence. +Does yer want to find a crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his +companion. + +"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find some quiet place where I can +sleep, cheap, you know." + +"Out of work?" the boy inquired. + +"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present. I am looking for a +place, you know." + +"Don't know no one about?" + +"No; I have just come in from Croydon." + +The boy shook his head. + +"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said. "Why, yer'd get them +clothes and any money yet had walked off with the wery fust night." + +"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose, even for fourpence?" +George asked, making a rapid calculation that this would come to two +and fourpence per week, as much as his mother had paid for a +comparatively comfortable room in Croydon. + +The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his companion requiring a +room for himself. + +"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with yer!" + +"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just some place to sleep in. +Just some straw in any quiet corner." + +This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he thought the matter +over. + +"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place where they puts up the +hosses of the market carts. I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when +it's wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it warm and +comfortable just! I helps him with the hosses sometimes, and that's +why. I will ax him if yer likes." + +George assented at once. His ideas as to the possibility of sleeping +in the open air had vanished when he saw the surroundings, and a bed +in a quiet loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in a room +with twenty others. + +"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and what's your name?" + +"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather proudly; "but my real +name's Bill." + +"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George asked. + +"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands on me," Bill +replied. + +"But what do they want to lay hands on you for?" George asked. + +"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied calmly. + +"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?" George said, greatly shocked. + +"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied; "not wipes, yer +know, nor tickers, nor them kind of things. I aint never prigged +nothing of that kind." + +"Well, what is it then you do--prig?" George asked, mystified. + +"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes, onions sometimes, or +'taters. That aint regular prigging, you know." + +"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing," George said, after a +pause. + +"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all," the Shadow said +angrily. "Everyone as aint a fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no +one can't say as a apple and a ticker are the same." + +"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you see one is just as much +stealing as the other." + +"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the same as money and +t'other aint. I am hungry and I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint +the worse for it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here? Why, +there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is rotten. Well, it aint +no more if I takes one than if it was rotten. Is it now?" + +George thought there was a difference, but he did not feel equal to +explaining it. + +"The policemen must think differently," he said at last, "else they +wouldn't be always trying to catch you." + +"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously. "I don't; and I +don't want no more jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer +leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I? So now then." + +George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and moreover he saw that +in the event of a quarrel his chance of finding a refuge for the night +was small. In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he was +loath to break with the only acquaintance he had made. + +"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said; "only I was sorry to +hear you say you took things. It seems to me you might get into +trouble; and it would be better after all to work for a living." + +"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively. "Who's agoing to give me +work? Does yer think I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for +'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing about my character, I +suppose? nor where I had worked before? nor where my feyther lived? +nor nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming easy to get work +about here; only got to ax for it, that's all. Good wages and all +found, that's your kind." + +"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but it seems to me people +could get something to do if they tried." + +"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think we don't try! Why, we +are always trying to earn a copper or two. Why, we begins at three +o'clock in the morning when the market-carts come in, and we goes on +till they comes out of that there theater at night, just trying to +pick up a copper. Sometimes one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's a +good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner by the end of it. +Don't tell me! And now as to this ere stable; yer means it?" + +"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it." + +"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at nine o'clock. I will go +before that and square it with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking +of." + +"I had better give you something to give him," George said. "Will a +shilling do?" + +"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights. Are you going to trust +me with it?" + +"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure you wouldn't be so mean +as to do me out of it; besides, you told me that you never stole money +and those sort of things." + +"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob for all that," Bill +replied; "and yer are running a risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer +goes on with that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore yer've +done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going to bilk yer." + +The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of confidence on the part +of his companion really touched him, and as he went off he said to +himself, "He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so precious +green. I must look arter him a bit and see he don't get into no +mischief." + +George, on his part, as he walked away down into the Strand again, +felt that he had certainly run a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of +his capital to his new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner had +attracted him, and he felt that, although the Shadow's notions of +right and wrong might be of a confused nature, he meant to act +straight toward him. + +George passed the intervening hours before the time named for his +meeting in Covent Garden in staring into the shop windows in the +Strand, and in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles and foot +passengers flowing steadily out westward. He was nearly knocked under +the wheels of the vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to +the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused by the jostling +and pushing that he was glad to turn down a side street and to sit +down for a time on a doorstep. + +When nine o'clock approached he went into a baker's shop and bought a +loaf, which would, he thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself +and his companion. Having further invested threepence in cheese, he +made his way up to the market. + +The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling loudly. + +"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along. I have squared Ned, +and it's all right." + +He led the way down two or three streets and then stopped at a +gateway. + +"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as there aint no one but Ned +about." + +He returned in a minute. + +"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a hoss; he won't take no +notice of yer as yer pass. He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause +in case anyone comed and found yer up there he could swear he never +saw yer go in, and didn't know nothing about yer. I will go with yer +to the door, and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer whip +up that yer'll find it all right up there." + +"But you are coming too, aint you?" George asked. + +"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a chap like me up there. I +might pick yer pocket, yer know; besides I aint your sort." + +"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like to have you with me, Bill; +I should really. Besides, what's the difference between us? We have +both got to work for ourselves and make our way in the world." + +"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the way as I do; yer have +been brought up different. Don't tell me." + +"I may have been brought up differently, Bill. I have been fortunate +there; but now, you see, I have got to get my living in the best way I +can, and if I have had a better education than you have, you know ever +so much more about London and how to get your living than I do, so +that makes us quits." + +"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same to this child. So if +yer aint too proud, here goes." + +He led the way down a stable yard, past several doors, showing the +empty stalls which would be all filled when the market carts arrived. +At the last door on the right he stopped. George looked in. At the +further end a man was rubbing down a horse by the faint light of a +lantern, the rest of the stable was in darkness. + +"This way," Bill whispered. + +Keeping close behind him, George entered the stable. The boy stopped +in the corner. + +"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give yer a hand when yer +gets to the top." + +George stood quiet until his companion had mounted, and then ascended +the ladder, which was fixed against the wall. Presently a voice +whispered in his ear: + +"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your foot." + +In a minute he was standing in the loft. His companion drew him along +in the darkness, and in a few steps arrived at a pile of hay. + +"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer 'ave only to make +yourself comfortable there. Now mind you don't fall down one of the +holes into the mangers." + +"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he ensconced himself +in the hay. + +"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill said, as he left his +side, and directly afterwards a door opened and the light of a +gaslight in the yard streamed in. + +"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said as he rejoined him. +"I shuts it up afore I goes to sleep, 'cause the master he comes out +sometimes when the carts comes in, and there would be a blooming row +if he saw it open; but we are all right now." + +"That's much nicer," George said. "Now here's a loaf I brought with +me. We will cut it in half and put by a half for the morning, and eat +the other half between us now, and I have got some cheese here too." + +"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good sort, I could see that, +and I am pretty empty, I am, for I aint had nothing except that bit +of duff yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust then. 'Cept +for running against you I aint been lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job +nohows, and it aint for want of trying neither." + +For some minutes the boys ate in silence. George had given much the +largest portion to his companion, for he himself was too dead tired to +be very hungry. When he had finished, he said: + +"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning. I am so dead beat I can +scarcely keep my eyes open, so I will just say my prayers and go off +to sleep." + +"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment. "Do yer mean to say as +yer says prayers!" + +"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?" + +"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly; "don't know how, +don't see as it would do no good ef I did." + +"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I hope some day you will think +differently, and I will teach you some you will like." + +"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively. "A missionary chap, +he came and prayed with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not +make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same, so you see what +good did it do her?" + +But George was too tired to enter upon a theological argument. He was +already half asleep, and Bill's voice sounded a long way off. + +"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you in the morning," and in +another minute he was fast asleep. + +Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly over his companion; +then he closed the door of the loft and threw himself on the hay, and +was soon also sound asleep. When George woke in the morning the +daylight was streaming in through the cracks of the door. His +companion was gone. He heard the voices of several men in the yard, +while a steady champing noise and an occasional shout or the sound of +a scraping on the stones told him the stalls below were all full now. + +George felt that he had better remain where he was. Bill had told him +the evening before that the horses and carts generally set out again +at about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better wait till they had +gone before he slipped down below. Closing his eyes he was very soon +off to sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by his side looking +at him. + +"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said. "Why, it's nigh ten +o'clock, and it's time for us to be moving. Ned will be going off in a +few minutes, and the stables will be locked up till the evening." + +"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?" George asked. + +"No, we had better eat it when we get down to the market; come +along." + +George at once rose, shook the hay off his clothes, and descended the +ladder, Bill leading the way. There was no one in the stable, and the +yard was also empty. On reaching the market they sat down on two empty +baskets, and at once began to eat their bread and cheese. + + + + +CHAPTER II. + +TWO FRIENDS. + + +"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he had eaten a few +mouthfuls; "but you were out." + +"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to come in," Bill said, +"and a wery good morning I have had. One old chap gave me twopence for +looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into the market with his +flowers. But the best move was just now. A chap as was driving off +with flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect, by the look +of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't see it till I ran after him +with it, then he gave me a tanner; that was something like. Have yer +finished yer bread and cheese?" + +"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink of water if I could +get one." + +"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you come along with me, I +am agoing to stand two cups of coffee if yer aint too proud to take +it;" and he looked doubtfully at his companion. + +"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he saw that the +slightest hesitation would hurt his companion's feelings. + +"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a brightened look on +his face he turned and led the way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's +hot and sweet, and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny." + +George found the coffee really better than he had expected, and Bill +was evidently very much gratified at his expression of approval. + +"Now," he said, when they had both finished, "for a draw of 'baccy," +and he produced a short clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?" + +"No, I haven't begun yet." + +"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is," Bill said. "Why, when +yer are cold and hungry and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful +thing, and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer thirty pipes +if yer don't squeeze it in too hard. Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs +threepence halfpenny, so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a +penny; and now," he went on when he had filled and lit his pipe, +"let's know what's yer game." + +"You mean what am I going to do?" George asked. + +Bill nodded. + +"I want to get employment in some sort of works. I have been an +errand-boy in a grocer's for more than a year, and I have got a +written character from my master in my pocket; but I don't like the +sort of thing; I would rather work with my own hands. There are plenty +of works where they employ boys, and you know one might get on as one +gets older. The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of that +sort are." + +"There are lots of works at the East End, I have heard tell," Bill +said; "and then there's Clerkenwell and King's Cross, they aint so far +off, and there are works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but +I don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The only work as I have +done is holding hosses and carrying plants into the market, and +sometimes when I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out what I +got in _Echoes_, or _Globes_, or _Evening Standards_; that pays yer, +that does, for if yer can sell them all yer will get a bob for eight +penn'orth of papers, that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and +I calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out for a bob! +Oh, no, I should think not! Well, what shall it be? I knows the way +out to Whitechapel and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I can +show yer." + +"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try that first," George +said, "and I shall be much obliged to you for showing the way." + +The two boys spent the whole day in going from workshop to workshop +for employment; but the answers to his application were unvarying: +either he was too young or there was no place vacant. George took the +disappointment quietly, for he had made up his mind that he would have +difficulty in getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf +of his companion. + +"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A chap can pick up a few +coppers there, and here we have been a-tramping about all day and aint +done nothing." + +Day after day George set out on his quest, but all was without +success. He and Bill still slept in the loft, and after the first day +he took to getting up at the same time as his companion, and going out +with him to try and pick up a few pence from the men with the +market-carts. Every other morning they were able to lie later, as +there were only regular marketdays three mornings a week. + +On market mornings he found that he earned more than Bill, his better +clothes giving him an advantage, as the men were more willing to trust +their carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking boy +than to that of the arabs who frequented the Garden. But all that was +earned was laid out in common between the two boys, and George found +himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence on his private stock. +He had by this time told the Shadow exactly how much money he had, and +the boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting work, was +most averse to the store being trenched upon, and always gave his vote +against the smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread and +cheese being purchased, except from their earnings of the day. This +George felt was the more creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the +latter had, in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the petty +thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned his dry crusts. + +George had learned now what Bill knew of his history, which was little +enough. He supposed he had had a father, but he knew nothing of him; +whether he had died, or whether he had cut away and left mother, Bill +had no idea. His mother he remembered well, though she had died when +he was, as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in a hushed +voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior being. + +"We was poor, you know," he said to George, "and I know mother was +often short of grub, but she was just kind. I don't never remember her +whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she was good, she was. +She used to pray, you know, and what I remember most is as the night +afore she was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live honest, +Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't you take to stealing, +however poor you may be;' and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and +over again. "When I has seed any chap going along with a ticker handy, +which I could have boned and got away among the carts as safe as +ninepence, or when I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of +them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to bless myself with, and +perhaps nothing to eat all day, I have felt it hard not to make a +grab; but I just thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I +told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or out of the +baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as that was stealing, but as +you says it is, I aint going to do so no more. Now look yer here, +George; they tells me as the parsons says as when people die and they +are good they goes up there, yer know." + +George nodded, for there was a question in his companion's tone. + +"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there. Now it aint likely +as ever I should see her again, 'cause, you know, there aint nothing +good about me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I might be, and +was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been a-stealing?' do yer think she +would feel very bad about them 'ere apples and things?" + +"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see you didn't quite know that +was stealing, and you kept from stealing the things that you thought +she spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking even little +things you are not going to take them any more." + +"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said; "not if I never gets +another apple between my teeth." + +"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it, not only to please +your mother, but to please God. That's what my mother has told me over +and over again." + +"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest, "and did you use to prig +apples and sichlike sometimes?" + +"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but she was talking of +things in general. Of doing things that were wrong, such as telling +lies and deceiving, and that sort of thing." + +"And your mother thinks as God knows all about it?" + +George nodded. + +"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done bad?" + +George nodded again. + +"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill said in solemn wonder. +"Why, I heard a woman say last week as six children was enough to +worrit anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of us!" and +Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive way and repeated, "What a time +he must have of it!" + +For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill wondering over the +problem that had presented itself to him, and George trying to find +some appropriate explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had +started. At last he said: + +"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to you, for I am not +accustomed to talk about such things. My mother talks to me sometimes, +and of course I went to church regularly; but that's different from my +talking about it; but you know what we have got to do is to try and +please God, and love him because he loves us." + +"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've heard fellows say +beats 'em. If he loves a chap like me how is it he don't do something +for him? why don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint been +a-prigging apples or a-putting him out. That's what I wants to know." + +"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it would be very hard +to understand if this world were the only one; but you see we are only +here a little time, and after that there's on and on and on, right up +without any end, and what does it matter if we are poor or unhappy in +this little time if we are going to be ever so happy afterwards? This +is only a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were, and +if we do the best we can, even though that best is very little, then +you see we get a tremendous reward. For instance, you would not think +a man was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his horse on a cold +day, if he were going to give you enough to get you clothes and good +lodging for the rest of your life." + +"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so it's like that, is +it?" + +George nodded. "Like that, only more." + +"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in astonishment at this new +view of things. + +After that there were few evenings when, before they nestled +themselves down in the hay, the boys did not talk on this subject. At +first George felt awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the +generality of English boys, however earnest their convictions may be, +he was shy of speaking what he felt; but his companion's eagerness to +know more of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak, and +having in his bundle a small Bible which his mother had given him, he +took to reading to Bill a chapter or two in the mornings when they had +not to go out to the early market. + +It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled him. The boy saw +things in a light so wholly different from that in which he himself +had been accustomed to regard them that he found a great difficulty in +replying to them. + +George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her exactly what he was +doing, for he knew that if he only said that he had not yet succeeded +in getting work she would be very anxious about him, and although he +had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at least he could tell her that +he had sufficient to eat and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he +received replies from her, directed to him at a little coffee-house, +which, when they had had luck, the boys occasionally patronized. As +time went on without his succeeding in obtaining employment George's +hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate; "I will try for another +fortnight, Bill, and if at the end of that time I don't get anything +to do I shall go back to Croydon again." + +"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated. + +"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving, but that is all, +Bill. I came up to London in hopes of getting something to do by which +I might some day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this I +should be going down, and a nice sight I should be to mother if, when +she gets well enough to come out of the infirmary, I were to go back +all in rags." + +"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked. "Is there any chance of +picking up a living there? 'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I +goes with yer. I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we +might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer wouldn't mind that?" + +"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a good friend to me, and +I should be sorry to think of you all alone here." + +"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied. "I aint done +nothing except put yer in the way of getting a sleeping-place, and as +it's given me one too I have had the best of that job. It's been good +of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't know how to read or +write or nothing, and as aint no good anyway. But you will let me go +with yer to Croydon, won't yer?" + +"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to see much of me. I +shall have to get a place like the last. The man I was with said he +would take me back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am all +day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of course you would +have to be busy too at something." + +"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I can hold a hoss, but that +aint much for a living. One may go for days without getting a chance." + +"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would be to try and get +work either in a brickfield or with a market-gardener. At any rate we +should be able to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was +always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in work we could take +a room together." + +Bill shook his head. + +"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it, George. I knows as I +aint fit company for yer, and if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he +would think yer was going to run off with the money if he knew yer +kept company with a chap like me. No, the 'greement must be as yer +goes yer ways and I goes mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to +do up here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this place of +yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on getting work here." + +A week later the two boys were out late in Covent Garden trying to +earn a few pence by fetching up cabs and carriages for people coming +out from a concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded in +earning threepence, and had returned to the entrance to the hall, and +was watching the people come out, and trying to get another job. +Presently a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years old, came +out and took their place on the footpath. + +"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked. + +"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it." + +George fell back and stood watching the girl, who was in a white +dress, with a little hood trimmed with swansdown over her head. + +Presently his eye fell on something on which the light glittered as it +hung from her neck. Just as he was looking a hand reached over her +shoulder, there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child, then a +boy dived into the crowd, and at the same moment George dashed after +him. There was a cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab +at George as he dived through the crowd; but he slipped through them +and was soon in the roadway. + +Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy running. He turned up +Bow Street and then dashed down an alley. He did not know that he was +followed until suddenly George sprang upon his back, and the two fell +with a crash, the young thief undermost. George seized his right hand, +and kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and forced him to +open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise, and not knowing who was +his assailant, making but slight resistance. + +George seized the gold locket and dashed back at full speed into the +market, and was soon in the thick of the crowd round the entrance. The +gentleman was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking a note +of the description of the lost trinket. The girl was standing by +crying. + +"Here is your locket," George said, putting it into her hand. "I saw +the boy take it, and have got it from him." + +"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my locket again." + +"Why, where did you get it from?" her father asked in astonishment. + +"This boy has just given it to me," she replied. "He says he took it +from the boy who stole it." + +"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who brought it back?" + +The girl looked round, but George was gone. + +"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her father said. "Of course I +should wish to thank and reward him, for the locket was a very +valuable one, and the more so to us from its having belonged to your +mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?" + +"No, sir, I did not see him at all." + +"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?" + +"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied. "At least I +don't think so; but I only looked at his face. He didn't speak like a +poor boy at all." + +"Would you know him again?" + +"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking boy with a nice +face." + +"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my dear. Evidently he does +not want a reward, but at any rate I should have liked to thank him. +Are you always on this beat, policeman?" + +"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are on." + +"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables who are about here in +the daytime. I wish you would mention the fact to them, and ask them +if they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me this service, to +let me know. Here is a card with my name and address." + +After restoring the locket George made his way to the entrance to the +stables, where he generally met Bill after the theater had closed and +there was no farther chance of earning money. It was not till half an +hour later that the boy came running up. + +"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is something like luck. I got +three jobs. One stood me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence +each. What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee afore we turns +in?" + +"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence. We will put +that by, with the sixpence we saved the other day, for the hostler. We +haven't given him anything for some time. Your eightpence will get us +a good breakfast in the morning." + +When they had comfortably nestled themselves in the hay George told +his companion how he had rescued and restored the locket. + +"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd tell of such a scaly +trick as that. I should ha' said it ought to have been good for a bob +anyway." + +"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given the little girl her +locket I bolted." + +"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have waited to have seen what +the bloke meant to give yer?" + +"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as that," George replied. +"I don't mind being paid when I have done a job for anyone; but this +was different altogether." + +Bill meditated for a minute or two. + +"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last. "Yer did him a +good turn, and got the thing back. I dare say it were worth five bob." + +"A good deal more than that, Bill." + +"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have come down handsome. +Didn't yer run like winking, and didn't yer jump on the chap's back +and knock him down, and didn't yer run back again? And warn't there a +chance, ef one of the bobbies had got hold of yer collar and found it +in yer hand, of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer walks +off and don't give him a chance of giving yer nuffin. My eye, but yer +are a flat!" + +"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill. But when people do a +thing to oblige somebody, and not as a piece of regular work, they +don't expect to be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered +me money for such a thing." + +"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill rejoined; "but it +seems a rum sort of notion to me. When people loses things they +expects to pay to get 'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice +station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so much for giving +back things as is lost. I can't read 'em myself, yer know; but chaps +have read 'em to me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being +offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies coming out of +theayters, and I have often thought what a turn of luck it would be to +light on one of 'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the money +ef I found it." + +"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing and saw a reward +offered, and you wanted the money, you would have good right to take +it. But, you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at losing +her locket, and I went after it to please her, and I was quite content +that I got it back for her." + +Bill tried again to think the matter over in his mind, but he was +getting warm and sleepy, and in a few minutes was sound off. + +Two or three days later the lads had, to their great satisfaction, +obtained a job. Walnuts were just coming in, and the boys were engaged +to take off the green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he +had never before been taken on for such a job, and he considered it a +sort of promotion. Five or six women were also employed, and as the +group were standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly nudged his +friend: + +"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?" + +George looked up from his work and at once recognized the girl to whom +he had restored the locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment. + +"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if you brought me down to +the market I felt sure I should know the boy again if I saw him. +That's him, the one looking down into the basket. But he knew me +again, for I saw him look surprised when he noticed me." + +The gentleman made his way through the women to George. + +"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket to my daughter three +evenings ago?" + +"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked up. "I was standing +close by when the boy took it, so I gave chase and brought it back, +and that's all." + +"You were off again in such a hurry that we hadn't time to thank you. +Just come across to my daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for +a minute?" + +"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George said, and looking rather +shamefaced he followed the gentleman to the sidewalk. + +"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie." + +"I was sure I should know him again," the child said, "though I only +saw him for a moment. We are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and +me, because it had been mamma's locket, and we should have been very +sorry to have lost it." + +"I am glad I was able to get it back for you," George said; "but I +don't want to be thanked for doing it; and I don't want to be paid +either, thank you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his +hand into his pocket. + +"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise. "You have done me a +great service, and there is no reason why I should not pay you for it. +If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to get it back." + +"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all the same I would +rather not be paid for a little thing like that." + +"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said again. "One does not +expect to find a boy in the market here refusing money when he has +earned it." + +"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George said; "but I don't +call getting back a locket for a young lady who has lost it earning +money." + +"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a boy who has been brought +up in the market here." + +"I have only been here three months," George said. "I came up to +London to look for work, but could not get any. Most days I go about +looking for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's a chance." + +"What sort of work do you want? Have you been accustomed to any work? +Perhaps I could help you." + +"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George answered; "but I didn't +like it, and I thought I would rather get some sort of work that I +could work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking in a shop." + +"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman asked. + +"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an infirmary, and so as I +was alone I thought I would come to London and try to get the sort of +work I liked; but I have tried almost all over London." + +"And are you all alone here?" + +"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in that boy there, and we +have worked together since I came up." + +"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it you." + +"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently. + +"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some works down at Limehouse +and employ a good many boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card +from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of it, and handed it to +George. + +"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he will arrange for you +to begin work on Monday. Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the +fruit for to-morrow, you know." + +So saying he took his daughter's hand, and George, wild with delight, +ran off to tell Bill that he had obtained work for them both. + +"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?" + +"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa; didn't he look pleased? +Wasn't it funny his saying he wouldn't have any money?" + +"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal in Covent Garden; +but you were right, child, and you are a better judge of character +than I gave you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad, and +spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is really a very good style of +boy. Of course he is shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an +errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better brought up than +the generality of such lads. The one he called his friend looked a +wild sort of specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I should +say he was one of the regular arabs hanging about this place. If so, I +expect a very few days' work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be +surprised if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it." + +The next morning the two boys presented themselves at Mr. Penrose's +works at Limehouse. These were sawing and planing works, and the sound +of many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws innumerable, came +out through the open windows of the building as they entered the yard. + +"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said as he appeared at one of +the doors. + +"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I have a card for him from +Mr. Penrose." + +"I will let him know," the man replied. + +Two minutes later the foreman came out, and George handed him the +card. He read what Mr. Penrose had written upon it and said: + +"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay, eight shillings a week; +seven o'clock; there, that will do. Oh, what are your names?" taking +out a pocket-book. "George Andrews and William Smith;" and then, with +a nod, he went back into his room, while the boys, almost bewildered +at the rapidity with which the business had been arranged, went out +into the street again. + +"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in delight. + +"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more doubtful tone; "it's a +rum start, aint it? I don't expect I shall make much hand of it, but I +am wery glad for you, George." + +"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it? You are as strong as I am." + +"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed to work regular, and I +expect I shan't like it--not at first; but I am going to try. George, +don't yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort; still I +expects I shall get the sack afore long." + +"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once get accustomed to it, +and it's a thousand times better having to draw your pay regularly at +the end of the week than to get up in the morning not knowing whether +you are going to have breakfast or not. Won't mother be pleased when I +write and tell her I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said +that she was a great deal better, and the doctor thought she would be +out in the spring, and then I hope she will be coming up here, and +that will be jolly." + +"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it is; you and I will +get on fust-rate, but it aint likely as your mother would put up with +a chap like me." + +"My mother knows that you have been a good friend to me, Bill, and +that will be quite enough for her. You wait till you see her." + +"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about here!" Bill said, +"just all the same pattern; and how wide the streets is to what they +is up Drury Lane!" + +"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a room here, Bill, now +that we shall have money to pay for it; only think, we shall have +sixteen shillings a week between us!" + +"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen bob! My eye, there +aint no saying what it will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more +respectable," he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies of +his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden; but to go to work with a +lot of other chaps, these togs aint what you may call spicy." + +"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with a laugh. "We must see +what we can manage." + +George's own clothes were worn and old, but they looked respectable +indeed by the side of those of his companion. Bill's elbows were both +out, the jacket was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his +trousers were far too large for him, and were kept up by a single +brace, and were patched in a dozen places. + +When George first met him he was shoeless, but soon after they had set +up housekeeping together George had bought from a cobbler's stall a +pair of boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost +falling to pieces, were still the best part of Bill's outfit. + + + + +CHAPTER III. + +WORK. + + +The next morning George went out with the bundle containing his Sunday +clothes, which had been untouched since his arrival in town, and going +to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit of working clothes +in fair condition, and then returning hid his bundle in the hay and +rejoined Bill, who had from early morning been at work shelling +walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised at his companion not +beginning work at the usual time he asked no questions, for his faith +in George was so unbounded that everything he did was right in his +eyes. + +"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill," George said as +they reached their loft that evening. + +"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no doubt; but I expects it +aint mine by a long way. I have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and +I don't think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint fit to +go to such a place, and they are sure to make it hot for me." + +"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish sort of boys in +works of that sort, and you will soon be at home with the rest." + +"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the interruption, "I +shall be getting into some blooming row or other afore I have been +there a week, and they will like enough turn you out as well as me. +That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If they chucks me the +chances are as they chucks you too; and if they did that arter all the +pains you have had to get a place I should go straight off and make a +hole in the water. That's how I looks at it." + +"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance of your getting into +a row. Of course at first we must both expect to be blown up +sometimes, but if we do our best and don't answer back again we shall +do as well as the others." + +"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I am pretty well used to +getting blown up. Every one's always at it, and I know well enough as +it don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a market-cart +between you and a clear road for a bolt. I wasn't born yesterday. +Yer've been wery good to me, you have, George, and before any harm +should come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself under a +market-wagon." + +"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say, you have been a far +greater help to me than I have to you. Anyhow we are not going to part +now. You are coming to work with me to start with, and I know you will +do your best to keep your place. If you fail, well, so much the worse, +it can't be helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Penrose I +feel quite sure that the foreman would not turn me off even if he had +to get rid of you." + +"D'yer think so?" + +"I do, indeed, Bill." + +"Will yer take yer davey?" + +"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will take my davey that +I do not think that they would turn me off even if they sent you +away." + +"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help yer?" + +"Really and truly, Bill." + +"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer, it's 'cause yer wishes +me." + +So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and George soon heard by +his regular breathing that he was sound asleep. + +The next morning, before anyone was stirring, they went down into the +yard, as was their custom on Sunday mornings, for a good wash, +stripping to the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each other. +Bill had at first protested against the fashion, saying as he did very +well and did not see no use in it; but seeing that George really +enjoyed it he followed his example. After a morning or two, indeed, +and with the aid of a piece of soap which George had bought, Bill got +himself so bright and shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and +remark from his former companions, which led to more than one +pugilistic encounter. + +That morning George remained behind in the loft for a minute or two +after Bill had run down, attired only in his trousers. When Bill went +up the ladder after his ablutions he began hunting about in the hay. + +"What are you up to, Bill?" + +"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of yourn knocking about, but +I can't see where's mine, nor my jacket neither." + +"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find them, and even if +you found them you couldn't put 'em on. I have torn them up." + +"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation. "What lark are +yer up to now, George?" + +"No lark at all. We are going together to work to-morrow, and you +could not go as you were; so you put on that shirt and those things," +and he threw over the clothes he had procured the day before. + +Bill looked in astonishment. + +"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows yer only had four bob +with what we got yesterday. Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't--no, +in course yer didn't--nip 'em." + +"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said, laughing. "I swapped +my Sunday clothes for them yesterday. I can do without them very well +till we earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say anything +about it, Bill, else I will punch your head." + +Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute, and then threw +himself down in the hay and burst into tears. + +"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed. "What have you to cry +about?" + +"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed, "to find a chap +doing things for him like that? I wish I may die if I don't feel as if +I should bust. It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one +side; that's the wust of it." + +"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill; so don't let's say +anything more about it, but put on your clothes. We will have a cup of +coffee each and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will go +for a walk into the park, the same as we did last Sunday, and hear the +preaching." + +The next morning they were up at their accustomed hour and arrived at +the works at Limehouse before the doors were opened. Presently some +men and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the two boys followed +the others in. + +"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate asked. + +George gave their names, and the man looked at his time-book. + +"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You are to go into that +planing-shop," and he pointed to one of the doors opening into the +yard. + +The boys were not long before they were at work. Bill was ordered to +take planks from a large pile and to hand them to a man, who passed +them under one of the planing-machines. George was told to take them +away as fast as they were finished and pile them against a wall. When +the machines stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were to +sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags, in which they were +carried to the engine-house. + +For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the whirl of the machinery, +the rapid motion of the numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of +the broad bands which carried the power from them to the machinery on +the floor, by the storm of shavings which flew from the cutters, and +the unceasing activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving +an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone--for conversation in an +ordinary voice would have been inaudible--nothing occurred till the +bell rang at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery +suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded the din which had +prevailed. + +"How long have we got now?" George asked the man from whose bench he +had been taking the planks. + +"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried away. + +"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George asked when they had got +outside. + +"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill replied. "Why, talk +about the Garden! Lor', why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what +I was a-doing at first." + +"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you do and not touch any of +those straps and wheels and things. I know when I was at Croydon there +was a man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the strap; they +said it drew him up and smashed him against the ceiling. And now we +had better look out for a baker's." + +"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere handy?" + +"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we have no time to spare +to look for one. There's a pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of +water as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem very hard, Bill," +George said as they ate their bread. + +"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't for all them +rattling wheels. But I expect it aint going to be like that regular. +They've just gived us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be +worse presently." + +"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill, and I don't think we +shall find the work any harder. They don't put boys at hard work, but +just jobs like we are doing, to help the men." + +"What shall we do about night, George?" + +"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the man we work for. He +looks a good-natured sort of chap. He may know of someone he could +recommend us to." + +They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as they came out George +said to the man with whom they were working: + +"We want to get a room. We have been lodging together in London, and +don't know anyone down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of +some quiet, respectable people who have a room to let?" + +The man looked at George more closely than he had hitherto done. + +"Well, there aint many people as would care about taking in two boys, +but you seem a well-spoken young chap and different to most of 'em. Do +you think you could keep regular hours, and not come clattering in and +out fifty times in the evening, and playing tom-fools' tricks of all +sorts?" + +"I don't think we should be troublesome," George said; "and I am quite +sure we shouldn't be noisy." + +"You would want to be cooked for, in course?" + +"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond hot water for a cup of +tea in the evening, we should not want much cooking done, especially +if there is a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in the +morning." + +"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?" + +George looked puzzled. + +"I mean bed and chairs, and so on." + +George shook his head. + +"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't any now." + +"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows. I have got a bedroom in +my place empty. A brother of mine who lodged and worked with me has +just got a job as foreman down in the country. At any rate I will try +you for a week, and if at the end of that time you and my missis don't +get on together you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that will +about suit you?" + +George said that would suit very well, and expressed his thanks to the +man for taking them in. + +They had been walking briskly since they left the works, and now +stopped suddenly before the door of a house in a row. It was just like +its neighbor, except that George noticed that the blinds and windows +were cleaner than the others, and that the door had been newly painted +and varnished. + +"Here we are," the man said. "You had best come in and see the missis +and the room. Missis!" he shouted, and a woman appeared from the +backroom. "I have let Harry's room, mother," he said, "and these are +the new lodgers." + +"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't mean to say that you let +the room to them two boys. I should have thought you had better sense. +Why, they will be trampling up and down the stairs like young hosses, +wear out the oil cloth, and frighten the baby into fits. I never did +hear such a thing!" + +"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't give much trouble. At +any rate I have agreed to try them for a week, and if you don't get +on with them at the end of that time, of course they must go. They +have only come to work at the shop to-day; they work with me, and as +far as I can see they are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads, +I will show you your room." + +It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the house, over the +kitchen, which was built out there. It was a comfortable little room, +not large, but sufficiently so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest +of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a strip of carpet +ran alongside the bed, and there was, moreover, a small fireplace. + +"Will that do for you?" the man asked. + +"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;" while Bill was so +taken aback by its comfort and luxury that he was speechless. + +"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If you have got any +things you can bring 'em in when you like." + +"We have not got any to speak of," George said, flushing a little. "I +came up from the country three months ago to look for work, and beyond +odd jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything I had is +pretty well gone; but I can pay a week's rent in advance," he said, +putting his hand in his pocket. + +"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as you work in the shop +it's safe enough. Now I must get my dinner, else I shall be late for +work." + +"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George asked as they left the +house. + +"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it nice just! Why, yer +couldn't get a room like that, not furnished, anywhere near the +market, not at four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if the +house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down every day! What a +woman that must be for washing!" + +"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and make as little +mess as we can in going in and out." + +"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to me as if it could be +true as we're to have such a room as that to ourselves, and to walk +into a house bold without being afraid as somebody would have his eye +on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week for grub regular." + +"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill; pretty near half our +time must be gone, and mind we must be very saving at first. There +will be several things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot, +and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a gridiron for frying +rashers of bacon upon." + +"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in. + +"And we shall want some towels," George went on with his enumeration. + +"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they like?" + +"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face after you have +washed." + +"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of course we must get 'em; +but I've always found my hands dried quick enough by themselves, +especially if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers." + +"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I want to save every +penny we can, so as to get some things to furnish two rooms by the +time mother comes out." + +"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly, though a slight shade +passed over his face at the thought that they were not to be always +alone together. "Well, yer know, George, I am game for anythink. I can +hold on with a penn'orth of bread a day. I have done it over and over, +and if yer says the word I am ready to do it again." + +"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed. "Still, we must live +as cheap as we can. We will stick to bread for breakfast, and bread +and cheese for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a rasher +as a great treat. At any rate we will try to live on six shillings a +week." + +"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently; "and then two +shillings for rent, and that will leave us eight shillings a week to +put by." + +"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she would be able to come +out 'til the spring. We are just at the beginning of November, so if +she comes out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two +weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings, let me see. That's eight +pounds in twenty weeks, eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would +furnish two rooms very well, I should think." + +"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for to his mind eight +pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of sum, and the fact that his +companion had been able to calculate it increased if possible his +admiration for him. + +It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs. Grimstone to her new +lodgers. + +"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of the week to a +neighbor, "as two boys could have been that quiet. They comes in after +work as regular as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat, and +you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't hear no more of 'em +till they goes out agin in the morning. They don't come back here to +breakfast or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing like." + +"But what do they do with themselves all the evening, Mrs. Grimstone?" + +"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can hear a voice going +regular over the kitchen." + +"And how's their room?" + +"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't lock the door when they +goes out, and I looked in yesterday, expecting to find it like a +pigsty; but they had made the bed afore starting for work, and set +everything in its place, and laid the fire like for when they come +back." + +Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended six pence in as many +old books at a bookstall. One of them was a spelling-book, and he had +at once set to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first +protested. "He had done very well without reading, and didn't see much +good in it." However, as George insisted he gave way, as he would have +done to any proposition whatever upon which his friend had set his +mind. So for an hour every evening after they had finished tea Bill +worked at his letters and spelling, and then George read aloud to him +from one of the other books. + +"You must get on as fast as you can this winter, Bill," he said; +"because when the summer evenings come we shall want to go for long +walks." + +They found that they did very well upon the sum they agreed on. Tea +and sugar cost less than George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in +for them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for tea they were +generally able to afford a bloater between them, or a very thin rasher +of bacon. Their enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed +frequently protested that they were spending too much money; but +George said as long as they kept within the sum agreed upon, and paid +their rent, coal, candles, and what little washing they required out +of the eight shillings a week, they were doing very well. + +They had by this time got accustomed to the din of the machinery, and +were able to work in comfort. Mr. Penrose had several times come +through the room, and had given them a nod. After they had been there +a month he spoke to Grimstone. + +"How do those boys do their work?" + +"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys we have ever had. No +skylarking about, and I never have to wait a minute for a plank. They +generally comes in a few minutes before time and gets the bench +cleared up. They are first-rate boys. They lodge with me, and two +quieter and better-behaved chaps in a house there never was." + +"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am interested in them, +and am pleased to hear so good an account." + +That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went to get their money +they received ten shillings apiece. + +"That's two shillings too much," George said as the money was handed +to them. + +"That's all right," the foreman said. "The governor ordered you both +to have a rise." + +"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What do you think of that, +George? Four bob a week more to put by regularly. How much more will +that make by the time your mother comes?" + +"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other will be enough. This +four shillings a week we will put aside at present for clothes. We +want two more shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall +want some shoes before long, and another suit of clothes each. We must +keep ourselves decent, you know." + +From the time when they began work the boys had gone regularly every +Sunday morning to a small iron church near their lodging, and they +also went to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too, at home +was often on religion, for Bill was extremely anxious to learn, and +although his questions and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he +was always ready to explain things as far as he could. + +February came, and to George's delight he heard, from his mother that +she was so much better that the doctor thought that when she came out +at the end of April she would be as strong as she had ever been. Her +eyes had benefited greatly by her long rest, and she said that she was +sure she should be able to do work as before. She had written several +times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing her great pleasure +at hearing that George was so well and comfortable. At Christmas, the +works being closed for four days, George had gone down to see her, and +they had a delightful talk together. Christmas had indeed been a +memorable occasion to the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had +left a basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews." The boys had +prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting of some fine rashers of +bacon and sixpenny-worth of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and +had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs. Grimstone had that +afternoon invited them to dine downstairs. George was reading from a +book which he bought for a penny that morning when there was a knock +at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone said: + +"Here is a hamper for you, George." + +"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment, opening the door. +"Why, whoever could have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake." + +"That's your name on the direction, anyhows," Mrs. Grimstone said. + +"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George agreed, and at once began +to unknot the string which fastened down the lid. + +"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he shouted. He turned it over. +On the back were the words: + +"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose." + +"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a husky voice; and indeed +it was the kindness that prompted the gift rather than the gift itself +that touched him. + +"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never mind that there card, +let's see what's inside." + +The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain a cold goose, a +Christmas pudding, and some oranges and apples. These were all placed +on the table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill executed a +war-dance in triumph and delight. + +"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as he sat down +exhausted. "There's a Christmas dinner for yer! Why, it's like them +stories of the genii you was a-telling me about--chaps as come +whenever yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought a tuck-out or +whatever yer asked for. Of course that wasn't true; yer told me it +wasn't, and I shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere +is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was right and what I +said was wrong. I thought yer were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take +nothing for getting back that there locket, and now yer see what's +come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas dinner fit for a +king. Now what are we going to do with it, 'cause yer know we dines +with them downstairs to-morrow?" + +"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered, "will be to +invite all of them downstairs, Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three +young uns, to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after, because +I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but say the evening after." + +"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking round the room. + +"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I dare say they will let +us have the feed in their parlor. There will be nothing to get, you +know, but some bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs. Grimstone +don't take it, so we must have plenty of tea." + +"I should like some beer too, just for once, George, with such a +blow-out as that." + +"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You know we agreed that we +wouldn't take beer. If we begin it once we shall want it again, so we +are not going to alter from what we agreed to. We see plenty of the +misery which drink causes all round and the way in which money is +wasted over it. I like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I +get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with my dinner +regularly, though I won't do even that if I find it makes me want to +take more; but anyhow at present we can do without it." + +Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and the supper two nights +afterwards came off in due course, and were both most successful. + +The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter of some trouble to +George, but he had finally bought a pretty New Year's card and had +written on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George Andrews," and +had sent it to the daughter of his employer. + +At the beginning of April George had consulted Grimstone and his wife +as to the question of preparing a home for his mother. + +"How much would two rooms cost?" he had asked; "one a good-sized one +and the other the same size as ours." + +"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs. Grimstone replied. + +"And supposing we had a parlor and two little bedrooms?" + +"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say," Mrs. Grimstone +replied. + +"And how much for a whole house?" + +"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings a week, but you +might get one without the kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six +shillings." + +"That would be much the nicest," George said, "only it would cost such +a lot to furnish it." + +"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs. Grimstone suggested. +"Just a kitchen and two bedrooms for a start, and you can put things +into the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when we first +married. But you must have some furniture." + +"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and two bedrooms?" + +"Of course going cheaply to work and buying the things secondhand, I +should say I could pick up the things for you, so that you could do +very well," Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds." + +"That will do capitally," George said, "for by the end of this month +Bill and I will have more than ten pounds laid by." + +"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed in astonishment. "Do +you mean to say you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?" + +"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife put in. + +"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!" + +"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I am sure Bill is a stone +heavier than when he came here." + +"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit," Bob Grimstone said. +"It isn't every boy, by a long way, would stint himself as you must +have done for the last five months to make a comfortable home for his +mother, for I know lots of men who are earning their two quid a week +and has their old people in the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that +if I or the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a house we +shall be right down glad." + +"Thank you," George said. "We will look about for a house, and when we +have fixed on one if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for us I +shall be much obliged, for I don't think landlords would be inclined +to let a house to two boys." + +"All right, George! we will do that for you with pleasure. Besides, +you know, there are things, when you are going to take a house, that +you stand out for; such as papering and painting, or putting in a new +range, and things of that sort." + +After their dinner on the following Sunday the two boys set out +house-hunting. + +"If it's within a mile that will do," George said. "It doesn't matter +about our going home in the breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a +basket and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do; but if +it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get there and back for +dinner. Still there are plenty of houses in a mile." + +There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular rows, bare and +hard-looking, but George wanted to find something more pleasant and +homelike than these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he +wanted. It was just about a mile from the works and beyond the lines +of regular streets. Here he found a turning off the main road with but +eight houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the man who +built them had intended to run a street down for some distance, but +had either been unable to obtain enough ground or had changed his +mind. + +They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front, with a bow-window +and little portico. They appeared to be inhabited by a different class +to those who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the +gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and spotless, muslin +curtains hung in the windows, and fancy tables with pretty ornaments +stood between them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the left-hand +side, was to let. + +"What do you think of this, Bill?" + +"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the rent, George? I +should think they were awful dear." + +"I don't suppose they are any more than the houses in the rows, Bill. +They are very small, you see, and I don't suppose they would suit +workmen as well as the others; at any rate we will see." + +Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of paper the name of the agent +of whom inquiry was to be made. + +"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the street? Oh, there it is. +Laburnum Villas. No. 8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate, +doesn't it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the agent +to-morrow." + +This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she was asked. After +speaking to her husband she said, "I will get the key from the agent's +and will be there just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there +straight when you get out you will be able to see the rooms and what +state it's in." + +"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked. + +"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will set it out for him +before I start." + +"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you very much. It would be +just the thing." + +Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the following day the two +boys arrived breathless at No. 8 Laburnum Villas. + +"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs. Grimstone at the window." + +The door was opened and they rushed in. + +"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said; "and it's in good +order and won't want any money laying out upon it." + +The house was certainly small, but the boys were delighted with it. On +the ground-floor were two little rooms opening with folding doors, +and a little kitchen built out behind. There was a room over this, and +two rooms above the sitting rooms. + +"That's just the right number," George said, "a bedroom each for us; +it couldn't be nicer; and what pretty paper!" + +"And there is a good long slip of garden behind," Mrs. Grimstone said, +"where you could grow lots of vegetables. Of course in the front you +would have flowers." + +"And how much do they want for it?" + +"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and taxes. I call it dear +for its size, but then of course it's got the garden and it looks +pretty and nice. The agent says it's been painted and papered from top +to bottom since the last people left, but he says the owner won't let +it unless somebody comes who is likely to stop, and he will want +references of respectability." + +"All right!" George said; "I can manage that," for he had already been +thinking of the question in his mind; "and we can manage seven and +sixpence a week; can't we, Bill?" + +"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he was as much pleased +with the cottage as George was. + +They explored the garden behind the house. This was about a hundred +feet long by twenty-five wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a +plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and had evidently +been dug up by the last tenants ready for planting. + +"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow all our own potatoes +here!" George exclaimed in delight. + +Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head. + +"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if you gave it all up to +potatoes; but if you planted the further end with potatoes you might +get a good many, and then, you know, at this end you might have three +or four rows of peas and French beans, and lettuces and such like, but +you will have to get some manure to put in. Things won't grow without +manure even in the country, and I am sure they won't here; and then +you know you can have flowers in the front of the house. But it's time +for you to be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure it's +more than half an hour since you came in. I will take the key back and +tell them they shall have an answer by Wednesday or Thursday." + +George did not think they could have been a quarter of an hour; +however, he and Bill started at a trot, which they increased into a +run at the top of their speed when the first clock they saw pointed to +seven minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached the +works; it stopped when they were within fifty yards, and the gate was +just closing as they rushed up. + +"Too late," the man said. + +"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's the first time we +have ever been late, and we have run a mile to be here in time!" + +"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the gate a few inches to +look through. "Ah, well I will let you in this time, 'cause you are +well-behaved young chaps; but don't you run it so close another time, +else you will have to lose your hour." + + + + +CHAPTER IV. + +HOME. + + +That evening George wrote a letter to Dr. Jeffries at Croydon, saying +that he had taken a little house for his mother to come to when she +came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said that he would +render her help if he could, would he be good enough to write to the +agent whose address he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was about +taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person of respectability. + +The following evening he received a letter from the doctor saying that +he had written to the agent, and that he was glad indeed to hear that +George was getting on so well that he was able to provide a home for +his mother. + +On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone handed George a key. + +"There you are, George. You are master of the house now. The agent +said the reference was most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and +sixpence you gave me for a week's rent in advance, and you can go in +when you like. We shall be sorry to lose you both, for I don't want +two better lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has been quiet +and pleasant in the house; and to think what a taking I was in that +day as Bob brought you here for the first time, to think as he had let +the room to two boys. But there, one never knows, and I wouldn't have +believed it as boys could be so quiet in a house." + +"Now we must begin to see about furniture," Bob Grimstone said. "The +best plan, I think, will be for you two to go round of an evening to +all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just what you think +will suit you. You put down the prices stuck on them, and just what +they are, and then the missis can go in the morning and bargain for +them. She will get them five shillings in the pound cheaper than you +would. It's wonderful how women do beat men down, to be sure. When a +man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves it or takes it just as +he likes, but a woman begins by offering half the sum. Then the chap +says no, and she makes as if she was going away; he lets her go a +little way and then he hollers after her, and comes down a goodish bit +in the price. Then she says she don't particularly want it and +shouldn't think of giving any such price as that. Then he tries again, +and so they gets on till they hit on a figure as suits them both. You +see that little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just three weeks +buying that caddy. The chap wanted seven and six for it, and she +offered him half a crown. He came down half a crown at the end of the +first week, and at last she got it for three and nine. Now, the first +thing you have got to do is to make out a list. First of all you have +got to put down the things as you must have, and then the things you +can do without, though you will get them if you can afford it. Mother +will help you at that." + +So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with paper and a pencil, and +George was absolutely horrified at the list of things which Mrs. +Grimstone declared were absolutely indispensable. However, after much +discussion, some few items were marked as doubtful. When the list was +finished the two boys started on an exploring expedition, and the next +week all their evenings were fully occupied. In ten days after they +began the three bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly +furnished, Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand at bargaining, and +making the ten pounds go farther than George had believed possible. On +the Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to inspect the house. + +"It's a very comfortable little place," he said, "and that front +bedroom with the chintz curtains the missis made up is as nice a +little room as you want to see. As to the others they will do well +enough for you boys." + +The only articles of furniture in the sitting room were two long +muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone had bought a bargain at a shop +selling off; for it was agreed that this was necessary to give the +house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone was so much pleased at +what had been done that he shared George's feeling of regret that one +of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished, and on the walk home +said: + +"Look here, George. I know you would like to have the house nice for +your mother. You couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable +not under a five-pound note, not even with the missis to market for +you, but you might for that. I have got a little money laid by in the +savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and welcome, if you +like to take it. I know it will be just as safe with you as it will be +there." + +"Thank you very much, Bob--thank you very much, but I won't take it. +In the first place, I should like mother to know that the furniture is +all ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and in the next +place, I should find it hard at first to pay back anything. I think we +can just manage on our money, but that will be all. I told you mother +does work, but she mayn't be able to get any at first, so we can't +reckon on that. When she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to +buy the furniture." + +"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man said after a pause. +"You would have been welcome to the money: but perhaps you are right +not to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first went into +housekeeping, and it took a wonderful trouble to pay off, and if +there's illness or anything of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I +should be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me, but it would +worry you." + +A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary, and on Saturday +George asked for a day off to go down to fetch her. Every evening +through the week he and Bill had worked away at digging up the garden. +Fortunately there was a moon, for it was dark by the time they came +out from the works. Bill was charged with the commission to lay in the +store of provisions for the Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a +capital fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which George +calculated he would be back. + +Very delighted was George as in his best suit--for he and Bill had two +suits each now--he stepped out of the train at Croydon and walked to +the workhouse. His mother had told him that she would meet him at the +gate at half-past two, and punctually at the time he was there. A few +minutes later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as he had seen her at +Christmas, in the infirmary garb, but in her own clothes. George gave +a cry of delight as he ran forward to meet her. + +"My darling mother! and you are looking quite yourself again." + +"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a long nine months, but the +rest and quiet have done wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind; +and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you had got work that you +liked helped me to get strong again. And you are looking well too; and +your friend, I hope he is well?" + +"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about you. He is glad you +are coming because I am glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up +his mind that you won't like him and you won't think him a fit +companion for me. I told him over and over again that you are not that +sort; but nothing can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't talk +good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions; but he is very much +changed in that way since I first knew him, and he tries very hard, +and don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he is beginning to +read easy words quite well; and he is one of the best-hearted fellows +in the world." + +"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you, that's enough for me," +Mrs. Andrews said; "but I have no doubt I shall soon like him for +himself. You could not like him as much as you do if there were not +something nice about him. And you have succeeded in getting a room for +me in the house in which you lodge?" for George had never mentioned a +word in his letter about taking a house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if +he should see his mother to say nothing to her about his application +to him. + +"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied briskly. + +"And you have got some new clothes since I saw you last, George. You +wanted them; yours were getting rather shabby when I saw you at +Christmas." + +"Yes, mother, they were." + +"I suppose you had to part with your best suit while you were so long +out of work?" + +"That was it, mother; but you see I have been able to get some more +things. They are only cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well +until I can afford better ones. I am not walking too fast for you, am +I? But we shall just catch the train. Or look here, would you mind +going straight by yourself to the railway station? Then you can walk +slowly. I will go round and get your box. I went into our old place as +I came along, and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs for +me as I came back." + +"No, I would rather go round with you, George. I want to thank her for +having kept it for me so long. Even if we do miss the train it will +not matter much, as it will make no difference whether we get in town +an hour earlier or later." + +As George could not explain his special reason for desiring to catch +that train he was obliged to agree, and they stopped a quarter of an +hour at their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon their having +a cup of tea which she had prepared for them. However, when they +reached the station they found that a train was going shortly, and +when they reached town they were not so very much later than George +had calculated upon. + +They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews' box was not heavy, it was +too much for George to carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews +herself was tired from her walk to the station from the infirmary, +having had no exercise for so long. When they got into the +neighborhood of Limehouse George got outside to direct the cabman. It +was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up at No. 8 Laburnum +Villas. + +"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked in surprise as George +jumped down and opened the door. "Why, you told me in one of your +letters it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place! It is +really here, George?" + +"It is here, mother; we moved the other day. There is Bill at the +door;" but Bill, having opened the door, ran away out into the garden, +and George, having paid the cabman, carried his mother's box in and +entered the house with her. + +"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the end." + +"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews said as she entered it; +"and tea all laid and ready! What, have they lent you the room for +this evening?" + +"My dear mother," George said, throwing his arms round her neck, +"this is your kitchen and your house, all there is of it, only the +sitting room isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you know." + +"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy! that is very nice; but +can we afford it, George? It seems too good to be true." + +"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear little house, and +will be splendid when we have got it all furnished. Now come up and +see the bedrooms. This is Bill's, you know," and he opened the door on +the staircase, "and this is mine, and this is yours." + +"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews said: "but, my dear +George, the rent of this house and the hire of the furniture will +surely be more than we can afford to pay. I know what a good manager +you are, my boy, but I have such a horror of getting into debt that it +almost frightens me." + +"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a week, mother, with +rates and taxes, and we can afford that out of Bill's earnings and +mine, even if you did not do any work at all; and as to the furniture, +it is every bit paid for out of our savings since we went to work." + +On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms round George's neck and +burst into tears of happiness. She was not very strong, and the +thought of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to get a +house together for her completely overpowered her. + +"It seems impossible, George," she said when she had recovered +herself. "Why, you have only been earning ten shillings a week each, +and you have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and all sorts of +things; it seems impossible." + +"It has not cost so much as you think, mother, and Bill and I had both +learned to live cheap in Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs; +you have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be ready." + +But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to go out into the garden +to fetch him. + +"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything. She won't eat +you, you know." + +"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will think me an out-and-out +sort of 'ottentot," which word had turned up in a book the boys had +been reading on an evening previously. + +"Well, wait till she says so; come along." + +So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him along, and brought him +shamefaced and bashful into the kitchen. + +"This is Bill, mother." + +"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said, holding out her hand. +"I have heard so much of you from George that I seem to know you quite +well." + +Bill put his hand out shyly. + +"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs. Andrews went on. "I +shall never forget that you were a friend to my boy when he was +friendless in London." + +"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said eagerly; "don't you go +for to think it. Why, just look what George has done for me! There was +I, a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving, and sure to get +quadded sooner or later; and now here I am living decent, and earning +a good wage; and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know about +things, and aint been ashamed of me, though I am so different to what +he is. I tell you, ma'am, there aint no saying what a friend he's been +to me, and I aint done nothing for him as I can see." + +"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other something," Mrs. Andrews +said: "and I owe you something as well as my son, for George tells me +that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own that I owe this +delightful surprise of finding a home ready for me; and now," she went +on, seeing how confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you two +ought to make tea this evening, for you are the hosts, and I am the +guest. In future it will be my turn." + +"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair; Bill, you do the +rashers, and I will pour the water into the pot and then toast the +muffins." + +Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as they had hitherto +attempted had generally fallen to his share, as he had a greater +aptitude for the work than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a +turn was soon upon the table. + +Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely, and was pleased with the +result of her observation. Bill was indeed greatly improved in +appearance since he had first made George's acquaintance. His cheeks +had filled out, and his face had lost its hardness of outline; the +quick, restless, hunted expression of his eyes had nearly died out, +and he no longer looked as if constantly on the watch to dodge an +expected cuff; his face had always had a large share of that merriment +and love of fun which seem the common portion of the London arabs, and +seldom desert them under all their hardships; but it was a happier and +brighter spirit now, and had altogether lost its reckless character. A +similar change is always observable among the waifs picked up off the +streets by the London refuges after they have been a few months on +board a training ship. + +When all was ready the party sat down to their meal. Mrs. Andrews +undertook the pouring out of the tea, saying that although she was a +guest, as the only lady present she should naturally preside. George +cut the bread, and Bill served the bacon. The muffins were piled on a +plate in the front of the fire as a second course. + +It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the three had ever sat +down to. Mrs. Andrews was not only happy at finding so comfortable a +home prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of pride and +thankfulness at the evidence of the love, steadiness, and +self-sacrifice of her son. George was delighted at having his mother +with him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment at the +home he had prepared for her. Bill was delighted because George was +so, and he was moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews less +terrible than he had depicted her. + +After tea was cleared away they talked together for a while, and then +Bill--feeling with instinctive delicacy that George and his mother +would like to talk together for a time--said he should take a turn for +an hour, and on getting outside the house executed so wild a war-dance +of satisfaction that it was fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas +would have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle. + +"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews said when she was +alone with George. "I was sure from what you told me that he must be a +good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been, poor boy, I feared a +little that he would scarcely be a desirable companion in point of +manners. Of course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar; but +his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice, considering all." + +"Look what an example he's had, mother," George laughed; "but really +he has taken great pains ever since he knew that you were coming +home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything he does which is +not right, especially about eating and that sort of thing. You see he +had never used a fork till we came down here, and he made me show him +directly how it should be held and what to do with it. It has been +quite funny to me to see him watching me at meals, and doing exactly +the same." + +"And you have taught him to read, George?" + +"Yes, mother." + +"And something of better things, George?" she asked. + +"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't know anything when I met +him; but he goes to church with me now regularly, and says his prayers +every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it. More, I think, +than I ever did," he added honestly. + +"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you have done him, George." + +"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When you see a chap so very +earnest for a thing you can't help being earnest yourself; besides, +you know, mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had not been +accustomed to talk much of these matters with his mother--"you see +when one's down in the world and hard up, and not quite sure about the +next meal, and without any friend, one seems to think more of these +things than one does when one is jolly at school with other fellows." + +"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know why it should be so, for the +more blessings one has the more reason for love and gratitude to the +giver. However, dear, I think we have both reason to be grateful now, +have we not?" + +"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference since we said +good-by to each other last summer! Now here you are strong and well +again, and we are together and don't mean to be separated, and I have +got a place I like and have a good chance of getting on in, and we +have got a pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be able +to live a little like a lady again,--I mean as you were accustomed +to,--and everything is so nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every +reason to be grateful!" + +"We have indeed, George, and I even more than you, in the proofs you +have given me that my son is likely to turn out all that even I could +wish him." + +Bill's hour was a very long one. + +"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to get out of our way," Mrs. +Andrews said when he returned, "else I shall think that I am in your +way. It was kind of you to think of it the first evening, and George +and I are glad to have had a long talk together, but in future I hope +you won't do it. You see there will be lots to do of an evening. There +will be your lessons and George's, for I hope now that he's settled he +will give up an hour or two every evening to study. Not Latin and +Greek, George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something like +dismay in George's face, "that will be only a waste of time to you +now, but a study of such things as may be useful to you in your +present work and in your future life, and a steady course of reading +really good books by good authors. Then perhaps when you have both +done your work, you will take it by turns to read out loud while I do +my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who knows, if we get on very +flourishingly, after we have furnished our sitting room, we may be +able to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have a little music +of an evening." + +"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be really like old times, +when you used to sing to me!" + +Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the thought of the old times, +but she kept them back bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment, +the happiness of this first evening. So they chatted till nine +o'clock, when they had supper. After it was over Mrs. Andrews left the +room for a minute and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned +with a Bible in her hand. + +"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this first happy evening +in our new home by thanking God together for his blessings." + +"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and Bill's face expressed +his approval. + +So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they knelt and thanked God +for his blessings, and the custom thus begun was continued henceforth +in No. 8 Laburnum Villas. + +Hitherto George and his companion had found things much more pleasant +at the works than they had expected. They had, of course, had +principally to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were many other men +in the shop, and at times, when his bench was standing idle while some +slight alterations or adjustment of machinery were made, they were set +to work with others. Men are quick to see when boys are doing their +best, and, finding the lads intent upon their work and given neither +to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp word addressed to +them. But after Mrs. Andrews had come home they found themselves +addressed in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men. Bob Grimstone +had told two or three of his mates of the sacrifices the boys had made +to save up money to make a home for the mother of one of them when she +came out of hospital. They were not less impressed than he had been, +and the story went the round of the workshops and even came to the +ears of the foreman, and there was not a man there but expressed +himself in warm terms of surprise and admiration that two lads should +for six months have stinted themselves of food in order to lay by half +their pay for such a purpose. + +"There's precious few would have done such a thing," one of the older +workmen said, "not one in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred, +even when he's going to be married, will stint himself like that to +make a home for the gal he is going to make his wife, so as to start +housekeeping out of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will +you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as much for his mother as +for the gal who is agoing to be his wife, seeing how much he owes her; +but how many does it, that's what I says, how many does it?" + +So after that the boys were surprised to find how many of the men, +when they met them at the gate, would give them a kindly nod or a +hearty, "Good-morning, young chaps!" + +A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in Laburnum Villas she +went up to town and called upon a number of shops, asking for work. As +she was able to give an excellent reference to the firm for whom she +had worked at Croydon she succeeded before the end of the week in +obtaining millinery work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard, and as +she had excellent taste and was very quick at her needle she was soon +able to earn considerably more than she had done at Croydon. + +The three were equally determined that they would live as closely as +possible until the sitting-rooms were furnished, and by strict +management they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews' earnings +being devoted to the grand purpose. The small articles were bought +first, and each week there was great congratulation and pleasure as +some new article was placed in the rooms. Then there was a pause for +some time, then came the chairs, then after an interval a table, and +lastly the carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until the end +of July. After this they moved solemnly into the sitting-room, +agreeing that the looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added +at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs. Andrews' earnings +need no longer be devoted. + +"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable evening, "I want you +in future, when you come in, to change your working clothes before you +come in here to your teas. So long as we lived in the kitchen I have +let things go on, but I think there's something in the old saying, +'Company clothes, company manners,' and I think it is good when boys +come in that they should lay aside their heavy-nailed shoes and their +working clothes. Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render +people clumsy in their movements, and the difference of walk which you +observe between men of different classes arises very greatly from the +clumsy, heavy boots which workingmen must wear." + +"But what does it matter, mother?" George urged, for it seemed to him +that it would be rather a trouble to change his clothes every day. +"These little things don't make any real difference to a man." + +"Not any vital difference, George, but a real difference for all +that. Manners make the man, you know! that is, they influence +strangers and people who only know him in connection with business. If +two men apply together for a place the chances are strongly in favor +of the man with the best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think +the observance of little courtesies of this kind make home pleasanter +and brighter. You see I always change my dress before tea, and I am +sure you prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat with a +fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place in my working dress with +odds and ends of threads and litter clinging to it." + +"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you mean now. Certainly I will +change my things in future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?" + +Bill would not have minded in the least any amount of trouble by which +he could give the slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had now +a place in his affections closely approximating to that which George +occupied. + +During the summer months the programme for the evening was not carried +out as arranged, for at the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared +that there must be a change. + +"The evenings are getting light enough now for a walk after tea, boys, +and you must therefore cut short our reading and studies till the days +close in again in the autumn. It would do you good to get out in the +air a bit." + +"But will you come with us, mother?" + +"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get longer we may make little +excursions together: go across the river to Greenwich and spend two or +three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go up the river to Kew; +but as a general thing you had better take your rambles together. I +have my front garden to look after, the vegetables are your work, you +know, and if I like I can go out and do whatever shopping I have to do +while you two are away." + +So the boys took to going out walks, which got longer and longer as +the evenings drew out, and when they were not disposed for a long +ramble they would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and watch +the barges drifting down the river or tacking backwards and forwards, +if there was a wind, with their great brown and yellow sails hauled +tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly down the river, and +the little busy tugs dragging great ships after them. There was an +endless source of amusement in wondering from what ports the various +craft had come or what was their destination. + +"What seems most wonderful to me, George," Bill said one day, "when +one looks at them big steamers----" + +"Those," George corrected. + +"Thank ye--at those big steamers, is to think that they can be tossed +about, and the sea go over them, as one reads about, just the same +way as the wave they make when they goes down----" + +"Go down, Bill." + +"Thank ye--go down the river, tosses the little boats about; it don't +seem possible that water can toss itself about so high as that, does +it?" + +"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that it is so because there +are constantly wrecks; but looking at the water it does not seem +possible that it should rise up into waves large enough to knock one +of those great steamers in pieces. Some day, Bill, not this year, of +course, because the house isn't finished, but next year, I hope we +shall be able all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have seen +it stuck up you can go to Margate and back for three or four +shillings; and though Bob Grimstone says that isn't regular sea, it +would be enough to show us something of what it's like." + +The garden occupied a good deal of the boys' time. Bill's long +experience in the market had given him an interest in vegetables, and +he was always ready for an hour's work in the garden after tea. The +results of much labor and plenty of manure were not unsatisfactory, +and Mrs. Andrews was delighted with her regular supply of fresh +vegetables. Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount that could be +grown in a limited space were by no means fulfilled, and seeing the +small amount which could be daily gathered, and recalling the +countless piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to see in +Covent Garden, he was continually expressing his astonishment at the +enormous quantity of ground which must be employed in keeping up the +supply of the market. + +They did not that year get the trip to Margate; but in the autumn, +after the great work of furnishing was finished, they did get several +long jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus, once in a +steamer up to Kew, and several times across to Greenwich Park. Mrs. +Andrews found it a very happy summer, free from the wear of anxiety, +which, more even than the work, had brought on her long illness. She +grew stronger and better than she had ever expected to be again, and +those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking needlewoman of +Croydon would not have recognized her now; indeed, as George said +sometimes, his mother looked younger and younger every day. She had +married very young, and was still scarcely five-and-thirty, and +although she laughed and said that George was a foolish boy when he +said that people always took her for his sister, she really looked +some years younger than she was. Her step had regained its elasticity, +and there was a ring of gladness and happiness in her voice which was +very attractive, and even strangers sometimes looked round as they +passed the bright, pleasant-looking woman chatting gayly with the two +healthy, good-looking young fellows. + + + + +CHAPTER V. + +AN ADVENTURE. + + +In August the annual outing, or, as it was called, the bean-feast, at +the works took place. Usually the men went in vans down into Epping +Forest; but this year it was determined that a steamer should be +engaged to take the whole party with their wives and families down to +Gravesend. They were to make an early start, and on arriving there all +were to do as they pleased until they assembled to dine in a pavilion +at one of the hotels. After this they were to go to the gardens and +amuse themselves there until the steamer started in the evening. The +party embarked at Blackwell at ten o'clock in the morning. George and +Bill got together up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted +with their voyage down, their only regret being that Mrs. Andrews had +declined to accompany them, saying that she would far rather go with +them alone than with so large a party. + +"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when they landed. "We are not +to dine till two, so we have two good hours before us. I vote we hire +a boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here as up in that +crowded river by London." + +This was said in reference to various short rows which they had had +in boats belonging to barges which had been sometimes lent them for +half an hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as they hung +about the wharves. + +"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the waterman, whom they hired +the boat of, said. + +"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the confidence of youth. + +"Mind the tide is running out strong," the waterman said. + +"All right, we will mind," George answered, scarce heeding his words; +and getting out the oars they pushed off. + +For some little time they rowed among the anchored vessels, both being +especially filled with delight at the yachts moored opposite the +clubhouses. These were new craft to them, and the beauty and neatness +of everything struck them with surprise and admiration. Tide had only +turned a short time before they got into their boat, and while keeping +near the shore they had no difficulty in rowing against it. + +Presently they determined to have a look at a fine East-Indiaman +moored well out in the stream a short distance below Gravesend. They +ceased rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on their oars +talking over the distant voyage on which she was probably about to +start, and the country she might visit, George was telling his +companion the ports she would touch if her destination was China, and +absorbed in their conversation they paid no attention to anything +else, until George gave a sudden exclamation. + +"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so far behind. It is two +miles, I should think, from the town. We must set to work or we shan't +be back in time for dinner." + +The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the Thames was not sufficient +to tell them that to row against tide it is necessary to keep close +inshore, and turning the boat's head they set to work to row back in +the middle of the river. Their knowledge of rowing was but slight, and +the mere operation of their oars took up all their attention. They +rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration ran down their +faces. + +After half an hour of this George looked round, thinking that he ought +to be near to the vessel by this time. He uttered an exclamation of +surprise and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were visible. +Their puny efforts had availed nothing against the sweeping tide. They +had already, without knowing it, swept round the turn in the river, +and were now entering Sea Reach. + +"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just look at that buoy; we are +going past it as fast as a horse could trot. Look what a width the +river is. What on earth are we to do?" + +"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall we go to if we go on like +this?" + +"Right out to sea, I should think," George said. "I do not know how +far it is; but the river seems to get wider and wider in front." + +"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn again and take us +back." + +"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you know, all the way down, +and could only have turned a little while before we got in the boat. +Look at that line of barges sailing down on the right-hand side. I +vote we pull to them and ask the men what we had better do. Anyhow we +could row to the land and get out there and wait till tide turns. It +turned at about eleven, so that it will turn again somewhere about +five. The steamer is not to start till eight, so we shall be back in +plenty of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and the fun in +the gardens, but that can't be helped." + +"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully; "this is a regular +venture, this is; but I say, shan't we have to pay a lot for the +boat?" + +"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps the man will let us +off cheap when he sees we couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered +sort of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute it is taking us +further away." + +They set steadily to work. The boat was a large and heavy one, and +their progress was by no means rapid. + +"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed suddenly. + +"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye, George, I can't see the +barges!" + +Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily creeping up the river. They +were just at its edge when they made the discovery. Another two +minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they could not see ten +yards away. They looked at each other in silent bewilderment. + +"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at length in awe-struck tones. + +"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no use rowing, that I +see, for we don't know which way the boat's head is pointing." + +"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically. "I am going to +have a pipe. Oh, I say, aint my hands blistered!" + +"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but keep your oar in your +hand to be ready to row." + +"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you said it warn't no use +rowing!" + +"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for those big buoys. If the +tide were to sweep us against one of them we should capsize to a +certainty. That must have been a big steamer," he went on, as the boat +rolled suddenly. "It's lucky we were pretty well over towards the side +of the river, before the fog came on. Listen--there's another. I can +hear the beat of her engines. I have an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed +suddenly. "We know the steamers were passing to the left of us when +the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles and the sound of their +paddles, and then row to the right, we shall get to the bank at last." + +"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying down the pipe he had +just lighted. "There's a whistle over there." + +"Yes, and another the other way," George said, puzzled. "Why, how can +that be! Oh, I suppose one is coming up the river and one down, but +it's awfully confusing." + +It was so, but by dint of listening intently the boys gained some idea +of the proper direction; but they could only row a few strokes at a +time, being obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance. + +Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water, and the upper spars +of the steamers were above it, and men placed there were able to +direct those on deck as to their course. Had it not been for this the +steamers must all have anchored. As it was they proceeded slowly and +cautiously on their way, whistling freely to warn any small craft, +that might be hidden in the fog, of their coming. + +Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous exclamation. +The boat had quietly grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could +not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it was. Bill at once +offered to get overboard and reconnoiter, but George would not hear of +it. + +"You might not be able to find your way back, Bill, or you might sink +in the mud and not be able to get out again. No, we won't separate; +and, look here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge of the +mud. If we were to get left here we should not float again till tide +comes up to us, and that wouldn't be till about two hours before high +tide, and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock at night." + +"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking round at the +wall of white vapor which surrounded them. "It regular confuses a +chap. I say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at present. +I feel awfully hungry." + +"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall be a good deal more +hungry before we are done; but I am so glad we have found the land and +stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being hungry." + +"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are we to find our way +back to Gravesend?" + +"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to the edge of the +mud--just as close as the boat will swim. That way, you know, we must +come to Gravesend at last." + +"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have got a good head, George, +you have. I should never have thought about the way to find the bank +if it hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating and +floating till we was starved." + +"This fog can't last forever, Bill." + +"No, but I have known them last a week in London." + +"Yes, but not in August, Bill." + +"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you see these here fogs may +last just as long down here in August as they do in London in +November." + +"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter to us; we have got +the land for a guide, and I hope we shall be back in Gravesend before +it's quite dark." + +"But if we don't, George?" + +"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before it gets too dark, and +wait till it is morning. We shall be all right if we keep quite cool +and use our senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind a bit, +except that mother will be getting anxious about us. It's a regular +adventure, and we shall have something to talk about for a long time. +Look out, Bill, we must push her further off--she's getting aground!" + +For an hour they sat and chatted. + +"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last. "That's the rattle of a +chain. I expect it's a barge anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can +hear voices. I vote we hollo." + +George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The shout was repeated +not very far off, and was followed by the shout of "Who are you?" + +"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost our way," George +shouted back. "We will come on board if you will let us." + +"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on shouting and you row to +my voice." + +It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close at hand said +sharply: + +"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain." + +Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw that they were close +to the bows of a barge. Half a dozen more strokes and they were +alongside. Bill seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and the +boat was soon towing astern. + +"Well, young men, however did you manage to get here?" one of the +bargemen asked. "It's lucky for you you weren't taken out to sea with +the tide." + +George related the history of their voyage and how they had managed to +reach the shore. + +"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the man said; "aint they, +Jack? Most chaps your age would just have sat in the boat and howled, +and a good many longshoremen too. You have done the best thing you +could under the circumstances." + +"Where are we?" George asked. + +"You are on board the _Sarah and Jane_ topsail barge, that's where you +are, about three parts down Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well +even in a fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the Swashway +with it as thick as this, so we brought up." + +"Where is the Swashway?" George asked. + +"The Swashway is a channel where the barges go when they are making +for Sheerness. It's well buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the +help of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs are worse +than anything. It aint no use groping about for the buoy when you +can't see ten yards ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on +the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap this fog will clear +off before evening, and we shall be able to work in; and now I expect +you two young uns would like some grub. Come below." + +The two boys joyfully followed into the little cabin, and were soon +satisfying their hunger on bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug +of water from the breaker and placed it before them. + +"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would give yer a cup of +tea--that's our tipple; we don't keep spirits on board the _Sarah and +Jane_. I like a drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge, +where you wants your senses handy at all times. And now what are you +thinking of doing?" he asked when the boys had finished. + +"What we had made up our minds to do was to lie where we were at the +edge of the mud till tide turned, and then to keep as close to the +shore as we could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer we came +by does not go back till late, and we thought we should be back by +that time." + +"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the middle of the stream you +would be back in two hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide +don't help you much there, and half your time you are in eddies and +back-currents. No, you wouldn't be back in Gravesend by eight noway." + +"Then what would you advise us to do?" + +"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at all. We will see how +things are going after a bit. Now let's take a look round." + +So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed by the boys. The +white fog still shut the boat in like a curtain. + +"What do you think of it, Jack?" + +"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just now there was a puff of +air coming down the river. I wish it would, or we shan't make +Sheerness to-night, much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure +enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like enough in half an hour there +will be a brisk wind blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before +it." + +Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples swept across the +oil-like face of the water. + +"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said. "I'd bet a pot of +beer as the fog will have lifted in a quarter of an hour." + +Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind. + +The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand. It was no longer a +dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark shadows seemed to flit across it, and +sometimes the view of the water extended here and there. + +"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly, but ere George could +turn round to look it was gone again. + +"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now I tell you what will +be the best thing for you if the wind holds, as I expect it will. We +shall be at Sheerness in little over an hour--that will make it four +o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and the young flood will be +coming up soon afterwards, and I shall go up with the first of it to +Rochester. We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven o'clock. Now +the best thing I can do for you is to tow that ere boat up to +Rochester with me, and you can get a train there that will take you up +to town in goodish time." + +"You are very kind," George said; "but what are we to do about the +boat?" + +"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more likely next morning, +and I will take her along and hand her over to her rightful owner at +Gravesend." + +"James Kitson." + +"Yes, I know him." + +"But how about paying for it?" George said. "I am afraid he will +expect a great deal of money, for it has been away all the time, and +we have only got six shillings between us." + +"You will want that to get up to town. Never mind about the boat. I +will put that square for you. I will tell Kitson as how you have been +shipwrecked, and he will think himself precious lucky in getting the +boat without being damaged. If I take the trouble to tow it up to +Rochester and back, he needn't grumble about getting no fare." + +"I would rather pay something," George said; "though, you see, we +can't afford to pay much." + +"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for five bob. I will +tell him you are going to send him that, and he will thank his stars +he has got so well out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he +expects you have by this time, and the boat didn't get smashed by a +steamer, you would likely enough have been taken off by one of them; +but the captain wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub. I +looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so don't you worry about +him. There, the mist's driving off fast. We will up with the kedge." + +The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the anchor was soon hanging +from the bow. Then the brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great +sail shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few minutes the +_Sarah and Jane_ was running before a brisk wind down Sea Reach. + +The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear astern, though a thick +bank still hung over the river ahead, but this was rapidly melting +away; and the bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins, +pointed out a large building low down on the water ahead. + +"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can lend Jack a hand to get up +the topsail. The wind is rising every minute, and we shall soon be +bowling along hand over hand." + +Both ahead and astern of them were a line of barges, which had, like +the _Sarah and Jane_, anchored when the fog was thickest, and were, +like her, making their way to Sheerness. The wind was blowing briskly +now, and the barge made her way through the water at a rate which +surprised the boys. + +"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George said. + +"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins replied. "With a +breeze so strong that they can only just carry their topsails, they +will hold their own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are mighty +few yachts can keep alongside us when we are doing our best." + +As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour they brought up just +inside the mouth of the Medway, and dropped the anchor to wait till +the tide turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock they were +again under way. The wind had fortunately veered round somewhat to the +north of west, and they were able for the most part to lay their +course, so that soon after seven they were abreast of the dockyard, +and a few minutes later dropped anchor off Rochester. + +"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured bargeman said; "I will +put you ashore at once. There is the station close to the end of the +bridge." + +With many very hearty thanks for his kindness the lads jumped ashore +and hurried up to the station. They found that there would be a train +in half an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in town. + +Before they had landed the bargeman had scrawled on a piece of paper, +"Your boat was picked up by the _Sarah and Jane_. Will bring her back +on return trip. No damage done. William Atkins." This he had handed to +the boys, and they now got an envelope and directed it to "James +Kitson, Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set out to walk +home. + +"It's not been the sort of day we expected," George said; "but it's +been good fun, hasn't it?" + +"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so when we were in the +middle of that fog listening to them whistles and trying to find out +the way. I didn't say much, George, but I felt downright funky." + +"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a horribly lonely +feeling, lost in the fog there; but it was all right as soon as we +touched the mouth, and got an idea where we were. I was worrying most +about mother getting anxious if we did not get back to-night, and a +little about what we should have to pay for the boat. It was lucky +that bargeman took the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should +have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully good fellow, wasn't +he?" + +"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He was a good un, and no +mistake. It aint cost us so very much either, considering." + +"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece railway fare, that's +four and sixpence, and five bob we are to send down for the boat, nine +shillings and sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings for +the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have spent another shilling +apiece in things at the gardens, perhaps more; that would make four +shillings anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings more than +we calculated. And haven't we got a lot to talk about! It's been a +regular adventure." + +"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think I want many more of +them kind of adventures. It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't +jolly at the time. I always thought as adventures was jolly; but that +didn't seem to me to have no jolliness about it, not when we was out +there. It's all very well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with +savages, but I expect there aint no larks about it at the time. I +suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow, and get it off your +mind?" + +"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for another three or four +days. The man will have got his boat back all right then, and the five +bob would come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell Kitson that +he had arranged with us that was what we were to pay, as we couldn't +afford more; but he will never expect to get it, so when it comes he +will be only too glad to receive it." + +They were met at the door of the house by Bob Grimstone, who was just +coming out. + +"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said angrily. "I have been +wondering all day what has become of you, and the missis has done +nothing but worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day. What have +you been up to? I haven't seen you since we got ashore at Gravesend, +and I have just come round to ask your mother if she has heard of +you." + +"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at least it was not +altogether our fault. We went for a row, and the tide took us down, +and then the fog came on and we got lost." + +"I expected better of you," Grimstone said angrily. "Foggy, indeed! +I've been anxious and worried all day. I did think as you warn't like +other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go and play such a +prank as this. Well, go in; your mother is in a nice taking about +you." + +"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I am so sorry you have +been uneasy about us, awfully sorry; but really it hasn't been our +fault altogether." + +"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews said, throwing her arms +round his neck. "Fortunately I did not know anything about it till Mr. +Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been expecting you in for +some little time, but I supposed the steamer was late, and I was not +at all uneasy till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not +seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend, and that you +had not come back with the rest. Is Bill with you?" + +"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to Bob." + +"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs. Andrews said. "He has been +most kind, and he had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first +train in the morning if you did not come home to-night, and to make +inquiries about you there. He tried to cheer me up by saying that as +you were together nothing could very well happen to you and that +probably you had only got into some boyish scrape--perhaps, he +suggested, only gone out into the country and had helped yourselves to +some apples, and had so got locked up." + +Bob, however, would not come in again, but went off saying he would +hear all about it in the morning, but would go off to tell his wife at +once that they had returned safely, for "that she was in such a worry +as never was." + +Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat since two o'clock, Mrs. +Andrews at once laid the table for supper; and when they had finished +it listened to George's account of their adventure. + +"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said when they had finished. +"You might have been swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the +fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you forget to thank God +for his protection through the danger you have run; and I do hope, my +dear boys, that you will be more careful in future." + +The next evening, after work was over, George went in to Bob +Grimstone's and told them all that had happened. When the story was +told, Bob agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault, and +that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified his opinion of +them. Mrs. Grimstone, however, was not so easily pacified. They had +come back, she said; but it was more than likely that they wouldn't +have come back at all, but might have been drifting out far at sea, +perhaps cutting each other's throats and eating each other alive, +which was, as the good woman said, what she had heard happened when +boats were lost at sea. + +Two days later they sent off the money to the waterman, and received +in reply a letter from him saying that the boat had been brought +safely back by the _Sarah and Jane_ and that he was glad to get the +five shillings. + +"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send it; but knowing what +boys is, I say fair as I didn't expect to see the color of your money. +It aint everyone as would have paid up when they got safe away, and I +consider as you have behaved handsome." + +They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off which the _Sarah and Jane_ +might generally be found moored, between her cruises, and after one or +two ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge there when they +rowed up to the spot. She had but just returned from a trip to +Rochester and Bill Atkins was still on board. He was very glad to see +the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading him to accept a +pound of tobacco which their mother had sent off to him with her +compliments as a token of gratitude for his kindness to them. + +"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of the sort, but seeing +as your mother has got it for me it wouldn't be manners to say no. +Well, look here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down to +Rochester and back you're free of the _Sarah and Jane_, and heartily +glad shall I be to have you with me." + +The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as they were still at +work there was but small chance of their being able to accept it, but +that they should be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes +when he was in the Pool. + + + + +CHAPTER VI. + +FIRE! + + +One Saturday evening early in October the boys had been for a long +walk down among the marshes. They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be +late, and it was past eight o'clock when they came along past the +works. + +"We shan't get home at this hour again for some time, I expect," +George said, "for they say that we are going to begin to work overtime +on Monday, and that the orders are so heavy that it will very likely +have to be kept up all through the winter." + +"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied; "it would have been +horrid if we had lost all our walks while the weather was fine. How +dark the place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still it is +after the rattle we are accustomed to!" + +"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand on his arm. + +"What is it, George?" + +"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment, as if I saw the big +stack clearly and then it was dark again." + +"How could that be, George?" + +"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a reflection of light +from one of the windows at the back there. There it is again." + +"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it be?" + +"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back. There might +be--it's awful to think of--but there might be a fire." + +The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of the works onto a piece +of waste ground behind. + +"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room. There must be +fire. Here, help to put this bit of old timber against the wall." + +The piece of wood was placed into position, the two lads climbed up it +onto the wall, and dropped into the yard within. Just as they did so +there was a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light as +a body of flame burst out from one of the windows. + +"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call people's attention, +and then we must do the best we can." + +They ran along until they reached the front gate, and then, seizing +the bell-rope, rang it violently. + +In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside, and shouts of +"What's the matter?" + +"There is a fire in the molding-room," George shouted; "run for the +engines, someone, and break the gate open. Now come on, Bill." + +The two boys ran towards that part of the building where the flames +had been seen, broke a window, and climbed in. There was an almost +stifling smell of burning wood and at a door at the end of the +planing-room they could see a light flame flickering through the +cracks of the door leading into the molding-room, which was next to +it. + +"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the hydrant. We must stop +it from getting through here till the engines come." + +The hydrant communicated with the great tank at the top of the +building, and as soon as the hose was screwed on and Bill stood with +the nozzle directed towards the burning door, George turned the cock +and volumes of water flew out. + +The first result seemed disastrous. The door was already nearly burned +through, and, as the powerful jet flew against it, it seemed to +crumble away and a mass of flame darted out from the molding-room. The +joists and timbers supporting the floor above the planing-room would +have caught at once, but the boys deluged them with water, as also the +framework of the door, and then, throwing the stream of water into the +blazing workshop, they kept down the flames near the door. The smoke +was stifling. + +"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped. + +"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always better near the +ground." + +This they found to be the case, and they were still able to direct the +jet of water. But three or four minutes had elapsed when the outer +door of the planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and several +other men rushed in, but were at once driven back by the smoke. George +had recognized Grimstone's voice, and shouted: + +"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet. Come and lend a hand, +for it's gaining on us in spite of the water. You can breathe if you +kneel down." + +Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled in and joined the +boys. + +"What! is it you, George? How on earth did you get here?" Bob +exclaimed. + +"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in from behind. When we +saw what it was we rang the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do +what we could till help came." + +"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone said admiringly; "but I am +afraid it's not much good." + +"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters drenched there. Bill and +I will crawl forward and clear the shavings out of the way if we can. +They have caught half a dozen times already." + +The two boys crawled forward, and although the heat was tremendous +they managed to clear away the shavings for a considerable distance. +The smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged to crawl back +into the outer air, where for a while they lay almost insensible. +There were crowds of men in the yard now, but most of them were round +at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only watching the +flames as they roared through the whole of the windows of the +molding-room. + +Men were hurrying past with buckets of water, and one of them, seeing +the condition of the boys, dashed some over their heads and faces, and +they presently staggered to their feet. It was now a quarter of an +hour since they had first given the alarm, and they were just about to +re-enter the planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and his +comrades coming out. + +"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines aint here in a minute +or two it will be too late." + +But just at that moment there was a cheer outside, and immediately +afterwards a fire-engine dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to +the firemen as they leaped off. + +"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it spreading from that shop +into this. We have been keeping it back till now, but the tank has +just run dry." + +While the other firemen were fitting the hose to the fire-plug just +outside the gates one of them made his way into the planing-room to +ascertain the exact position of affairs. + +"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be lost; the fire is +making its way through. Another five minutes and we should have been +too late to save any of this block. Is there any communication through +the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone. + +"Yes, there is a door on each floor," + +"Have you got any empty sacks about the place?" + +"Yes, there is a pile of them in there." + +The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades, while he himself +made his way into the planing-room with the hose; the other got out +the sacks, and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands drenched +them with water, and then proceeding to the door on the first floor +piled them against it. + +"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand upon it. "Now, do you +men bring me buckets of water. Keep the sacks drenched till another +engine comes up." + +George and Bill, finding they could be of no more use, made their way +out to the back and joined the crowd watching the flames, which had +already spread to the first floor. They were, however, with the rest +of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the yard by the police, who, +having now arrived in sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear +the premises of all save a score or two of men who were engaged in +assisting the firemen. + +As the boys went out through the front gate another engine dashed up +at full speed, dropping lighted cinders on its way. + +"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect they will do now." + +Then the boys made their way round again to the back, and by means of +the pieces of timber established themselves on the wall, where they +were soon joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle with +the flames. + +In half an hour six engines were on the spot; but even this force had +no visible effect upon the flames in that portion of the building in +which they had taken possession, and the firemen turned the whole of +their efforts to prevent it from spreading. + +The party wall dividing it from the main building was a very strong +one; but so hot had it become that the floor boards touching it were +over and over again in flames. + +A score of men with saws and axes cut away the flooring adjoining the +doors on the first and second stories. The planing-room was +fortunately not boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade worked +unceasingly in preventing the spread of the flames in this direction, +the rest turned their attention to the great wood piles, which were +repeatedly ignited by the fragments of burning wood. + +Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up high into the air, +but grand as the sight was, the boys did not wait any longer looking +on. Their faces smarted severely from the heat to which they had been +exposed; their hands had been a good deal burned by the shavings; +their hair, eyebrows, and eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs +ached with the glare. + +"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely enough hear of the +fire, and as we said we should be back soon after eight she will be +getting anxious." + +"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and see the end of it +here." + +But this George would not hear of. + +"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must get some grease or +something to put on my face and hands; they are smarting awfully." + +Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise and alarm as the boys +entered. The irritation of the wood smoke had so much inflamed their +eyes that they could scarcely see out of them, and their faces looked +like pieces of raw beef. + +"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed. + +"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it broke out just as we +were passing, so we stopped to help for a bit, and then came home to +tell you, thinking that you might be anxious." + +"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed; "that is dreadful. +Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and for all of you who work there; more, +perhaps, for you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and you may +be out of work for months. Thank God I have plenty of work, so I dare +say we shall be able to tide it over." + +"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop and the floors +above it are on fire at present, and as there are six fire-engines at +work, and they keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will save +the rest; and now, mother, what can we do to our faces and hands, they +are smarting awfully?" + +"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought you were only dreadfully +hot." + +"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were being roasted." + +"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing," Mrs. Andrews said, +hurrying away to the kitchen, and coming back with a piece of +cotton-wool, and some olive-oil in a cup. + +"You are burned, George. Why, child, your hair is all singed, and your +eyebrows and eyelashes. Why, what have you been doing to yourselves? +There could have been no occasion to put your heads into the flames +like that. Why, your hands are worse still; they are quite blistered. +I had better wrap them up in cotton-wool." + +"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps if you put a bit of +cotton-wool there and tie it round the back it will do; we can't go +out with our hands all swaddled round like that. And now, please, +directly you have done we want to go down again to see the fire. Just +you go up to the road corner, mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell +you." + +"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly; "everything has +been ready except pouring the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a +quarter past nine now. After we have done I will put on my bonnet and +walk down with you as near as I can get. I am not going to lose you +out of my sight again." + +So after their meal they went down together, but could not get +anywhere near the works, all the approaches now being guarded by the +police. It was a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was a +general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it would spread no +further. A dozen engines were at work now. Some of the firemen were on +the roof, some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot from the +deep glow from the fire. The flames were intermittent now, sometimes +leaping up high above the shell of the burned-out buildings, then +dying down again. + +"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said fervently. "It would have +been a bad winter for a great many down here if the fire had spread; +as it is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned." + +"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a tenth, I should say. It's +lucky that there was a strong wall between that and the next shops, or +it must all have gone. I have heard them say that part was added on +five or six years ago, so that the wall at the end of the planing-shop +was an outside wall before; that accounts for its being so thick." + +After looking on for about half an hour they went back home. But +neither of the boys got much sleep that night, the excitement they had +gone through and the pain of their burns keeping them wide awake till +nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard no movement in their +rooms--whereas they were usually up and about almost as early on +Sundays as on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual +hour for rising--she did not disturb them. George was the first to +awake, and looking out of the window felt sure by the light that it +was later than usual. He put his head out of the door and shouted: + +"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer. "Mother, are you up; what +o'clock is it?" + +"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past eleven!" + +George gave an exclamation of astonishment and rushed into Bill's +room. The latter had woke at his shout. + +"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up for hours;" and he +dashed off again to his room to dress. It was but a few minutes before +they came downstairs just at the same moment. + +"Why didn't you wake us, mother?" + +"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on, George. I guessed +that your burns had kept you awake for some time." + +"That they did. I thought I was never going to get to sleep," George +said; and Bill gave a similar account of himself. "Still, mother, a +short night does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to get to +church." + +"It does not matter for once, George. What figures you both are!" + +"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I hardly knew myself when I +looked in the glass. My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is +peeling off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby; and Bill +looks as bad as I do. You are a figure, Bill!" and George burst into a +fit of laughter. + +"He's no worse than you, George; but come along, breakfast is +waiting." + +"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope, mother?" + +"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys, and had a slice of +bread and butter, for I thought you might not be down for some time; +but I am quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put them down +directly you called." + +"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother; and I am glad too you +didn't have your regular breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit +down on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only regular +breakfast we get in the week." + +Just as they had finished their meal there was a knock at the door. It +was Bob Grimstone. Bill opened the door. + +"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I would just come round and +see. You look pretty badly burned; and so do you, George," he added, +as he followed Bill into the sitting room. + +"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews." + +"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews said. Since her coming the +Grimstones had several times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum +Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished them to come in more +frequently, for she felt much indebted to them for their kindness to +George, and, moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were good +specimens of their class. + +"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone; your face looks +scorched; but you did not manage to get yourself burned as these silly +boys did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did not +spread!" + +"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two lads can have told you +what they did, for if they had you would hardly call them silly boys." + +Mrs. Andrews looked surprised. + +"They told me they lent a hand to put out the fire--I think those were +George's words--but they did not tell me anything else." + +"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't been for them there +would not have been a stick or stone of Penrose's standing now; the +shops and the wood piles would all have gone, and we should all have +been idle for six months to come; there is no doubt about that at +all." + +"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How was it they did more than +anyone else?" + +"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and rung the +alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found out for another five minutes, +and five minutes would have been enough for the fire. In the next +place, when they had given the alarm they did the only thing that +could have saved the place: they got into the planing-shop and turned +on the hose there, and fought the fire from spreading through the +door till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was all we could +do to stop it then; but if they hadn't done what they did the +planing-shop would have been alight from end to end, and the floors +above it too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing could +have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs. Andrews, that there +isn't a man on the works, nor the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that +they owe these two lads their living through the winter. I don't know +what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I know what we all feel." + +"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her eyes were filled with +happy tears at the praises of her son, "why did you not tell me about +it?" + +"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell," George said, "and Bob +has made a great fuss about nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as +we came along and when we went round behind and got on the wall we saw +the place was on fire, so we rang the alarm-bell, and then turned on +the hose and flooded the place with water till Bob and some more came +to help us." + +"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can tell you it wasn't so. +When we opened the door of the planing-shop it was so full of smoke +that it didn't seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute, and +as we could see the glare of the flames at the other end we thought +the place was gone. We should have gone out and waited for the engines +if we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were there; and even +though we knelt down and crawled in, as they shouted to us to do, we +were pretty nearly stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward +and got the shavings cleared away; that was how they burned their +hands, I expect; and I hear they tumbled down insensible when they got +out. Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever two young +chaps behaved like heroes they did, and you have every right to be +proud of them--I say of them, because although Bill's no son of yours +I know he is what you and your boy have made him. He was telling me +about it one day." + +"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?" George asked, in order to +change the subject. + +"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob said; "but in our shop +and the floors above it it will take a day or two to clear up. I saw +the foreman just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters +will be put on, for both the floors are burned away at the end of the +wall and pretty near twenty feet of the roof are charred. Two +surveyors are coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and say +whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that are burned out must +come down, of course. The surveyor says that if the wall at the end of +the planing-room looks pretty strong they will build up another wall +against it as soon as it gets cold enough and the rubbish is cleared +away for men to work; that will make a strong job of it, and there +won't be any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to come down +there can't be much work done in the shops till it's finished. The +governor got down about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up to +him almost directly after the fire broke out, but he was out at +dinner, and by the time he got down here all danger of it spreading +was over. He had a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall +with him. He is as anxious as we are that there should be no delay, +for there are some heavy orders in, and, of course, he doesn't want +them taken anywhere else." + +"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I don't know much about +it, but they seem to be badly burned." + +"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said when he had examined them; +"pretty nigh raw. If I might give an opinion, I should say as the +doctor had better see them; they are precious painful, aint they, +George?" + +"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I don't see any use in +a doctor. I don't suppose he can do more than mother has." + +"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them for all that; he may +give you some cooling lotion for them, and I can tell you burns on the +hand are apt to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers may +get stiffened. I have known two or three cases like that. You had +better go at once to Dr. Maxwell; he always attends if there are any +accidents at the works. You know the house, George; it is about +halfway between this and the works." + +"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews said; "there, put +on your hats and be off." + +"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway, for the missis will be +waiting dinner for me." + +"Are we to pay, mother?" + +"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say you will have to have +your hands dressed several times." + +"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs. Andrews. The firm always +pays the doctor in case of accidents, and you may be very sure that in +this case they will be only too glad." + +"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said, "you can tell the +doctor that you will pay when he says that you need not come to him +again. If Mr. Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should not +think of refusing, as you have been burned in his service; but +certainly I should not assume that he will do so." + +"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when they reached the door. +"I know the doctor; he attended me two years ago when I pretty nigh +had my finger taken off by one of the cutters." + +"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would." + +They were shown into the surgery, where the doctor soon joined them. + +"I've brought these two young chaps for you to look at their hands, +Dr. Maxwell. They got them burnt last night at the fire. Mrs. +Andrews, the mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would pay +the charges when you have done with them; but as if it hadn't been for +them the works would have been burnt down as sure as you are standing +there, I expect the firm will take the matter in their own hands." + +"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining the boys' +hands. "Can you open and shut them, boy?" + +"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but I shouldn't like to +try, for if I move my fingers at all it hurts them awfully." + +"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your hands." + +"Yes." + +"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on some soothing +poultices. Tell your mother to get some linseed and mix it with +olive-oil. I will give you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about +twenty drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with the +linseed. Every four or five hours change the poultices. I think you +will find that will relieve the pain a good deal. I see your faces are +scorched too. You can do nothing better than keep them moistened with +sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet as possible for three +or four days." + +"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George said. + +"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can use your hands in +another fortnight. I will send in the usual certificate to the works." + +"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said when they left the +doctor's, "how it is we can't come to work? You tell him we wanted to, +and that we hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right; +because, you see, the men and boys at the shops which have been burnt +down will be all out of work, and it would be awful if we found our +places filled up when we went to work again." + +"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of your being out of +work after what you have done." + +"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews' first question when +they returned home. + +"He didn't say much, mother, except that we must not think of going to +work for a fortnight anyhow, and we are to have poultices made with +linseed mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from this bottle, +and it must be put on fresh every three or four hours. I am afraid it +will be an awful trouble." + +"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said brightly. "Did he say +you were to go to bed?" + +"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we could." + +"Then in that case, George, I think you had better go to bed." + +"No; I am sure we had better not," George said. "I should toss and +fidget about there horridly. The best thing will be for us to sit +here, and then we shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and +perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much. What are you going +to do, mother?" he asked five minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came +down with her bonnet on. + +"I am going to get some linseed, George, of course. I haven't got any +in the house." + +"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be shut." + +"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They will always supply +things that are needed even on Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as +well as any other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than a quarter +of an hour. You must keep very quiet till I come back." + +The boys found a good deal of relief from the effect of the poultices, +and were very much better after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock +the next morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work, with the +boys both on the hearthrug in front of the fire, there was a knock at +the door. It was a loud double knock, quite unlike the ordinary +summons of the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller. The boys +jumped up in surprise. + +"Who can that be, mother?" + +"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly. + +She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see a gentleman +standing there, whom, by the description the boys had given of him, +she guessed to be their employer. A little girl was standing by his +side. + +"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked. + +"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly. + +"My name is Penrose. I have called with my daughter to inquire after +the two lads--one of them your son, I believe--who so gallantly saved +my place from being burned down on Saturday evening. I only heard +about it late yesterday evening, when I came down to arrange about +some matters with the foreman. He did not know the facts of the case +on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday, and there can be no +doubt whatever, from what he says, that had it not been for the +presence of mind and bravery of these two lads nothing could have +saved the entire works and all the wood piles from destruction. I told +my daughter this morning, and she insisted on coming down with me. You +know she is already indebted to your son for saving a locket which we +both greatly valued." + +"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews showed them into the sitting +room. + +Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by Mrs. Andrews' manner, +although the foreman, in telling him of the boys' conduct, had also +stated what he knew about them. + +"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he said. "There was quite +a talk about them in the shops in the spring. They lodged with +Grimstone, and it seems that after they had been here at work five +months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was coming to them, and they +got Grimstone to take a house for them, and it turned out that ever +since they had been at work here they had been putting by half their +wages to furnish a place for her, so they must have lived on about +five shillings a week each and got clothes for themselves out of it. +Now, sir, boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there was +quite a talk among the men about it. I hear from Grimstone that Mrs. +Andrews is a superior sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does +work, I believe, for some London shop." + +Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the boys in a more +comfortable abode than usual, and their mother what the foreman called +a superior sort of woman; but he perceived at once by her address that +Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one, and that she was indeed a +lady. The prettiness of the little sitting room, with its comfortable +furniture, its snowy curtains and pretty belongings, heightened this +feeling. + +"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to tell you how indebted +I feel to you for your exertions on Saturday. There is no doubt that +had it not been for you the place would have been entirely burned. It +was fully insured, but it would have been a serious matter for me, as +I should have lost four or five months' work, and it would have been +still more serious for the men to have been thrown out of employment +at this time of the year, so we all feel very much indebted to you. I +hope you are not much burned." + +"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they will be all right +in a few days. Bill and I are very glad, sir, that we happened to be +passing, and were able to give the alarm and do something to stop the +flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that it was anything +out of the way. It was just a piece of fun and excitement to us." + +"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose, when they came home, +and it was only when one of the men came in next day to ask after them +that I heard that they had really been of use." + +"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose replied; "but there +is no doubt you showed a great deal of courage, as well as presence of +mind, and you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And now, Mrs. +Andrews," he said, turning round to her, "I feel rather in a false +position. I came round to see the lads, who, when I last saw them, +were not in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going to make +them a present for the service they had done me, and my daughter has +brought them a basket with some wine, jelly, and other things such as +are good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them, in your care and +in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty about it altogether." + +"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the kindness of your +intention; but my boys--for although one is in no way related to me I +feel towards him as if he were my own--would not like to take money +for doing their duty towards their employer." + +"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously. + +"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were good enough to give the +boys and to my needle,"--and she glanced towards the articles on the +table,--"we are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys will be very +glad to accept the things which your daughter has been so kind as to +bring down for them, and will feel very much obliged for her +thoughtfulness." + +"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved. "Nelly, you may as well +leave the basket as it is. I am sure you don't want to carry it back +again?" + +"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the empty basket would have +been more than the child could well have carried. It had come on the +top of the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had +accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum Villas. + +"You would have hardly known your young friend. Would you, Nelly?" + +"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her head. "He looks +dreadfully burned, and his hair is all funny and frizzled." + +"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling. "The doctor says our +faces will be all right when the skin is peeled off. Thank you very +much, Miss Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate day +indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing your locket." + +"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr. Penrose responded. "Now, +Mrs. Andrews, we will say good-by. You will not mind my calling again +to see how the boys are getting on?" + +"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be glad to see you," +Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope in a few days they will both be out +of the doctor's hands." + +"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said, patting the boys on +the shoulder, "but I hope next time I see you to be able to do so. +Good-morning, Mrs. Andrews." + + + + +CHAPTER VII. + +SAVED! + + +"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother," George said as Mrs. +Andrews returned into the room after seeing her two visitors off. +"It's very kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us +money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?" + +"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose is evidently a +gentleman of delicacy and refinement of feeling, and he saw that he +would give pain if he did so." + +"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked. "You know you thought +I was a fool not to take money when he offered it for getting back the +locket; but you see it in the same way now, don't you?" + +"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money," Bill said. "I sees----" + +"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected. + +"Thank you. I see things different--differently," he corrected +himself, seeing that George was about to speak, "to what I did then." + +"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the basket; it's almost as +big as a clothes-basket, isn't it?" + +The cover was lifted and the contents, which had after much thought +been settled by Nelly herself, were disclosed. There were two bottles +of port-wine, a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen oranges, +some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some almonds and raisins, two +packets of Everton toffee, a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of +black-currant jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a +sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in a tumbler of water for +a drink at night." + +"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a jolly collection, isn't +it? I think Miss Penrose must have chosen it herself, don't you?" + +"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews replied, smiling. +"I do not think any grownup person would have chosen mince-pies and +toffee as appropriate for sick boys." + +"Yes; but she must have known we were not badly burned, mother; and +besides, you see, she put in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there +are the oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and some toffee at +once, Bill." + +"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them in the market, but I +never tasted toffee." + +"It's first-rate, I can tell you." + +"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the packet was opened. + +George burst into a laugh. + +"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you peel that off, Bill, +and you will find the toffee inside. Now, mother, you have a glass of +wine and a piece of cake." + +"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am not going to open the +wine. We will put that by in case of illness or of any very +extraordinary occasion." + +"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother, or I expect you would +be wanting to put them all away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?" + +"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made of?" + +"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire." + +"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews laughed, "instead of boys +getting on for sixteen years old. Now I must clear this table again +and get to work; I promised these four bonnets should be sent in +to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be done to them yet." + +It was three weeks before the boys were able to go to work again. The +foreman came round on Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called +again; this time they were out, but he chatted for some time with Mrs. +Andrews. + +"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews," he said, after +asking about the boys; "but I have a motive for asking if your son +has, as I suppose he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair +education." + +"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs. Andrews said quietly; +"circumstances at that time obliged me to remove him; but I have +since done what I could myself towards continuing his education, and +he still works regularly of an evening." + +"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should like in time to place him +in the counting-house. I say in time, because I think it will be +better for him for the next two or three years to continue to work in +the shops. I will have him moved from shop to shop so as to learn +thoroughly the various branches of the business. That is what I should +do had I a son of my own to bring into the business. It will make him +more valuable afterwards, and fit him to take a good position either +in my shops or in any similar business should an opening occur." + +"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said gratefully; +"though I say it myself, a better boy never lived." + +"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him, and I shall be only too +glad, after the service he has rendered me, to do everything in my +power to push him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the same +advantages. At the time I first saw him he looked a regular young +arab." + +"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow. He was very kind to my +boy when he was alone in London, and gave up his former life to be +with him. George taught him to read before I came here, and he has +worked hard ever since. No one could be nicer in the house than he is, +and had I been his own mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious +to please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for my home here as +much to him as to my own boy." + +"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for of course I should +wish to do something for him too. At any rate, I will give him, like +your son, every opportunity of learning the business, and he will in +time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop--by no means a bad one +for a lad who has had such a beginning as he has had. After that, of +course, it must depend upon himself. I think, if you will allow me to +suggest, it would be as well that you should not tell them the nature +of our conversation. Of course it is for you to decide; but, however +steady boys they are, it might make them a little less able to get on +well with their associates in a shop if they know that they are going +to be advanced." + +"I don't think it would make any difference to them, sir; but at the +same time I do think it would be as well not to tell them." + +One day Bill was out by himself as the men were coming out of the +shop, and he stopped to speak to Bob Grimstone. + +"Oh! I am glad to find you without George," Bob said; "'cause I want +to talk to you. Look here! the men in all the shops have made a +subscription to give you and George a present. Everyone feels that +it's your doing that we have not got to idle all this winter, and when +someone started the idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that +didn't agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's come to +just thirty pounds. Now I don't know what you two boys would like, +whether you would like it in money, or whether you would like it in +something else, so I thought I would ask you first. I thought you +would know what George would like, seeing what friends you are, and +then you know it would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do you +say?" + +"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure George would like +anything better than money, and so should I." + +"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know in a day or two. We +were thinking of a watch for each of you, with an inscription, saying +it was presented to you by your shopmates for having saved the +factory, and so kept them at work for months just at the beginning of +winter. That's what seemed to me that you would like; but if there is +anything you would like better, just you say so. You come down here +to-morrow or next day, when you have thought it over, and give me an +answer. Of course you can consult George if you think best." + +Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day. + +"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know what George and me +would like better than any possible thing you could get." + +"Well, what is it, Bill?" + +"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what we were going to save +up our money to get, was a piano for George's mother. I heard her say +that we could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds, and it +would be splendid if you were all to give it her." + +"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know a chap as works at +Kirkman's, and I expect he will be able to give us a good one for the +money." + +Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the boys were going to +work again, Mrs. Andrews and George were astonished at seeing a cart +stop before the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and four other +men coming up to the door. + +Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered. He had been +apprised of the time that they might be expected, and at once showed +them in. + +"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my mates here are a +deputation from the hands employed in the shop, and we have come to +offer you a little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your son +and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving the shops. If it +hadn't been for them it would have been a bad winter for us all. So +after thinking it over and finding out what form of testimonial the +lads would like best, we have got you a piano, which we hope you may +live long to play on and enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch +each; but we found that they would rather that it took the form of a +piano." + +"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. Andrews said, much affected. +"I shall indeed be proud of your gift, both for itself and for the +kind feeling towards my boys which it expresses." + +"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just bring it in;" and the +deputation retired to assist with the piano. + +"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling me!" Mrs. Andrews +exclaimed. + +George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise. + +"But I didn't know anything about it, mother. I don't know what they +mean by saying that we would rather have it than watches. Of course we +would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they knew it." + +"Then it must have been your kind thought, Bill." + +"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but they spoke to me about +it, and I knew that a piano was what we should like better than +anything else, and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob +Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise to George as +well as to you." + +"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking Bill by the hand; "why, +there never was such a good idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?" + +The men now appeared at the door with the piano. This was at once +placed in the position which had long ago been decided upon as the +best place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. Andrews opened it, +and there on the front was a silver plate with the inscription: + +"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at Messrs. Penrose & Co., in token +of their gratitude to George Andrews and William Smith for their +courage and presence of mind, by which the factory was saved from +being destroyed by fire on Saturday the 23d of October, 1857." + +The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered it difficult for +her to read the inscription. + +"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps you would like to hear +its tones." So saying she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home." "It +has a charming touch," she said as she rose, "and, you see, the air +was an appropriate one, for your gift will serve to make home even +sweeter than before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those of my +boys, to all who have subscribed." + +The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had long been a subject of +considerable discussion and interest to their neighbors, for the +appearance of the boys as they came home of an evening in their +working clothes seemed altogether incongruous with that of their +mother and with the neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was, +indeed, considered derogatory to the respectability of Laburnum Villas +in general. Upon this evening they were still further mystified at +hearing the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness, +accompanied by a piano, played evidently by an accomplished musician, +issuing from the house. As to the boys, they thought that, next only +to that of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was such a happy +evening spent in the world. + +I do not think that in all London there was a household that enjoyed +that winter more than did the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their +total earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week, much less than +that of many a mechanic, but ample for them not only to live, but to +live in comfort and even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into +the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have dreamed that the +lady at the piano worked as a milliner for her living, or that the +lads were boys in a manufactory. + +When spring came they began to plan various trips and excursions which +could be taken on bank holidays or during the long summer evenings, +when an event happened which, for a time, cut short all their plans. +The word had been passed round the shops the first thing in the +morning that Mr. Penrose was coming down with a party of ladies and +gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were to be made as +tidy as possible. + +Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and vast quantities of +shavings and sawdust were swept up from the floors, although when the +machines had run again for a few hours no one would have thought that +a broom had been seen in the place for weeks. + +George was now in a shop where a number of machines were at work +grooving, mortising, and performing other work to prepare the wood for +builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work had recommenced +after dinner. + +There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many ladies. Nelly Penrose, +with two girls about her own age, accompanied the party. They stopped +for a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the nature of the +work and the various points of the machinery. + +They had passed through most of the other rooms before they entered +that in which George was engaged, and the young girls, taking but +little interest in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat +away from the rest of the party, chatting among themselves. George had +his eye upon them, and was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round +and speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly and not +paying sufficient heed to the machinery. + +Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward with a shout; but +he was too late, a revolving-band had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In +an instant she was dragged forward and in another moment would have +been whirled into the middle of the machinery. + +There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden crash and a harsh +grating sound, and then the whole of the machinery on that side of the +room came to a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had +happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends rushed forward to raise +Nelly. Her hand was held fast between the band and the pulley, and the +band had to be cut to relieve it. + +"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose murmured, as he lifted +her. "Another second and nothing could have saved her. But what +stopped the machinery?" and for the first time he looked round the +shop. There was a little group of men a few yards away, and, having +handed Nelly, who was crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised, +to one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The foreman came +forward to meet him. + +"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of the shop. I am +afraid young Andrews is badly hurt." + +"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked. + +"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter was in, and shoved his +foot in between two of the cog-wheels." + +"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as he pushed forward among +the men. + +Two of them were supporting George Andrews, who, as pale as death, lay +in their arms. One of his feet was jammed in between two of the +cog-wheels. He was scarcely conscious. + +"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a low tone, "his foot must be +completely crushed! Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?" + +"Yes, sir, I did that first thing." + +"That's right; now work away for your lives, lads." This was said to +two men who had already seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts +of the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to be lifted and +the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr. Penrose returned to his friends. + +"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down into the office. There's +been a bad accident; a noble young fellow has sacrificed himself to +save Nelly's life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off a +man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump into one of the cabs he +will find waiting at the gate, and tell the man to drive as hard as he +can go. If Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone else." + +George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly Penrose. When he +saw the band catch her dress he had looked round for an instant for +something with which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing at +hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had thrust his foot +between the cog-wheels. He had on very heavy, thickly nailed working +boots, and the iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent the +shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George felt a dull, sickening +pain, which seemed to numb and paralyze him all over, and he +remembered little more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot +was extricated and he was laid gently down on a heap of shavings. The +first thing he realized when he was conscious was that someone was +pouring some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat. + +When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling beside him, was +supporting his head, while on the other side knelt Bill Smith, the +tears streaming down his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs. + +"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then the remembrance of what +had passed flashed upon him. + +"Is she safe; was I in time?" + +"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your noble sacrifice was not in +vain," Mr. Penrose answered with quivering lips, for he too had the +greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion. + +"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a pause, "because, if so, +will you please send home for mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I +feel strange and weak." + +"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly crushed, but +otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot threw the machinery out of gear." + +In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already been informed of the +nature of the accident. + +"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr. Penrose asked in a low +voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped over George's leg. + +"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the same tone. "The foot +is crushed to a pulp. It must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save +it. He had better be taken home at once. You had best send to Guy's +and get an operating surgeon for him. I would rather it were done by +someone whose hand is more used than mine to this sort of work." + +"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said, "and will send off at +once for one of their best men. You are not afraid of the case, I +hope, Dr. Maxwell?" + +"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied; "but the shock to the +system of such a smash is very severe. However, he has youth, +strength, and a good constitution, so we must hope for the best. The +chances are all in his favor. We are thinking of taking you home, my +boy," he went on, speaking aloud to George. "Are you in any great +pain?" + +"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully cold, and, please, +will someone go on before and tell mother. Bill had better not go; he +would frighten her to death and make her think it was much worse than +it is." + +"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will prepare her for your +coming." + +"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor said; "that will warm you +and give you strength for your journey." + +There was a stretcher always kept at the works in case of emergency, +and George was placed on this and covered with some rugs. Four of the +men raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose at once +driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews. + +Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When it neared home he +fell behind and wandered away, not being able to bring himself to +witness the grief of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about, +sitting down in waste places and crying as if his heart would break. +"If it had been me it wouldn't have mattered," he kept on +exclaiming--"wouldn't have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no +odds one way or the other. There, we have always been together in the +shops till this week, and now when we get separated this is what comes +of it. Here am I, walking about all right, and George all crushed up, +and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I would rather a hundred times +that they had smashed me up all over than have gone and hurt George +like that!" + +It was dark before he made his way back, and, entering at the back +door, took off his boots, and was about to creep upstairs when Mrs. +Andrews came out of the kitchen. + +"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the tears again burst from him. + +"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and the doctors have +every hope that he will recover. They are upstairs with him now, with +a nurse whom Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital. He will +have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added with a sob that she could +not repress, "but we should feel very thankful that it is no worse +after such an accident as that. The doctor says that his thick boots +saved him. If it hadn't been for that his whole leg would have been +drawn into the machinery, and then nothing could have saved him. Now I +must go upstairs, as I only came down for some hot water." + +"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?" + +"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here for the present for +both your sakes. I will let you know when you can go up to him." + +So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He heard movements +upstairs and wondered what they were doing and why they didn't keep +quiet, and when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice the nurse +came down for hot water, but Bill did not speak to her; but in half an +hour Mrs. Andrews herself returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler +than before. + +"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy, that it's all over. +They gave him chloroform, and have taken his foot off." + +"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an awed voice. + +"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it, and the first thing he +asked when he came to was when they were going to begin. They will be +going away directly, and then you can come up and sit quietly in his +room if you like. The doctors say he will probably drop asleep." + +Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle with himself before +he felt that he was fit to go up into George's room. It was a long +struggle, and had George caught his muttered remonstrances to himself +he would have felt that Bill had suffered a bad relapse into his +former method of talking. It came out in jerks between his sobs. + +"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of yerself, a-howling and +a-blubbering like a gal! Call yerself a man!--you are a babby, that's +what you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more of it." + +But it was a long time before he again mastered himself; then he went +to the scullery and held his head under the tap till the water took +away his breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then went +and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came in and told him that he +could go upstairs to George. He went up to the bedside and took +George's hand, but he could not trust himself to speak. + +"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in a somewhat lower +voice than usual, "this is a sudden go, isn't it?" + +Bill nodded. He was still speechless. + +"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said, feeling that the lad +was shaking from head to foot. "It won't make much odds, you know. I +shall soon be about again all right. I expect they will be able to put +on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping about as well as ever, +though I shouldn't be much good at a race." + +"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I would have jammed my head +in between them wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you should +have gone and done it." + +"Fortunately there was no time," George said with a smile. "Don't you +fret yourself, Bill; one can get on well enough without a foot, and it +didn't hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze either, not +regular hurting; it was just a sort of scrunch, and then I didn't feel +anything more. Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at play +and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked much worse to you than +it felt to me." + +"We will talk of it another time," Bill said huskily. "Your mother +said I wasn't to talk, and I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit +down here quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So saying he +sat down by the bedside. George asked one or two more questions, but +Bill only shook his head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a +short time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed that he was +asleep. + +The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to George. Every day +hampers containing flowers and various niceties in the way of food +were sent down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself very +frequently called in for a chat with him. As soon as the wound had +healed an instrument-maker came down from town to measure him for an +artificial foot, but before he was able to wear this he could get +about on crutches. + +The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Penrose brought Nelly down +to see him. The child looked pale and awed as he came in. + +"My little girl has asked me to thank you for her, George," Mr. +Penrose said as she advanced timidly and placed her hand in his. "I +have not said much to you about my own feelings and I won't say much +about hers; but you can understand what we both feel. Why, my boy, it +was a good Providence, indeed, which threw you in my way! I thought so +when you saved the mill from destruction. I feel it tenfold more now +that you have saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed, strange. +Who would have thought that all this could have sprung from that boy +snatching the locket from Helen as we came out of the theater! And now +about the future, George. I owe you a great debt, infinitely greater +than I can ever repay; but what I can do I will. In the future I shall +regard you as my son, and I hope that you will look to me as to a +father. I have been talking to your mother, and she says that she +thinks your tastes lie altogether in the direction of engineering. Is +that so?" + +"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather be an engineer than +anything else, but I don't like----" + +"Never mind what you like and what you don't like," Mr. Penrose said +quietly. "You belong to me now, you know and must do as you are told. +What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good school for +another three years, and I will then apprentice you to a first-class +engineer, either mechanical or civil as you may then prefer, and when +you have learned your business I will take good care that you are +pushed on. What do you say to that?" + +"I think it is too much altogether," George said. + +"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said, "that is my business. If +that is the only objection we can imagine it settled. There is another +thing. I know how attached you are to your friend Bill, and I am +indebted to him, too, for the part he played at the fire, so I +propose, if he is willing, to put him to a good middle-class school +for a bit. In the course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient +education to get on fairly with, and then I propose, according as you +may choose to be a civil or mechanical engineer, to place him with a +mason or smith; then by the time that you are ready to start in +business he will be ready to take a place under you, so that you may +again work together." + +"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even more pleased at the news +relating to Bill than at his own good fortune, great as was the +delight which the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused him. + +As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose sent him with his mother +and Bill down to the seaside. Here George rapidly regained strength, +and when, after a stay there of two months, he returned to town, he +was able to walk so well with his artificial foot that his loss would +not have been noticed by a stranger. + +The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were all in due time carried +out. George went for three years to a good school, and was then +apprenticed to one of the leading civil engineers. With him he +remained five years and then went out for him to survey a railroad +about to be constructed in Brazil, and remained there as one of the +staff who superintended its construction. Bill, who was now a clever +young mason, accompanied him, and through George's interest with the +contractor obtained the sub-contract for the masonry of some of the +bridges and culverts. + +This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is now one of the most +rising engineers of the day, and whatever business he undertakes his +friend Bill is still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in all +respects as good as his word, and has been ready to assist George with +his personal influence in all his undertakings, and in all respects +has treated him as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the +affection of a sister. + +Both George and Bill have been married some years, and Mrs. Andrews +the elder is one of the proudest and happiest of mothers. She still +lives with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who is often +left alone during George's frequent absence abroad on professional +duties. As for Bill, he has not even yet got over his wonder at his +own good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first met George in +Covent Garden. + + + + +DO YOUR DUTY. + + +Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor was sitting on a +bench gazing over the stretch of sea which lies between Hayling Island +and the Isle of Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those +days ships of war were constantly running in and out, and great +convoys of merchantmen sailed under the protection of our cruisers; +and the traffic between Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a +much frequented road. + +Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's service, and had +settled down in his old age on a pension, and lived in a small cottage +near the western extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see what +was going on at Spithead, and when he needed a talk with his old +"chums" could get into his boat, which was lying hauled up on the +sand, and with a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was +sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up by a very high +tide on the sandy slope, when his meditations were disturbed by a +light step behind him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen +years of age, with a bright honest face, came running down behind him. + +"Hallo, dad!" + +"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought o' seeing you!" and the +old man clasped the boy in his arms in a way that showed the close +relationship between the two. "I didn't expect you for another week." + +"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy said; "fine wind all +the way up, with a gale or two in the right quarter. We only arrived +in the river on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I got +leave to run down to see you." + +"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old sailor said. "It's the +duty of every hand to stop by the ship till she's cleared out." + +"I have always stayed before till the crew were paid off; but no +sooner had we cast anchor than one of the owners came on board, and +told the captain that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to be +unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and sail again in a +fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was on the point of sailing for +the West Indies under a strong convoy." + +"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old sailor said. "And the goods +will have to be bundled out and in again with double speed. I know +what it will be. You will be going out with the paint all wet, and +those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off as fast as it's put on. +Well, a few days at sea will shake all down into its place. But how +did you get leave?" + +"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the lad said. "The +men who desired to leave were to be discharged at once and a fresh +gang taken on board, so I asked him directly the news came round if I +might have four days away. He agreed at once, and I came down by the +night coach; and here I am for eight-and-forty hours." + +"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after more than a year +away, but we mustn't waste the time in regretting it. You've grown, +Harry, and are getting on fast. In another couple of years you'll be +fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've got over your silly idea +about sticking to the merchant service. It's all very well to learn +your business there as a boy, and I grant that in some things a +merchantman is a better school than a king's ship. They have fewer +hands, and each man has to do more and to learn to think for himself. +Still, after all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement +and happiness." + +"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been learning a little +navigation. The first officer has been very kind to me, and I hope in +the course of two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third +mate. Still, I should like three or four years on board a man-of-war." + +"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a man ought to do his +duty to his country." + +"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to their country," the +boy said. + +"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's a great difficulty +in finding hands for the navy. Everyone wants to throw their duty upon +everyone else. They all hanker after the higher wages and loafing life +on board a merchantman, and hate to keep themselves smart and clean as +they must do in a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should serve +at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war. It is above all +things essential, Harry, that you should do your duty." + +"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said, "when the time comes. I +do it now to the best of my power, and I have in my pocket a letter +from the first officer to you. He told you when you went down with me +to see me off on my last voyage that he would keep an eye upon me, and +he has done so." + +"That's right," the old man said. "As you say, Harry, a man may do his +duty anywhere; still, for all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a +sailor, to help his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies. +Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh fifty years, and was in +action one way and another over a hundred times, and here I am now +with a snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious majesty +himself. What can you want more than that?" + +"I don't know that I can want more," the boy said, "in its way, at +least; but there are other ways in the merchant service. I might +command a ship by the time I am thirty, and be my own master instead +of being a mere part of a machine. I have heard the balls flying too," +he said, laughing. + +"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?" the old tar said, greatly +interested. + +"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer off the coast of +Spain. Fortunately the old bark carries a long eighteen, as well as +her twelves, and when the Frenchman found that we could play at long +bowls as well as himself he soon drew off, but not before we had +drilled a few holes in his sails and knocked away a bit of his +bulwarks." + +"Were you hit, Harry?" + +"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did little damage beyond +knocking away a few of the fittings and frightening the lady +passengers. We had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that the +skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman come close before +he opened fire. We should like to have towed him up the river with our +flag over the tricolor." + +"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said, "you were just as ready +to fight as if you had been on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing +ship you only get a chance if one of these privateers happens to see +you, in a king's ship you go looking about for an enemy, and when you +see one the chances are he is bigger, instead of smaller, than +yourself." + +"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it, I expect," the boy +said; "but for all that, I do mean to serve for a few years in a +man-of-war. I expect that we may have a chance of seeing some +fighting in the West Indies. There are, they say, several French +cruisers in that direction, and although we shall have a considerable +convoy the Frenchmen generally have the legs of our ships. I believe +that some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out troops, and that +we are going to have a slap at some of the French islands. Has there +been any news here since I went?" + +"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers. The revenue officers +have a busy time here. There's no such place for smuggling on the +coast as between Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just the +places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic in the Channel that +a solitary lugger does not attract the attention of the coastguard as +it does where the sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself +one way or the other about it. I may know a good deal of the +smuggling, or I may not, but it's no business of mine. If it were my +duty to lend a hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it +isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am content enough to +get my spirits cheap." + +"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the king being cheated?" +Harry said with a smile. + +"If the king himself were going to touch the money," the old sailor +said sturdily, "I would lend a hand to see that he got it, but there's +no saying where this money would have gone. Besides, if the spirits +hadn't been run, they would not have been brought over here at all, +so after all the revenue is none the worse for the smuggling." + +The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad, when you like, but you +know as well as I do that smuggling's dishonest, and that those who +smuggle cheat the revenue." + +"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I don't clearly see +that it's my duty to give information in the matter. If I did feel as +it were going to be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it, +and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything within earshot +of me, that I might feel called on to repeat. And now, let's go up to +the cottage and see the old woman." + +"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said, "as I passed. Mother +looks as hale and hearty as she did when I left, and so do you, dad." + +"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old man said. "I have been +so thoroughly seasoned with salt water that it would take a long time +for me to decay." + +When they got up to the cottage they found that Jane Langley had got +breakfast prepared. Rashers of bacon were smoking on the table, and a +large tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of tea had +not become general in this country. + +"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said, "that the boy is to +leave us again in forty-eight hours?" + +"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is hard news. I had hoped +that you would be with us for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast +in life, and may not be here when you return." + +"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing as that," Harry said. +"Father was just saying that he's so seasoned that even time cannot +make much of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as he is." + +"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when old oak does come +down, he generally falls sudden. However, we won't make our first meal +sad by talking of what might be." + +Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents of Harry's +voyage to India and back. It was his second trip. The lad had had a +much better education than most boys in his rank of life at that time, +the boatswain having placed him at the age of ten in charge of a +schoolmaster at Portsmouth. When Harry had reached that age Peter had +retired from the service, and had settled down at Hayling, but for two +years longer he had kept Harry at school. Then he had apprenticed him +to a firm of shipowners in London, and one of the officers under whom +Peter had served had spoken to the heads of the firm, so that the boy +was put in a ship commanded by a kind and considerate officer, and to +whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus he had not forgotten +what he had learned at school, as is too often the case with lads in +his position. His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what he +knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each day such subjects as +would be useful to him in his career. + +After breakfast the pair again went out onto the sandhills, Peter, as +usual, carrying a huge telescope with him, with which he was in the +habit of surveying every ship as she rounded the west of the island +and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth. Most of the +men-of-war he knew in an instant, and the others he could make a +shrewd guess at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full of talk +of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's future bearing, and of +suggestions and hints as to the best course to be adopted in various +emergencies. But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and smoked +his pipe, and looked out in silence over the sea, scarcely even +lifting his telescope to his eye. + +"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last, "that as you are going +away again, and, as the old woman says, you may not find us both here +when you come back, it is right that I should tell you a little more +about yourself. I once told you, years ago, that you were not my son, +and that I would give you more particulars some day." + +The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It was a matter which +he had often thought over in his mind, for although he loved the +honest tar and his good wife as much as he could have done his natural +parents, still, since he had known that he was their adopted son only, +he had naturally wondered much as to who his parents were, and what +was their condition in life. + +"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not to tell you this +here yarn until you were getting on. Boys' heads get upset with a +little breeze, especially if they have no ballast, and though it isn't +likely now that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and it +will make no difference whether it was a duke or a ship's caulker who +was your father, still it's right that you should know the facts, as +no one can say when they start on a voyage in life what craft they may +fall aboard before they've done. It may be, Harry, that as you intends +to stick to the merchant service--saving, of course, that little time +you mean to serve on board a king's ship--you may rise to be a +skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy, that as a skipper you +may fall in love with some taut craft sailing in your convoy. I've +seen such things before now, and then the fact that you might be, for +aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of being that of a +boatswain, might score in your favor. Women have curious notions, and +though, for my part, I can't see that it makes much difference where +the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and well-built, +there are those who thinks different. + +"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen years ago that I +was boatswain aboard the _Alert_ frigate, as taut a craft as ever +sailed. We had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd want to +see. We were cruising in the West Indies, and had for months been, +off and on, in chase of a craft that had done much damage there. She +carried a black flag, and her skipper was said to be the biggest +villain that ever even commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed but +some ship was missing. It mattered little to him whether she sailed +under the English, the French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to +him. Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never reached Europe. +Sometimes a few charred timbers would be thrown up on the shore of the +islands, showing that the ship to which they belonged had been taken +and burned before she had gone many days on her way. Often and often +had the pirate been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in itself a +very unusual thing with pirates--indeed, I never knew of one before. +But she had been, I believe, a merchantman captured by the pirate, and +was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her, and handed his own +schooner over to his mate. Somehow or other he had altered her +ballast, and maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have a +rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are so strong that they +can, if need be, build a ship of their own. Anyhow, she was the +fastest ship of her class that ever was seen on those seas, and though +our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she laughed at them, +and would for a whole day keep just out of reach of their bow-chasers +with half her sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under +every rag they could put on their masts. Then when she was tired of +that game she would hoist her full canvas and leave the king's vessel +behind as if she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got +caught by cruisers coming up in different directions, but each time +she managed to slip away without ever having a rope or stay started by +a shot. We in the _Alert_ had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but +had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the mere name of the +_Seamew_ was sufficient to put any one of us into a passion. There +wasn't one of the ship's company, from the captain down to the +powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully given a year's pay to get +alongside the _Seamew_. The _Alert_ carried thirty-two guns, and our +crew was stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there was a +good deal of boat service, and it was considered that at any moment +'Yellow Jack' might lay a good many hands up--or down, as the case may +be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto Rico, and the first +lieutenant had strolled up with two of the middies to the top of a +hill just before the sun went down. He had taken a glass with him. +Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck, who was +looking at the shore with a glass, said to the second lieutenant, who +was on watch: + +"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen and Hobart down that hill +as if he were running a race. He isn't likely to be racing the +middies. What can he be after?' + +"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile; 'Mr. Jones is hardly +likely to be racing the middies'; which, indeed, was true enough, for +the first lieutenant was as stiff as a ramrod--a good officer, but as +strict a martinet as ever I sailed under. + +"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw that, whatever the +reason might be, it was as the midshipman had said. The news that Mr. +Jones was coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was after him, +soon spread, and there was quite an excitement on the quarter-deck as +to what could be the matter. + +"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming off to the ship, and +it was evident, by the way the spray was flying and the oars bending, +that the men were pulling as if for life or death. By this time the +news had spread through the ship, and the captain himself was on the +quarter-deck. + +"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as the boat came within +call he shouted, 'What's the matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?' + +"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up and making a trumpet +with his two hands, 'two craft together round the point of the island +some fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line, but by +their look I think that one is the _Seamew_ and the other a +merchantman she has captured.' + +"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the orders sharp and quick. +The men, who were all standing about, were in a minute clustering on +the yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster than it was on +the _Alert_ that evening. Before the boat was fairly run up to the +davits the anchor was at the cat-head, and the _Alert's_ bows were +pointing seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every stitch of +canvas set, we were running out of the harbor. The first lieutenant +had taken the bearings pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk +evening breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By this time it +was dark, and we had every hope that we might come upon the pirate +before she had finished transferring the cargo of her prize under her +own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as the moon was not up we +hoped to get within gunshot before being seen, as the pirate, seeing +no craft within sight before the sun went down, would not suspect that +the _Alert_ could be on his traces. We had to sail close to the wind +till we were round the point of the island, and then to run nearly +before it towards the spot where the vessels had been seen. In two +hours from the time of starting we reckoned that we must be getting +close to them if they still remained hove-to. + +"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point or two off the +starboard bow, a great flame shot up. Every moment it grew and grew +until we could see a large ship in flames, while another lay about a +quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were pulling from the +ship in flames towards the other, and as this was a bark we had no +doubt that we had caught the _Seamew_ at her villainous work. The +pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman, so that while +her spars stood out clear and distinct against the glare of light we +must have been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly forward +for the men to go to quarters. Every gun was double-shotted and run +out, and then, all being ready for the fight, the men stripped to +their waists, cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we waited +with breathless anxiety. We were already within range of our +bow-chasers, and as yet there was no sign that the pirate was +conscious of our presence. The boats were now near him, and no doubt +those on board were looking rather in their direction than to +windward. Rapidly the _Alert_ tore through the water, the sail +trimmers were all ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's +notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck, and the men stood +by their guns with every eye strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer +we came, and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were within a mile +now, when suddenly a great movement was seen on board the pirate. The +breeze was steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command could +be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran up the rattlins. It was clear +we were seen. There was no further need of concealment, and the +captain gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as the pirate +got her canvas spread--and I do think that sharp as we had been on +board the _Alert_, the _Seamew_ was even quicker in getting under +canvas--we were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she got +fairly under way. Up to this moment not a gun had spoken save the two +bow-chasers, as the captain would not yaw her until the last moment +Then round she came and poured a broadside into the _Seamew_. Orders +had been given to fire high, and every man was on his mettle. The +maintop-mast of the _Seamew_ fell, snapped at the cap; the peak +halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a number of holes were +drilled through her sails. A loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as +the _Seamew_ was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent her +getting away, and at last she was to show whether she could fight as +well as run, and I must say for her she did. + +"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two, but they were of +far heavier metal, and after ten minutes the _Alert_ was as much +bruised and battered as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of equal +size for an hour. However, we had not been idle, and as our shot had +been principally directed against the enemy's rigging, as our great +object was to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away, she +was by this time a mere wreck above, although her sides were scarcely +touched; whereas two of our ports had been knocked into one, and some +thirty of our men had been struck down either by shot or by splinters. +Pouring a last broadside into her, the captain ordered the _Alert_ to +be brought alongside the _Seamew_. There was no need to call upon the +boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared, and as the vessels came +alongside our men rushed to the assault. But the crew of the _Seamew_ +were as eager to board us as we were them, and upon the very bulwarks +a desperate combat ensued. Strong as we were, the _Seamew_ carried +fully as many hands, and as they were fighting with halters round +their necks it's little wonder that they fought so well. + +"I've been in a good many fights, but never did I see one like that. +Each man hacked, and hewed, and wielded his boarding-pike as if the +whole fight depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the men +whose places were at the guns on the starboard side left their places +and joined in the fight, while those on the port side continued to +pour a fire of grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour before +we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and then steadily and +gradually we fought our way forward. But it was another half-hour +after the pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and +fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered. + +"On board the _Alert_ we had fully one-third of our complement killed +or wounded. Mr. Jones had been shot through the head; the second and +third lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain himself had +had his jaw broken by a pistol fired in his face. I got this scar on +my cheek, which spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I +had been over thirty years married to the old woman that made but +little difference. Never were a crew more glorious than we were that +night. Even the wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply +purchased. We had captured the scourge of these seas, which had for +ten years laughed at all the fastest cruisers of our navy, and we felt +as proud as if we had captured a French first-rate. + +"All hands were at work next day in repairing damages. I was up aloft +seeing to the fitting of fresh gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw +something floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed to me +like a box, and an empty one, for it floated high on the water. Its +lid seemed to be open, and I thought once or twice that I saw +something inside. I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I +had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty with his arm in a +sling, was not disposed to take the men off their work to lower a +boat; but as I pointed out that the box might have belonged to the +merchantman which had been burned overnight, and that it might afford +some clew as to the name of the ship, he consented, and with four +hands I was soon rowing towards the box. + +"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I was never more +surprised than when, getting there, I found that it was a trunk, and +that in it, sitting up, was a child about eighteen months old. That +was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were a locket with a +woman's likeness in it, a curious Indian bangle, and a few other +articles of jewelry. How you got there we never knew, but the +supposition was that when the pirate was overhauling the merchantman, +and her true nature was ascertained, some mother, knowing the fate +that awaited all on board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in +what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped the trunk overboard, +in hopes that it might drift away and be picked up by some passing +ship. It was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against its +success, but the Lord had watched over it, and there you were as snug +and comfortable as if you had been laying in your own cot, though, by +the way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens, and I +expect had missed your breakfast considerably. You were sitting up, +and it was lucky that you were backward of your age, for, although by +your size we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still unable +to walk. If you had been as active as some chaps of that age you would +have scrambled onto your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat. + +"Well, we brought you on board, and there was a great talk as to what +was to be done with you; but as I was your discoverer I claimed you as +a lawful prize, and I thought you would amuse the old woman while I +was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort to me when I got laid up in +ordinary, as indeed you have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every +inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship which exactly +answered to the description. You see, beyond the fact that she was a +square-rigged ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments +found in the box seemed to show that she had come from the East +Indies, but of course that could not be, for what would she be doing +there? But at any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and who +was no doubt your mother, had been to the East Indies, or at least had +been given those ornaments by someone who had, for there was no doubt +where they were turned out. + +"Well, on board the _Alert_ everyone got promoted. There was enough +valuable property found on board the _Seamew_ to give us a handsome +sum all round, and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled me +to buy this little cottage, and went no small way towards paying for +your schooling and board. As no one else claimed you, and your friends +could not be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship; +and so, my boy, here you have been cruising about the world as Harry +Langley ever since." + +The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some time before he spoke. + +"Well, dad, you may not have been my real father, but no one could +have been a better father to me than you have, and as it isn't likely +now that I shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to discover +who I am, I shall continue to regard you as my real father. Still, as +you say, it may perhaps in life be some advantage to me to be able to +claim that I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily. They +talked the matter over for some time, and then Harry changed the +subject. + +"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked. + +"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his cable six months since, and +his wife, poor old soul, is gone to some friends near Winchester." + +"Who's living in the cottage?" + +"Black Jack has taken it." + +"What! has he moved from his old place, then?" + +"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy, who comes down off +and on. They say he's in the smuggling business with Black Jack, and +that he disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over in the +_Lucy_, and that Jack trades over in France with his friends. The +lieutenant at the coast-guard station has his eye upon him, and I +believe that some day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo; +but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day for Hayling if +they could do so, for he and his crew do a lot of harm to the place. +They look more like men who have belonged to the _Seamew_ I was +talking to you about than honest English fishermen." + +"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman should be coming +backwards and forwards here, and I wonder that the revenue people +don't inquire into it." + +"I don't suppose that they know very much about it, Harry. He comes +off and on, generally arriving at night, and leaving a few hours +afterwards. I hear about these things because everyone knows that old +Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into other people's +business. I don't like these goings on, I must say, and consider they +will end badly. However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our +brandy cheap in Hayling--nowhere cheaper, I should say--and that, +after all, is the matter that concerns us most. The wind's rising +fast; I think we're in for a gale." + +It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast behind the island, +the waves were breaking with a short, sharp sound upon the beach, +white heads were beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing +craft were running in towards Portsmouth under reefed sails, the +men-of-war at Spithead could be seen sending down their topmasts, and +everything betokened that it would be a nasty night. + +"What time must you leave, Harry?" + +"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall cross the ferry, and +catch the coach as it goes along at eight. I promised that I would be +back on the following morning, and I would not fail in keeping my +appointment, for as the captain has been so good I should be sorry +that he should think that I had broken my word." + +In the course of the day Harry went over to the village and saw many +of his boy friends. Bill Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened +to be away, but his parents said that he would be back at nine in the +evening. He had gone over to Winchester to see a brother who was in a +regiment quartered there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock Harry +said to his father that he would just walk over to have a chat with +his friend, and be back in an hour or so. + +"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at once," Jane Langley said; +"if thou hast to start at three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed +now." + +"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said, laughing, "and I shall +be able to sleep long to-morrow." + +Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple, and went off at a run +into the darkness. + +The road was a wide one, and but little frequented, and the grass grew +thick over a considerable portion of the sides, therefore as he ran +along with a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was +deadened. As he came along by the cottage of which he had been +speaking to Peter Langley he heard the sound of voices within. Being +curious to see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry paused, +lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered the little garden. +He had intended to peep in at the window, and having satisfied his +curiosity to be off; but just as he reached the door the latter opened +suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw back behind the little porch +before two men came out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the +smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting English evidently +the foreigner. They stopped for a moment, looking out into the night. + +"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be a storm, and no +mistake. The _Lucy_ is a tight craft, and has weathered gales when +many a bigger ship has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into +it without necessity." + +"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have sought zat ze earning of +five hundred pounds was as urgent a necezity as was wanted." + +"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the smuggler said, "though one +does put one's head into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is +bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important." + +"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter about ze nooze? It +hasn't got over your zick neck or my zin one, and till it does we +needn't trouble about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch +we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand zey cannot grudge us +double pay. I have ridden from London wizout stopping, and have killed +a horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat matters not. Zis +letter should fetch us ze money to pay for a dozen horses and a dozen +of your _Lucys_." + +"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we will be off. Letters +like that in your pocket are best not kept on hand. You are sure that +the _Chasse Maree_ will put out to meet us in such weather as we are +likely to have?" + +"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the Frenchman said. "Zey +know ze importance of ze news, which is expected, and which I am +bringing zem. _Mon Dieu!_ what sums have been paid to get ze news +zat's in zis little dispatch!" + +"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said. + +"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but I believe it is ze +orders zat are to be sent to ze British fleet, and zat zey are about +to strike a great blow zomewhere." + +"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and tell the boys. I +warned them to be in readiness, and I will send them straight down to +the beach. In a quarter of an hour I will return for you." + +While this conversation had been going on Harry had been standing +against the porch, the sides of which were filled with latticework +over which a creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance of +the secret that he was hearing, and had been rapidly meditating in his +mind how this all-portant information which was about to be conveyed +to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up his mind that the +instant the smuggler moved out he would make his way down to the +village, tell the tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman +seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult, for the smuggler +and his gang were not men to be attacked with impunity, and the +fishers of the village would hesitate in taking part in such a +struggle merely on the information of a boy. However, Harry saw that +it was the only chance. + +In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so hide himself from +the view of the two men who were standing on the little garden-path in +front, he pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was rotten with +age, and suddenly with a crash it gave way. + +With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he and the Frenchman +dashed to the spot, and in an instant had collared the lad. In a +moment he was dragged into the room. + +"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler said, with a terrible +imprecation. "The scoundrel has heard what we've said, and our lives +won't be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free. Stand by +and I'll knock out his brains;" and he seized a heavy poker from the +side of the hearth. + +"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have blood. Zere might be +inquiries, and zese sings will sometimes be found. Better take him to +sea wis you in ze _Lucy_, and hand him over to ze _Chasse Maree_. Zey +will take care zat he does not come back again." + +"I will take care myself," the smuggler said. "I'm not going to risk +my neck on the chance of his blabbing. It's better, as you say, to +have no blood, but as soon as the _Lucy's_ at sea overboard he goes." + +"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm wis you zat he must be +silenced, but it may be better--my plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I +suppose, to ze village?" + +"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight. He's the son of an +old man-of-war's man who lives half a mile away." + +"Well, you see, some of your men might some day, if they quarreled wis +you, or in zeir drink, drop some words which might lead to inquiries. +Better put him on board ze _Chasse Maree_. I will see ze matter is +settled." + +Harry had spoken no word from the time he was grasped. He felt in an +instant that his life was forfeited, and was surprised that he had not +been instantly killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo, for he +knew that no cottagers were near, and was sure that an attempt to give +the alarm would insure his instant death. To struggle would have been +useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad, was but a child in +the grasp of a powerful man like the smuggler. He saw, too, that on +the instant the Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and +though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the tone of his voice +that he was as determined as his colleague that his silence should be +secured by death. + +In another minute he was bound and thrown into a corner. The Frenchman +then took his seat near him, assuring him in a low tone that he would +at his first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The smuggler +strolled off to summon his crew, and for a quarter of an hour silence +reigned in the cottage. + +"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last, as if he had been +thinking the matter over--"one meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen +at people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want to kill you, +but what are we to do? You make us kill you. You push your own head +into ze trap. Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling in +affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze trouble to kill zem. I +would give a hundred pounds if zis had not happened; but what can I +do? It is my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to have to do +it--_parbleu!_ my life is of much more value zan zat of a fishing boy. +Bah! you are one meddlesome fool." + +So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble which the prying of +this lad had brought upon him that he got up and angrily gave him a +kick. A few minutes later the smuggler returned. + +"The men have all gone down to the boat," he said briefly. "Come +along, mounseer. Bring that tin case with you, and those pistols." + +"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the Frenchman said. "As to +ze pistols--zey are not of much use. However, I will take zem;" and he +thrust them into the pockets of his coat. + +The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw him onto a sail which he +had laid on the ground, wrapped this round him, and then cast him over +his shoulder. + +"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the boat," he said, "but +should I do so I'm taking the mainsail of the _Lucy_ down to her." + +In another minute Harry heard the door slam, and then he felt himself +being carried steadily along, his weight being as nothing to the +smuggler. Not a word was spoken between the two men on their way down +to the shore. Presently Harry felt by the deadened sound of the +footsteps, and by the more uneven motion, that he was being carried +over the sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and through the +canvas he could hear the loud roar of the waves, which were now +breaking violently. + +Presently he was flung roughly down on the sands. A minute later he +was lifted by the head and feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was +spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers, and after ten +minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock, and knew that they were +alongside of the _Lucy_. He was hauled up on deck. He heard a few +words of command, and then felt the vessel was on her way. A minute or +two later the covering was unloosed. His cords were cut, and the +smuggler said to him, "You can't get away now, and may as well make +yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that rope." + +The _Lucy_ was, in fact, short-handed, two of the six men who composed +her crew being absent. She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons' +burden, built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but longer and +lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing when her crew were not +engaged upon other adventures. She was a remarkably fast craft, and +had more than once showed her heels with success when chased by the +revenue cutters. She owed her immunity from capture, however, chiefly +to her appearance, as from her size and build she generally passed +unsuspected as an innocent fisherman. + +The storm increased in violence, and the little lugger, although a +good sea-boat, had difficulty in making her way almost in the teeth of +the gale. She was bound, Harry gained from a word or two dropped by +the captain, for the mouth of the Loire, off which she was to be met +by the _Chasse Maree_. Long before morning the coast of England was +out of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel bravely +holding her way in the sou'westerly gale. + +"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman asked the smuggler. + +"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the wind holds as at +present. Two o'clock in the morning is the time named, and if your +people are as punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will be +gained. There's one thing--in such a gale as is blowing to-day none of +our cruisers who may be off the coast are likely to trouble themselves +about a boat like ours. They may wonder what we are doing at sea, but +are scarcely likely to chase us." + +Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels were seen in the +distance, which Harry knew, by the cut of their sails, to be English +cruisers. All were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas, and +Harry knew that any assistance from them was out of the question. +Towards evening the gale moderated, but the sea was still very high. +During the day Harry had turned over in his mind every possible plan +by which he might destroy the tin case which contained, as he knew, +such important documents. From what he had gathered he learned that +the success of some great undertaking upon which the British fleet +were about to embark would be marred if these papers were to find +their way into the hands of the French authorities. His own life he +regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure that no sooner was +he fairly on board the French _Chasse Maree_ than he would, at the +orders of the French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life had +been so preserved, not from any feeling of mercy, but in order that +his death might be accomplished with less risk to those whose safety +demanded it. + +He was determined, if opportunity presented, to seize the little case +and to leap overboard with it. The French spy never for one moment put +it down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the top, and some +eight inches long by three inches wide, and the same deep. Sometimes +the Frenchman put it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but +even then he took the precaution always to keep his hand upon it. +During the day Harry was constantly employed in work on board the +lugger, hauling at ropes and acting as if he were one of the regular +crew. He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond a curse now +and then not a word had been addressed to him by any on board. The +night came on; the wind was still going down, but the sea was very +heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the stars could be seen +shining brightly, and once or twice the moon broke through and spread +a light over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler became +anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead. + +"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the Frenchman, "and we are +nearly off the mouth of the river. When the moon shone out just now I +thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and I believe to +windward an English cruiser is lying. However, I will get ready the +lanterns." + +The next time the moon came out a vessel was clearly seen. The +smuggler raised the lantern above the bulwarks, held it there for half +a minute, and then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A moment +later a similar signal was made on the bows of the vessel. + +"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly, "and the five hundred +pounds is as good as in my pocket!" + +As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward. + +"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser has caught sight of +the Frenchman. However, we shall be on board in plenty of time, and +whether she gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me. I shall +have done my part of the work, and you, mounseer, will give me the +order for payment on London." + +"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said; "you've done your work +well. Here's the order." + +By this time the French craft was within a distance of a quarter of a +mile, running down at a great pace under her reefed sails. + +"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the smuggler said, "for the +sea is running tremendously. They will have to throw a rope, and you +will have to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose your +dispatch-box is water-tight?" + +"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked. + +"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler said, "and you can haul +him on board too. It won't make much matter whether I slip the noose +round his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest plan perhaps, +for then, if he happens not to be alive when you pull him out, it +would be an accident; and even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't +swear that it was purposely done." + +Harry was standing near, and heard the words. He was close to the helm +at the time, and watched with intense anxiety as the _Chasse Maree_ +ran rapidly down to them. It was clear that what had to be done must +be done quickly, for another flash came up from the cruiser; and +although in the din of the wind and the toss of the waves it could not +be seen where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash showed +that she had come up since the last shot was discharged. The _Chasse +Maree_ ran down, and as she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks +and shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady, and as I run +past I will throw a rope." + +"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are two to come on board." + +The course taken by the _Chasse Maree_ would bring her along at a +distance of some ten yards from the side of the lugger. At the moment +a squall came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards the +approaching craft. When she was just upon them Harry saw that his one +chance of escape had come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at +the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard. The lugger paid +off instantly. Black Jack, with an oath, turned round and sprang at +Harry. The lad leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the +Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him, and snatching the +tin box from his hand leaped overboard. + +Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it had been sufficient. +The vessel had paid off from the wind, and before the helmsman could +regain his feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay across +the course of the _Chasse Maree_; and in another moment the French +craft plunged down upon her, and with a crash the _Lucy_ sank under +her bows, and went down with all on board. + +As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a shout of dismay from those +on board the _Lucy_. When he came up a minute later he saw the _Chasse +Maree_ plowing her way from him, but no sign of the _Lucy_ was to be +seen. Harry was a good swimmer, and fortunately the dispatch-box which +he grasped was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket he felt +that it kept his head easily above the water. He swam as well as he +could away from the spot where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew +that if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being run down and +should see him, his death was certain--not indeed that his chances +were in any case good, but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he +clung to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as +possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he must have speedily +succumbed, for in so heavy a sea it was difficult in the extreme to +swim. However, after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and +suffered himself quietly to drift. + +Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense delight, morning +began to break. He saw on his right the low shores of the French +coast, and looking round beheld seaward the British cruiser which had +fired at the _Chasse Maree_. She was running quietly along the coast, +and was evidently on guard at the mouth of the river. The sea had now +gone down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost cloudless sky. + +Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at once swam towards her. +She was farther out by a mile than the spot where he was swimming, and +was some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but slowly, and he +hoped that by the time she came along he would be able to get within +a distance whence he might be seen. His fear was that she might run +back before she reached the spot where she would be nearer to him. + +With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping his eye fixed +steadily on the ship. Still she came onward, and was within half a +mile when she was abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he +could from the water, he shouted at the top of his voice. Again and +again he splashed with his hands to make as much spray and commotion +as possible in order to attract attention. His heart almost stood +still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a moment later he +saw the vessel come round into the wind, and lay there with her sails +back. Then a boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was hauled +in, his senses almost leaving him now that the time for exertion had +passed. It was not until he had been lifted onto the deck of the +_Viper_, and brandy had been poured down his throat, that he was able +to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently recovered he was sent for to +the captain's cabin. + +"And who are you, boy, and whence do you come?" the captain asked. "Do +you belong to the _Chasse Maree_, which we chased in the night?" + +The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry had fallen overboard +from that craft. + +"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped from a lugger which was +run down by the French craft just as you were firing at her." + +"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my eyes had not been wrong. +I was sure that I saw a small fishing-boat close to the _Chasse +Maree_. We lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon, and +thought we must have been mistaken. How came you there in an English +fishing-boat?" + +Harry modestly told the story, and produced the dispatch-box. + +"This is important news indeed," the officer said, "and your conduct +has been in every way most gallant. What is your name, lad?" + +"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice on board the Indiaman +_Dundas Castle_, and was to have sailed this week in the convoy for +the West Indies." + +"You will not be able to do that now," the captain said. "This is most +important. However, the steward will take charge of you, and I will +talk to you again presently." + +The steward was called, and was told to put Harry into a cot slung for +him, and to give him a bowl of warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad +was asleep. + +The _Viper_ shortly afterwards hauled her wind, and ran down to a +consort who was keeping watch with her over the mouth of the Loire. +The captain repaired on board the other ship, whose commander was his +senior officer, and a consultation was held between them, after which +the _Viper_ was again got under sail and shaped her course for +Portsmouth. + +The wind was fair, and the next morning the _Viper_ passed through +the Needles, and soon afterwards anchored at Spithead. Here a large +number of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and above two of the +largest floated the flags of admirals. The _Viper_ had made her signal +as she came in sight of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up +from the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain to come +on board immediately the anchor was dropped. The moment this was done +the captain's gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him the +captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and rowed for the admiral's +ship. Directing the lad to remain on deck, the captain at once entered +the admiral's cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's orderly +summoned Harry to enter. + +Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a breakfast party, for a +number of naval officers, including Admiral Nelson and most of the +captains of the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The admiral +turned to Harry. + +"So you are the lad who has brought this box of dispatches?" + +"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly. + +"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said. "It's a strange +one." + +Harry again repeated the account of his adventures from the time of +leaving his father's cottage. When he had done Admiral Nelson +exclaimed: + +"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted with more presence of +mind had you been a captain of the fleet. You showed great bravery +and did your duty nobly." + +"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said modestly, "for I knew +that they were going to kill me anyhow, so that it made no difference. +But I was determined, if possible, that the dispatches should be +destroyed." + +The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to hear his dicta even so +slightly questioned by a lad. + +"You are an apprentice in the merchant service, Captain Skinner tells +me," Sir Hyde Parker said, "and have been two years at sea." + +"Yes, sir," Harry said. + +"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one of his majesty's +vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?" + +Harry's eyes glistened at the question. + +"I should indeed, sir," he said. + +"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered. "Have any of you +gentlemen a vacancy in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him +ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship." + +"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of the captains said. +"Poor little De Lisle fell overboard the night before last as we came +round from Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and I'll +arrange for him to have his togs. I like his look, and I should be +glad to have him with me. I am sure he will be a credit to the +service." + +"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You are now, sir," he said, +turning to Harry again, "an officer in his majesty's service, and, as +Captain Ball remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service. A +lad who does his duty when death is staring him in the face, and +without a hope that the act of devotion will ever be known or +recognized, is sure to make a brave and worthy officer." + +Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece of paper, and said to +the admiral's servant, "Will you tell the midshipman of my gig to come +here?" + +A minute afterwards the midshipman entered. The captain gave him the +slip of paper and said, "Take this young gentleman on board the ship +with you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and with him give +this note. He will be your shipmate in future. See that he's made +comfortable." + +The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow him, gazing askance, +and with no slight astonishment in his face, at the appearance of his +new messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance with the +received ideas of that of a midshipman freshly joining a ship. His +clothes were all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his +trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves. Without a word the +midshipman took his place in the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to +sit beside him. + +"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly. + +"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said with a laugh. +"Before that from his majesty's ship _Viper_, and before that from the +sea." + +"You look like the sea," said the midshipman. "But what have you been +doing? Have you served before?" + +"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only just been appointed." + +The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's appearance to question him +further. He felt that there was some mystery in the affair, and that +it would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing upon which +Harry was placed. He had little doubt from the fact of his appointment +being made under such circumstances that there must be something at +once singular and noteworthy about it. + +Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at once led him up to the +first lieutenant, and presented the captain's note. The lieutenant +opened it and glanced at the contents. They were brief: + +"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman on board the _Caesar_, and +has been promoted by Sir Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most +gallant action, and one of the greatest importance. Make him at home +at once, and let him have poor De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about +it." + +The senior midshipman was at once sent for by Mr. Francis, and Harry +handed over to him. The first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the +contents of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to make him +as comfortable as possible. + +Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival was greeted with +a storm of questions, as his appearance on the quarter-deck had +naturally excited a great deal of observation. The midshipman who had +come with him could, of course, furnish no information, and beyond the +brief fact mentioned by the captain and repeated by the first +lieutenant, his new conductor could say no more. + +"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got into his new clothes +and looks presentable. He's in my charge, and I am to make him +comfortable. As he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde +himself you may be sure he has done something out of the way." + +In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full midshipman's dress, and +being a very good-looking and gentlemanly lad, his appearance +favorably impressed his new messmates, who had at first been disposed +to resent the intrusion among themselves of a youngster whose +appearance was at least the reverse of reputable. + +"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting will resolve itself +into a committee. Let everyone who can, sit down; and let those who +can't, stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now, prisoner at +the bar," he said, "what is your name?" + +"Harry Langley." + +"And how came you here?" + +"I was brought in the captain's gig." + +"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what brought you onto the +quarter-deck?" + +"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent a very important +dispatch falling into the hands of the French." + +"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and how was that? That is to +say," he said, "if there's no secret about it?" + +"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very simple;" and for the +second time that morning he told the story. + +When he had done there was a general exclamation of approval among +those present, and the midshipmen crowded round him, shaking his hand, +patting him on the back, and declaring that he was a trump. + +"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said, "and is received as a +worthy member of this noble body. Boy!" + +"Yes, sir." + +"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two bottles of rum for this +honorable mess to drink the health of a new comrade." + +Presently the boy returned. + +"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the rum?" + +There was a roar of laughter among the middies, for the master's mate, +who had acted as president, was notoriously in the purser's books to +the full amount of his credit. However, a midshipman, who happened +that morning to have received a remittance, undertook to stand the +liquor to the mess, and Harry's health was drunk with all honors. + +"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that the contents of the +dispatch were with reference to the point to which we are all bound. I +wonder where it can be?" + +Here an animated discussion arose as to the various points against +which the attack of the fleet, now rapidly assembling at Spithead, +might be directed. So far no whisper of its probable course had been +made public, and it was believed indeed that even the captains of the +fleet were ignorant of its object. + +Upon the following day Harry at once obtained leave to go on shore for +twenty-four hours. Immediately he reached the Head he chartered a +wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he heard a well-known +voice among a group of sailors standing near him. + +"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley said. "My boy left me +merely to go down to the village, and was to have returned the first +thing in the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he never came +back no more. What he did with himself, unless he sailed in a +smuggling lugger which put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make +out. The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly, and I +can see no reason why he should have gone otherwise. He didn't cross +the ferry, and I can't help suspecting there was some foul play. When +Black Jack returns I will have it out of him if I kill him for it. He +has a strong party there, and I want half a dozen good tight hands to +come with me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a couple of days, +and if we tackle him directly he lands we may find out something about +him. Who will go with me?" + +Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were willing to assist their +old mate, when suddenly Harry stepped in among them, saying, "There's +no occasion for that. I can tell them all about him." + +Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment, and stared +open-mouthed at Harry. + +"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it isn't Harry himself, and +in a midshipman's rig. What means this, my boy?" + +"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on board his majesty's ship +_Caesar_." + +Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with astonishment, and then +threw his tarpaulin high in the air with a shout of delight. It fell +into the water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no further +thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung it with enthusiastic +delight. + +"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To think of seeing you on the +quarter-deck, and that so soon!" + +It was some minutes before Harry could shake himself free from his +friends, all of whom were old chums of the boatswain, and had known +him in his childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him to a +quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment of the veteran, he +related to him the circumstances which had led to his elevation. The +old sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration, and it +was only the consideration that beyond doubt Black Jack and the +Frenchman had both perished in the _Lucy_ that restrained him from +instantly rushing off to take vengeance upon them. + +An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed to Hayling, where the +joy of Peter was rivaled by that of Harry's foster-mother. That +evening Peter went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the +seafaring population in honor of the event that the village was a +scene of rejoicing and festivity such as was unknown in its quiet +annals. + +The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and commenced his regular duties +as a midshipman on board. + +A week later the whole of the ships destined to take part in it had +arrived. The "Blue Peter" was hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun +firing from the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and the fleet +soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted of eighteen sail of the +line, with a number of frigates and gunboats. The expedition was +commanded by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson second in command. +Contrary to the general expedition they sailed eastward instead of +passing through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of England, +passed through the Straits of Dover and stood out into the North Sea. + +Harry had had an interview with his captain four days after he had +joined. The latter told him that the dispatch-box which he had taken +had been sent up to London, and that its contents proved to be of the +highest importance, and that the Lords of the Admiralty had themselves +written to the admiral expressing their extreme satisfaction at the +capture, saying that the whole of their plans would have been +disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of the enemy. They +were pleased to express their strong approval of the conduct of Harry +Langley, and gave their assurance that when the time came his claim +for promotion should not be ignored. + +"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure that when you have +passed your cadetship you will get your epaulette without loss of +time, and if you are steady and well conducted you may look out for a +brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter the navy under such +favorable conditions. I should advise you to study hard in order to +fit yourself for command when the time should come. From what you tell +me your education has not been neglected, and I have no doubt you know +as much as the majority of my midshipmen as to books. But books are +not all. An officer in his majesty's service should be a gentleman. +That you are that in manner, I am happy to see. But it is desirable +also that an officer should be able in all society to hold his own in +point of general knowledge with other gentlemen. Midshipmen, as a +class, are too much given to shirking their studies, and to think that +if an officer can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required. +It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you will find that the +men who have most made their mark are all something more than rough +sailors. I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at all times +and hazards doing your duty. That is a lesson that you have clearly +already learned." + +As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose higher and higher as to +the object of the expedition. Some supposed that a dash was to be made +on Holland. Others conceived that the object of the expedition must be +one of the North German or Russian forts, and the latter were +confirmed in their ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found to +be entering the Sound. Instead of passing through, however, the fleet +anchored here, out of gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great +was the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the fleet when +it became known that an ultimatum had been sent on shore, and that the +Danes (who had been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon at +once to surrender their fleet to the English. + +Upon the face of facts known to the world at large, this was indeed a +most monstrous breach of justice and right. The Danes had taken no +part in the great struggle which had been going on, and their +sympathies were generally supposed to be with the English rather than +the French. Thus, for a fleet to appear before the capital of Denmark, +and to summon its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed +act of brute force. + +In fact, however, the English government had learned that negotiations +had been proceeding between the Danish government and the French; and +that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which the Danes should +join the French at a given moment, and the united fleets being +augmented by ships of other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon +England. Had this secret confederation not been interfered with, the +position of England would have been seriously threatened. The fleet +which the allies would have been able to put onto the scene would have +greatly exceeded that which England could have mustered to defend her +coast, and although peace nominally prevailed between England and +Denmark the English ministry considered itself justified--and +posterity has agreed in the verdict--in taking time by the forelock, +and striking a blow before their seeming ally had time to throw off +the mask and to join in the projected attack upon them. + +It was the news of this secret resolve on the part of the cabinet +that, having in some way been obtained by a heavy bribe from a +subordinate in the admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to +France in the _Lucy_, and had it reached its destination the Danes +would have been warned in time, and the enterprise undertaken by +Parker and Nelson would have been impossible, for the forts of +Copenhagen, aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too strong to have +been attacked had they been thoroughly prepared for the strife. As all +these matters were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was the +astonishment when the captains of the ships assembled in the admiral's +cabin, and each received orders as to the position which his vessel +was to take up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This being +settled, the captains returned to their respective ships. + +Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the Danes finally +refused compliance with the English demands the long-looked-for signal +was hoisted and the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine +sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve line-of-battle +ships and a number of frigates under Admiral Nelson, steered on +through the Sound, followed at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker +with the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound cannonaded +them, but their fire was very ineffectual, and the fleet without +replying steered on until they had attained the position intended for +them. The Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of thirteen +men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported by floating batteries +mounting seventy heavy guns, was moored in a line four miles long in +front of the town, and was further supported by the forts on shore. + +This great force was to be engaged by the squadron of Admiral Nelson +alone, as that of Sir Hyde Parker remained outside menacing the +formidable Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding their fire +to that of the fleet and other shore batteries upon Nelson's squadron. + +The _Caesar_, the leading ship of the fleet, had been directed to sail +right past the line of ships and to operate against a detached fort +standing on a spit of land on the right flank of the Danish position. +This fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of the Caesar in +weight, but the crew were in high spirits at the prospect of a fight, +little as they understood the cause for which they were engaged. +Stripping to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer at +his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen, being upon the +quarter-deck near the captain to carry orders from him as might be +required to different parts of the ship. As the _Caesar_ passed along +the line of ships to take up her position she was saluted by a storm +of fire from the Danish vessels, to which she made no reply. She +suffered, however, but little injury, although shot and shell whistled +between the masts and struck the water on all sides of her, several +striking the hull with a dull, crashing sound, while her sails were +pierced with holes. Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was +disgusted with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he +experienced. But there is nothing that tries the nerves more than +standing the fire of an enemy before it is time to set to work to +reply. As soon as orders were given for the _Caesar's_ fire to be +opened, directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the roar of +her cannon answered those of the fort, the feeling of uneasiness on +Harry's part disappeared, and was succeeded by that of the excitement +of battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole line the British +fleet was engaged, and the boom of the heavy guns of the ships, forts, +and batteries, and the rattle of musketry from the tops of the ships, +kept up a deep roar like that of incessant thunder. + +"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant reported to the +captain. "There are but two fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is +dropping so much that we have scarcely steerage-way, and the current +is sweeping us along fast." + +"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain said. + +He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was a slight shivering +sensation in the ship, and it was known by all on board that she was +aground, and that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were +kept at work the men were called off from those of the port side, +boats were lowered and hawsers were got out, and every effort was made +to tow the ship off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of the +storm of shot and shell which fell round them from the fort and the +nearest Danish ships. But the _Caesar_ was fast. Calling the men on +board again, the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft +and see what was going on in other parts of the line. He returned with +the news that four or five other ships were plainly aground, and that +things appeared to be going badly. In the meantime the _Caesar_ was +suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well directed, and the +gunners, working their pieces under comparative shelter, were able to +pour their fire steadily into the _Caesar_, while a floating battery +and two frigates also kept up an incessant fire. + +The number of killed and wounded was already large, but as only the +guns of the starboard side could be worked the fire was kept up with +unabated zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of the +fire. The parapet was in many places shot away and several of the guns +put out of action. But the _Caesar_ was clearly overmatched, and the +captain hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the ship was +aground and was altogether overmatched, and begging that another +vessel might be dispatched to his aid, if one could be spared, in +order to partially relieve her of the enemy's fire. + +"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to the flagship +instantly." + +Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot and shell which was +flying, striking up the water in all directions, he made his way to +the admirals ship, which was lying nearly a mile away. + +Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it through. + +"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a ship to spare. +Several are aground, and all hard pressed. He must do the best he can. +Ah! you are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin, are you +not?" + +"Yes, sir." + +The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and Harry prepared to leave. +Suddenly a thought struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he +asked the steward for a small tablecloth. + +"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed. + +"Never mind. Give it me at once." + +Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat. As they returned +towards the _Caesar_ they could see how hardly matters were going with +her. One of her masts was down. Her sides were battered and torn, and +several of her port-holes were knocked into one. Still her fire +continued unabated, but it was clear that she could not much longer +resist. + +"Do you think she must haul down her flag?" Harry said to the coxswain +of the boat. + +"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and iron can't stand such a +pounding as that much longer. Most captains would have hauled down the +flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand out much +longer. There won't be a man alive to fight her." + +"Will you do as I order?" Harry said. + +"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will do what you like;" +for the story of the conduct by which Harry had gained his +midshipman's promotion had been repeated through the ship, and the men +were all proud of the lad who had behaved so pluckily. + +"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it can't do harm. Where's +the boat-hook? Fasten this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort." + +The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise, but did as Harry told +him, and with the white flag flying the boat pulled straight towards +the fort. As he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had +been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the duel between the +battery and the _Caesar_ continued with unabated vigor. Harry steered +direct to the steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of the +fort, where, on saying that he brought a message from the captain, he +was at once conducted to the commandant. + +"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain to beg of you to +surrender at once. Your guns have been nobly fought, but two more +ships are coming down to engage with you, and the captain would fain +save further effusion of life. You have done all that brave men could +do, but the fight everywhere goes against you, and further resistance +is vain. In a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your +guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain therefore begs you +to spare the brave men under your orders from further sacrifice." + +Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which was fortunately at the +moment backed up by two ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken +no part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor, after a +hasty consultation with his officers, resolved to surrender, and two +minutes afterwards the Danish flag was hauled down in the fort and the +white flag run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to return +with Harry to the ship to notify the captain of the surrender of the +fort. + +The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the course of his boat +suddenly altered, a white flag hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct +to the fort, had been extreme, and he could only suppose that Harry +had received some orders direct from the admiral and that a general +cessation of hostilities was ordered. His surprise became astonishment +when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white flag hoisted in +its place; and a shout of relief and exultation echoed from stem to +stern of the _Caesar_, for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless +and that in a few minutes the _Caesar_ must strike her flag. All sorts +of conjectures were rife as to the sudden and unexpected surrender of +the fort, and expectation was at its highest when the gig was seen +rowing out again with a Danish officer by the side of the midshipman. + +On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the ladder with the Danish +officer, and advancing to Captain Ball said: + +"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the summons which I took +to the commander of the fort in your name, come off to surrender." + +The Danish officer advanced and handed his sword to the captain, +saying: + +"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender." + +The captain handed him back his sword, and ordering Harry to follow +him at once entered his cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the +latter informed him what he had done, with many apologies for having +taken the matter into his own hands. + +"I saw," he said, "that the _Caesar_ was being knocked to pieces, and +the coxswain told me that it was impossible she could much longer +resist. I therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling upon +the governor to surrender, and that it was possible that I might +succeed, as you see that I have." + +"You certainly have saved the _Caesar_," Captain Ball said warmly, "and +we are all indeed indebted to you. It was a piece of astounding +impudence indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with which his +captain had not charged him; but success in the present case a +thousand times condones the offense. You have indeed done well, young +sir, and I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you. I will +report the matter to the admiral." + +A hundred men speedily took their places in the boats. Lieutenant +Francis was sent ashore to take possession, and a few minutes later +the British flag was flying upon the fort. + +Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball at once took his place +in his gig and rowed to the flagship. The battle was still raging, and +to the practiced eye there was no doubt that the English fleet was +suffering very severely. Captain Ball mounted the quarter-deck, and +saluting the admiral reported that the fort with which he was engaged +had struck, but that the _Caesar_ being aground was unable to render +any assistance to the general attack. + +"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral Nelson said, "but I +congratulate you on having caused the fort to haul down its colors. +Several of the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot take +possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came off from shore, and their +fire has reopened. Our position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker +has signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no attention. I +fear that we shall have to haul off and leave some four or five ships +to the enemy." + +"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who made the fort haul +down its flag, but this midshipman of mine." + +"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who, at Captain Ball's +order, had left the boat and was standing a short distance off. "How +on earth did he do that?" + +"When you told him, sir, that you could give us no aid he took upon +himself, instead of returning to the ship, to row straight to the +fort with one of your tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and +summoned the commander in my name to surrender at once so as to save +all further effusion of life, seeing that more ships were bearing down +and that he had done all that a brave man could, and should now think +of the lives of his troops." + +"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed. "Midshipmen were +impudent enough in my days, but this boy beats everything. However, +his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I will adopt it +myself. A man should never be above learning, and we are in such a +sore strait that one catches at a straw." + +So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain, entered his cabin, +and at once indited a letter to the King of Denmark begging him to +surrender in order to save the blood of his subjects, expressing +admiration at the way in which they had fought, and saying that they +had done all that was possible to save honor, and might now surrender +with a full consciousness of having done their duty. This missive was +at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral awaited with anxiety its +result. + +A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with unabated fury. + +"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed, "there's the white +flag!" and a tremendous cheer broke along the whole of the British +ships as the flag of truce waved over the principal fort of +Copenhagen. Instantly the fire on both sides ceased. Boats passed +between the shore and the flagship with the proposals for surrender +and conditions. Nelson insisted that the Danish fleet should be +surrendered, in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king +that he had it in his power completely to destroy the town, and had +only so far desisted from motives of humanity. At length, to the +intense relief of the admiral and his principal officers, who knew how +sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors, the +negotiations were completed, and the victory of Copenhagen won. + +"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked. + +"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the quarter-deck. One of the +last shots fired from the Danish fleet had struck him above the knee, +carrying away his leg. He had at once been carried down to the +cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of the flagship. In the +excitement of an action men take but little heed of what is happening +around them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed by his +captain. Now, however, that the battle was over, Captain Ball looked +round for his midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing what +had happened. He hurried below to the wounded boy, whose leg had +already been amputated, above the point at which the ball had severed +it, by the surgeon. + +"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he said, "and Copenhagen +has been captured, and to you more than to anyone is this great +victory due. I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been shot." + +Harry smiled faintly. + +"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the navy has not been a +long one. It is but a fortnight since I got my commission, and now I +am leaving it altogether." + +"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said cheerfully, "but not +leaving life, I hope. I trust there's a long one before you; but +Admiral Nelson will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career +of a young officer, who promised to rise to the highest honors of his +profession and be a credit and glory to his country, has been cut +short." + +A short time later the admiral himself came down and shook hands with +the boy, and thanked him for his services, and cheered him up by +telling him that he would take care that his presence of mind and +courage should be known. + +For some days Harry lay between life and death, but by the time that +the ship sailed into Portsmouth harbor the doctors had considerable +hope that he would pull round. He was carried at once to the Naval +Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley was by his bedside. His +captain frequently came to see him, and upon one occasion came while +his foster-father was sitting by his bedside. + +"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told me that you had served +his majesty; but I didn't recognize the name as that of my old +boatswain on board the _Cleopatra_." + +"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but I wish it had been on +any other occasion. However, I think that the lad will not slip his +wind this time; but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at +an end." + +"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said; "but there are +many men who may live to a good age and will have done less for their +country than this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he +prevented the dispatch, which would have warned the enemy of what was +coming, from reaching them; and, in the second place, his sharpness +and readiness saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet, and +converted what threatened to be a defeat into a victory. You must be +proud of your son, old salt." + +"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my son?" the boatswain +said. + +"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised; "on the contrary, he +spoke of you as his father." + +In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances of the finding +of Harry when a baby. Captain Ball was silent for a while, and then +said, "Do you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by the +resemblance of that lad to an old friend and school-fellow of mine, a +Mr. Harper? They are as like as two peas--that is, he is exactly what +my friend was at his age. My friend never was married; but I remember +hearing a good many years ago--I should say some fifteen years ago, +which would be about in accordance with this lad's age--that he had +lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed to have +foundered, and was never heard of again. She was the wife of the +captain, and was taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may be +a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong that it would be +worth while making some inquiries. Have you anything by which the +child can be identified?" + +"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship for the most +part, and a locket. I will bring them over to your honor to-morrow if +you will let me." + +"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to London to-morrow, and +shall see my friend. Don't speak to the boy about it, for it's a +thousand to one against its being more than a coincidence. Still I +hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so." + +The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach to London, and the +following day called upon his friend, who was a rich retired +East-Indian director. He told the story as Peter had told it to him. + +"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously, although the ship was +lost in the West Indies, it's likely enough that the ornaments of my +poor sister would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of often +sending her home things from Calcutta." + +"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and produced the little +packet which Peter had given him. + +The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and then, taking the +locket, pressed the spring. He gave a cry as he saw the portrait +within it, and exclaimed, "Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as +she was when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery! Where is +the lad of whom you have been speaking? for surely he is my nephew, +the son of my sister Mary and Jack Peters." + +Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings from the time he +had known him, and the old gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of +bravery. The very next day he went down to Portsmouth with Captain +Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment, found himself claimed as nephew +by the friend of his captain. + +When Harry was well enough to be moved he went up to London with his +uncle, and a fortnight later received an official letter directing him +to attend at the Board of Admiralty. + +Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded thither in his uncle's +carriage, and walked with crutches--for his wound was not as yet +sufficiently healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg--to the +board-room. Here were assembled the first lord and his colleagues. +Admiral Nelson was also present, and at once greeted him kindly. + +A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then addressed him. "Mr. +Peters, Admiral Nelson has brought to our notice the clever stratagem +by which, on your own initiation and without instruction, you obtained +the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved the _Caesar_ at a time when +she was aground and altogether overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also +been good enough to say that it was the success which attended your +action which suggested to him the course that he took which brought +the battle to a happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that the +victory which has been won is in no small degree due to you. Moreover, +we are mindful that it was your bravery and quickness which prevented +the news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching the +Continent, in which case the attack could not have been carried out. +Under such extraordinary and exceptional circumstances we feel that an +extraordinary and exceptional acknowledgment is due to you. We all +feel very deep regret that the loss of your leg will render you unfit +for active service at sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of +so meritorious and most promising a young officer. We are about, +therefore, to take a course altogether without precedent. You will be +continued on the full-pay list all your life, you will at once be +promoted to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to that of +commander, and again in another three years to the rank of post +captain. The board are glad to hear from Captain Ball that you are in +good hands, and wish you every good fortune in life." + +Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he could only stammer a word +or two of thanks, and the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral +Nelson having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken back to the +carriage, still in a state of bewilderment at the honor which had been +bestowed upon him. + +There is little more to tell. Having no other relations his uncle +adopted him as his heir, and the only further connection that Harry +had with the sea was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the +fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of an English port. +Later on he sat in Parliament, married, and to the end of his life +declared that, after all, the luckiest point in his career was the +cutting off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries, +for that, had this not happened, he should never have known who he +was, would never have met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would +have passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley, when not +at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in a snug cottage at Southsea, +and had never reason to the end of his life to regret the time when he +sighted the floating box from the tops of the _Alert_. + + + + +SURLY JOE. + + +"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir? No, as you say, I hope I +don't deserve the title now; but I did once, and a name like that +sticks to a man for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at +present, and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it." + +The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty years old, broad and +weather-beaten; he had but one arm. I had been spending a month's +well-earned holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the most of +it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my first arrival I had gone out +with the one-armed boatman, and as he was a cheery companion, and his +boat, the _Grateful Mary_, was the best and fastest on the strand, I +had stuck to him throughout. The boatmen at our watering-places soon +learn when a visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to +importune him with offers of a sail; consequently it became an +understood thing after a day or two that I was private property, and +as soon as I was seen making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which +is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough, a shout would at +once be raised for Surly Joe. The name seemed a singularly +inappropriate one; but it was not until the very day before I was +returning to town that I made any remark on the subject. By this time +we had become great allies; for what with a bathe in the morning +early, a sail before lunch, and a fishing expedition afterwards, I had +almost lived on board the _Grateful Mary_. The day had been too clear +and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted boy who assisted +Joe had grown tired of watching us catch nothing, and had fallen +asleep in the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose and +fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative of sleep that I +had nodded once or twice as I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then +the happy idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered why my +companion was called by a nickname which seemed so singularly +inappropriate. Joe's offer to tell me how he obtained it woke me at +once. I refilled my pipe,--an invariable custom, I observe, with +smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a story,--passed my +pouch to Joe, who followed my example; and when we had "lighted up" +Joe began: + +"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a strong, active chap +then--not that I aint strong now, for I can shove a boat over the +sandbar with any man on the shore--but I aint as active as I were. I +warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms like other men. My +nickname then was Curly; 'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight +on my head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned my own boat, +and the boys that worked with me warn't strangers, like Dick there, +but they were my own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the two +boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and as good-plucked uns +as any on the shore. I had lost their mother ten years, maybe, before +that, and I never thought of giving them another. One of 'em was about +twelve, just the size of Dick there; the other was a year older. Full +of tricks and mischief they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle +the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one thing they couldn't +do, sir--they couldn't swim. I used to tell 'em they ought to learn; +but there, you see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and +boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on 'em can swim. Rum, +aint it, sir? All their lives in the water or on the water, seeing all +these visitors as comes here either swimming or learning to swim, and +yet they won't try. They talks about instinks; I don't believe in +instinks, else everybody who's got to pass his life on the water would +learn to swim, instead of being just the boys as never does learn. +That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman and his wife +and darter used to use my boat regular; morning and afternoon they'd +go out for a sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put +out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared so much for it; +but they was just wrapped up in the girl, who was a pale, quiet sort +o' girl, who had come down to the sea for her health. She was +wonderful fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she warn't +like the same creature after she had been here two months. + +"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls from the east, but +not too rough to go out: they was to go out at four o'clock, and they +came down punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets down: + +"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a friend is coming down +by the five-o'clock train, and we must be at the station to meet her, +she being an invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so will +trust her with you.' + +"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring her back safe,' the +mother says, half laughing like; but I could see she were a little +anxious about lettin' her go alone, which had never happened before. + +"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may take your oath I'll +bring her back if I comes back myself.' + +"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on the plank; 'don't you +fidget: you know you can trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six +to dinner.' + +"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible like, and +although I'd told the boys before that one reef would be enough, I +made 'em put in another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't many +boats out, for there was more sea on than most visitors care to face; +but once fairly outside we went along through it splendid. When we got +within a mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or go on for a +bit farther. + +"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't we, Joe?' + +"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight on the shore.' + +"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she says, looking at her watch; +'I'd rather go a bit farther.' + +"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The wind was freshening, +and the gusts coming down strong; it was backing round rather to the +north too, and the sea was getting up. + +"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into Filey,' I says; 'and you +could go across by the coach.' + +"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?' + +"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall get a ducking before we +get back; there's rain in that squall to windward.' + +"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the coach won't get in +till half-past seven, and mamma would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd +so much rather go on!' + +"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and in another few +minutes the squall was down upon us. The rain came against us as if it +wanted to knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled again. A +sharper squall I don't know as ever I was put in. It was so black you +couldn't have seen two boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put +the helm up; but something went wrong, and--I don't know rightly how +it was, sir. I've thought it over hundreds and hundreds of times, and +I can't reason it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of +that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must somehow ha' lost my +head--I don't know, I can't account for it; but there it was, and in +less time than it takes me to tell you we were all in the water. +Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough now. I threw one arm +round the gal, as I felt her going, and with the other I caught hold +of the side of the boat. We was under water for a moment, and then I +made shift to get hold of the rudder as she floated bottom upwards. +The boys had stuck to her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel; +for you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing nigh a foot of +water there more than they does astern. However, after a bit, they +managed to get down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel about +halfway along. They couldn't come no nigher, because, as you know, the +keel of them boats only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I +shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have seen us from the +cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here for us in no time.' + +"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my heart that a lugger, to +get out with that wind on, would have to run right into t'other side +o' the bay before she could get room enough to weather the brig. The +girl hadn't spoken a word since the squall struck us, except that she +gave a little short cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she +got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as well as she could +with my help. The squall did not last five minutes; and when it +cleared off I could look round and judge of our chances. They weren't +good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and another on the +brig, who were making their way out as far as they could on the brig, +for it were about half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we went +into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over the brig, and there +was a man galloping on horseback along the sands to'rds Filey as hard +as he could go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the brig, and +I saw that we should drift down on it before a boat could beat out of +the bay and get round to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always +does break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and the spray +was flying up fifty feet in places where the waves hit the face of the +rock. There aint a worse place on all the coast than this, running as +it do nigh a mile out from the head, and bare at low water. The waves +broke over the boat heavy, and I had as much as I could do to hold on +by one hand to the rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with +every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't hold on if they +couldn't get onto the bottom of the boat; so I shouted to 'em to try +to climb up. But they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over +and over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm water; but with +the boat rolling and such waves going over her, and knocking them back +again when they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd ha' +been free I could have got 'em up by working round to the side +opposite 'em, and given them a hand to haul them up; but as it was, +with only one hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I +was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face round to me, and +spoke for the first time. + +"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your boys.' + +"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till we're both +drowned together.' + +"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe me, I was +actually beginning to hate that gal. There was my own two boys +a-struggling for their lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em, +because I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She saw it in my +face, for she gave a sort of little cry, and said: + +"'Oh, do--do let me go!' + +"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the harder. Presently +Bill--he was my youngest boy--sang out: + +"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand to get up? I can't +hold on much longer.' + +"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my promise to take this +young woman back, and I must keep my word. Her life's more precious to +her father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to be saved.' + +"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust, and I knew it was +when I said it, but I couldn't help it. I felt as if I had a devil in +me. I was just mad with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word +seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it was frozen. For a +moment she didn't move, and then, all of a sudden like, she gave a +twist out of my arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her, and +just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up again. She never moved +after that, but just lay quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head +was back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only by the tears +that run down sometimes through her eyelids, and by a little sob in +her breast, that I knew that she was sensible. + +"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God bless you!' and then he +let go his hold and went down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though +it seemed a week to me, Jack did the same. + +"There we was--the girl and I--alone. + +"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was mad then. I felt +somehow as that the gal had drowned my two boys; and the devil kept +whispering to me to beat her white face in, and then to go with her to +the bottom. I should ha' done it too, but my promise kept me back. I +had sworn she should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to me +that included the promise that I would do my best for us both to get +there. I was getting weak now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and +my thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if they could +hear me. Once or twice my hold had slipped, and I had hard work enough +to get hold again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't last +much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had told the boys I would +be with 'em in a minute or two, when a sound of shouting quite close +roused me up sudden. + +"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig. Some men had climbed +along, taking hold hand-in-hand when they passed across places where +the sea was already breaking over, and bringing with them the rope +which, as I afterwards heard, the man on horseback had brought back +from Filey. It was a brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was +rising fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could hear them they +shouted that they would throw me the rope, and that I must leave go of +the boat, which would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she had +struck the rocks with us. Where they were standing the rock was full +six feet above the sea; but a little farther it shelved down, and each +wave ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me could I swim; +and when I shook my head, for I was too far gone to speak now, one of +'em jumped in with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the two of +us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was time, for we weren't +much above a boat's length from the brig. Three of the chaps as had +the rope run down to the low part of the rock and pulled together, +while another two kept hold of the end of the rope and kept on the +rock, so as to prevent us all being washed across the brig together. I +don't remember much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at +once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of the rope, and +then, just as the water seemed choking me, a great smash, and I +remember nothing else. When I came to my right senses again I was in a +bed at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and my right arm, +which had been round the girl, was just splintered. They took it off +that night. The first thing as they told me when I came round was that +the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was glad or sorry to hear it. +I was glad, because I had kept my promise and brought her back alive. +I was sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should she have been +saved when my two boys was drowned? She was well-plucked, was that +gal, for she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment she had +got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike she wanted to get dry +clothes and to go straight on to Scarborough in a carriage. However, +the doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little letter saying +as she was all right; and a man galloped off with it on horseback, and +got there just as they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to +Filey to ask if there was any news there about the boat. They came +over and slept there, and she went back with them next day. I heard +all this afterwards, for I was off my head, what with the blow I had +got and one thing and another, before I had been there an hour. And I +raved and cussed at the girl, they tell me, so that they wouldn't let +her father in to see me. + +"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself, to find my arm gone, +and then I was another month before I was out of bed. They came over +to Filey when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the best doctor +over from Scarborough to see me, and paid everything for me till I was +well, but I wouldn't see them when they came. I was quite as bitter +against her as I had been when I was in the sea drowning; and I was so +fierce when they talked of coming in that the doctor told them it +would make me bad again if they came. So they went up to London, and +when I could get about they sent me a letter, the gal herself and her +father and mother, thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I +just tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a lawyer of the +town here came to me and said he'd 'struction to buy me a new boat, +and to buy a 'nuity for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my +boys back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money; and as +to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her and sink her if she came. A year +after that lawyer came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions; +and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was man enough still to +knock his head off his shoulders, and that I'd do it if he came to me +with his 'structions or anything else. + +"By this time I'd settled down to work on the shore, and had got the +name of Surly Joe. Rightly enough, too. I had one of them planks with +wheels that people use to get in and out of the boats; and as the +boatmen on the shore was all good to me, being sorry for my loss, and +so telling my story to people as went out with them, I got enough to +live on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable about me. I +wouldn't speak a word, good or bad, to a soul for days together, +unless it was to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I hated +everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was always cussing the rocks that +didn't kill me, and wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this +work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never cared for drink; but +sometimes I'd find my thoughts too hard for me, and I'd go and drink +glass after glass till I tumbled under the table. + +"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and made offers to me to +take a share in their boats, or to make one in a fishing voyage; but I +would not hear them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and left +me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a surlier, +wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all England, than I was. Well, +sir, one day--it was just at the beginning of the season, but was too +rough a day for sailing--I was a-sitting down on the steps of a +machine doing nothing, just wondering and wondering why things was as +they was, when two little gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the +other a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum away from the +side of a lady and gentleman. I never did notice nothing that didn't +just concern me; but I did see that they had a nurse not far off. The +biggest girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked up into +my face, and held out a broken wooden spade and a bit of string, and +says she, 'Sailor-man, please mend our spade.' I was struck all of a +heap like; for though I had been mighty fond of little children in the +old days, and was still always careful of lifting them into boats, my +name and my black looks had been enough, and none of them had spoken +to me for years. I felt quite strange like when that child spoke out +to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson Crusoe, he as was wrecked +on the island, felt when he saw the mark of a foot. + +"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it back, and says, +gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but one hand? Go to your nurse.' + +"I expected to see her run right off; but she didn't, but stood as +quiet as may be, with her eyes looking up into my face. + +"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when Nina digs. Nina will hold +spade together, sailor-man tie it up strong.' + +"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver, and it was plain +she had been crying just before; so I put my hand into my pocket and +brings out a bit of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was +of no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as I hardly +knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll tie it.' + +"So she held the broken pieces together, and I ties 'em up with the +aid of my hand and my teeth, and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it. +I did it sitting on the bottom step, with a child standing on each +side watching me. When I had done it the eldest took it, and felt it. + +"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you. Annie, say thank +you.' + +"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on my arm as a good-by, +the little ones trotted away to a nurse sitting some little distance +off. + +"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's talk to +a child; but it warn't a little thing to me. It seemed regularly to +upset me like; and I sat there thinking it over and wondering what was +come over me, till an hour afterwards they went past me with their +nurse; and the little things ran up to me and said, 'The spade's quite +good now--good-by, sailor-man!' and went on again. So I shook it off +and went to my work; for as the tide rose the wind dropped, and a few +boats went out; and thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and +surlier than ever. + +"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand painting a boat, when I saw +the two children coming along the sand again, and I wondered to +myself whether they would know me again, or think any more of me, and +though I wanted them to do so I turned my back to the way they was +coming, and went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful glad +when I heard their little feet come, pattering along the sand, and +they sang out: + +"'Good-morning, sailor-man!' + +"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't want no talk; and +I goes on with my work without turning round. + +"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me. + +"'Joe, there's a party coming down.' + +"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out yourself.' + +"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute or two, watching me at +work, and then the eldest says: + +"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never been inside a boat, and +we do want to so much.' + +"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making a fight with +myself against giving in. + +"Then the little one said: + +"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold round oor neck; then oo +stand up and we det in.' + +"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those soft little faces +against my cheeks as they got in fairly knocked me over, and it was +some time before I could see what I was doing. + +"Once in, they never stopped talking. They asked about everything, and +I had to answer them; and as I got accustomed to it the words came +freer, till I was talking away with them as if I had known 'em all my +life. Once I asked them didn't their papa and mamma ever take 'em out +for a sail, and they shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea, +and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she must have lost +someone dear to her by it. + +"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those children used to come +every day down to talk with me, and I got to look for it regular; and +if it was a wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put out by +it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in my pockets for them. +After a fortnight I took to carrying them across the wet sands and +putting them on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people to +the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their mother, and brought +back the message that she knew she could trust them with me. + +"All this time it never once struck me as strange that their nurse +should sit with a baby-brother of theirs at a distance, and let them +play with me by the hour together, without calling them away, for I +wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling stories to 'em +just as I'd do with children who came out sailing with me in the old +time, and in knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I couldn't +wonder at anything else. Natural like, I changed a good deal in other +respects, and I got to give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce +spoken with for years; and the moment the children turned down onto +the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of 'There's your little +ladies, Joe.' + +"I don't know why my mates should ha' been pleased to see me coming +round, for I had made myself onpleasant enough on the shore; but +they'd made 'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd cum +back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like, and would just say, +natural, 'Lend us a hand here, Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over +the bank, Joe,' and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was a +hard day for me when, after staying nigh two months, the little ladies +came to say good-by. It warn't as bad as might have been, though, for +they were going to stay with some friends near York, and were to come +back again in a fortnight before they went back to London. But they +kissed me, and cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I +was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they would be sure to +think of me, for they loved me very much. + +"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by my stage, Jim +Saunders--he'd been mate with me before I owned a boat of my own--says +out loud: + +"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've jammed my hand so as I +can't hoist a sail. Who'll come out and lend me a hand?' + +"Well, everyone says they were busy, and couldn't come; but I believe +now as the whole thing was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and +then Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him. + +"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old times; come along, old +chap.' + +"I was taken aback like, and could only say something about my stage; +but half a dozen chaps volunteers to look after my stage, and afore I +scarce knew what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and as the +party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every chap on the shore +runs in to help shove her off, and a score of hands was held out just +to give me a shake as we started. + +"I don't think I was much good on that vyage, for I went and sat up in +the bow, with my back to the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead. + +"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the ice I went regular +to the sea again, and handed my stage over to a poor fellow who had +lost his craft and a leg the winter before. + +"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two little figures upon the +sands, and it needed no word from anyone to tell me my little ladies +had come back. They jumped and clapped their hands when they saw me, +and would have run across the water to meet me hadn't I shouted to +them to wait just a minute till I should be with them. + +"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where have you been?' + +"'I've been out sailing, missy.' + +"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories? You told us you +should never go on sea any more.' + +"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I don't suppose I ever +should if I hadn't met you, though you won't understand that. However, +I've give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.' + +"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and mamma will be glad +too.' + +"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I asked. + +"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I know she will be glad +when I tells her.' + +"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk to them about their +mamma. Mamma very good, very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and +then they went on telling me about their home in London, and their +carriage and amusements. Presently they stopped, and I could see the +eldest wanted to say something particular, for she puckered up her +forehead as she always did when she was very serious; and then she +said, with her hands folded before her, almost as if she was saying a +lesson: + +"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two little girls and baby-brother, +and papa love her so much; but there's one thing keeps her from being +quite happy.' + +"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be happy with all these +things. What is it?' + +"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for her. If it hadn't been +for him Nina and sissy and little baby-brother could never have been +born, and papa would never have had dear mamma to love; but it cost +the man who did it a great deal--all he cared for; and now he won't +let mamma and papa and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma +unhappy when she thinks of it.' + +"Here she had evidently finished what she had heard her mamma say, for +her forehead got smooth again, and she began to fill my pockets with +sand. + +"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I says. 'It don't stand +to reason nohow. You can't have understood what mamma said.' + +"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of time,' Nina said. 'Nina +quite sure she said right.' + +"We didn't say no more about it then, though after the children had +gone I wondered to myself how a chap could go on so foolish as that. +Well, sir, three days after come round from Whitby this very boat, the +_Grateful Mary_. She was sent care of Joe Denton; and as that was me, +I had her hauled up on the beach till I should hear whose she was. +Several visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous like, +that they should like to have a boat of their own, and I supposed they +had bought her at Whitby and sent her down, though why they should +have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see. + +"Two days afterwards them children come down, and says: + +"'We want you to go through the town to the other cliff with us, Joe.' + +"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you here, missies; but I +shouldn't be a credit to you in the town, and your pa wouldn't be +best pleased if he was to see you walking about in the streets with a +boatman.' + +"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.' + +"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to their nurse, who +come back with them and says: + +"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler glad if you would go +with the young ladies.' + +"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object, and they wishes +it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You wait here a quarter of an hour, +while I goes and cleans myself, and I'll go with you.' + +"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand, and the oldest holds by +my jacket, and we goes up into High Street, and across to the other +cliff. We goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage looking +over the sea. There was a garden in front, new planted with flowers. + +"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I, when they turned in. + +"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned the handle. + +"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me into a parlor, where a +lady and gentleman was sitting. + +"The gentleman got up. + +"'My little girls have spoken so much to me about you, Joe, that I +feel that we know each other already.' + +"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I. + +"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great deal as to these +little girls?' + +"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the little missies; +they have made a changed man of me, they have; you ask anyone on the +shore.' + +"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got round your heart, and +led you to your better self, I could never have done what I have done, +for you would have rendered it useless.' + +"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither head nor tail of +what he was saying, and, I dessay, looked as surprised as might be. +Then he takes a step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder, and +says he: + +"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little girls were?' + +"I looked first at the children, and then at him, and then at the +lady, who had a veil down, but was wiping her eyes underneath it. I +was downright flummuxed. + +"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on. 'Well, Joe, it is time +you should know now. I owe to you all that is dear to me in this +world, and our one unhappiness has been that you would not hear us, +that you had lost everything and would not let us do anything to +lighten your blow.' + +"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant, and began to think +that I was mad, or that he was. Then the lady stood up and threw back +her veil, and come up in front of me with the tears a-running down +her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down suddenly in a chair, +for, sure enough, it was that gal. Different to what I had seen her +last, healthy-looking and well--older, in course; a woman now, and the +mother of my little ladies. + +"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before her, pleading +like. + +"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children stand between us. I +know what you have suffered, and, in all my happiness, the thought of +your loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell you. I so +often thought of you--a broken, lonely man. I have talked to the +children of you till they loved the man that saved their mother's +life. I cannot give you what you have lost, Joe--no one can do that; +but you may make us happy in making you comfortable. At least, if you +cannot help hating me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh +with you.' + +"As she spoke the children were hanging on me; and when she stopped +the little one said: + +"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate mamma, and make her cry!' + +"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about it. You can imagine +how I quite broke down, like a great baby, and called myself every +kind of name, saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so now, +that I had been somehow mad from the moment the squall struck the +_Kate_ till the time I first met the little girls. + +"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that poor gal to her drowning +heart with my words, I could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At +last, when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and its +furniture and the _Grateful Mary_ was all for me; and we'd a great +fight over it, and I only gave in when at last she says that if I +didn't do as she wanted she'd never come down to Scarborough with the +little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come down regular +every year, and that the little girls should go out sailing with me +regular in the _Grateful Mary_. + +"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that, was there? So here I +am; and next week I expect Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's +a Parliament man, as she was engaged to be married to at the time of +the upset, and my little ladies, who is getting quite big girls too. +And if you hadn't been going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle +tower, and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes, sir, I see +what you are going to ask. I found it lonely there; and I found the +widow of a old mate of mine who seemed to think as how she could make +me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir--no words could say how +comfortable I am; and do you know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe +up there at this identical time, only he's a very little one, and has +got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about as little right as +has any chap in this mortial world to the name of Surly Joe." + + + + +A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM. + + +Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place. Capitalists and +speculative builders have somehow left it alone, and, except for its +great hotel, standing in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled, +there have been comparatively few additions to it in the last quarter +of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should make Falmouth my +headquarters: blow high, blow low, there are shelter and plenty of +sailing room, while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along +which to cruise--something very different from the flat shores from +Southampton to Brighton. It is some six years since that I was lying +in the harbor, having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes. +Upon the day after we had come in my friend went into Truro, and I +landed, strolled up, and sat down on a bench high on the seaward face +of the hill that shelters the inner harbor. + +An old coastguardsman came along. I offered him tobacco, and in five +minutes we were in full talk. + +"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out there?" + +"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet." + +"Do they do well generally?" + +"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's an uncertain fish the +pilchard, and it's a rough life is fishing on this coast. There aint a +good harbor not this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a +gale from the southeast it goes hard with them. With a southwester +they can run back here." + +"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?" + +"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy well-nigh fifty +year back, but I got a sickener of it, and tramped to Plymouth and +shipped in a frigate there, and served all my time in queen's ships." + +"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships of the life, or +from any particular circumstance?" + +"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty boats lost that night, +and scarce a hand was saved. I shouldn't have been saved myself if it +had not been for a dream of mother's." + +"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind telling me about it?" + +The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two; and then, after a +sharp puff at his pipe, he told me the following story, of which I +have but slightly altered the wording: + +I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of a village now, as it +was then. My father had been washed overboard and drowned two years +before. I was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's, and +four men and myself worked her in shares. I was twenty-one, or maybe +twenty-two, years old then. It was one day early in October. We had +had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd agreed to start at eight +o'clock in the morning. I was up at five, and went down to the boats +to see as everything was ready. When I got back mother had made +breakfast; and when we sat down I saw that the old woman had been +crying, and looked altogether queer like. + +"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip." + +"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother! Why? What's happened? Your +share and mine didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would be +a talk if I didn't go out in the _Jane_. Why, what is it?" + +"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how you was drowned." + +"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be drowned, mother." + +But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us Cornishmen goes a +good deal on dreams and tokens; and sure enough mother had dreamed +father was going to be drowned before he started on that last trip of +his. + +"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of you in bed, and a chap +was leaning over you cutting your throat." + +I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast after that; but in a +minute or two I plucks up and says: + +"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for if I be drowned no one has no +call to cut my throat." + +"I didn't see you downright drowned in my dream," she said. "You was +in the sea--a terribly rough sea--at night, and the waves were +breaking down on you." + +"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit. "It's a fine day, +and it's our boat. All the lads and girls in the village would laugh +at me if I stayed at home." + +"That's just what your father said; and he went to his death." + +And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron over her head and +began to cry again. I'd more than half a mind to give way; but you +know what young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of the place +would say about my being afraid to go was too much for me. + +At last, when mother saw I was bent on going, she got up and said: + +"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back, will you do something +else I ask you?" + +"I will, mother," said I--"anything but stay back." + +She went off without a word into her bedroom, and she came back with +something in her arms. + +"Look here, Will, I made this for your father, and he wouldn't have +it; now I ask you to take it, and put it on if a storm comes on. You +see, you can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no one will +be any the wiser." + +The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch spirit-bottles, sewn +between two pieces of canvas. It had got strings sewed on for tying +round the body, and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle each +side of the chest, it lay pretty flat. + +"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for hours. A gentleman who +was staying in the village before you was born was talking about +wrecks, and he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked, would +keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I made it; but no words could get +your father to try it, though he was willing enough to say that it +would probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you, Will?" + +I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there wasn't much chance +of a storm, and that if I put it under my coat and hid it away down in +the forecastle, no one would see it; and so to please her I said I'd +take it, and that if a bad storm came on I would slip it on. + +"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the bottles," mother +said. "It may be useful to you; who can say?" + +I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays, on board without +its being seen, and stowed it away in my locker. I felt glad now I'd +got it, for mother's dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way down +old Dick Tremaine said to me: + +"I don't like the look of the sky, lad." + +"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough." + +"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look of it. I think +we're going to have a bad blow." + +I told the others what he had said; but they didn't heed much. Two +boats had come in that morning with a fine catch, and after the bad +time we'd been having it would have taken a lot to keep them in after +that. + +We thought no more about it after we had once started. The wind was +light and puffy; but we had great luck, and were too busy to watch the +weather. What wind there was, was northerly; but towards sunset it +dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped we looked round at the sky. + +"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper, who was skipper, +said, "and I wish we had taken more heed to his words. That's about as +wild a sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing our boat." + +Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old enough to read the signs +of a storm--the heavy bank of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken +light, the horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken +irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them. Instinctively we +looked round towards the coast. It was fully fifteen miles away, and +we were to the east of it. The great change in the appearance of the +sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous to that time there +had been nothing which would have struck any but a man grown old upon +the coast like Dick Tremaine. + +"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail too; take in the +mizzen. Like enough it will come with a squall, and we'd best be as +snug as may be. What do you say? shall we throw over some of the +fish?" + +It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute the sky was +changing. The scud was flying thicker and faster overhead, and the +land was lost in a black cloud that seemed to touch the water. + +"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if we get rid of half +she'll be about in her best trim; and she's as good a sea-boat as +there is on the coast. Come, lads, don't look at it." + +It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five minutes half our +catch of the day was overboard. The _Jane_ was a half-decked boat, +yawl-rigged; she wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round +from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft. He had used her +for two years, and had got tired of the sport, and my father had +bought her of him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used about +here, but we all liked her, and swore by her. + +"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few minutes, I reckon," +Jabez said after a while. "Lower down her sails altogether; get her +head to it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you stand ready to +hoist the foresail a few feet; and, Will, you and John stand by the +hoists of the mainsail. We must show enough to keep her laying-to as +long as we can. You'd best get your coats out and put 'em on, and +batten down the hatch." + +I let the others go down first, and when they came up I went in, tied +the life-belt round me, and put on my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle +of hollands from my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch. + +"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said. + +I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for our future use, and took +hold of the throat halyard. + +"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared under the cloud +of mist and darkness ahead, and then with a roar it was upon us. + +I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years, and I never remember +in these latitudes such a squall as that. For a few minutes I could +scarcely see or breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the +wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder ten +yards off. At first I thought we were going down bodily. It was lucky +we had taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun round, +the force of the wind against the masts and rigging all but capsized +her. In five minutes the first burst was over, and we were running +before it under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no occasion +for us to stand by the halyards now, and we all gathered in the stern, +and crouched down in the well. Although the sun had only gone down +half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white foam round us +gave a sort of dim light that made the sky look all the blacker. The +sea got up in less time than it takes in telling, and we were soon +obliged to hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves from +coming in over the stern. For three hours we tore on before the gale, +and then it lulled almost as suddenly as it had come on. There had +scarcely been a word spoken between us during this time. I was half +asleep in spite of the showers of spray. Jim Hackers, who was always +smoking, puffed away steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the +others were quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on our feet. + +"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked. + +"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember such a gale as this +since I was a boy. Pass that bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be +busy again directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with the wet. +We shall have it round from the south in a few minutes." + +There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she rolled so I thought she +would have turned turtle. + +"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her head round." + +We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from behind struck us, +and in five minutes we were running back as fast as we had come. The +wind was at first south, but settled round to southeast. We got up a +little more sail now, and made a shift to keep her to the west, for +with this wind we should have been ashore long before morning if we +had run straight before it. The sea had been heavy--it was tremendous +now; and, light and seaworthy as the _Jane_ was, we had to keep baling +as the sea broke into her. Over and over again I thought that it was +all over with us as the great waves towered above our stern, but they +slipped under us as we went driving on at twelve or fourteen knots an +hour. I stood up by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought +of it. + +"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we must run, and by +midnight we shall be among the Scillys. Then it's a toss-up." + +Jabez's calculations could not have been far out, for it was just +midnight, as far as I could tell, when we saw a flash right ahead. + +"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said. "I wish I knew +which it was." + +He tried to bring her a little more up into the wind, but she nearly +lay over onto her beam-ends, and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw +one more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship was burning a +blue light. She was not a mile ahead now, and we could see she was a +large vessel. I had often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as +well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land. It was as Jabez +had said--a toss-up. If we just missed one of them we might manage to +bring up under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of them +the _Jane_ would break up like an egg-shell. + +We were rapidly running down upon the wreck when the glare of a fire +on shore shone up. It was a great blaze, and we could faintly see the +land and a white cottage some hundred yards from the shore. + +"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the end of the island; we +may miss it yet. Hoist the mainsail a bit." + +I leapt up with another to seize the halyards, when a great wave +struck us; she gave a roll, and the next moment I was in the water. + +After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I knew the shore was +but half a mile ahead, and that the wind would set me dead upon it. I +loosened my tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with +mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat, though I was half +drowned with the waves as they swept in from behind me. My mother's +dream cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem as I was +to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards. I drifted past the +wreck within a hundred yards or so. They were still burning blue +lights; but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw that in a +very few minutes she would go to pieces. Many times as the seas broke +over me I quite gave up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair +swimmer, and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on. + +I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that broke against the +rocks showed a certain death if I made for it, and I tried hard to +work to the left, where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me +that the fire was built close to the end of the island. As I came +close I found that this was so. I drifted past the point of land not +fifty feet off, where the waves were sending their spray a hundred +feet up; then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee of the +point. There was a little bay with a shelving shore, and here I made a +shift to land. Five minutes to rest, and then I made my way towards +the fire. There was no one there, and I went to the edge of the rocks. +Here four or five men with ropes were standing, trying to secure some +of the casks, chests, and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of +floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of a crash against +those rocks. The water was deep alongside, and the waves, as they +struck, flew up in spray, which made standing almost impossible. + +The men came round me when they saw me. There was no hearing one speak +in the noise of the storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the +point, and that if they came with their ropes to the point they might +get something as it floated past. They went off, and I sat down by the +fire, wrung my clothes as well as I could,--I thought nothing of the +wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,--took off +mother's belt, and found one of the bottles had broke as I got ashore; +but luckily it was the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out +of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt pretty right +again. I had good hopes the boat was all right, for she would get +round the point easy, and Jabez would bring her up under the lee of +the island. I thought I would go and see if I could help the others, +and perhaps save someone drifting from the wreck; but I did not think +there was very much chance, for she lay some little distance to the +right, and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the shore. + +Just as I was going to move I saw two of them coming back. They had a +body between them, and they put it down a little distance from the +fire. I was on the other side, and they had forgotten all about me. +They stooped over the figure, and I could not see what they were +doing. I got up and went over, and they gave a start when they saw me. +"Is he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled; and I could see +pretty well that if I had not been there it would have gone hard with +the chap. He was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around him +one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of rings on his fingers, +and he had a belt round his waist that looked pretty well stuffed out. +I put my hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and then I +poured a few drops of brandy which remained in my bottle down his +throat. + +While I was doing this the two men had talked to each other aside. +"He's alive, all right," says I. "That's a good job," one of 'em said; +but I knew he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage. +You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must be past two o'clock by +this time." + +They took the chap up, and carried him to the cottage, and put him on +a bed. He was moaning a little, and between us we undressed him and +got him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said. + +"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink of whisky?" + +I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off my wet clothes, I +got into the other bed, for there were two in the room. + +The men said they were going down again to see what they could get. +They left the whisky bottle on the table, and as soon as I was alone I +jumped out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth, so as to +give him as good a chance as I could; but I didn't much think he'd get +round, and then I got into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off, +when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up. Mother's dream came right +across me. I was out of bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There +was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it. Then I took my +clasp-knife out of my pocket and opened it. I gave the other chap a +shake, but there was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I +thought to myself they would never risk a fight when they saw me armed +and ready. But I soon found that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up +and dressed in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it was +fastened on the outside. I soon opened the window and got out, but +before I did that I rolled up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and +made a sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in bed was +lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure that he would not live +till morning. The candle was a fresh one when they had first lighted +it, and I left it burning. + +When I had got out I shut the window, and went away fifty yards or so, +where I could hear them come back. Presently I heard some footsteps +coming from the opposite direction. Then I heard a voice I knew say, +"There is the fire; we shall soon know whether the poor lad has got +ashore." + +"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and the other were going to +break into a shout of welcome, "hush! Some wreckers are coming up +directly to cut my throat and that of another chap in that cottage." + +In a word or two I told them all about it; and they agreed to wait +with me and see the end of it. Jabez had brought the _Jane_ up under +the lee of the island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had come +on shore in the cobble with the other to look for me, but with very +faint hopes of finding me. + +"You had best get hold of something to fight with, if you mean to take +these fellows, Jabez." + +"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another," Jabez said. + +Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour later we heard footsteps +coming up from the shore again. Two men passed us, went into the +cottage, and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the window, +where we could see in, and John Redpath stood at the door. He was to +open it and rush in when he heard us shout. We stood a little back, +but we could see well into the room. Presently we saw the door open +very quietly, little by little. A hand came through and moved the +chairs, and then it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One, a big +fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards the bed, where, as +it seemed, I was sleeping, with my head covered up by the clothes. The +other had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other bed. + +"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me. + +The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it down into the figure, +throwing his weight onto it at the same moment, while the smaller man +snatched the pillow from under the other's head and clapped it over +his face, and threw his weight on it. As they did so we pushed the +casement open and leapt in. I seized the smaller man, who was +suffocating the other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had +him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The big fellow had leapt +up. He gave a howl of rage as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay +with his knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump of rock, as +big as a baby's head, right into his stomach. It just tumbled him over +like a cannon-shot. John burst in through the door, and we had 'em +both tied tightly before five minutes was over. Then we lit a big fire +in the kitchen, and with warm clothes and some hot whisky and water +we got the foreign chap pretty well round. + +In the morning I went off and found a village on the other side of the +island. I woke them up and told my story, and, to do 'em justice, +though there were some who would have shielded the fellows we had +caught, the best part were on our side. Some of 'em told me there had +been suspicion upon these men, and that they bore a bad name. There +was no magistrate in the island, and no one objected when I said we +would take them across to Penzance and give them in charge there. + +So we did; and they were tried and got transportation for life for +attempting to murder the foreign chap, who, it turned out, was a +Brazilian Jew, with diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but +we would have none; but that's neither here nor there. + +So you see, master, mother's dream saved me from drowning and from +having my throat cut. I gave up fishing after that and went into the +queen's service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live with a sister +of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands have changed since those times, +and you'll meet as much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will +anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those days, and I had a +pretty close shave of it, hadn't I? + + + + +Boys' Own Library. + + + BOUND IN CLOTH. + + Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers. + + A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular + Authors. + + Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold. + + THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED. + + Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Horatio Alger, Jr.# + + Adventures of a Telegraph Boy. + Dean Dunham. + Erie Train Boy. + Five Hundred Dollar Check. + From Canal Boy to President. + From Farm Boy to Senator. + Mark Stanton. + Ned Newton. + New York Boy. + Tom Brace. + Tom Tracy. + Walter Griffith. + Young Acrobat. + +#C. B. Ashley.# + + Gilbert, the Trapper + +#Annie Ashmore.# + + Smuggler's Cave, The. + +#Capt. Ralph Bonehill.# + + Neka, the Boy Conjurer. + Tour of the Zero Club. + +#Walter F. Burns.# + + In the Sunk Lands. + +#Frank H. Converse.# + + Gold of Flat Top Mountain. + Happy-Go-Lucky Jack. + Heir to a Million. + In Search of an Unknown Race. + In Southern Seas. + Mystery of a Diamond. + That Treasure. + Voyage to the Gold Coast. + +#Harry Collingwood.# + + Pirate Island. + +#George H. Coomer.# + + Boys In the Forecastle. + Old Man of the Mountain. + +#William Dalton.# + + Tiger Prince. + War Tiger. + White Elephant. + +#Edward S. Ellis.# + + Arthur Helmuth. + Check Number 2134. + From Tent to White House. + Golden Rock. + Land of Mystery. + On the Trail of Geronimo. + Perils of the Jungle. + White Mustang. + +#George Manville Fenn.# + + Commodore Junk. + Dingo Boys. + Golden Magnet. + Grand Chaco. + Weathercock. + +#Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.# + + Bound for Annapolis. + Cliff, the Naval Cadet. + Cruise of the Training Ship. + From Port to Port. + Strange Cruise, A. + +#William Murray Graydon.# + + Butcher of Cawnpore, The. + Camp In the Snow, The. + Campaigning with Braddock. + Cryptogram, The. + From Lake to Wilderness. + In Barracks and Wigwam. + In Fort and Prison. + Jungles and Traitors. + Rajah's Fortress, The. + White King of Africa, The. + With Boer and Britisher. + +#Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.# + + Cadet's Honor, A. + Off for West Point. + On Guard. + West Point Treasure, A. + West Point Rivals, The. + +#Headon Hill.# + + Spectre Gold. + +#Henry Harrison Lewis.# + + Centerboard Jim. + Ensign Merrill. + King of the Island. + Midshipman Merrill. + Sword and Pen. + Valley of Mystery, The. + Yankee Boys In Japan. + +#Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.# + + Cadet Kit Carey. + Capt. Carey. + Kit Carey's Protege. + Lieut. Carey's Luck. + Out with Commodore Decatur. + Randy, the Pilot. + Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip. + Tom Truxton's School Days. + Treasure of the Golden Crater. + Won at West Point. + +#Victor St. Clair.# + + Cast Away in the Jungle. + Comrades Under Castro. + For Home and Honor. + From Switch to Lever. + Little Snap, the Postboy. + Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror. + Zip, the Acrobat. + +#Arthur M. Winfield.# + + Mark Dale's Stage Venture. + Young Bank Clerk, The. + Young Bridge Tender, The. + +#Matthew White, Jr.# + + Adventures of a Young Athlete. + Eric Dane. + Guy Hammersley. + My Mysterious Fortune. + Tour of a Private Car. + Young Editor, The. + +#Gayle Winterton.# + + Young Actor, The. + +#Ernest A. Young.# + + Boats, Bats and Bicycles. + + + + +Splendid Books for Girls. + + + HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED. + + Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:# + + #Breakneck Farm.# + + The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her brothers, on + an old abandoned country place. + + #Jessica Trent.# + + Her Adventures on a Ranch. + + #Jessica, the Heiress.# + + This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published. A Charming + Story. + +#KATE TANNATT WOODS:# + + #A Fair Maid of Marblehead.# + + A book to please both young and old. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +BOYS' OWN LIBRARY + + + Bound in Cloth. + Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Brooks McCormick.# + + Giant Islanders, The. + How He Won. + Nature's Young Noblemen. + Rival Battalions. + +#Walter Morris.# + + Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy. + +#Stanley Norris.# + + Phil, the Showman. + Young Showman's Rivals, The. + Young Showman's Pluck, The. + Young Showman's Triumph, The. + +#Lieut. James K. Orton.# + + Beach Boy Joe. + Last Chance Mine. + Secret Chart, The. + Tom Havens with the White Squadron. + +#James Otis.# + + Chased Through Norway. + Inland Waterways. + Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale. + Unprovoked Mutiny, An. + Wheeling for Fortune. + +#Gilbert Patten.# + + Boy Boomers. + Boy Cattle King. + Boy from the West. + Don Kirk's Mine. + Jud and Joe. + +#St. George Rathborne.# + + Canoe and Camp Fire. + Chums of the Prairie. + Gulf Cruisers, The. + Paddling Under Palmettos. + Rival Canoe Boys. + Shifting Winds. + Sunset Ranch. + Young Range Riders. + +#Arthur Sewell.# + + Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days. + +#Capt. David Southwick.# + + Jack Wheeler. + +#Burt L. Standish.# + + Frank Merriwell's Bravery. + Frank Merriwell Down South. + Frank Merriwell's School Days. + Frank Merriwell's Chums. + Frank Merriwell's Foes. + Frank Merriwell's Trip West. + + + + +The New "Henty" Series. + + + With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS on each book. The + Illustrations are reproductions of paintings representing + scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover design is done in + Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth. These books are all + by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers. + + AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril. + BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden. + BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades. + BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain. + BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604). + BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic. + BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico. + BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War. + CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California. + CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt. + CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars. + DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred. + FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines. + FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia. + FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes. + FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem. + FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England. + GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico. + IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce. + IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy. + IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India. + JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea. + LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century. + LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of + Religion. + LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India. + MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War. + ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo. + ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick. + OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America. + ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers. + STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way. + THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots. + TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence. + UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main. + WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire. + WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War. + WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent. + YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War. + YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal. + YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa. + YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War. + YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria. + + _Any of the above books will be sent postpaid, upon receipt of + price, 50 cents._ + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +Boys' Popular Library. + + + BOUND IN CLOTH. + + An excellent series of books for boys by such popular authors + as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers. + + These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive cover + designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed from large + type, on good paper. Printed wrappers. + + Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Walter Aimwell.# + + Jerry. + Whistler. + +#Horatio Alger, Jr.# + + Brave and Bold. + Only an Irish Boy. + Paul, the Peddler. + Phil, the Fiddler. + Slow and Sure. + Strive and Succeed. + Strong and Steady. + Tom, the Bootblack. + Try and Trust. + +#Z. R. Bennett.# + + Young Vagabond, A. + +#Daniel Defoe.# + + Robinson Crusoe. + +#John De Morgan.# + + Always on Duty. + +#Richard Dowling.# + + Catmur's Cave. + +#George Manville Fenn.# + + In the Wilds of New Mexico. + +#Blanche Willis Howard.# + + Battle and a Boy, A. + +#W. H. G. Kingston.# + + Dick Cheveley. + From Powder Monkey to Admiral. + Hendricks, the Hunter. + Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean. + Peter Trawl. + Peter, the Whaler. + Shore and Ocean. + The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry. + +#Leon Lewis.# + + Diamond Seekers of Brazil. + Kit Carson's Last Trail. + Silver Ship, The. + Young Castaways, The. + +#Montleau & Wyse.# + + Swiss Family Robinson. + +#Alfred Oldfellow.# + + Joe Nichols. + Uncle Nat. + Way to Success. + +#Oliver Optic# + + All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club"). + Boat Club, The. + Little by Little. + Now or Never. + Try Again. + +#Capt. Mayne Reid.# + + Boy Tar, The. + Cliff Climber, The. + Lone Ranch, The. + Ran Away to Sea. + +#Gordon Stables.# + + Cruise of the Snowbird. + Life at Sea. + Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole. + Young Explorer, The. + +#Jefferys Taylor.# + + Boy Crusoes, The. + +#A Wolvertonian.# + + Three Years at Wolverton. + +#Ernest A. Young.# + + Toss Up for Luck. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York. + + + + +Girls' Popular Library. + + + ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH. + + LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers. Very attractive + cover design stamped in colors. Just the books that girls + delight to read--and can read with profit as well as pleasure. + Note the list of Authors--all well-known writers of the best + books for girls. + + Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid. + +#Walter Aimwell.# + + Ella. + Jessie. + Marcus. + +#Mary D. Brine.# + + Echoes from Story Land. + Stories Grandma Told. + +#Alice Carey.# + + Clovernook Children. + Clovernook Tales. Vol. I. + Clovernook Tales. Vol. II. + +#Rosa Nouchette Carey.# + + Averil. + Our Bessie. + +#Cousin Virginia.# + + Cricket's Friends, The. + Dolls' Club, The. + 3 Vols. in 1. + Jo's Doll. + Katy's Christmas. + Patty's Pranks. + +#Lewis Carroll.# + + Alice's Adventures In Wonderland. + Through the Looking-Glass. + +#Maria S. Cummins.# + + Lamplighter, The. + +#Mary A. Denison.# + + Barbara's Triumphs. + Frenchman's Ward, The. + Guardian's Trust, The. + +#Maria Edgeworth.# + + Simple Susan. + +#Juliana Horatia Ewing.# + + Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A. + Great Emergency, A. + Jackanapes. + Jan of the Windmill. + Six to Sixteen. + We and the World. + +#Julia Goddard.# + + Fairy Tales In Other Lands. + +#Virginia F. Townsend.# + + Amy Deane. + While it Was Morning. + + + THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York. + + + + +TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE: All apparent printer's errors retained. + + + + + +End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty + +*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG *** + +***** This file should be named 33939.txt or 33939.zip ***** +This and all associated files of various formats will be found in: + http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/ + +Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed +Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was +produced from images generously made available by The +Internet Archive) + + +Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions +will be renamed. + +Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no +one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation +(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without +permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules, +set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to +copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to +protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project +Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you +charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you +do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the +rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose +such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and +research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do +practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is +subject to the trademark license, especially commercial +redistribution. + + + +*** START: FULL LICENSE *** + +THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE +PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK + +To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free +distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work +(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project +Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project +Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at +http://gutenberg.org/license). + + +Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic works + +1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to +and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property +(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all +the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy +all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession. +If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the +terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or +entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8. + +1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be +used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who +agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few +things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works +even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See +paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement +and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. See paragraph 1.E below. + +1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation" +or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the +collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an +individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are +located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from +copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative +works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg +are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project +Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by +freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of +this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with +the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by +keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project +Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others. + +1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern +what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in +a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check +the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement +before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or +creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project +Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning +the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United +States. + +1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg: + +1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate +access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently +whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the +phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project +Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed, +copied or distributed: + +This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with +almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or +re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included +with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org + +1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived +from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is +posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied +and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees +or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work +with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the +work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 +through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the +Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or +1.E.9. + +1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted +with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution +must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional +terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked +to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the +permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work. + +1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this +work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm. + +1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this +electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without +prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with +active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project +Gutenberg-tm License. + +1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary, +compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any +word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or +distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than +"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version +posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org), +you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a +copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon +request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other +form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm +License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1. + +1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying, +performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works +unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9. + +1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing +access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided +that + +- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from + the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method + you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is + owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he + has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the + Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments + must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you + prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax + returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and + sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the + address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to + the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation." + +- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies + you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he + does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm + License. You must require such a user to return or + destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium + and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of + Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any + money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the + electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days + of receipt of the work. + +- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free + distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works. + +1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm +electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set +forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from +both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael +Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the +Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below. + +1.F. + +1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable +effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread +public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm +collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain +"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or +corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual +property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a +computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by +your equipment. + +1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right +of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project +Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project +Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all +liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal +fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT +LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE +PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE +TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE +LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR +INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH +DAMAGE. + +1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a +defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can +receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a +written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you +received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with +your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with +the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a +refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity +providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to +receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy +is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further +opportunities to fix the problem. + +1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth +in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER +WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO +WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE. + +1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied +warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages. +If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the +law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be +interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by +the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any +provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions. + +1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the +trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone +providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance +with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production, +promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works, +harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees, +that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do +or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm +work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any +Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause. + + +Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm + +Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of +electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers +including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists +because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from +people in all walks of life. + +Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the +assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's +goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will +remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project +Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure +and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations. +To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation +and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4 +and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org. + + +Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive +Foundation + +The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit +501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the +state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal +Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification +number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at +http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent +permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws. + +The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S. +Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered +throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at +809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email +business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact +information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official +page at http://pglaf.org + +For additional contact information: + Dr. Gregory B. Newby + Chief Executive and Director + gbnewby@pglaf.org + + +Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg +Literary Archive Foundation + +Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide +spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of +increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be +freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest +array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations +($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt +status with the IRS. + +The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating +charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United +States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a +considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up +with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations +where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To +SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any +particular state visit http://pglaf.org + +While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we +have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition +against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who +approach us with offers to donate. + +International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make +any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from +outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff. + +Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation +methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other +ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. +To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate + + +Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic +works. + +Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm +concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared +with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project +Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support. + + +Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed +editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S. +unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily +keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition. + + +Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility: + + http://www.gutenberg.org + +This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm, +including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary +Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to +subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks. diff --git a/33939.zip b/33939.zip Binary files differnew file mode 100644 index 0000000..e29dcfd --- /dev/null +++ b/33939.zip diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6312041 --- /dev/null +++ b/LICENSE.txt @@ -0,0 +1,11 @@ +This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements, +metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be +in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES. + +Procedures for determining public domain status are described in +the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org. + +No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in +jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize +this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright +status under the laws that apply to them. diff --git a/README.md b/README.md new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ff79778 --- /dev/null +++ b/README.md @@ -0,0 +1,2 @@ +Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for +eBook #33939 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/33939) |
